OWNER’S MANUAL
Operation
Maintenance
Specifications
All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time
of publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make
changes at any time so that our policy of continual product
improvement may be carried out.
This manual applies to all models of this vehicle and includes
descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard
equipment.
As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not
apply to your specific vehicle.
Introduction
CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO YOUR
HYUNDAI
Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering
the vehicle. Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations
established by the U.S. Department of Transportation and other federal or state
agencies.
7:2ǘ:$<5$',2,167$//$7,21
Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System, Passenger
Occupant Classification System and other CAN bus systems. It is possible for
an improperly installed/adjusted high powered two-way radio to adversely
affect electronic systems. For this reason, we recommend that you carefully
follow the radio manufacturer’s instructions if you choose to install one of these
devices.
F2
SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE WARNING
This manual includes information titled as DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION and
NOTICE.
These titles indicate the following:
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in
death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
F3
HYUNDAI VEHICLE OWNER PRIVACY POLICY
Your Hyundai vehicle may be equipped with technologies and services that use
information collected, generated, recorded or stored by the vehicle. Hyundai
has created a Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy to explain how these technologies
and services collect use and share this information.
You may read our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy on the Hyundaiusa.com website
at: https://www.hyundaiusa.com/owner-privacy-policy.aspx
If you would like to receive a hard copy of our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy,
please contact our Customer Care Center at:
Hyundai Customer Care
P.O. Box 20850
Fountain Valley, CA 92728 800-633-5151
[email protected]
Hyundai’s Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through
Friday,
between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST and Saturday between 6:30
AM and 3:00 PM PST (English).
For Customer Connect Care assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives
are available Monday through Friday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.
Table of contents
Foreword
1
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and
Reporting Safety Defects
2
Seats & Safety System
3
Instrument cluster
4
Convenience features
5
Driving your vehicle
6
Driver assistance system
7
Emergency situations
8
Maintenance
9
Index
I
1. Foreword
Foreword ............................................................................................................ 1-2
Hyundai Motor America .................................................................................... 1-2
Guide to Hyundai Genuine Parts ...................................................................... 1-3
How to Use This Manual ....................................................................................1-4
Safety Messages ................................................................................................1-4
Fuel Requirements ............................................................................................. 1-5
Gasoline Engine ............................................................................................................ 1-5
Vehicle Modifications ........................................................................................ 1-7
Vehicle Break-in Process ................................................................................... 1-7
Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders ........................................1-8
1
Foreword
FOREWORD
Congratulations, and thank you for choosing HYUNDAI. We are pleased to welcome
you to the growing number of discerning people who drive HYUNDAI. We are very
proud of the advanced engineering and high-quality construction of each HYUNDAI
we build.
Your Owner’s Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new
HYUNDAI. To become familiar with your new HYUNDAI, so that you can fully enjoy it,
read this Owner’s Manual carefully before driving your new vehicle.
This manual contains important safety information and instructions intended to
familiarize you with your vehicle’s controls and safety features so you can safely
operate your vehicle.
This manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance safe
operation of the vehicle. It is recommended that all service and maintenance on your
car be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. An authorized HYUNDAI dealer
are prepared to provide high-quality service, maintenance and any other assistance
that may be required.
This Owner’s Manual should be considered a permanent part of your vehicle, and
should be kept in the vehicle so you can refer to it at any time. The manual should stay
with the vehicle if you sell it to provide the next owner with important operating, safety
and maintenance information.
HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA
CAUTION
Severe engine and transmission damage may result from the use of poor quality
fuels and lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications. You must always use
high quality fuels and lubricants that meet the specifications listed on Page 2-14 in
the Vehicle Specifications section of the Owner’s Manual.
Copyright 2022 HYUNDAI Motor America. All rights reserved. No part of this
publication may be reproduced, stored in any retrieval system or transmitted in
any form or by any means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI Motor
America.
1-2
01
GUIDE TO HYUNDAI GENUINE PARTS
1. What are HYUNDAI Genuine Parts?
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are the
same parts used by HYUNDAI Motor
Company to manufacture vehicles.
They are designed and tested for the
optimum safety, performance, and
reliability for our customers.
2. Why Hyundai Genuine Parts?
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are
engineered and built to meet rigid
manufacturing requirements.
Damage caused by using imitation,
counterfeit or used salvage parts is
not covered under the HYUNDAI New
Vehicle Limited Warranty or any other
HYUNDAI warranty.
In addition, any damage to or failure
of HYUNDAI Genuine Parts caused
by the installation or failure of an
imitation, counterfeit or used salvage
part is not covered by any HYUNDAI
Warranty.
3. How can you tell if you are
purchasing HYUNDAI Genuine Parts?
Look for the HYUNDAI Genuine Parts
Logo on the package (see below).
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts exported
to the U.S. are packaged with labels
written only in English.
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are only
sold through authorized HYUNDAI
Dealerships.
1-3
Foreword
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
We want to help you get the greatest possible driving pleasure from your vehicle. Your
Owner’s Manual can assist you in many ways. To gain an overview of the contents
of your Owner’s Manual, use the Table of Contents in the front of the manual. The
first page of each Chapter includes a detailed Table of Contents of the topics in that
Chapter.
To quickly locate information about your vehicle, use the Index in the back of the
manual. It is an alphabetical list of what is in this manual and the page number where it
can be found.
For your convenience, we have incorporated tabs on the right-hand page edges.
These tabs are coded with the Chapter titles to assist you with navigating through the
manual.
SAFETY MESSAGES
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. This Owner’s Manual provides
you with many safety precautions and operating procedures. This information alerts
you to potential hazards that may hurt you or others, as well as damage to your vehicle.
Safety messages found on vehicle labels and in this manual describe these hazards
and what to do to avoid or reduce the risks.
Warnings and instructions contained in this manual are for your safety. Failure to follow
safety warnings and instructions can lead to serious injury or death.
Throughout this manual DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and the SAFETY
ALERT SYMBOL will be used.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to potential physical injury
hazards. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol to avoid possible
injury or death. The safety alert symbol precedes the signal words DANGER,
WARNING and CAUTION.
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, will
result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, could
result in death or serious injury.
1-4
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, could
result in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which,
if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
01
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
Gasoline engine
Unleaded
Your new vehicle is designed to use only unleaded fuel having an octane number
((R+M)/2) of 87 (Research Octane Number 91) or higher. (Do not use methanol blended
fuels)
Your new vehicle is designed to obtain maximum performance with UNLEADED FUEL,
as well as minimize exhaust emissions and spark plug fouling.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the engine and engine components, never add any fuel
system cleaning agents to the fuel tank other than what has been specified.
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for additional information.
WARNING
ś Do not “top off” after the nozzle automatically shuts off when refueling.
ś Always check that the fuel cap is installed securely to prevent fuel spillage in the
event of an accident.
Gasoline containing alcohol and methanol
Gasohol, a mixture of gasoline and ethanol (also known as grain alcohol) are being
marketed along with or instead of leaded or unleaded gasoline. For example, “E15” is a
gasohol comprised of 15% ethanol and 85% gasoline.
Do not use gasohol containing more than 15% ethanol, and do not use gasoline or
gasohol containing any methanol. Either of these fuels may cause drivability problems
and damage to the fuel system, engine control system and emission control system.
Discontinue using gasohol of any kind if drivability problems occur.
“E85” fuel is an alternative fuel comprised of 85 percent ethanol and 15 percent
gasoline, and is manufactured exclusively for use in Flexible Fuel Vehicles. “E85” is
not compatible with your vehicle. Use of “E85” may result in poor engine performance
and damage to your vehicle’s engine and fuel system. HYUNDAI recommends that
customers do not use fuel with an ethanol content exceeding 15 percent.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle’s engine and fuel system:
ś Never use gasohol which contains methanol.
ś Never use gasohol containing more than 15% ethanol.
ś Never use leaded fuel or leaded gasohol.
ś Never use “E85” fuel.
Your New Vehicle Limited Warranty does not cover damage to the fuel system or any
performance problems caused by the use of “E85” fuel.
1-5
Foreword
Using Fuel Additives (except Detergent Fuel Additives)
Using fuel additives such as:
- Silicone fuel additive
- Ferrocene (iron-based) fuel additive
- Other metallic-based fuel additives
May result in cylinder misfire, poor acceleration, engine stalling, damage to the
catalyst, or abnormal corrosion, and may cause damage to the engine resulting in a
reduction in the overall life of the powertrain.
- The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) may illuminate.
NOTICE
Damage to the fuel system or performance problem caused by the use of these fuels
may not be covered by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Gasoline containing MMT
Some gasoline contains harmful manganese-based fuel additives such as MMT
(Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl).
HYUNDAI does not recommend the use of gasoline containing MMT.
This type of fuel can reduce vehicle performance and affect your emission control
system.
The malfunction indicator lamp on the cluster may come on.
Detergent Fuel Additives
HYUNDAI recommends that you use good quality gasolines treated with detergent
additives such as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline, which help prevent deposit formation
in the engine. These gasolines will help the engine run cleaner and enhance
performance of the Emission Control System. For more information on TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline, please go to the website (www. toptiergas.com).
For customers who do not use TOP Tier Detergent Gasoline regularly, and have
problems starting or the engine does not run smoothly, detergent-based fuel additives
that you can purchase separately may be added to the gasoline. If TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline is not available, one bottle of additive added to the fuel tank according to the
maintenance schedule is recommended (refer to the Maintenance Schedule in chapter
9).
Additives are available from your authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information
on how to use them. Do not mix other additives.
Operation in foreign countries
If you are going to drive your vehicle in another country, be sure to:
ś Observe all regulations regarding registration and insurance.
ś Determine that acceptable fuel is available.
1-6
01
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS
ś This vehicle should not be modified. Modification of your vehicle could affect its
performance, safety or durability and may even violate governmental safety and
emissions regulations.
In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from any modification may
not be covered under warranty.
ś If you use unauthorized electronic devices, it may cause the vehicle to operate
abnormally, wire damage, battery discharge and fire. For your safety, we
recommend that you do not use unauthorized electronic devices.
9(+,&/(%5($.ǘ,1352&(66
By following a few simple precautions for the first 600 miles (1,000km) you may add to
the performance, economy and life of your vehicle.
ś Do not race the engine.
ś While driving, avoid sudden acceleration.
ś Do not maintain a single speed for long periods of time, either fast or slow. Varying
engine speed is needed to properly break-in the engine.
ś Avoid hard stops, except in emergencies, to allow the brakes to seat properly.
ś Do not tow a trailer during the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of operation.
ś Fuel economy and engine performance may vary depending on vehicle break-in
process and be stabilized after 4,000 miles (6,000 km). New engines may consume
more oil during the vehicle break-in period.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING
Items contained in motor vehicles or emitted from them are known to the State of
California to cause cancer and birth defects or reproductive harm. These include:
ś Gasoline and its vapors
ś Engine exhaust
ś Used engine oil
ś Interior passenger compartment components and materials
ś Component parts which are subject to heat and wear
In addition, battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead, lead
compounds and other chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer
and reproductive harm.
For more information go to https://www.p65warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle
1-7
Foreword
VEHICLE DATA COLLECTION AND EVENT DATA RECORDERS
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The main purpose of
an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a
vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle
dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:
ś How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
ś Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;
ś How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
ś How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which
crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (for example, name, gender, age, and crash location)
are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the
EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the
vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if
they have access to the vehicle or the EDR.
1-8
2. Vehicle Information,
Consumer Information and
Reporting Safety Defects
Exterior overview (I)...........................................................................................2-2
Exterior overview (II)..........................................................................................2-3
Interior overview .............................................................................................. 2-4
Instrument panel overview (I) .......................................................................... 2-5
Instrument panel overview (II) ......................................................................... 2-6
Engine compartment.........................................................................................2-7
Dimensions........................................................................................................ 2-8
Engine ................................................................................................................ 2-8
Bulb wattage ..................................................................................................... 2-9
Tires and wheels ..............................................................................................2-10
Air conditioning system ....................................................................................2-11
Volume and weight ...........................................................................................2-11
Recommended lubricants and capacities ..................................................... 2-12
Recommended SAE viscosity number ......................................................................2-14
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) .............................................................. 2-15
Vehicle certification label ................................................................................ 2-15
Tire specification and pressure label .............................................................. 2-15
Engine number................................................................................................. 2-16
Refrigerant label .............................................................................................. 2-16
Consumer Information .................................................................................... 2-17
Reporting Safety Defects ................................................................................ 2-18
2
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
(;7(5,2529(59,(:ǣ,Ǥ
Front view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OTM010001
1. Hood ...................................................... 5-67
5. Sunroof .................................................. 5-62
2. Headlight..................................... 5-82, 9-58
6. Front windshield wiper blades .. 5-95, 9-26
3. Tires and wheels ................................... 9-32
7. Windows ............................................... 5-58
4. Side view mirror.................................... 5-55
8. Front ultrasonic sensors ........................7-111
2-2
02
(;7(5,2529(59,(:ǣ,,Ǥ
Rear view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OTM010002
9. Door Handle ...........................................5-32
13. High mounted stop lamp .....................9-63
10. Fuel filler door ........................................ 5-77
14. Rear window wiper blades .........5-96, 9-27
11. Rear combination lamp........................9-60
15. Rear ultrasonic sensors ....................... 7-108
12. Liftgate ..................................................5-68
16. Antenna ................................................ 5-137
17. Rear view camera ................................. 7-88
2-3
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
INTERIOR OVERVIEW
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OTMA020001C
1. Inside door handle.................................5-32
2. Power window switches ...................... 5-58
3. Power window lock button / ...............5-60
Electronic child safety lock button...... 5-36
4. Side view mirror folding button .................5-56
5. Side view mirror control switch .................5-56
6. Central door lock switch ...................... 5-33
7. Instrument panel illumination control
switch ...................................................... 4-5
8. Lane Safety button ................................ 7-19
9. Power Liftgate open/close button ...... 5-70
2-4
10. ESC (Electronic Stability Control) OFF
button .................................................... 6-45
11. EPB (Electronic Parking Brake)
switch .................................................... 6-36
12. Steering wheel ...................................... 5-42
13. Steering wheel tilt/telescopic switch.. 5-43
14. Fuse box ................................................9-48
15. Hood release lever................................ 5-67
16. Seat.......................................................... 3-3
02
,167580(173$1(/29(59,(:ǣ,Ǥ
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OTM010008L
1. Instrument cluster .................................. 4-4
12. DBC (Downhill Brake Control) button...6-49
2. Driver’s front air bag............................. 3-47
13. Parking Safety button.................7-108, 7-111
3. Engine Start/Stop button ....................... 6-9
14. Parking/View button ................... 7-89, 7-92
4. Infotainment system ........................... 5-137
15. Air ventilation seat button ................... 3-20
5. Hazard warning lamp switch ................. 8-2
16. Seat warmer ...........................................3-19
6. Climate control system ..............5-97, 5-105
17. Passenger’s front air bag ..................... 3-47
7. Shift button .................................. 6-15, 6-24
18. Glove box ............................................. 5-122
8. ISG (Idle Stop and Go) button .............. 6-62
19. Wireless charging system pad ............ 5-129
9. Auto Hold button ..................................6-40
20. Cup holder ........................................... 5-124
10. Heated steering wheel button ............. 5-43
21. AC inverter ........................................... 5-127
11. Drive mode button ......................6-67, 6-70
22. USB charger ......................................... 5-127
2-5
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
,167580(173$1(/29(59,(:ǣ,,Ǥ
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OTM010005
1. Lighting control lever ........................... 5-82
5. LCD display control .............................. 4-29
2. Wiper and washer control lever........... 5-93
6. Driving Assist button .............................7-54
3. Voice recognition button ....................5-138
7. Smart cruise control Vehicle Distance
button .....................................................7-54
4. Bluetooth® hands-free phone button....5-139
2-6
02
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OTMA090001/OTMA090015
1. Engine oil filler cap ................................ 9-17
6. Battery terminal [+] .............................. 9-29
2. Engine oil dipstick .................................9-16
7. Battery terminal [-] ............................... 9-29
3. Engine coolant reservoir .......................9-18
8. Air cleaner ............................................. 9-23
4. Windshield washer fluid reservoir ....... 9-22
9. Fuse box ................................................9-48
5. Brake fluid reservoir .............................. 9-21
2-7
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
DIMENSIONS
Items
Overall length
Overall width
Overall height
Tread
Wheelbase
* : if equipped with roof rack
in (mm)
188.4 (4,785)
74.8 (1,900)
2WD
4WD
66.3 (1,685) / 67.3 (1,710)*
67.1 (1,705) / 68.1 (1,730)*
Front
Rear
18’’ / 19’’ : 64.80 (1,646)
18’’ / 19’’ : 65.19 (1,656)
20’’ : 64.44 (1,637)
20’’ : 64.84 (1,647)
108.9 (2,765)
ENGINE
Engine
Smartstream G 2.5 GDI
Smartstream G 2.5 T-GDI
2-8
Displacement
cu. in (cc)
152.4
(2,497)
Bore x Stroke
Firing order No. of cylinders
in. (mm)
3.5 x 4
(88.5 x 101.5)
1-3-4-2
4, in-line
02
BULB WATTAGE
Light bulb
Front
Rear
Interior
High
Headlight
Low
Type A
Daytime running lamp (DRL) /
position lamp
Turn signal lamp
High
Headlight
Low
Low beam assist
Type B
Daytime running lamp (DRL) /
position lamp
Turn signal lamp (Outside mirror)
Turn signal lamp (Outside mirror)
Tail lamp
Type A
Tail/Stop lamp
Tail lamp
Type B
Tail/Stop lamp
Type A
Turn signal lamp
Type B
Reverse lamp
License plate lamp
High mounted stop lamp
Type A
Map lamp
Type B
Room lamp
Personnal lamp
Glove box lamp
Sunvisor lamp
Luggage compartment lamp
Bulb type
LED
LED
Wattage
LED
LED
LED
LED
PY21W
LED
LED
LED
21
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
W5W
P21/5W
LED
LED
PY21W
LED
W16W
W5W
LED
W10W
LED
FESTOON
LED
W5W
FESTOON
FESTOON
LED
LED
5
5/21
LED
LED
21
LED
16
5
LED
10
LED
10
LED
5
5
10
2-9
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
TIRES AND WHEELS
Items
Tire size
Wheel
size
Full size tire
235/60 R18
235/55 R19
255/45 R20
7.5J x 18
7.5J x 19
8.5J x 20
Inflation pressure
kPa (psi)
Normal load
Maximum load
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
240(35)
Wheel bolt
torque
lbf·ft
(kgf·m, N·m)
79~94
(11~13, 107~127)
Compact
T135/90 D17 4.0B x 17
420(60)
spare tire*1
*1 : If your vehicle is not equipped with a compact spare tire, a Tire Mobility Kit will be
provided with your vehicle.
NOTICE
ś It is permissible to add 3 psi to the standard tire pressure specification if colder
temperatures are expected soon.
Tires typically lose 1psi (7kPa) for every 12°F temperature drop. If extreme
temperature variations are expected, recheck your tire pressure as necessary to
keep them properly inflated.
ś Tire inflation pressures will vary with changes in elevation. If driving in areas of
higher or lower elevation, be sure to check and adjust for proper tire inflation.
CAUTION
ś When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle.
Using tires of a different size can damage the related parts or not work properly.
ś When replacing tires, ALWAYS use the same size, type, construction and tread
pattern supplied with the vehicle for all tires.
2-10
02
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Items
Refrigerant
Weight of volume
oz. (g)
R1234yf
Compressor
lubricant
Front
Classification
22.05 (625) ± 0.88 (25)
Front
3.5 (100) ± 0.35 (10)
Front + Rear
7.4 (210) ± 0.35 (10)
R-1234yf
PAG
oz. (g)
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for more details.
VOLUME AND WEIGHT
Items
Gross vehicle weight
lbs. (kg)
Smartstream G2.5 GDi
2WD
4WD
5,137
5,247
(2,330)
(2,380)
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDi
2WD
4WD
5,247
5,357
(2,380)
(2,430)
Luggage volume
Items
SAE
BEHIND 1ST ROW
FXIW Ţ
BEHIND 2ND ROW
5-Seater
72.1 (2,041) ~ *84.6 (2,396)
(*Forward and upright seat position)
36.4 (1,032) ~ *37.9 (1,075)
(*upright seat position)
2-11
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
To help achieve proper engine and powertrain performance and durability, use only
lubricants of the proper quality. The correct lubricants also help promote engine
efficiency that results in improved fuel economy.
These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in your vehicle.
Lubricant
Volume
Engine oil *1
(drain and refill) Smartstream G2.5 GDI
Recommends
Automatic
transmission
fluid
*2 :
6.13 US qt.
Ţ
SAE 0W-30,API SN PLUS/
SP or ILSAC GF-6 *2
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
MICHANG ATF SP-IV,
SK ATF SP-IV,
NOCA ATF SP-IV,
HYUNDAI genuine ATF
SP-IV or other brands
meeting the above
specification approved by
HYUNDAI Motor Co.
6.87 US qt.
Ţ
3.4 ~ 3.6 US qt.
aŢ
GS WDCTF HD G
(GS CALTEX)
Smartstream
G2.5 T-GDI
Control oil
*1 :
SAE 0W-20, API SN PLUS/
SP or ILSAC GF-6 *2
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
Gear oil
Dual clutch
transmission
fluid
Classification
2.58 ~ 2.64 US qt. GS WDCTF HD H
aŢ
(GS CALTEX)
Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers.
Requires API SN PLUS(or Above) grade engine oil. If a lower grade engine oil is used, then
the engine oil and engine oil filter must be replaced at every 5,000 miles.
2-12
02
Lubricant
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
Coolant
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
Brake fluid *3
Rear differential oil (4WD) *4
Volume
Classification
7.5 US qt.
Ţ
8.17 US qt.
Ţ
Mixture of antifreeze and
water (Phosphate-based
Ethylene glycol coolant
for aluminum radiator)
As required
SAE J1704 DOT-4 LV,
FMVSS 116 DOT-4,
ISO4925 CLASS-6
0.56 ~ 0.67 US qt.
aŢ
DCT
0.51 ~ 0.55 US qt.
aŢ
A/T
0.66 ~ 0.72 US qt.
aŢ
Transfer case oil
(4WD)
Fuel
17.7 US gal.
Ţ
HYPOID GEAR OIL API
GL-5, SAE 75W/85
(SK HCT-5 GEAR OIL
75W/85 or EQUIVALENT)
Refer to “Fuel
requirements” in
chapter 1.
DCT : Dual clutch transmission
A/T : Automatic transmission
To maintain the best braking performance and ABS/ESC performance, we recommend
that you use fluid that conform to specifications.
*4 : If the front/rear differential is submerged, visit an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
*3 :
2-13
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Recommended SAE viscosity number
CAUTION
Always be sure to clean the area around any filler plug, drain plug, or dipstick before
checking or draining any lubricant. This is especially important in dusty or sandy
areas and when the vehicle is used on unpaved roads. Cleaning the plug and dipstick
areas will prevent dirt and grit from entering the engine and other mechanisms that
could be damaged.
Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has an effect on fuel economy and cold weather
operating (engine start and engine oil flowability). Lower viscosity engine oils can
provide better fuel economy and cold weather performance, however, higher viscosity
engine oils are required for satisfactory lubrication in hot weather. Using oils of any
viscosity other than those recommended could result in engine damage.
When choosing an oil, consider the range of temperature your vehicle will be operated
in before the next oil change. Proceed to select the recommended oil viscosity from
the chart.
Temperature
Engine Oil *1
*1 :
Temperature Range for SAE Viscosity Numbers
°C
-30
-20 -10
0
10
20
(°F)
Smartstream
G2.5 GDI
Smartstream
G2.5 T-GDI
-10
0
20
40
60
30
80
40
50
100
120
0W-20
0W-30
Requires API SN PLUS(or Above) grade engine oil. If a lower grade engine oil is used, then
the engine oil and engine oil filter must be replaced at every 5,000 miles.
An engine oil displaying this API Certification Mark conforms to
the international Lubricant Specification Advisory Committee
(ILSAC). It is recommended to only use engine oils that uphold
this API Certification Mark.
2-14
02
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
180%(5ǣ9,1Ǥ
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION
LABEL
Frame number
OTMA088011
The vehicle identification number (VIN)
is the number used in registering your
vehicle and in all legal matters pertaining
to its ownership, etc.
The number is punched on the floor
under the passenger seat. To check the
number, open the cover.
OTM010022
The vehicle certification label attached
on the driver’s (or front passenger’s)
side center pillar gives the vehicle
identification number (VIN).
TIRE SPECIFICATION AND
PRESSURE LABEL
VIN label (if equipped)
OTM010023L
The VIN is also on a plate attached to
the top of the left side dashboard. The
number on the plate can easily be seen
through the windshield from outside.
OTM010024L
The tires supplied on your new
vehicle are chosen to provide the best
performance for normal driving.
The tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar gives the tire pressures
recommended for your vehicle.
2-15
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
ENGINE NUMBER
REFRIGERANT LABEL
ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
OTMA010020
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
OTM088005
The refrigerant label provides
information such as refrigerant type and
amount. (R-1234yf)
OTMA011021
The engine number is stamped on the
engine block as shown in the drawing.
2-16
02
CONSUMER INFORMATION
This consumer information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued
by the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.Your HYUNDAI dealer will help answer any questions you may have as
you read this information.
HYUNDAI motor vehicles are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed all
applicable safety standards.
For your safety, however, we strongly urge you to read and follow all directions in
this Owner’s Manual, particularly the information under the headings “NOTICE”,
“CAUTION” and “WARNING”.
If, after reading this manual, you have any questions regarding the operation of your
vehicle, please contact the Hyundai Customer Care Center.
Hyundai Customer Care
P.O. Box 20850
Fountain Valley, CA 92728
800-633-5151
[email protected]
Hyundai’s Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through Friday,
between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST
and Saturday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English).
For Customer Care Center assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are
available Monday through Friday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.
2-17
Vehicle Information, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying
HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);
go to http://www.safercar.gov;
download the SaferCar mobile application;
or write to: Administrator, NHTSA
1200 New Jersey Ave, SE,
West Building Washington, D.C. 20590.
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it
finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and
remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual
problems between you, your dealer, or HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.
2-18
3. Seats & Safety System
This chapter provides you with important information about how to protect yourself and your
passengers. It explains how to properly use your seats and seat belts, and how your air bags work.
Additionally, this chapter explains how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle.
Important safety precautions ...........................................................................3-2
Always wear your seat belt .......................................................................................... 3-2
Restrain all children...................................................................................................... 3-2
Air bag hazards ............................................................................................................. 3-2
Driver distraction .......................................................................................................... 3-2
Control your speed....................................................................................................... 3-2
Keep your vehicle in safe condition ............................................................................ 3-2
Seats .................................................................................................................. 3-3
Safety precautions .......................................................................................................3-4
Front seats ....................................................................................................................3-5
Rear seats ................................................................................................................... 3-10
Head Restraints .......................................................................................................... 3-14
Seat warmers .............................................................................................................. 3-18
Air ventilation seat......................................................................................................3-20
Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) .........................................................................................3-21
Seat belts ......................................................................................................... 3-23
Seat belt safety precautions ...................................................................................... 3-23
Seat belt warning light ...............................................................................................3-24
Seat belt restraint system .......................................................................................... 3-25
Additional seat belt safety precautions .....................................................................3-31
Care of seat belts........................................................................................................3-33
Child Restraint System (CRS) ......................................................................... 3-34
Children Always in the Rear .......................................................................................3-34
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) .................................................................3-35
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS) ................................................................. 3-37
Air bag - supplemental restraint system ....................................................... 3-45
Where are the air bags? .............................................................................................3-47
How does the air bags system operate? .................................................................. 3-50
What to expect after an air bag inflates ...................................................................3-53
Occupant Classification System (OCS) .....................................................................3-54
Why didn’t my air bag go off in a collision? ............................................................. 3-60
SRS care ......................................................................................................................3-65
Additional safety precautions................................................................................... 3-66
Air bag warning labels............................................................................................... 3-66
3
Seats & Safety System
IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
You will find many safety precautions
and recommendations throughout this
section, and throughout this manual.
The safety precautions in this section are
among the most important.
Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all
types of accidents. Air bags are designed
to supplement seat belts, not replace
them. So even though your vehicle is
equipped with air bags, ALWAYS make
sure you and your passengers wear your
seat belts, and wear them properly.
Restrain all children
All children under age 13 should ride
in your vehicle properly restrained in a
rear seat, not the front seat. Infants and
small children should be restrained in
an appropriate Child Restraint System.
Larger children should use a booster
seat with the lap/shoulder belt until they
can use the seat belt properly without a
booster seat.
Drivers can become distracted when
they take their eyes and attention off
the road or their hands off the wheel to
focus on activities other than driving.
To reduce your risk of distraction and an
accident:
ś ALWAYS set up your mobile devices
(for example, MP3 players, phones,
navigation units, etc.) when your
vehicle is parked or safely stopped.
ś ONLY use your mobile device when
allowed by laws and conditions permit
safe use. NEVER text or email while
driving. Most countries have laws
prohibiting drivers from texting. Some
countries and cities also prohibit
drivers from using handheld phones.
ś NEVER let the use of a mobile device
distract you from driving. You have a
responsibility to your passengers and
others on the road to always drive
safely, with your hands on the wheel
as well as your eyes and attention on
the road.
Control your speed
Air bag hazards
While air bags can save lives, they can
also cause serious or fatal injuries to
occupants who sit too close to them, or
who are not properly restrained. Infants,
young children, and short adults are at
the greatest risk of being injured by an
inflating air bag. Follow all instructions
and warnings in this manual.
Driver distraction
Driver distraction presents a serious and
potentially deadly danger, especially for
inexperienced drivers. Safety should be
the first concern when behind the wheel
and drivers need to be aware of the wide
array of potential distractions, such as
drowsiness, reaching for objects, eating,
personal grooming, other passengers,
and using mobile phones.
3-2
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash
injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but
serious injuries can also occur at lower
speeds. Never drive faster than is safe
for current conditions, regardless of the
maximum speed posted.
Keep your vehicle in safe
condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical
failure can be extremely hazardous. To
reduce the possibility of such problems,
check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly
scheduled maintenance.
03
SEATS
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are
applicable to your vehicle.
OTMA030001
Front seat
(1) Forward and rearward
(2) Seatback angle
(3) Seat cushion angle
(4) Seat cushion height
(5) Seat cushion length*
(6) Lumbar support (Driver’s seat)*
(7) Seat warmer*
(8) Air ventilation seat*
(9) Head restraints
2nd row seat
(10) Seatback angle
(11) Head restraints
(12) Seat warmer*
(13) 2nd row seat remote folding switch*
*: if equipped
3-3
Seats & Safety System
Safety precautions
Adjusting the seats so that you are sitting
in a safe and comfortable position plays
an important role for the safety of the
driver and passengers, along with seat
belts and air bags when in an accident.
WARNING
Do not use a cushion that reduces
friction between the seat and the
passenger. The passenger’s hips may
slide under the lap portion of the seat
belt during an accident or a sudden
stop.
Serious or fatal internal injuries could
result because the seat belt cannot
operate properly.
Air bags
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air bag.
Sitting too close to an air bag greatly
increases the risk of injury in the event
the air bag inflates.
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) recommends
that drivers allow at least 10 inches
(25cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and their chest.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating air bag, take the
following precautions:
ś Adjust the driver’s seat as far to the
rear as possible while maintaining
the ability to control the vehicle.
ś Adjust the front passenger seat as far
to the rear as possible.
ś Hold the steering wheel by the rim
with your hands at the 9 o’clock and
3 o’clock positions to minimize the
risk of injuries to your hands and
arms.
ś NEVER place anything or anyone
between you and the air bag.
ś Do not allow the front passenger to
place feet or legs on the dashboard
to minimize the risk of leg injuries.
Seat belts
Always fasten your seat belt before
starting any trip. At all times, passengers
should sit upright and be properly
restrained. Infants and small children
must be restrained in appropriate Child
Restraint Systems. Children who have
outgrown a booster seat and adults must
be restrained using the seat belts.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
adjusting your seat belt:
ś NEVER use one seat belt for more
than one occupant.
ś Always position the seatback upright
with the lap portion of the seat belt
snug and low across the hips.
ś NEVER allow children or small infants
to ride on a passenger’s lap.
ś Do not route the seat belt across your
neck, across sharp edges, or reroute
the shoulder strap away from your
body.
ś Do not allow the seat belt to become
caught or jammed.
3-4
03
Front seats
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
adjusting your seat:
ś NEVER attempt to adjust the seat
while the vehicle is moving. The seat
could respond with unexpected
movement and may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Do not place anything under the
front seats. Loose objects in the
driver’s foot area could interfere
with the operation of the foot pedals,
causing an accident.
ś Do not allow anything to interfere
with the normal position and proper
locking of the seatback.
ś Do not place a cigarette lighter on
the floor or seat. When you operate
the seat, gas may exit out of the
lighter causing a fire.
ś Use extreme caution when picking
up small objects trapped under the
seats or between the seat and the
center console. Your hands might be
cut or injured by the sharp edges of
the seat mechanism.
ś If there are occupants in the rear
seats, be careful while adjusting the
front seat position.
ś Make sure that the seat is locked in
place after the adjustment. If not,
the seat might move unexpectedly
resulting in an accident.
CAUTION
To prevent injury:
ś Do not adjust your seat while
wearing your seat belt. Moving the
seat cushion forward may cause
strong pressure on your abdomen.
ś Do not allow your hands or fingers to
get caught in the seat mechanisms
while the seat is moving.
3-5
Seats & Safety System
Manual adjustment
The front seat can be adjusted by using
the levers located on the outside of
the seat cushion. Before driving, adjust
the seat to the proper position so that
you can easily control the steering
wheel, foot pedals and controls on the
instrument panel.
OTM030039
OTM030038
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Pull up the seat slide adjustment lever
and hold it.
2. Slide the seat to the position you
desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seat is locked in place. Move forward
and rearward without using the lever.
If the seat moves, it is not locked
properly.
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Lean forward slightly and lift up the
seatback lever.
2. Carefully lean back on the seat and
adjust the seatback to the position
you desire.
3. Release the knob and make sure the
seatback is locked in place.
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts
and/or air bags) is greatly reduced by
reclining your seatback.
WARNING
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal
injuries in the event of a collision or
sudden stop.
Drivers and passengers should ALWAYS
sit well back in their seats, properly
belted, and with the seatbacks upright.
3-6
03
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly. When
the seatback is reclined, the shoulder
belt cannot do its job because it will not
be snug against your chest. Instead,
it will be in front of you. During an
accident, you could be thrown into the
seat belt, causing neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder
belt.
Power adjustment (if equipped)
The front seat can be adjusted by using
the control switches located on the
outside of the seat cushion. Before
driving, adjust the seat to the proper
position so that you can easily control
the steering wheel, foot pedals and
controls on the instrument panel.
WARNING
NEVER allow children in the vehicle
unattended. The power seats are
operable when the vehicle is turned off.
NOTICE
OTM030040
Seat cushion height
To change the height of the seat cushion:
ś Push down the lever several times, to
lower the seat cushion.
ś Pull up the lever several times, to raise
the seat cushion.
To prevent damage to the seats:
ś Always stop adjusting the seats when
the seat has been adjusted as far
forward or rearward as possible.
ś Do not adjust the seats longer than
necessary when the vehicle is turned
off. This may result in unnecessary
battery drain.
ś Do not operate two or more seats at
the same time. This may result in an
electrical malfunction.
3-7
Seats & Safety System
OTM030047
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
OTM030050
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seatback
reaches the desired position.
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts and
air bags) is greatly reduced by reclining
your seatback.
WARNING
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal
injuries in the event of a collision or
sudden stop.
Driver and passengers should ALWAYS
sit well back in their seats, properly
belted, and with the seatbacks upright.
3-8
03
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly. When
the seatback is reclined, the shoulder
belt cannot do its job because it will not
be snug against your chest. Instead,
it will be in front of you. During an
accident, you could be thrown into the
seat belt, causing neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder
belt.
Seat cushion extension adjustment
(for driver's seat) (if equipped)
OTM030045
To move the front part of cushion
forward:
1. Push the front part of control switch
to move the seat cushion to the
desired length.
2. Release the switch once the seat
cushion reaches the desired length.
OTM030054
Seat cushion tilt (1)
To change the angle of the front part of
the seat cushion:
Push the front portion of the control
switch up to raise or down to lower the
front part of the seat cushion.
Release the switch once the seat reaches
the desired position.
To move the front part of cushion
rearward:
1. Push the rear part of control switch to
move the seat cushion to the desired
length.
2. Release the switch once the seat
cushion reaches the desired length.
Seat cushion height (2)
To change the height of the seat cushion:
Push the rear portion of the control
switch up to raise or down to lower the
height of the seat cushion.
Release the switch once the seat reaches
the desired position.
3-9
Seats & Safety System
Rear seats
OTM030055
Lumbar support (for driver’s seat, if
equipped)
To adjust the lumbar support:
1. Press the front portion of the switch
(1) to increase support or the rear
portion of the switch (2) to decrease
support.
2. Press switch (3) or (4) to move the
support position up or down.
3. Release the switch once the lumbar
support reaches the desired position.
Seatback pocket
OTM030046
The seatback pocket is provided on the
back of the front seatbacks.
CAUTION
Do not put heavy or sharp objects in the
seatback pockets. In an accident they
could come loose from the pocket and
injure occupants.
3-10
OTM030065
Forward and backward (2nd row seat)
To move the seat forward or backward:
1. Pull the seat slide adjustment lever up
and hold it.
2. Slide the seat to the position you
desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seat is locked in place.
Adjust the seat before driving, and make
sure the seat is locked securely by trying
to move forward and backward without
using the lever. If the seat moves, it is not
locked properly.
03
To fold down the rear seatback:
1. Set the front seatback to the upright
position and if necessary, slide the
front seat forward.
2. Lower the rear head restraints to the
lowest position.
OTM030067
Seatback angle (2nd row seat)
To recline the seatback:
1. Pull up the seatback recline lever.
2. Hold the lever and adjust the seatback
of the seat to the position you desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seatback is locked in place. (The lever
MUST return to its original position for
the seatback to lock.)
OTM030049
3. Route the seat belt webbing through
the rear seat belt guides to prevent
the belts from being trapped behind
or under the seats.
Folding the rear seat
The rear seatbacks can be folded to
facilitate carrying long items or to
increase the luggage capacity of the
vehicle.
WARNING
ś Never allow passengers to sit on top
of the folded down seatback while
the vehicle is moving. This is not a
proper seating position and no seat
belts are available for use. This could
result in serious injury or death in
case of an accident or sudden stop.
ś Objects carried on the folded down
seatback should not extend higher
than the top of the front seatbacks.
This could allow cargo to slide
forward and cause injury or damage
during sudden stops.
3-11
Seats & Safety System
WARNING
OTMPH031001N
4. Pull on the seatback folding lever (2nd
row seat), then fold the seat toward
the front of the vehicle. When you
return the seatback to its upright
position, always be sure it has locked
into position by pushing on the top of
the seatback.
OTM030074
5. To use the rear seat, lift and pull the
seatback backward by pulling the
folding lever or the strap. Pull the
seatback firmly until it clicks into
place. Make sure the seatback is
locked in place.
6. Return the rear seat belt to the proper
position.
3-12
When returning the rear seatback from
a folded to an upright position, hold the
seatback and return it slowly. Ensure
that the seatback is completely locked
into its upright position by pushing on
the top of the seatback. In an accident
or sudden stop, the unlocked seatback
could allow cargo to move forward with
great force and enter the passenger
compartment, which could result in
serious injury or death.
WARNING
Do not place objects in the rear seats,
since they cannot be properly secured
and may hit vehicle occupants in a
collision causing serious injury or death.
03
WARNING
Make sure the engine is off, the shift
button is in P (Park), and the parking
brake is securely applied whenever
loading or unloading cargo. Failure
to take these steps may allow the
vehicle to move if the shift button
is inadvertently moved to another
position.
2nd row seat folding (if equipped)
(from outside)
CAUTION
ś Be careful when loading cargo
through the rear passenger seats
to prevent damage to the vehicle
interior.
ś When cargo is loaded through the
rear passenger seats, ensure the
cargo is properly secured to prevent
it from moving while driving.
WARNING
Cargo should always be secured to
prevent it from being thrown about the
vehicle in a collision and causing injury
to the vehicle occupants. Do not place
objects in the rear seats, since they
cannot be properly secured and may hit
the front seat occupants in a collision.
OTMPH031003N
Push the 2nd row seat back folding
switch (1) located in the right side in the
liftgate. (L : Left seatback folding,
R : Right seatback folding)
WARNING
Rear seat folding
Do not fold the rear seats, if passengers,
pets or luggage are in the rear seats.
It may cause injury or damage to
passengers, pets, luggage.
3-13
Seats & Safety System
Armrest
Head Restraints
The vehicle’s front and rear (second row
and/or third row) seats have adjustable
head restraints. The head restraints
provide comfort for passengers, but
more importantly they are designed to
help protect passengers from whiplash
and other neck and spinal injuries during
an accident, especially in a rear impact
collision.
OTMPH031004N
The armrest is located in the center of
the rear seat. Pull the armrest down from
the seatback to use it.
Rear occupant alert system (2nd
seat)
This function alerts driver when you get
out of a car while the passengers remain
in the 2nd row seat.
If the front door is opened with
passengers in the 2nd row seats, A
warning message will appear in the
instrument cluster. After the 1st warning
if movement is detected in the 2nd row
seat after all doors are locked, a second
audible warning will be triggered.
Even if your vehicle is equipped with
Rear Occupant Alert, always make sure
to check the rear seat before you leave
the vehicle.
For more information, refer to the “Rear
occupant alert system” in chapter 3.
3-14
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death in an accident, take the following
precautions when adjusting your head
restraints:
ś Always properly adjust the head
restraints for all passengers BEFORE
starting the vehicle.
ś NEVER let anyone ride in a seat
with the head restraints removed or
reversed.
OHI039190N
ś Adjust the head restraints so the
middle of the head restraints is at the
same height as the height of the top
of the eyes.
ś NEVER adjust the head restraints
position of the driver’s seat when the
vehicle is in motion.
ś Adjust the head restraints as close to
the passenger’s head as possible. Do
not use a seat cushion that holds the
body away from the seatback.
ś Make sure the head restraints locks
into position after adjusting it.
03
Front seat head restraints
WARNING
OTL035061
When sitting on the rear seat, do not
adjust the height of the head restraints
to the lowest position.
OOSEV038012L
CAUTION
When there is no occupant in the rear
seats, adjust the height of the head
restraints to the lowest position. The
rear seat head restraints can reduce the
visibility of the rear area.
The driver’s and front passenger’s seats
are equipped with adjustable head
restraint for the passengers safety and
comfort.
NOTICE
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or pull
on the head restraints.
OTM030056
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the head restraint:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the head restraint:
1. Push and hold the release button (2)
on the head restraint support.
2. Lower the head restraint to the
desired position (3).
3-15
Seats & Safety System
NOTICE
Type A
OTM030058
OHI038136
Type B
If you recline the seatback towards the
front with the head restraint and seat
cushion raised, the head restraint may
come in contact with the sunvisor or
other parts of the vehicle.
OTM030059
Removal/Reinstall
To remove the head restraint:
1. Recline the seatback (2) with the
seatback angle lever (1).
2. Raise the head restraint as far as it can
go.
3. Press the head restraint release button
(3) while pulling the head restraint up
(4).
WARNING
NEVER allow anyone to travel in a seat
with the head restraint removed.
3-16
03
Rear seat head restraint
Type A
OTM030061
Type B
OOSEV038030L
The rear seats are equipped with head
restraint in all the seating positions for
the passenger’s safety and comfort.
OTM030063
To reinstall the head restraint :
1. Recline the seatback.
2. Put the head restraint poles (2) into
the holes while pressing the release
button (1).
3. Adjust the head restraint to the
appropriate height.
4. Recline the seatback (4) with the
seatback angle lever (3).
WARNING
Always make sure the head restraint
locks into position after reinstalling and
adjusting it properly.
OTMPH031005N
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the head restraint:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the head restraint:
1. Push and hold the release button (2)
on the head restraint support.
2. Lower the head restraint to the
desired position (3).
3-17
Seats & Safety System
Seat warmers (if equipped)
Seat warmers are provided to warm the
seats during cold weather.
During mild weather or under conditions
where the operation of the seat warmer
is not needed, keep the seat warmers
OFF.
WARNING
OTMPH031006N
Removal/Reinstallation
To remove the head restraint:
1. Raise the head restraint as far as it can
go.
2. Press the head restraint release button
(1) while pulling the headrest up (2).
To reinstall the head restraint:
1. Put the head restraint poles into the
holes (3) while pressing the release
button (1).
2. Adjust the head restraint to the
appropriate height.
The seat warmers can cause a SERIOUS
BURN, even at low temperatures and
especially if used for long periods of
time.
Passengers must be able to feel if the
seat is becoming too warm so they can
turn it off, if needed.
People who cannot detect temperature
change or pain to the skin should
use extreme caution, especially the
following types of passengers:
ś Infants, children, elderly or disabled
persons, or hospital outpatients.
ś People with sensitive skin or who
burn easily.
ś Fatigued individuals.
ś Intoxicated individuals.
ś People taking medication that can
cause drowsiness or sleepiness.
WARNING
NEVER place anything on the seat
that insulates against heat when the
seat warmer is in operation, such as a
blanket or seat cushion. This may cause
the seat warmer to overheat, causing a
burn or damage to the seat.
3-18
03
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seat warmers
and seats:
ś Never use a solvent such as paint
thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline
to clean the seats.
ś Do not place heavy or sharp objects
on seats equipped with seat
warmers.
ś Do not change the seat cover. It may
damage the seat warmer.
Front seat
While the engine is running, push either
of the switches to warm the driver's seat
or front passenger's seat.
During mild weather or under conditions
where the operation of the seat warmer
is not needed, keep the switches in the
OFF position.
ś Manual temperature control
Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows:
- Front seat
OFF
LOW (
)
HIGH (
)
MEDIUM (
)
- Rear seat
OFF Ɵ HIGH (
OTM030002
Rear seat
) Ɵ LOW (
)
ś Automatic temperature control
The seat warmer starts to
automatically control the seat
temperature in order to prevent
low-temperature burns after being
manually turned ON.
- Front seat
Ɵ
OFF
ơ
LOW (
+,*+
Ƣ0,1
) Ơ 0(',80
0,1
- Rear seat
OTM030078
OFF Ɵ HIGH (
) Ɵ LOW (
30 MIN
)
If HIGH temperature is manually
selected again, the temperature will
be controlled automatically.
3-19
Seats & Safety System
ś When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the seat warmer
operating, the seat warmer will turn
OFF.
ś The seat warmer defaults to the OFF
position whenever the ignition switch
is ON.
ś Auto Comfort Control (for driver’s
seat) (if equipped)
- The seat warmer automatically
controls the seat temperature
depending on the ambient
temperature and the set climate
control temperature when the
engine is running. If the seat
warmer switch is pushed, the seat
warmer will have to be controlled
manually.
To use this function, it must be
activated from the Settings menu in
the AV/AVN system screen.
- The seat warmer defaults to the
OFF position whenever the ignition
switch is ON. However, if the Auto
Comfort Control function is ON, the
driver’s seat warmer will turn on
and off depending on the ambient
temperature and the set climate
control temperature.
For more details, refer to the separately
supplied Infotainment manual with
your vehicle.
Information
With the seat warmer switch in the ON
position, the heating system in the seat
turns off or on automatically depending on
the seat temperature.
3-20
Air ventilation seat (if equipped)
OTM030003
The air ventilation seats are provided
to cool the front seats by blowing air
through small vent holes on the surface
of the seat cushions and seatbacks.
When the operation of the air ventilation
seat is not needed, keep the switches in
the OFF position.
While the engine is running, push the
switch to cool the driver's seat or the
front passenger's seat (if equipped).
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the air ventilation
seats:
ś Never use a solvent such as paint
thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline
to clean the seats.
ś Avoid spilling liquids on the surface
of the front seats and seatbacks;
this may cause the air vent holes
to become blocked and not work
properly.
ś Do not place materials such as
plastic bags or newspapers under
the seats. They may block the air
intake causing the air vents to not
work properly.
ś Do not change the seat covers. It may
damage the air ventilation seat.
ś If the air vents do not operate, restart
the vehicle. If there is no change,
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
03
ś Each time you push the switch, the
airflow changes as follows:
OFF
LOW (
)
HIGH (
)
MEDIUM (
)
ś When pressing the switch for
more than 1.5 seconds with the
air ventilation seat operating, the
operation will turn OFF.
ś The air ventilation seats defaults
to the OFF position whenever the
ignition switch is placed to the ON
position.
ś Auto Comfort Control (for driver’s
seat) (if equipped)
- The air ventilation seats
automatically controls the seat
temperature depending on the
ambient temperature and the set
climate control temperature when
the engine is running. If the air
ventilation seats switch is pushed,
the air ventilation seats will have to
be controlled manually.
To use this function, it must be
activated from the Settings menu in
the AV/AVN system screen.
- The air ventilation seats defaults
to the OFF position whenever the
ignition switch is ON. However, if
the Auto Comfort Control function
is ON, the air ventilation seats will
turn on and off depending on the
ambient temperature and the set
climate control temperature.
For more details, refer to the separately
supplied Infotainment manual with
your vehicle.
Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) (if
equipped)
Rear Occupant Alert is provided to help
prevent the driver from leaving the
vehicle with the rear passenger left in the
vehicle.
System setting
To use Rear Occupant Alert, it must be
enabled from the Settings menu in the
infotainment system screen. Select:
- 6HWXSƟ9HKLFOH6HWWLQJVƟ
&RQYHQLHQFHƟ5HDU2FFXSDQW$OHUW
For detailed information, scan the QR
code in the separately supplied simple
manual.
System operation
ś First alert
When you open the front door after
opening and closing the rear door and
turning off the engine, the ‘Check rear
seats’ warning message appears on
the cluster.
ś Second alert
After the first alert, the second alert
operates when any movement is
detected in the vehicle after the
driver’s door is closed and all the
doors are locked. The horn will sound
for approximately 25 seconds. If
the system continues to detect a
movement, the alert operates up to 8
times.
Unlock the doors with the smart key
to stop the alert.
ś The system detects movement in the
vehicle for 8 hours after the door is
locked.
ś The second alert is activated only after
the prior activation of the first alert.
3-21
Seats & Safety System
System precautions
WARNING
ś Make sure that all the windows are
closed. If the window is open, the
alert may operate by the sensor
detecting an unintended movement
(for example, wind or bugs).
ś
Cluster
Steering wheel
OTM048165L
ś
ś
ś
ś
ś
ś
OTM050216
If you do not want to use Rear
Occupant Alert, press the OK button
on the steering wheel when the first
alert is displayed on the cluster. Doing
so will deactivate the second alert one
time.
An alert can occur if the there is an
impact on the roof.
If boxes or objects are stacked in the
vehicle, the system may not detect
the boxes or objects. Or, the alert may
operate if the boxes or objects fall off.
The sensor may not operate normally
if the senor is obscured by foreign
substances.
The alert may operate if movement
in the driver or passenger seat is
detected.
The alert may operate with the doors
locked due to car wash or surrounding
vibration or noise.
If the vehicle is started remotely (if
equipped with Remote Start), inside
movement detection will stop.
3-22
Even if your vehicle is equipped with
Rear Occupant Alert, always make sure
to check the rear seat before you leave
the vehicle.
Rear Occupant Alert may not operate
when:
ś Movement does not continue for
a certain period of time or the
movement is small.
ś The rear passenger is covered with
an object such as a blanket.
ś Always be cautious of the
passenger’s safety as the detection
function and second alert may
not operate depending on the
surrounding environment and
certain conditions.
03
SEAT BELTS
This section describes how to use the
seat belts properly. It also describes
some of the things not to do when using
seat belts.
Seat belt safety precautions
Always fasten your seat belt and make
sure all passengers have fastened their
seat belts before starting any trip. Air
bags are designed to supplement the
seat belt as an additional safety device,
but they are not a substitute. Most states
require all occupants of a vehicle to wear
seat belts.
WARNING
Seat belts must be used by ALL
passengers whenever the vehicle is
moving. Take the following precautions
when adjusting and wearing seat belts:
ś Children under the age of 13 should
be properly restrained in the rear
seats.
ś Never allow children to ride in the
front passenger seat, unless the air
bag is deactivated. If a child is seated
in the front passenger seat, move the
seat as far back as possible. And the
child must always be restrained in
the seat properly.
ś NEVER allow an infant or child to be
carried on an occupant’s lap.
ś NEVER ride with the seatback
reclined when the vehicle is moving.
ś Do not allow children to share a seat
or seat belt.
ś Do not wear the shoulder belt under
your arm or behind your back.
ś Never wear a seat belt over fragile
objects. If there is a sudden stop or
impact, the seat belt can damage it.
ś Do not use the seat belt if it is
twisted. A twisted seat belt will not
protect you properly in an accident.
ś Do not use a seat belt if the webbing
or hardware is damaged.
ś Do not latch the seat belt into the
buckles of other seats.
ś NEVER unfasten the seat belt
while driving. This may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Make sure there is nothing in the
buckle interfering with the seat
belt latch mechanism, because any
materials in the buckle can cause the
seat belt not to be fastened securely.
ś No modifications or additions
should be made by the user which
will either prevent the seat belt
adjusting devices from operating to
remove slack, or prevent the seat
belt assembly from being adjusted to
remove slack.
WARNING
Damaged seat belts and seat belt
assemblies will not operate properly.
Always replace:
ś Frayed, contaminated, or damaged
webbing.
ś Damaged hardware.
ś The entire seat belt assembly after it
has been worn in an accident, even
if damage to webbing or assembly is
not apparent.
3-23
Seats & Safety System
Seat belt warning light
Seat belt warning light (for driver’s
seat)
Instrument cluster
Seat belt warning light (for front
passenger’s seat)
As a reminder to the front passenger,
the front passenger’s seat belt warning
lights will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you place the ignition
switch to the ON position regardless of
belt fastening.
If you continue not to fasten the seat belt
and you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h),
the seat belt warning chime will sound
for approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
OTM030004
As a reminder to the driver, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds each time
you place the ignition switch to the ON
position regardless of belt fastening. At
this time, if the seat belt is not fastened a
warning chime will sound for 6 seconds.
If you continue not to fasten the seat belt
and you drive over 6 mph (9 km/h), the
warning light will stay illuminated.
If you continue not to fasten the seat belt
and you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h),
the seat belt warning chime will sound
for approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
If you unfasten the seat belt while driving
under 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt
warning light will illuminate until the seat
belt is fastened.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
3-24
If you unfasten the seat belt while driving
under 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt
warning light will illuminate until the seat
belt is fastened.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
WARNING
Riding in an improper position
adversely affects the front passenger’s
seat belt warning system. It is important
for the driver to instruct the passenger
to be seated properly as instructed in
this manual.
Information
ś Although the front passenger seat is not
occupied, the seat belt warning light
will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.
ś The front passenger’s seat belt warning
may operate when luggage is placed on
the front passenger seat.
03
Front Seat Belt – Driver’s 3point
system with emergency locking
retractor
Seat belt restraint system
WARNING
OHI038140
OHI038182L
Improperly positioned seat belts may
increase the risk of serious injury
in an accident. Take the following
precautions when adjusting the seat
belt:
ś Position the lap portion of the seat
belt as low as possible across your
hips, not on your waist, so that it
fits snugly. This allows your strong
pelvic bones to absorb the force of
the crash, reducing the chance of
internal injuries.
ś Position one arm under the shoulder
belt and the other over the belt, as
shown in the illustration.
ś Always position the shoulder belt
anchor into the locked position at the
appropriate height.
ś Never position the shoulder belt
across your neck or face.
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull it out of the retractor and insert the
metal tab (1) into the buckle (2). There
will be an audible “click” when the tab
locks into the buckle.
OHI038137
You should place the lap belt (1) portion
across your hips and the shoulder belt (2)
portion across your chest.
The seat belt automatically adjusts to the
proper length after the lap belt portion
is adjusted manually so that it fits snugly
around your hips. If you lean forward in
a slow, easy motion, the belt will extend
and move with you.
If there is a sudden stop or impact, the
belt will lock into position. It will also lock
if you try to lean forward too quickly.
3-25
Seats & Safety System
Information
If you are not able to smoothly pull
enough of the seat belt out from the
retractor, firmly pull the seat belt out and
release it. After release, you will be able to
pull the belt out smoothly.
Height adjustment
You can adjust the height of the shoulder
belt anchor to one of the four different
positions for maximum comfort and
safety.
The shoulder portion should be adjusted
so it lies across your chest and midway
over your shoulder nearest the door, not
over your neck.
Front seat
OTM030079
To adjust the height of the seat belt
anchor, lower or raise the height adjuster
into an appropriate position.
To raise the height adjuster, pull it up
(1). To lower it, push it down (3) while
pressing the height adjuster button (2).
Release the button to lock the anchor
into position. Try sliding the height
adjuster to make sure that it has locked
into position.
3-26
OHI038142
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the locking
buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen, check
the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then
try again.
03
Rear Seat Belt – Passenger’s 3point
system with convertible locking
retractor
This type of seat belt combines the
features of both an emergency locking
retractor seat belt and an automatic
locking retractor seat belt. Convertible
retractor type seat belts are installed
in the rear seat positions to help
accommodate the installation of child
restraint systems. Although a convertible
retractor is also installed in the front
passenger seat position, NEVER place
any infant/child restraint system in the
front seat of the vehicle.
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull the seat belt out of the retractor
and insert the metal tab into the buckle.
There will be an audible “click” when
the tab locks into the buckle. When
not securing a child restraint, the seat
belt operates in the same way as the
driver’s seat belt (Emergency Locking
Retractor Type). It automatically adjusts
to the proper length only after the lap
belt portion of the seat belt is adjusted
manually so that it fits snugly across your
hips.
When the seat belt is fully extended from
the retractor to allow the installation of
a child restraint system, the seat belt
operation changes to allow the belt to
retract, but not to extend (Automatic
Locking Retractor Type). Refer to the
“Using a Child Restraint System” section
in this chapter.
OHI038142
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the locking
buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen, check
the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then
try again.
NOTICE
Although the seat belt retractor provides
the same level of protection for seated
passengers in either emergency
or automatic locking modes, the
emergency locking mode allows seated
passengers to move freely in their seat
while keeping some tension on the belt.
During a collision or sudden stop, the
retractor automatically locks the belt to
help restrain your body.
To deactivate the automatic locking
mode, unbuckle the seat belt and allow
the belt to fully retract.
3-27
Seats & Safety System
Second row center seatbelt
(3-point rear center seat belt)
Stowing the rear seat belt
OTM030022
OTM038041
1. Insert the tongue plate (1) into the
buckle (2) until an audible “click" is
heard, indicating the latch is locked.
Make sure the belt is not twisted.
When using the rear center seat belt, the
buckle with the “CENTER” mark must be
used.
ś The rear seat belt buckles can be
stowed in the pocket between the
rear seatback and cushion when not
in use.
Rear seat
Information
If you are not able to pull out the safety
belt from the retractor, firmly pull the belt
out and release it. After release, you will be
able to pull the belt out smoothly.
OTM030024
WARNING
Make sure that the seatback is locked in
place when using the rear center seat
belt.
If not, the seatback may move when
there is a sudden stop or collision,
which could result in serious injury.
ś Routing the seat belt webbing through
the rear seat belt guides will help keep
the belts from being trapped behind
or under the seats.
After inserting the seat belt, tighten
the belt webbing by pulling it up.
CAUTION
When using the seat belt, use it after
taking it out of the guides.
If you pull the seat belt when it is stored
in the guides, it may damage the guides
and/or belt webbing.
3-28
03
Pre-tensioner seat belt
OTL035053
Your vehicle is equipped with driver’s
and front passenger’s Pre-tensioner
Seat Belts(Retractor Pretensioner and
Emergency Fastening Device System).
The purpose of the pre-tensioner is
to make sure the seat belts fit tightly
against the occupant’s body in
certain frontal or side collision(s). The
Emergency Fastening Device System
may be activated in certain crashes
where the frontal collision(s) is severe
enough, together with the air bags.
(1) Retractor Pretensioner
The purpose of the retractor pretensioner is to make sure that the
shoulder belts fit in tightly against the
occupant’s upper body in certain frontal
or side collision(s).
(2) Emergency Fastening Device System
The purpose of the Emergency Fastening
Device System is to make sure that
the pelvis belts fit in tightly against the
occupant’s lower body in certain frontal
collision(s).
If the system senses excessive tension
on the driver or passenger’s seat belt
when the pre-tensioner system activates,
the load limiter inside the retractor
pre-tensioner will release some of the
pressure on the affected seat belt.
When the vehicle stops suddenly, or
if the occupant tries to lean forward
too quickly, the seat belt retractor will
lock into position. In certain frontal or
side collision(s), the pre-tensioner will
activate and pull the seat belt into tighter
contact against the occupant’s body.
3-29
Seats & Safety System
WARNING
ś Always wear your seat belt and sit
properly in your seat.
ś Do not use the seat belt if it is loose
or twisted. A loose or twisted seat
belt will not protect you properly in
an accident.
ś Do not place anything near the
buckle. This may adversely affect
the buckle and cause it to function
improperly.
ś Always replace your pre-tensioners
after activation or an accident.
ś NEVER inspect, service, repair
or replace the pre-tensioners by
yourself. Have the pre-tensioners
inspected, serviced, repaired or
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Do not hit the seat belt assemblies.
WARNING
Do not touch the pre-tensioner seat
belt assemblies for several minutes
after they have been activated. When
the pre-tensioner seat belt mechanism
deploys during a collision, the pretensioner can become hot and can burn
you.
CAUTION
Body work on the front area of the
vehicle may damage the pre-tensioner
seat belt system. Therefore, have the
system to be serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
3-30
OLMB033040
The Pre-Tensioner Seat Belt System
consists mainly of the following
components. Their locations are shown
in the illustration above:
(1) SRS air bag warning light
(2) Retractor pre-tensioner
(3) SRS control module
(4) Emergency fastening device
03
NOTICE
The sensor that activates the SRS
control module is connected with the
pre–tensioner seat belts. The SRS air
bag warning light on the instrument
cluster will illuminate for approximately
3~6 seconds after the Engine Start/Stop
button is in the ON position, and then it
should turn off.
If the pre-tensioner is not working
properly, the warning light will
illuminate even if the SRS air bag is not
malfunctioning. If the warning light
does not illuminate, stays illuminated
or illuminates when the vehicle is being
driven, have the pre-tensioner seat
belts and/or SRS control module be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
Information
ś Pre-tensioner seat belts may be
activated in certain frontal or side
collisions or rollover situations (if
equipped with rollover sensor).
ś When the pre-tensioner seat belts are
activated, a loud noise may be heard
and fine dust, which may appear to be
smoke, may be visible in the passenger
compartment. These are normal
operating conditions and are not
hazardous.
ś Although it is non-toxic, the fine dust
may cause skin irritation and should
not be inhaled for prolonged periods.
Wash all exposed skin areas thoroughly
after an accident in which the pretensioner seat belts were activated.
Additional seat belt safety
precautions
Seat belt use during pregnancy
The seat belt should always be used
during pregnancy. The best way to
protect your unborn child is to protect
yourself by always wearing the seat belt.
Pregnant women should always wear
a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the
shoulder belt across your chest, routed
between your breasts and away from
your neck. Place the lap belt below your
belly so that it fits SNUGLY across your
hips and pelvic bone, under the rounded
part of the belly.
WARNING
ś Pregnant women and patients are
more vulnerable to any impacts on
the abdomen during an abrupt stop
or accident. If you are in an accident
while pregnant, consult your doctor.
ś To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to an unborn child during an
accident, pregnant women should
NEVER place the lap portion of the
seat belt above or over the area of
the abdomen where the unborn child
is located.
Seat belt use and children
Infant and small children
Most countries have Child Restraint
System laws which require children to
travel in approved Child Restraint System
devices, including booster seats. The age
at which seat belts can be used instead
of Child Restraint System differs among
countries, so you should be aware of the
specific requirements in your country,
and where you are travelling. Infant and
Child Restraint System must be properly
placed and installed in a rear seat.
For more information refer to the “Child
Restraint Systems” section in this
chapter.
3-31
Seats & Safety System
WARNING
ALWAYS properly restrain infants and
small children in a Child Restraint
System appropriate for the child’s
height and weight.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to a child and other passengers,
NEVER hold a child in your lap or arms
when the vehicle is moving. The violent
forces created during an accident will
tear the child from your arms and throw
the child against the interior of the
vehicle.
Small children are best protected from
injury in an accident when properly
restrained in the rear seat by a Child
Restraint System that meets the
requirements of the Safety Standards of
your country. Before buying any Child
Restraint System, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets Safety
Standard of your country.
The Child Restraint System must be
appropriate for your child’s height and
weight. Check the label on the Child
Restraint System for this information.
Refer to “Child Restraint Systems”
section in this chapter.
Larger children
Children under age 13 and who are
too large for a booster seat should
always occupy the rear seat and use the
available lap/shoulder belts. A seat belt
should lie across the upper thighs and
be snug across the shoulder and chest
to restrain the child safely. Check belt fit
periodically. A child’s squirming could
put the belt out of position. In the event
of an accident, children are afforded the
best safety restrained by a proper Child
Restraint System in the rear seats.
If a larger child over age 13 must be
seated in the front seat, the child must
be securely restrained by the available
lap/shoulder belt and the seat should be
placed in the rearmost position.
If the shoulder belt portion slightly
touches the child’s neck or face, try
placing the child closer to the center
of the vehicle. If the shoulder belt still
touches their face or neck, they need to
be returned to an appropriate booster
seat in the rear seat.
WARNING
ś Always make sure larger children’s
seat belts are worn and properly
adjusted.
ś NEVER allow the shoulder belt to
contact the child’s neck or face.
ś Do not allow more than one child to
use a single seat belt.
Seat belt use and injured people
A seat belt should be used when an
injured person is being transported.
Consult a physician for specific
recommendations.
3-32
03
One person per belt
Care of seat belts
Two people (including children) should
never attempt to use a single seat belt.
This could increase the severity of
injuries in case of an accident.
Seat belt systems should never be
disassembled or modified. In addition,
care should be taken to assure that seat
belts and belt hardware are not damaged
by seat hinges, doors or other abuse.
Do not lie down
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts
and/or air bags) is greatly reduced by
reclining your seatback.
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly.
During an accident, you could be thrown
into the seat belt, causing neck or other
injuries.
The more the seat back is reclined, the
greater the chance for the passenger’s
hips to slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck to strike the shoulder
belt.
WARNING
ś NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
ś Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious
or fatal injuries in the event of a
collision or sudden stop.
ś Driver and passengers should always
sit well back in their seats with the
seatbacks upright and should be
belted properly.
Periodic inspection
All seat belts should be inspected
periodically for wear or damage of any
kind. Any damaged parts should be
replaced as soon as possible.
Keep belts clean and dry
Seat belts should be kept clean and
dry. If belts become dirty, they can be
cleaned by using a mild soap solution
and warm water. Bleach, dye, strong
detergents or abrasives should not be
used because they may damage and
weaken the fabric.
When to replace seat belts
The entire seat belt assembly or
assemblies should be replaced if the
vehicle has been involved in an accident.
This should be done even if no damage is
visible. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
3-33
Seats & Safety System
&+,/'5(675$,176<67(0ǣ&56Ǥ
Children Always in the Rear
WARNING
Always properly restrain children in the
vehicle. Children of all ages are safer
when restrained in the rear seat. A child
riding in the front passenger seat can
be forcefully struck by an inflating air
bag resulting in SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH.
Children under age 13 should always
ride in the rear seats and must always be
properly restrained to minimize the risk
of injury in an accident, sudden stop or
sudden maneuver.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in the
rear seats than in the front seat. Even
with air bags, children can be seriously
injured or killed. Children too large for a
Child Restraint System must use the seat
belts provided.
All 50 states have child restraint laws
which require children to travel in
approved Child Restraint Systems.
The laws governing the age or height/
weight restrictions at which seat belts
can be used instead of Child Restraint
System differs among states, so
you should be aware of the specific
requirements in your country, and where
you are travelling.
Child Restraint Systems must be properly
placed and installed in the rear seat.
You must use a commercially available
Child Restraint System that meets the
requirements of the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS 213).
Child Restraint Systems are generally
designed to be secured in a vehicle seat
by lap belt portion of a lap/shoulder belt,
or by a LATCH system in the rear seats of
the vehicle.
3-34
Child Restraint System (CRS)
Infants and younger children must be
restrained in an appropriate rearwardfacing or forward-facing CRS that has
first been properly secured to the seat
of the vehicle. Read and comply with
the instructions for installation and use
provided by the manufacturer of the
Child Restraint System.
WARNING
An improperly secured child restraint
can increase the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH in an accident. Always
take the following precautions when
using a Child Restraint System:
ś NEVER install a child or infant
restraint in the front passenger's
seat.
ś Always properly secure the child
restraint to a rear seat of the vehicle.
ś Always follow the child restraint
system manufacturer's instructions
for installation and use.
ś Always properly restrain your child in
the child restraint.
ś If the vehicle head restraint prevents
proper installation of a child seat
(as described in the child restraint
system manual), the head restraint of
the respective seating position shall
be readjusted or entirely removed.
ś Do not use an infant carrier or a
child safety seat that "hooks" over
a seatback, it may not provide
adequate protection in an accident.
ś After an accident, have an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer check the child
restraint system, seat belts, tether
anchors and lower anchors.
03
Selecting a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
When selecting a Child Restraint System
for your child, always:
ś Make sure the Child Restraint System
has a label certifying that it meets
applicable Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standards (FMVSS 213).
ś Select a Child Restraint System based
on your child’s height and weight. The
required label or the instructions for
use typically provide this information.
ś Select a Child Restraint System that
fits the vehicle seating position where
it will be used.
ś Read and comply with the warnings
and instructions for installation and
use provided with the Child Restraint
System.
Child Restraint System types
There are three main types of Child
Restraint Systems: rearward-facing,
forward-facing and booster Child
Restraint Systems.
They are classified according to the
child’s age, height and weight.
OTM030026
Rearward-facing Child Restraint System
A rearward-facing Child Restraint System
provides restraint with the seating
surface against the back of the child. The
harness system holds the child in place,
and in an accident, acts to keep the child
positioned in the Child Restraint Systems
and reduce the stress to the fragile neck
and spinal cord.
All children under the age of one year
must always ride in a rearward-facing
Child Restraint System. Convertible and
3-in-1 Child Restraint Systems typically
have higher height and weight limits for
the rearward-facing position, allowing
you to keep your child rearward-facing
for a longer period of time.
Keep using Child Restraint Systems in
the rearward-facing position as long as
children fit within the height and weight
limits allowed by the Child Restraint
System’s manufacturer.
Continue using Child Restraint Systems
in the rearward-facing position as long as
children fit within the height and weight
limits allowed by the Child Restraint
System’s manufacturer. It's the best way
to keep them safe. Once your child has
outgrown the rearward-facing Child
Restraint System, your child is ready for
a forward-facing Child Restraint System
with a harness.
3-35
Seats & Safety System
WARNING
NEVER install a child or infant restraint
in the front passenger's seat.
Placing a rearward-facing child restraint
in the front seat can result in SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH if the child restraint is
struck by an inflating air bag.
OTM030062
Forward-facing Child Restraint System
A forward-facing Child Restraint System
provides restraint for the child’s body
with a harness. Keep children in a
forward-facing Child Restraint System
with a harness until they reach the top
height or weight limit allowed by your
Child Restraint System’s manufacturer.
Once your child outgrows the forwardfacing Child Restraint System, your child
is ready for a booster seat.
Booster seats
A booster seat is a Child Restraint
System designed to improve the fit of
the vehicle’s seat belt system. A booster
seat positions the seat belt so that it
fits properly over the stronger parts of
your child’s body. Keep your children in
booster seats until they are big enough
to fit in a seat belt properly.
For a seat belt to fit properly, the lap belt
must lie comfortable across the upper
thighs, not the stomach. The shoulder
belt should lie comfortable across the
shoulder and chest and not across the
neck or face. Children under age 13
must always be properly restrained to
minimize the risk of injury in an accident,
sudden stop or sudden maneuver.
3-36
03
Installing a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
WARNING
Before installing your Child Restraint
System always:
Read and follow the instructions
provided by the manufacturer of the
Child Restraint System.
Failure to follow all warnings and
instructions could increase the risk of
the SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH if an
accident occurs.
WARNING
If the vehicle head restraint prevents
proper installation of a Child Restraint
System, the head restraint of the
respective seating position shall be
readjusted or entirely removed.
After selecting a proper Child Restraint
System for your child and checking that
the Child Restraint System fits properly
on the seating position, there are three
general steps for a proper installation:
ś Properly secure the Child Restraint
System to the vehicle. All Child
Restraint Systems must be secured
to the vehicle with the lap belt or
lap part of a lap/shoulder part of a
lap/shoulder belt or with the LATCH
system.
ś Make sure the Child Restraint System
is firmly secured. After installing a
Child Restraint System to the vehicle,
push and pull the seat forward and
from side-to-side to verify that it is
securely attached to the seat. A Child
Restraint System secured with a seat
belt should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, some side-to-side
movement can be expected.
When installing a Child Restraint
System, adjust the vehicle seat and
seatback (up and down, forward
and rearward) so that your child fits
in the Child Restraint System in a
comfortable manner.
ś Secure the child in the Child
Restraint System. Make sure the
child is properly strapped in the Child
Restraint System according to the
Child Restraint System manufacturer’s
instructions.
CAUTION
A Child Restraint System in a closed
vehicle can become very hot. To prevent
burns, check the seating surface and
buckles before placing your child in the
Child Restraint System.
3-37
Seats & Safety System
Lower Anchors and Tether for
Children (LATCH System)
The LATCH system holds a Child
Restraint System during driving and in
an accident. This system is designed
to make installation of the Child
Restraint System easier and reduce
the possibility of improperly installing
your Child Restraint System. The LATCH
system uses anchors in the vehicle and
attachments on the Child Restraint
System. The LATCH system eliminates
the need to use seat belts to secure the
Child Restraint System to the rear seats.
Lower anchors are metal bars built into
the vehicle. There are two lower anchors
for each LATCH seating position that will
accommodate a Child Restraint System
with lower attachments.
To use the LATCH system in your vehicle,
you must have a Child Restraint System
with LATCH attachments.
The Child Restraint System manufacturer
will provide you with instructions on how
to use the Child Restraint System with its
attachments for the LATCH anchorages.
3-38
OOSEV038012
LATCH anchors have been provided in
the left and right outboard rear seating
positions. Their locations are shown in
the illustration. There are not LATCH
anchors provided for the center rear
seating position.
WARNING
Do not attempt to install a Child
Restraint System using LATCH anchors
in the rear center seating position.
There are no LATCH anchors provided
for this seat. Using the outboard seat
anchors can damage the anchors which
may break or fail in a collision resulting
in serious injury or death.
03
Securing a Child Restraint System
with the “LATCH Anchors System”
Rear passenger seat
OTM030012
[A] : Lower Anchor Position Indicator
(Type A,Type B),
[B] : Lower Anchor
The lower anchor position indicator
symbols are located on the left and right
rear seat backs to identify the position
of the lower anchors in your vehicle (see
arrows in illustration).
The LATCH anchors are located between
the seatback and the seat cushion of the
rear seat left and right outboard seating
positions.
To install a LATCH-compatible Child
Restraint System in either of the rear
outboard seating positions:
1. Move the seat belt buckle away from
the lower anchors.
2. Move any other objects away from
the anchorages that could prevent
a secure connection between the
Child Restraint System and the lower
anchors.
3. Place the Child Restraint System on
the vehicle seat, then attach the seat
to the lower anchors according to the
instructions provided by the Child
Restraint System manufacturer.
4. Follow the instructions of the Child
Restraint System’s manufacturer for
proper installation and connection of
the lower attachments on the Child
Restraint System to the lower anchors.
WARNING
Before installing the Child Restraint
System, make sure that there are no
objects (for example, toy, pen, wire)
around the lower anchor area. Those
objects may damage either the seat belt
system or the Child Restraint System
during the installment procedure. If
necessary, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3-39
Seats & Safety System
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the LATCH system:
ś Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your Child
Restraint System.
ś To prevent the child from reaching
and taking hold of unretracted
seat belts, buckle all unused rear
seat belts and retract the seat belt
webbing behind the child. Children
can be strangled if a shoulder belt
becomes wrapped around their neck
and the seat belt tightens.
ś NEVER attach more than one
Child Restraint System to a single
anchorage. This could cause the
anchor or attachment to come loose
or break.
ś Always have the LATCH system
inspected by your dealer after an
accident. An accident can damage
the LATCH system and may not
properly secure the Child Restraint
System.
NOTICE
The recommended weight for the
LATCH system is under 65 lb. (30 kg).
How to determine an appropriate child
restraint weight: Child weight + Child
restraint weight < 65 lb. (30kg)
3-40
Securing a Child Restraint System
seat with “Tether Anchor” system
OTMPH031002N
First secure the child restraint with
the LATCH lower anchors or the seat
belt. If the child restraint manufacturer
recommends that the top tether strap
be attached, attach and tighten the
top tether strap to the top tether strap
anchor.
Child restraint hook holders are located
on the rear of the seatbacks.
03
WARNING
OTMPH031010N
To install the tether anchor:
1. Route the Child Restraint System
top-tether strap over the seatback.
Route the tether strap under the
head restraint and between the head
restraint posts, or route the tether
strap over the top of the vehicle
seatback. Make sure the strap is not
twisted.
2. Connect the tether strap hook to
the tether anchor, then tighten the
top-tether strap according to the
instructions of your Child Restraint
System’s manufacturer to firmly
attach the Child Restraint System to
the seat.
3. Check that the Child Restraint System
is securely attached to the seat by
pushing and pulling the seat forwardand-back and side-to-side.
Take the following precautions when
installing the top-tether:
ś Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your Child
Restraint System.
ś NEVER attach more than one
Child Restraint System to a single
tether anchor. This could cause the
anchorage or attachment to come
loose or break.
ś Do not attach the tether strap to
anything other than the correct
top-tether anchor. It may not work
properly if attached to something
else.
ś Child Restraint System anchors are
designed to withstand only those
loads imposed by correctly fitted
Child Restraint System.
Do not use them for adult seat belts,
harnesses, or for attaching other
items or equipment to the vehicle.
3-41
Seats & Safety System
Securing a Child Restraint System
with a lap/shoulder belt
WARNING
ALWAYS place a rearward-facing Child
Restraint System in the rear seat of the
vehicle.
Placing a rearward-facing child restraint
in the front seat can result in serious
injury or death if the Child Restraint
System is struck by an inflating air bag.
When not using the LATCH system, all
Child Restraint Systems must be secured
to a rear seat with the lap part of a lap/
shoulder belt.
OHI038145
Automatic locking mode
Since all passenger seat belts move
freely under normal conditions and
only lock under extreme or emergency
conditions (emergency locking mode),
you must manually pull the seat belt all
the way out to shift the retractor to the
"Automatic Locking" mode to secure a
Child Restraint System.
The "Automatic Locking" mode will help
prevent the normal movement of the
child in the vehicle from causing the
seat belt to loosen and compromise
the Child Restraint System. To secure a
Child Restraint System, use the following
procedure.
To install a Child Restraint System on the
rear seats, do the following:
1. Place the Child Restraint System on a
rear seat and route the lap/shoulder
belt around or through the Child
Restraint System, following the Child
Restraint System manufacturer’s
instructions. Make sure the seat belt
webbing is not twisted.
Information
When using the rear center seat belt, you
should also refer to the "Rear Seat Belt –
Passenger's 3-point system" section in this
chapter.
3-42
03
OHI038146
2. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch
into the buckle. Listen for the distinct
“click” sound.
Information
Position the release button so that it is easy
to access in case of an emergency.
OHI038147
3. Pull the shoulder portion of the
seat belt all the way out. When the
shoulder portion of the seat belt
is fully extended, it will shift the
retractor to the "Automatic Locking"
(child restraint) mode.
OHI038148
4. Slowly allow the shoulder portion of
the seat belt to retract and listen for
an audible "clicking" or "ratcheting"
sound. This indicates that the retractor
is in the "Automatic Locking" mode.
If no distinct sound is heard, repeat
steps 3 and 4.
5. Remove as much slack from the belt
as possible by pushing down on the
Child Restraint System while feeding
the shoulder belt back into the
retractor.
6. Push and pull on the Child Restraint
System to confirm that the seat belt
is holding it firmly in place. If it is not,
release the seat belt and repeat steps
2 through 6.
7. Double check that the retractor is in
the "Automatic Locking" mode by
attempting to pull more of the seat
belt out of the retractor. If you cannot,
the retractor is in the "Automatic
Locking" mode.
If your Child Restraint System
manufacturer instructs or recommends
you to use a tether anchor with the lap/
shoulder belt, refer to the previous pages
for more information.
3-43
Seats & Safety System
Information
When the seat belt is allowed to retract to
its fully stowed position, the retractor will
automatically switch from the “Automatic
Locking” mode to the emergency lock
mode for normal adult usage.
WARNING
If the retractor is not in the “Automatic
Locking” mode, the child restraint
can move when your vehicle turns or
stops suddenly. A child can be seriously
injured or killed if the child restraint
is not properly anchored in the car,
including manually pulling the seat belt
all the way out to shift the retractor to
the “Automatic Locking” mode.
To remove the Child Restraint System,
press the release button on the buckle
and then pull the lap/shoulder belt out of
the Child Restraint System and allow the
seat belt to retract fully.
WARNING
If a child restraint is installed in the
second row center seat, move the
second row seat far back as possible, to
minimize contact with the front center
air bag.
3-44
03
$,5%$*ǘ6833/(0(17$/5(675$,176<67(0
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OTMPH031011N
1.
2.
3.
4.
Driver’s front air bag
Passenger’s front air bag
Side air bag
Curtain air bag
3-45
Seats & Safety System
The vehicles are equipped with a Supplemental Air Bag System for the driver’s seat and
front passenger’s seats.
The front air bags are designed to supplement the three-point seat belts. For these air
bags to provide protection, the seat belts must be worn at all times when driving.
You can be severely injured or killed in an accident if you are not wearing a seat belt.
Air bags are designed to supplement seat belts, but do not replace them. Also, air bags
are not designed to deploy in every collision. In some accidents, the seat belts are the
only restraint protecting you.
WARNING
AIR BAG SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
ALWAYS use seat belts Child Restraint Systems - every trip, every time, everyone!
Even with air bags, you can be seriously injured or killed in a collision if you are
improperly belted or not wearing your seat belt when the air bag inflates.
NEVER place a child in any Child Restraint System or booster seat in the front
passenger seat, unless the air bag is deactivated.
An inflating air bag could forcefully strike the infant or child causing serious or fatal
injuries.
ABC - Always Buckle Children under age 13 in the back seat. It is the safest place
for children of any age to ride. If a child age 13 or older must be seated in the front
seat, he or she must be properly belted and the seat should be moved as far back as
possible.
All occupants should sit upright with the seatback in an upright position, centered
on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs comfortably extended and their feet
on the floor until the vehicle is parked and the vehicle is turned off. If an occupant
is out of position during an accident, the rapidly deploying air bag may forcefully
contact the occupant causing serious or fatal injuries.
You and your passengers should never sit or lean unnecessarily close to the air bags
or lean against the door or center console.
Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still maintaining
control of the vehicle. The U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) recommends that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the
center of the steering wheel and the chest.
3-46
03
Where are the air bags?
Driver’s and passenger’s front air
bags
Driver’s front air bag
OTM030006
Passenger’s front air bag
The seat belt buckle sensors determine
if the driver and front passenger's seat
belts are fastened. These sensors provide
the ability to control the SRS deployment
based on whether or not the seat belts are
fastened, and how severe the impact is.
The advanced SRS offers the ability to
control the air bag inflation within two
levels. A first stage level is provided for
moderate-severity impacts. A second
stage level is provided for more severe
impacts.
According to the impact severity, and
seat belt usage, the SRS Control Module
(SRSCM) controls the air bag inflation.
Failure to properly wear seat belts can
increase the risk or severity of injury in an
accident.
WARNING
OTM030007
Your vehicle is equipped with a
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
and lap/shoulder belts at both the driver
and passenger seating positions.
The SRS consists of air bags which are
located in the center of the steering
wheel and the passenger’s side front
panel pad above the glove box.
The air bags are labeled with the letters
“AIR BAG” embossed on the pad covers.
The purpose of the SRS is to provide the
vehicle’s driver and front passengers with
additional protection than that offered
by the seat belt system alone in case of a
frontal impact of sufficient severity.
The SRS uses sensors to gather
information about the driver’s and front
passenger's seat belt usage and impact
severity.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from inflating front air bags, take
the following precautions:
ś Seat belts must be worn at all times
to help keep occupants positioned
properly.
ś Move your seat as far back as
possible from front air bags, while
still maintaining control of the
vehicle.
ś Never lean against the door or center
console.
ś Do not allow the front passenger
to place their feet or legs on the
dashboard.
ś No objects (such as crash pad
cover, mobile phone holder, cup
holder, perfume or stickers) should
be placed over or near the air bag
modules on the steering wheel,
instrument panel, windshield glass,
and the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box. Such objects
could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
crash severe enough to cause the air
bags to deploy.
ś Do not attach any objects on the
front windshield and inside mirror.
3-47
Seats & Safety System
Side air bags
WARNING
Side air bag
OTM030029
OTM030030
Your vehicle is equipped with a side air
bag in each front seat. The purpose of
the air bag is to provide the vehicle’s
driver and the front passenger with
additional protection than that offered by
the seat belt alone.
The side air bags are designed to deploy
during certain side impact collisions,
depending on the crash severity, angle,
speed and point of impact.
The side air bags on both sides of the
vehicle are designed to deploy when a
rollover is detected by a rollover sensor.
(if equipped with rollover sensor)
The side air bags are not designed to
deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
3-48
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating side air bag and
front center air bag, take the following
precautions:
ś Seat belts must be worn at all times
to help keep occupants positioned
properly.
ś Do not allow passengers to lean their
heads or bodies onto doors, put their
arms on the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
ś Hold the steering wheel at the 9
o’clock and 3 o’clock positions, to
minimize the risk of injuries to your
hands and arms.
ś Do not use any accessory seat
covers. This could reduce or prevent
the effectiveness of the system.
ś Do not hang other objects except
clothes. In an accident it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury
especially when air bag is inflated.
ś Do not place any objects over the
air bag or between the air bag and
yourself. Also, do not attach any
objects around the area the air bag
inflates such as the door, side door
glass, front and rear pillar.
ś Do not place any objects between
the door and the seat. They may
become dangerous projectiles if the
side air bag inflates.
ś Do not install any accessories on the
side or near the side air bags.
ś Do not cause impact to the doors
when the Engine Start/Stop button
is in the ON or START position as this
may cause the side air bags to inflate.
ś If the seat or seat cover is damaged,
have the system be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
03
For vehicles equipped with a rollover
sensor the side and/or curtain air bags
and pre-tensioners on both sides of
the vehicle may deploy if a rollover or
possible rollover is detected.
The curtain air bags are not designed
to deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
Curtain air bags
WARNING
OTM030031
OTM030032
Curtain air bags are located along both
sides of the roof rails above the front and
rear doors.
They are designed to help protect the
heads of the front seat occupants and
the rear outboard seat occupants in
certain side impact collisions.
The curtain air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity, angle, speed and impact.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating curtain air bag,
take the following precautions:
ś All seat occupants must wear
seat belts at all times to help keep
occupants positioned properly.
ś Properly secure Child Restraint
System as far away from the door as
possible.
ś Do not place any objects over the air
bag. Also, do not attach any objects
around the area the air bag inflates
such as the door, side door glass,
front and rear pillar, roof side rail.
ś Do not hang other objects except
clothes, especially hard or breakable
objects.
In an accident, it may cause vehicle
damage or personal injury.
ś Do not allow passengers to lean their
heads or bodies onto doors, put their
arms on the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
ś Do not attempt to open or repair
the side curtain air bags yourself. If
necessary, have the air bag inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3-49
Seats & Safety System
How does the air bags system
operate?
OTMH030008N
The SRS consists of the following
components:
(1) Driver's front air bag module
(2) Passenger's front air bag module
(3) Side air bag modules
(4) Curtain air bag modules
(5) Retractor pre-tensioner
(6) Air bag warning light
(7) SRS control module (SRSCM)/
Rollover sensor
(8) Front impact sensors
(9) Side impact sensors
(10) Side pressure sensors
(11) Seat belt buckle sensor
(12) Emergency fastening device system
(13) Occupant classification system
The SRSCM continually monitors all SRS
components while the ignition switch
is ON to determine if a crash impact
is severe enough to require air bag
deployment or pre-tensioner seat belt
deployment.
3-50
SRS warning light
The SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
air bag warning light on the instrument
panel displays the air bag symbol
depicted in the illustration. The system
checks the air bag electrical system for
malfunctions. The light indicates that
there is a potential problem with your
air bag system, which could include
your side and/or curtain air bags used
for rollover protection (if equipped with
rollover sensor).
WARNING
If your SRS malfunctions, the air bag
may not inflate properly during an
accident, increasing the risk of serious
injury or death.
If any of the following conditions occur,
your SRS is malfunctioning:
ś The light does not turn on for
approximately three to six seconds
when the Engine Start/Stop button is
in the ON position.
ś The light stays on after illuminating
for approximately three to six
seconds.
ś The light comes on while the vehicle
is in motion.
ś The light blinks when the engine is
running.
Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
inspect the SRS as soon as possible if
any of these conditions occur.
03
During a moderate to severe frontal
collision, sensors will detect the
vehicle’s rapid deceleration. If the rate of
deceleration is high enough, the control
unit will inflate the front air bags, at the
time and with the force needed.
The front air bags help protect the driver
and front passenger by responding to
frontal impacts in which seat belts alone
cannot provide adequate restraint. When
needed, the side air bags help provide
protection in the event of a side impact
or rollover by supporting the side upper
body area.
ś Air bags are activated (able to
inflate if necessary) only when the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the
ON or START position, and it can be
activated within about 3 minutes after
the engine is turned off.
ś Air bags inflate in the event of certain
frontal or side collisions to help
protect the occupants from serious
physical injury.
ś There is no single speed at which the
air bags will inflate. Generally, air bags
are designed to inflate based upon the
severity of a collision and its direction.
These two factors determine whether
the sensors produce an electronic
deployment/inflation signal.
ś The front air bags will completely
inflate and deflate in an instant. It is
virtually impossible for you to see the
air bags inflate during an accident. It is
much more likely that you will simply
see the deflated air bags hanging out
of their storage compartments after
the collision.
ś In addition to inflating in serious side
collisions, vehicles equipped with a
rollover sensor, side and/or curtain air
bags will inflate if the sensing system
detects a rollover.
When a rollover is detected, curtain
air bags will remain inflated longer to
help provide protection from ejection,
especially when used in conjunction
with the seat belts. (if equipped with a
rollover sensor)
ś To help provide protection, the air
bags must inflate rapidly. The speed
of air bag inflation is a consequence
of extremely short time in which
to inflate the air bag between the
occupant and the vehicle structures
before the occupant impacts those
structures. This speed of inflation
reduces the risk of serious or
lifethreatening injuries and is thus a
necessary part of air bag design.
However, the rapid air bag inflation
can also cause injuries which can
include facial abrasions, bruises and
broken bones because the inflation
speed also causes the air bags to
expand with a great deal of force.
ś There are even circumstances under
which contact with the air bag can
cause fatal injuries, especially if the
occupant is positioned excessively
close to the air bag.
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air bag.
The greatest risk is sitting too close to
the air bag. An air bag needs about 10
in. (25 cm) of space to inflate. NHTSA
recommends that drivers allow at least
10 in. (25 cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest.
3-51
Seats & Safety System
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating air bag, take the
following precautions:
ś NEVER place a child restraint in the
front passenger seat.
Always properly restrain children
under age 13 in the rear seats of the
vehicle.
ś Adjust the front passenger’s and
driver's seats as far to the rear as
possible while maintaining you to
maintain full control of the vehicle.
ś Hold the steering wheel with
hands at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock
positions.
ś Never place anything or anyone
between the air bag and the seat
occupant.
ś Do not allow the front passenger
to place their feet or legs on the
dashboard.
Driver’s front air bag (1)
ODN8039077L
When the SRSCM detects a sufficiently
severe impact to the front of the vehicle,
it will automatically deploy the front air
bags.
Driver’s front air bag (2)
ODN8039078L
Upon deployment, tear seams molded
directly into the pad covers will separate
under pressure from the expansion of the
air bags. Further opening of the covers
allows full inflation of the air bags.
A fully inflated air bag, in combination
with a properly worn seat belt, slows the
driver’s or the front passenger’s forward
motion, reducing the risk of head and
chest injury.
3-52
03
What to expect after an air bag
inflates
Driver’s front air bag (3)
After a frontal or side air bag inflates, it
will deflate very quickly. Air bag inflation
will not prevent the driver from seeing
out of the windshield or being able
to steer. Curtain air bags may remain
partially inflated for some time after they
deploy.
ODN8039079L
Passenger’s front air bag
ODN8039080L
After complete inflation, the air bag
immediately starts deflating, enabling
the driver to maintain forward visibility
and the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
WARNING
To prevent objects from becoming
dangerous projectiles when the
passenger’s air bag inflates:
ś Do not install or place any objects
(drink holder, CD holder, stickers,
etc.) on the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box where the
passenger’s air bag is located.
ś Do not install a container of liquid
air freshener near the instrument
cluster or on the instrument panel
surface.
WARNING
After an air bag inflates, take the
following precautions:
ś Open your windows and doors as
soon as possible after impact to
reduce prolonged exposure to the
smoke and powder released by the
inflating air bag.
ś Do not touch the air bag storage
area’s internal components
immediately after an air bag has
inflated. The parts that come into
contact with an inflating air bag may
be very hot.
ś Always wash exposed skin areas
thoroughly with cold water and mild
soap.
ś Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
replace the air bag immediately after
deployment. Air bags are designed to
be used only once.
3-53
Seats & Safety System
Noise and smoke from inflating air
bag
When the air bags inflate, they make a
loud noise and may produce smoke and
powder in the air inside of the vehicle.
This is normal and is a result of the
ignition of the air bag inflator. After the
air bag inflates, you may feel substantial
discomfort in breathing because of the
contact of your chest with both the seat
belt and the air bag, as well as from
breathing the smoke and powder. The
powder may aggravate asthma for some
people. If you experience breathing
problems after an air bag deployment,
seek medical attention immediately.
Though the smoke and powder are
nontoxic, they may cause irritation to
the skin, eyes, nose, throat, etc. If this is
the case, wash and rinse with cold water
immediately and seek medical attention
if the symptoms persist.
3-54
Occupant Classification System
(OCS)
OTMA030003
Your vehicle is equipped with an
Occupant Classification System (OCS) in
the front passenger’s seat.
03
Main components of the Occupant
Classification System
ś A detection device located within the
front passenger seat cushion.
ś Electronic system to determine
whether the passenger air bag
systems should be activated or
deactivated.
ś An indicator light located on the
overhead console which illuminates
the words “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicating the front passenger air bag
system is deactivated.
ś The overhead console air bag
indicator light is interconnected with
the OCS.
The OCS is designed to help detect
the presence of a properly-seated
front passenger and determine if the
passenger’s front air bag should be
enabled (may inflate) or not.
The purpose is to help reduce the risk
of injury or death from an inflating air
bag to certain front passenger seat
occupants, such as children, by requiring
the air bag to be automatically turned
OFF.
For example, if a child restraint of the
type specified in the regulations is on the
seat, the occupant classification sensor
can detect it and cause the air bag to
turn OFF.
Front passenger seat adult occupants
who are properly seated and wearing the
seat belt properly, should not cause the
passenger air bag to be automatically
turned OFF. For smaller adults it may turn
OFF, however, if the occupant does not
sit in the seat properly (for example, by
not sitting upright, by sitting on the edge
of the seat, or by otherwise being out of
position), this could cause the sensor to
turn the air bag OFF.
You will find the “PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF” indicator on the overhead console
panel. This system detects the conditions
1-4 in the following table and activates or
deactivates the front passenger air bag
based on these conditions.
Always be sure that you and all vehicle
occupants are seated properly and
wearing the seat belt properly for the
most effective protection by the air bag
and the seat belt.
The OCS may not function properly if the
passenger takes actions which can affect
the classification system. These include:
ś Failing to sit in an upright position.
ś Leaning against the door or center
console.
ś Sitting towards the sides of the front
of the seat.
ś Putting their legs on the dashboard or
resting them on other locations which
reduce the passenger weight on the
front seat.
ś Wearing the seat belt improperly.
ś Reclining the seatback.
ś Wearing thick clothes like ski wear or
hip protection wear.
ś Putting an additional thick cushion on
the seat.
ś Putting electrical devices (for
example, notebook, satellite radio) on
the seat with inverter charging.
3-55
Seats & Safety System
Condition and operation in the front passenger Occupant Classification System
Indicator/Warning light
Condition detected by the
occupant classification system
Devices
“PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF”
indicator light
SRS warning
light
Front
passenger air
bag
1. Adult*1
Off
Off
Activated
2. Infant*2 or child restraint
system with 12 months old *3 *4
On
Off
Deactivated
3. Unoccupied
On
Off
Deactivated
4. Malfunction in the system
Off
On
Activated
The system judges a person of adult size as an adult. When a smaller adult sits in the
front passenger seat, the system may recognize him/her as a child depending on his/her
physique and posture.
*2 : Do not allow children to ride in the front passenger seat. When a larger child who has
outgrown a child restraint system sits in the front passenger seat, the system may
recognize him/her as an adult depending upon his/her physique or sitting position.
*3 : Never install a child restraint system on the front passenger seat.
*4 : The PASSENGER AIR BAG “OFF” indicator may turn on or off when a child above 12
months to 12 years old (with or without child restraint system) sits in the front passenger
seat. This is a normal condition.
*1 :
3-56
03
WARNING
Riding in an improper position or placing weight on the front passenger’s seat when
it is unoccupied by a passenger adversely affects the OCS. To reduce the risk of
serious injury or death:
ś NEVER put a heavy load in the front seat or seatback
pocket, or hang any items on the front passenger
seat.
OHI038163
ś NEVER place your feet on the front passenger
seatback.
OHI038156
ś NEVER sit with your hips shifted towards the front of
the seat.
OHI038155
ś NEVER ride with the seatback reclined when the
vehicle is moving.
OHI038157
ś NEVER place your feet or legs on the dashboard.
OHI039192N
3-57
Seats & Safety System
ś NEVER lean on the door or center console or sit on
one side of the front passenger seat.
OHI038158
ś Do not sit on the passenger seat wearing heavily
padded clothes such as ski wear and hip protector.
OJX1039069
ś Do not use car seat accessories such as thick blankets
and cushions which cover up the car seat surface.
OJX1039070
ś Do not place electronic devices such as laptops, DVD
player, or conductive materials such as water bottles
on the passenger seat.
ś Do not use electronic devices such as laptops and
satellite radios which use inverter chargers.
OJX1039071
ś If large quantity of liquid has been spilled on the
passenger seat, the air bag warning light may
illuminate or malfunction.
Therefore, make sure the seat has been completely
dried before driving the vehicle.
OJX1039072
ś Do not place sharp objects on the front passenger seat. These may damage the
occupant detection system, if they puncture the seat cushion.
ś Do not place any items under the front passenger seat.
ś When changing or replacing the seat or seat cover, use original items only.
The OCS has been developed based on using original HYUNDAI car seats only.
Altering or changing the authentic parts may result in system malfunction and
increase risk of injury when in collision. Any of the above could interfere with the
proper operation of the OCS sensor thereby increasing the risk of an injury in an
accident.
3-58
03
WARNING
OHI038118
Proper seated position for OCS
If the “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicator is on when an adult is seated
in the front passenger seat, place the
Engine Start/Stop button in the OFF
position and ask the passenger to sit
properly (sitting upright with the seat
back in an upright position, centered
on the seat cushion with their seat belt
on, legs comfortably extended and their
feet on the floor). Restart the engine and
have the person remain in that position.
This will allow the system to detect the
person and to enable the passenger air
bag. If the “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicator is still on, ask the passenger to
move to the rear seat.
NEVER allow an adult passenger to ride
in the front passenger seat when the
“PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF” indicator
is illuminated. During a collision, the
air bag will not inflate if the indicator
is illuminated. Have your passenger
reposition themselves in the seat. If the
“PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF” indicator
remains illuminated after the passenger
repositions themselves properly
and the vehicle is restarted, have
the passenger move to the rear seat
because the air bag will not inflate.
NOTICE
The “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicator generally illuminates for
approximately 4 seconds after the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON
or START position. But, if the Engine
START/STOP button is pressed to the
ON or START position within 3 minutes
after the engine is turned OFF, the
indicator does not illuminate. If the
front passenger seat is occupied,
the OCS will then classify the front
passenger after several more seconds.
3-59
Seats & Safety System
Do not install a Child Restraint
System on the Front Passenger’s
Seat
Why didn’t my air bag go off in a
collision?
There are certain types of accidents in
which the air bag would not be expected
to provide additional protection. These
include rear impacts, second or third
collisions in multiple impact accidents,
as well as low speed impacts. Damage to
the vehicle indicates a collision energy
absorption, and is not an indicator of
whether or not an air bag should have
inflated.
Air bag collision sensors
OHI039193N
Even though your vehicle is equipped
with the OCS, never install a child
restraint in the front passenger’s seat.
An inflating air bag can forcefully strike a
child or child restraint resulting in serious
or fatal injury.
WARNING
NEVER use a rearward facing Child
Restraint on a seat protected by an
ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH
or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can
occur.
3-60
WARNING
To reduce the risk of an air bag
deploying unexpectedly and causing
serious injury or death:
ś Do not hit or allow any objects to
impact the locations where air bags
or sensors are installed.
ś Do not perform maintenance on or
around the air bag sensors. If the
location or angle of the sensors is
altered, the air bags may deploy
when they should not or may not
deploy when they should.
ś Installing bumper guards with nongenuine Hyundai or non-equivalent
parts may adversely affect the
collision and airbag deployment
performance.
ś Press the Engine Start/Stop button to
the OFF or ACC position and wait for
3 minutes when the vehicle is being
towed to prevent inadvertent air bag
deployment.
ś Have all air bag repairs performed by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
03
OTM030009/OTM030010/OTM030011/OTM030035/OTM030036/OTM030037
1. SRS control module / Rollover sensor
2. Front impact sensor
3. Side impact sensor (Pressure)
4. Side impact sensor (Acceleration)
5. Side impact sensor (Acceleration)
3-61
Seats & Safety System
Air bag inflation conditions
OTM030014
Front air bags
Front air bags are designed to inflate
in a frontal collision depending on the
severity of impact of the front collision.
OTM030013
OTM030033
3-62
Side and curtain air bags
Side and curtain air bags are designed
to inflate when an impact is detected
by side collision sensors depending on
the severity, speed or angles of impact
resulting from a side impact collision.
Although the driver’s and front
passenger’s air bags are designed to
inflate in frontal collisions, they also may
inflate in other types of collisions if the
front impact sensors detect a sufficient
impact. Side and curtain air bags are
designed to inflate in side impact
collisions, but they may inflate in other
collisions if the side impact sensors
detect a sufficient impact.
Also, the side and curtain air bags are
designed to inflate when a rollover
is detected by a rollover sensor. (if
equipped with rollover sensor)
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved roads,
the air bags may deploy. Drive carefully
on unimproved roads or on surfaces not
designed for vehicle traffic to prevent
unintended air bag deployment.
03
Air bag non-inflation conditions
OTM030017
OTM030015
In certain low-speed collisions the air
bags may not deploy. The air bags are
designed not to deploy in such cases
because they may not provide benefits
beyond the protection of the seat belts.
Front air bags may not inflate in side
impact collisions, because occupants
move in the direction of the collision,
and thus in side impacts, front air bag
deployment would not provide additional
occupant protection.
However, side and curtain air bags
and front center air bag may inflate
depending on the severity of impact.
OTM030016
Front air bags are not designed to inflate
in rear collisions, because occupants
are moved backward by the force of the
impact. In this case, inflated air bags
would not provide any additional benefit.
OTM030034
In an angled collision, the force of impact
may direct the occupants in a direction
where the air bags would not be able to
provide any additional benefit, and thus
the sensors may not deploy any air bags.
3-63
Seats & Safety System
OTM030018
OTM030019
Just before impact, drivers often brake
heavily. Such heavy braking lowers the
front portion of the vehicle causing it
to “ride” under a vehicle with a higher
ground clearance. Air bags may not
inflate in this “underride” situation
because deceleration forces that are
detected by sensors may be significantly
reduced by such “underride” collisions.
Air bags may not inflate if the vehicle
collides with objects such as utility poles
or trees, where the point of impact is
concentrated and the collision energy is
absorbed by the vehicle structure.
OTM030041
Front air bags may not inflate in
rollover accidents because front air bag
deployment would not provide additional
occupant protection.
However, the side and curtain air bags
and front center air bag may inflate in a
rollover situation, when it is detected by
the rollover sensor.
3-64
03
SRS care
The SRS is virtually maintenance-free
and there are no parts you can safely
service by yourself. If the SRS air bag
warning light does not illuminate when
the Engine Start/Stop button is in the
ON position, or continuously remains
on, have the system be immediately
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Any work on the SRS system, such as
removing, installing, repairing, or any
work on the steering wheel, the front
passenger’s panel, front seats and roof
rails be performed by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer. Improper handling of
the SRS system may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death take the following precautions:
ś Do not attempt to modify or
disconnect the SRS components or
wiring, including the addition of any
kind of badges to the pad covers or
modifications to the body structure.
ś Do not place objects over or near
the air bag modules on the steering
wheel, instrument panel, and the
front passenger’s panel above the
glove box.
ś Clean the air bag pad covers with
a soft cloth moistened with plain
water. Solvents or cleaners could
adversely affect the air bag covers
and proper deployment of the
system.
ś Always have inflated air bags be
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś If components of the air bag system
must be discarded, or if the vehicle
must be scrapped, certain safety
precautions must be observed.
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for the necessary information.
Failure to follow these precautions
could increase the risk of personal
injury.
3-65
Seats & Safety System
Additional safety precautions
Passengers should not move out of
or change seats while the vehicle is
moving. A passenger who is not wearing
a seat belt during a crash or emergency
stop can be thrown against the inside of
the vehicle, against other occupants, or
be ejected from the vehicle.
Do not use any accessories on seat
belts. Devices claiming to improve
occupant comfort or reposition the seat
belt can reduce the protection provided
by the seat belt and increase the chance
of serious injury in a crash.
Do not modify the front seats.
Modification of the front seats could
interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components or side air bags.
Do not place items under the front
seats. Placing items under the front seats
could interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components and wiring harnesses.
Do not cause impact to the doors.
Impact to the doors when the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON or START
position may cause the air bags to
inflate.
Modifications to accommodate
disabilities. If you require modification
to your vehicle to accommodate
a disability, contact the HYUNDAI
Customer Connect Center at 800-6335151.
Adding equipment to or modifying
your air bag equipped vehicle
If you modify your vehicle by changing
your vehicle’s frame, bumper system,
front end or side sheet metal or ride
height, this may affect the operation of
your vehicle’s air bag system.
3-66
Air bag warning labels
OTMA030005
Air bag warning labels, required by the
U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA), are attached
to alert the driver and passengers of
potential risks of the air bag system. Be
sure to read all of the information about
the air bags that are installed on your
vehicle in this Owners Manual.
4. Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster ............................................................................................ 4-4
Instrument cluster control ...........................................................................................4-5
Instrument panel illumination...................................................................................4-5
Gauges and meters ......................................................................................................4-5
Speedometer .............................................................................................................4-5
Tachometer ................................................................................................................4-5
Engine coolant temperature gauge......................................................................... 4-6
Fuel gauge ................................................................................................................. 4-6
Outside temperature gauge ...................................................................................... 4-7
Odometer .................................................................................................................. 4-8
Distance to empty .................................................................................................... 4-8
Fuel economy (for 12.3-inch cluster) ...................................................................... 4-9
Transmission shift indicator........................................................................................ 4-9
Automatic transmission / Dual clutch transmission shift indicator ..................... 4-9
Warning and indicator lights ..................................................................................... 4-10
Seat belt warning light ............................................................................................ 4-10
Air bag warning light ............................................................................................... 4-10
Parking brake & Brake fluid warning light .............................................................. 4-10
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) warning light ........................................................... 4-11
Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) system warning light .......................... 4-11
Electric Power Steering (EPS) warning light .......................................................... 4-12
Charging system warning light ............................................................................... 4-12
Engine oil pressure warning light ........................................................................... 4-13
Low fuel level warning light .................................................................................... 4-13
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) .......................................................................... 4-13
Exhaust system (GPF) warning light (for gasoline engine) ................................... 4-14
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) warning light ........................................................ 4-14
AUTO HOLD indicator light ..................................................................................... 4-15
Low tire pressure warning light .............................................................................. 4-15
Forward Safety warning light .................................................................................. 4-16
Lane Safety indicator light ...................................................................................... 4-16
4 Wheel Drive (4WD) warning light ........................................................................ 4-16
4 Wheel Drive (4WD) LOCK Indicator Light ............................................................4-17
LED headlight warning light .....................................................................................4-17
Icy road warning light .............................................................................................. 4-18
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) indicator light................................................... 4-18
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF indicator light ........................................... 4-18
Immobilizer Indicator Light (without smart key) .................................................. 4-19
Immobilizer Indicator Light (with smart key) ......................................................... 4-19
Downhill Brake Control (DBC) indicator light ........................................................4-20
4
4
AUTO STOP indicator light ......................................................................................4-20
Turn signal indicator light .........................................................................................4-21
High beam indicator light ........................................................................................4-21
High Beam Assist indicator light..............................................................................4-21
Cruise Indicator Light ...............................................................................................4-21
SPORT Mode Indicator Light ...................................................................................4-22
ECO Mode Indicator Light .......................................................................................4-22
SMART Mode Indicator Light ..................................................................................4-22
Master warning light ................................................................................................4-22
LCD display messages ...............................................................................................4-23
Shift to P (for smart key system) .............................................................................4-23
Low key battery (for smart key system)..................................................................4-23
Press START button while turning wheel (for smart key system) .........................4-23
Check steering wheel lock system
(for smart key system) .............................................................................................4-23
Press brake pedal to start engine (for smart key system) ....................................4-23
Key not in vehicle (for smart key system) ...............................................................4-23
Key not detected (for smart key system)................................................................4-23
Press START button again (for smart key system) ................................................4-23
Press START button with key (for smart key system) ...........................................4-24
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse (for smart key system) .............................................4-24
Shift to P or N to start engine (for smart key system) ..........................................4-24
Battery discharging due to external electrical devices .........................................4-24
Door, Hood, Liftgate open indicator.......................................................................4-25
Sunroof open indicator............................................................................................4-25
Low tire pressure .....................................................................................................4-25
Lights ........................................................................................................................4-26
Wiper ........................................................................................................................4-26
Low washer fluid ......................................................................................................4-26
Low fuel ....................................................................................................................4-26
Low engine oil ..........................................................................................................4-26
Engine overheated / Engine has overheated ......................................................... 4-27
Check exhaust system ............................................................................................. 4-27
Check headlight ....................................................................................................... 4-27
Check turn signal ..................................................................................................... 4-27
Check headlight LED ............................................................................................... 4-27
Check Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist system ...............................................4-28
Check Lane Keeping Assist system ........................................................................4-28
Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning system..........................................................4-28
Check Driver Attention Warning system ................................................................4-28
Check High Beam Assist system.............................................................................4-28
Check Smart Cruise Control system.......................................................................4-28
4. Instrument cluster
LCD display...................................................................................................... 4-29
LCD display control ....................................................................................................4-29
View modes ............................................................................................................... 4-30
Trip computer mode ................................................................................................ 4-31
Turn By Turn (TBT) mode ......................................................................................... 4-31
Driving Assist mode ................................................................................................. 4-31
Master warning group .............................................................................................4-32
User settings mode ....................................................................................................4-33
Trip computer (Type A).............................................................................................. 4-40
Trip modes ............................................................................................................... 4-40
Trip computer (Type B).............................................................................................. 4-43
Trip modes ............................................................................................................... 4-43
4
Instrument cluster
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
4.2-inch
12.3-inch
The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more information, refer to “Gauges and meters” section in this chapter.
OTMA041001N/OCN7040080N
1. Tachometer
2. Speedometer
3. Engine coolant temperature gauge
4-4
4. Fuel gauge
5. Warning and indicator lights
6. LCD display
04
Instrument cluster control
Gauges and meters
Instrument panel illumination
Speedometer
When the vehicle’s parking lights or
headlights are on, press the illumination
control switch to adjust the brightness of
the instrument panel illumination.
When pressing the illumination control
switch, the interior switch illumination
intensity also adjusted.
You can adjust the brightness of the
instrument panel illumination form the
User Settings Mode on the LCD display
ZKHQWKHLJQLWLRQVZLWFKLVRQ œ/LJKWVƟ
Illumination’). When the vehicle’s parking
lights or headlights are on, interior switch
illumination intensity and mood lamps
are also adjusted.
If your vehicle is equipped with
additional navigation, please refer
to the infotainment system manual
separately supplied.
4.2-inch
12.3-inch
OTM040059L
OTM040006L
The speedometer indicates the speed of
the vehicle and is calibrated in miles per
hour (MPH) and/or kilometers per hour
(km/h).
Tachometer
4.2-inch
12.3-inch
WARNING
Never adjust the instrument cluster
while driving. This could result in loss
of control and lead to an accident that
may cause death, serious injury, or
vehicle damage.
ś The brightness of the instrument
panel illumination is displayed.
ś If the brightness reaches the
maximum or minimum level, a chime
will sound.
OTM040007L
OTM040008L
The tachometer indicates the
approximate number of engine
revolutions per minute (rpm).
Use the tachometer to select the correct
shift points and to prevent lugging and/
or over-revving the engine.
NOTICE
Do not operate the engine within the
tachometer's RED ZONE. This may
cause severe engine damage.
4-5
Instrument cluster
Engine coolant temperature gauge
4.2-inch
Type A
WARNING
Never remove the engine coolant
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
The engine coolant is under pressure
and could cause severe burn. Wait until
the engine is cool before adding coolant
to the reservoir.
Type B
Fuel gauge
4.2-inch
Type A
OTM040009
12.3-inch
Type A
Type B
OTM040009L
Type B
OTM040011
12.3-inch
Type A
OTM040010
OTM0400011L
Type B
OTM040010L
This gauge indicates the temperature
of the engine coolant when the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
NOTICE
If the gauge pointer moves beyond
the normal range area toward the
“H (Hot) or 130” position, it indicates
overheating that may damage the
engine.
Do not continue driving with an
overheated engine. If your vehicle
overheats, refer to “If the Engine
Overheats” section in chapter 8.
4-6
OTM040012
OTM040012L
This gauge indicates the approximate
amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank.
04
Information
ś The fuel tank capacity is given in
chapter 2.
ś The fuel gauge is supplemented by
a low fuel warning light, which will
illuminate when the fuel tank is nearly
empty.
ś On inclines or curves, the fuel gauge
pointer may fluctuate or the low fuel
warning light may come on earlier than
usual due to the movement of fuel in
the tank.
WARNING
Running out of fuel can expose vehicle
occupants to danger.
You must stop and obtain additional
fuel as soon as possible after the
warning light comes on or when the
gauge indicator comes close to the “E
(Empty) or 0” level.
NOTICE
Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level. Running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire damaging
the catalytic converter.
Outside temperature gauge
Type A
Type B
OTMA048112
OTMA040008
This gauge indicates the current outside
air temperatures by 1°F (1°C).
Note that the temperature indicated
on the LCD display may not change
as quickly as the outside temperature
(there may be a slight delay before the
temperature changes.)
You can change the temperature unit
from the Settings menu in the Cluster.
Select:
- 6HWXSƟ8QLWƟ7HPSHUDWXUH8QLWƟ
°F/°C
For vehicles equipped with Automatic
Climate Control, you can also:
- Press the AUTO button while pressing
the OFF button on the climate control
unit for 3 seconds
Both the temperature unit on the cluster
LCD display and climate control screen
will change.
4-7
Instrument cluster
Odometer
4.2-inch
Information
12.3-inch
OTMA048183
OCN7040015N
The odometer indicates the total
distance that the vehicle has been
driven and should be used to determine
when periodic maintenance should be
performed.
Distance to empty
4.2-inch
12.3-inch
OAD048563L
OCN7040016N
ś The distance to empty is the
estimated distance the vehicle can be
driven with the remaining fuel.
ś If the estimated distance is below
1 mi. (1 km), the trip computer will
display “---” as distance to empty.
4-8
ś If the vehicle is not on level ground or
the battery power has been interrupted,
the distance to empty function may not
operate correctly.
ś The distance to empty may differ
from the actual driving distance as it
is an estimate of the available driving
distance.
ś The trip computer may not register
additional fuel if less than 6 liters (1.5
gallon) of fuel are added to the vehicle.
ś The distance to empty may vary
significantly based on driving
conditions, driving habits, and
condition of the vehicle.
04
Fuel economy (for 12.3-inch cluster)
Transmission shift indicator
Automatic transmission / Dual
clutch transmission shift indicator
4.2-inch
12.3-inch
OTMA040002
The average fuel economy (1) and instant
fuel economy (2) is displayed at the
bottom of the cluster.
Automatic reset
To automatically reset the average fuel
economy, select between "After Ignition"
or "After Refueling" from the Settings
menu in the infotainment system screen.
OTM040016
OCN7040013N
This indicator informs the current gear
engaged.
4-9
Instrument cluster
Warning and indicator lights
Information
Make sure that all warning lights are OFF
after starting the engine. If any light is still
ON, this indicates a situation that needs
attention.
Seat belt warning light
This warning light informs the driver that
the seat belt is not fastened.
For more details, refer to “Seat Belts”
section in chapter 3.
Air bag warning light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you turn the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3~6
seconds and then goes off.
ś When there is a malfunction with the
SRS.
In this case, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
4-10
Parking brake & Brake fluid
warning light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The parking brake & brake fluid
warning light illuminates for about 3
seconds and will then turn off once
the parking brake is released.
ś Whenever the parking brake is
applied.
ś Whenever the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
- If the warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
If the brake fluid level in the reservoir is
low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. With the engine stopped, check the
brake fluid level immediately and add
fluid as required (For more details,
refer to “Brake Fluid” section in
chapter 9). After adding brake fluid,
check all brake components for fluid
leaks. If a brake fluid leak is found, or
if the warning light remains on, or if
the brakes do not operate properly, do
not drive the vehicle. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
04
Dual-diagonal braking system
Your vehicle is equipped with dualdiagonal braking system. This means you
still have braking on two wheels even if
one of the dual systems should fail.
With only one of the dual systems
working, more than normal pedal travel
and greater pedal pressure is required to
stop the vehicle.
Also, the vehicle will not stop in as short
a distance with only a portion of the
brake system working.
If the brakes fail while you are driving,
shift to a lower gear for additional engine
braking and stop the vehicle as soon as it
is safe to do so.
WARNING
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid warning
light
Driving the vehicle with a warning light
ON is dangerous. If the Parking Brake
& Brake Fluid warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid level is
low.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
warning light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The ABS warning light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and then goes
off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
the ABS.
Note that the hydraulic braking
system will still be operational even if
there is a malfunction with the ABS.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD) system
warning light
When the ABS warning and
Parking Brake warning lights are on
simultaneously, it may indicate a
problem with the Electronic Brake Force
Distribution system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-11
Instrument cluster
WARNING
Electronic Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) system warning light
When both ABS and Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid warning lights are on, the
brake system will not work normally
and you may experience an unexpected
and dangerous situation during sudden
braking.
If this occurs, avoid high speed driving
and abrupt braking.
Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
Electronic Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) system warning light
When the ABS warning light is on
or both ABS and Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid warning lights are on, the
speedometer, odometer, or tripmeter
may not work. Also, the EPS warning
light may illuminate and the steering
effort may increase or decrease.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
4-12
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
warning light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The electric power steering warning
light illuminates for about 3 seconds
and then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
the electric power steering.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Charging system warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
When there is a malfunction with either
the alternator or electrical charging
system.
If there is a malfunction with either the
alternator or electrical charging system:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and check the
alternator drive belt for looseness or
breakage.
If the belt is adjusted properly, there
may be a problem in the electrical
charging system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
04
Engine oil pressure warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
When the engine oil pressure is low.
If the engine oil pressure is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and check the
engine oil level (For more details,
refer to “Engine Oil” section in
chapter 9). If the level is low, add oil
as required.
If the warning light remains on after
adding oil or if oil is not available, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
Continued driving with the warning light
on may cause engine failure.
NOTICE
If the engine is not stopped
immediately after the Engine Oil
Pressure warning light is illuminated,
severe damage could result.
Low fuel level warning light
This warning light illuminates:
When the fuel tank is nearly empty.
Add fuel as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Driving with the Low Fuel Level warning
light on or with the fuel level below “E
or 0” can cause the engine to misfire
and damage the catalytic converter.
Information
When engine oil pressure decreases due to
insufficient engine oil, etc., the Engine Oil
Pressure warning light will illuminate. In
addition, the enhanced engine protection
system which limits engine power will
be activated. If the engine oil pressure is
restored, the Engine Oil Pressure warning
light and the enhanced engine protection
system will turn off. However, for gasoline
2.5 turbo engine and 2.5 gdi engine, when
the engine oil pressure is restored, the
warning light and the enhanced engine
protection system will turn off after the
engine is restarted.
4-13
Instrument cluster
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL)
Exhaust system (GPF)
warning light (for gasoline
engine, if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The malfunction indicator light
illuminates for about 3 seconds and
then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
either the emission control system or
the engine or the vehicle powertrain.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś This warning light illuminates, when
accumulated soot reaches a certain
amount.
ś When this warning light illuminates, it
may turn off after driving the vehicle
at more than 50 mph (80km/h) for
about 30 minutes (above 3rd gear
with 1500 ~ 4000 engine rpm).
If this warning light blinks in spite
of the procedure (at this time LCD
warning message will be displayed),
have the GPF system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
ś Driving with the Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) on may cause
damage to the emission control
system which could affect drivability
and/or fuel economy.
ś If the enhanced engine protection
system becomes activated due to
lack of engine oil, engine power
will be limited. If such condition
continues repeatedly, the
Malfunction Indicator Lamp will
illuminate.
NOTICE
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) illuminates, potential catalytic
converter damage is possible which
could result in loss of engine power.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
4-14
NOTICE
If you continue to drive with the GPF
warning light blinking for a long time,
the GPF system can be damaged and
fuel consumption can worsen.
04
Electronic Parking Brake
(EPB) warning light
(if equipped)
Low tire pressure warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The EPB warning light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and then goes
off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
EPB.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The low tire pressure warning light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś When one or more of your tires are
significantly underinflated. (The
location of the underinflated tires are
displayed on the LCD display.)
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 8.
Information
The Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
warning light may illuminate when
the Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
indicator light comes on to indicate that
ESC is not working properly. This does
not indicate malfunction of EPB.
AUTO HOLD indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
ś [White] When you activate Auto Hold
by pressing the AUTO HOLD switch.
ś [Green] When you stop the vehicle
completely by depressing the brake
pedal with Auto Hold activated.
ś [Yellow] Whenever there is a
malfunction with the Auto Hold
function.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Parking Brake (EPB)” section in chapter
6.
This warning light remains ON after
blinking for approximately 60 seconds, or
repeatedly blinks ON and OFF in 3 second
intervals:
When there is a malfunction with the
TPMS.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 8.
WARNING
Safe Stopping
ś The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors.
ś If you notice any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off the
accelerator pedal, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
4-15
Instrument cluster
Forward Safety warning light
(if equipped)
Lane Safety indicator light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The Forward Safety warning light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)”
section in chapter 7.
This indicator light illuminates:
ś [Green] When the system operating
conditions are satisfied.
ś [White] When the system operating
conditions are not satisfied.
ś [Yellow] Whenever there is a
malfunction with Lane Keeping Assist.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more details, refer to “Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA)” section in chapter 7.
4 Wheel Drive (4WD) warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
Whenever there is a malfunction with the
4WD system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “4 Wheel Drive
(4WD)” section in chapter 6.
4-16
04
4 Wheel Drive (4WD) LOCK
Indicator Light
LED headlight warning light
This indicator light illuminates:
ś Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop Button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś When you select 4WD Lock mode by
pressing the 4WD LOCK button.
- The 4WD LOCK mode is to increase
the drive power when driving on
wet pavement, snow covered roads
and/or off-road.
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The LED headlight warning light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
the LED headlight.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
Do not use 4WD LOCK mode on dry
paved roads or highway, it can cause
noise, vibration or damage of 4WD
related parts.
This warning light blinks:
Whenever there is a malfunction with a
LED headlight related part.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Continuous driving with the LED
Headlight warning light on or blinking
can reduce LED headlight life.
4-17
Instrument cluster
Icy road warning light
(if equipped)
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) indicator light
This warning light is to warn the driver
the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside
temperature gauge is approximately
below 4°C (40°F), the Icy Road warning
light and Outside Temperature Gauge
blinks and then illuminates. Also, the
warning chime sounds 1 time.
You can activate or deactivate Icy Road
Warning function from the User Settings
menu in the cluster LCD display.
Select:
- 6HWXSƟ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ&OXVWHUƟ,F\
Road Warning
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The Electronic Stability Control
indicator light illuminates for about
3 seconds and then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
ESC system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Information
If the Icy Road warning light appears
while driving, you should drive more
attentively and safely refraining from
over-speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden
braking or sharp turning, etc.
This indicator light blinks:
While ESC is operating.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” section in
chapter 6.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) OFF indicator light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The ESC OFF indicator light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś When you deactivate ESC system by
pressing the ESC OFF button.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” section in
chapter 6.
4-18
04
Immobilizer Indicator Light
(without smart key)
(if equipped)
Immobilizer Indicator Light
(with smart key)
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When the vehicle detects the
immobilizer in the key with the
ignition switch in the ON position.
- At this time, you can start the
engine.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light illuminates for up to
30 seconds:
ś When the vehicle detects the smart
key in the vehicle with the Engine
Start/Stop button in the ACC or ON
position.
- At this time, you can start the
engine.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks:
ś When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
In this case, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This indicator light blinks for a few
seconds:
ś When the smart key is not in the
vehicle.
- At this time, you cannot start the
engine.
This indicator light illuminates for 2
seconds and goes off:
ś If the smart key is in the vehicle and
the Engine Start/Stop button is ON,
but the vehicle cannot detect the
smart key.
In this case, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
ś When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
In this case, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
4-19
Instrument cluster
Downhill Brake Control (DBC)
indicator light
AUTO STOP indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- The downhill brake control indicator
light illuminates for about 3 seconds
and then goes off.
ś When you activate the system by
pressing the DBC button.
This indicator light illuminates:
When the engine enters the Idle Stop
mode of ISG (Idle Stop and Go) system.
When the engine automatically starts,
the AUTO STOP indicator on the cluster
Illuminates to white.
This indicator light blinks:
When Downhill Brake Control system is
operating.
This indicator light illuminates yellow:
Whenever there is a malfunction with
Downhill Brake Control system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "Downhill
Brake Control (DBC)“ section in chapter
6.
4-20
For more details, refer to "ISG (Idle Stop
and Go) system" section in chapter 6.
Information
When the engine automatically starts
by the ISG system, some warning lights
(ABS, ESC, ESC OFF, EPS or Parking
brake warning light) may turn on for a
few seconds. This happens because of
low battery voltage. It does not mean the
system has malfunctioned.
04
Turn signal indicator light
High Beam Assist indicator
light (if equipped)
This indicator light blinks:
When you operate the turn signal
indicator stalk.
This indicator light illuminates:
When the high-beam is on with the light
switch in the AUTO position.
ś White: When High Beam Assist is
ready to operate.
ś Green: When High Beam Assist is
operating.
If your vehicle detects oncoming or
preceding vehicles, High Beam Assist
will switch the high beam to low beam
automatically.
For more details, refer to “High Beam
Assist (HBA)” section in chapter 5.
If any of the following occur, there may
be a malfunction with the turn signal
system.
- The turn signal indicator light
illuminates but does not blink
- The turn signal indicator light blinks
rapidly
- The turn signal indicator light does not
illuminate at all
If any of these conditions occur, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
High beam indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When the headlights are on and in the
high beam position
ś When the turn signal lever is pulled
into the Flash-to-Pass position.
Cruise Indicator Light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
When the cruise control system is
enabled.
For more details, refer to "Smart Cruise
Control (SCC)" in chapter 7.
4-21
Instrument cluster
SPORT Mode Indicator Light
(if equipped)
SMART Mode Indicator Light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates
When you select "SPORT" mode as drive
mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive Mode
Integrated Control System" in chapter
6.
This indicator light illuminates:
When you select ''SMART" mode as drive
mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive Mode
Integrated Control System'' in chapter
6.
Master warning light
This warning light illuminates:
When there is a malfunction in operation
in any of the following systems:
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
malfunction (if equipped)
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
radar blocked (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning
malfunction (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
- LED headlight malfunction
(if equipped)
- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go
malfunction (if equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go
radar blocked (if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction
To identify the details of the warning,
look at the LCD display.
4-22
04
LCD display messages
Shift to P (for smart key system)
This message is displayed if you try to
turn off the vehicle without the gear in
the P (Park) position.
If this occurs, the Engine Start/Stop
button turns to the ACC position.
Low key battery (for smart key
system)
This message is displayed if the battery
of the smart key is discharged while
changing the Engine Start/Stop button to
the OFF position.
Key not in vehicle (for smart key
system)
This message is displayed if the smart
key is not in the vehicle when you leave
the vehicle with the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ON or Start position.
Always turn off the engine before leaving
your vehicle.
Key not detected (for smart key
system)
This message is displayed if the smart
key is not detected when you press the
Engine Start/Stop button.
Press START button while turning
wheel (for smart key system)
Press START button again (for smart
key system)
This message is displayed if the steering
wheel does not unlock normally when
the Engine Start/Stop button is pressed.
You should press the Engine Start/Stop
button while turning the steering wheel
right and left.
This message is displayed if you were
unable to start the vehicle when the
Engine Start/Stop button was pressed.
If this occurs, attempt to start the engine
by pressing the Engine Start/ Stop button
again.
If the warning message appears each
time you press the Engine Start/Stop
button, have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check steering wheel lock system
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the steering
wheel does not lock normally while the
Engine Start/Stop button is pressed to
the OFF position.
Press brake pedal to start engine (for
smart key system)
This message is displayed if the Engine
Start/Stop button changes to the ACC
position twice by pressing the button
repeatedly without depressing the brake
pedal.
You can start the vehicle by depressing
the brake pedal and then pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button.
4-23
Instrument cluster
Press START button with key
(for smart key system)
Battery discharging due to external
electrical devices (if equipped)
This message is displayed if you press
the Engine Start/Stop button while the
warning message “Key not detected” is
displayed.
At this time, the immobilizer indicator
light blinks.
This message is displayed if the 12V
battery voltage is weak due to any
non-factory electrical accessories (ex.
dashboard camera) while parking. Be
careful that the battery is not discharged.
If the message appears after removing
the non-factory electrical accessories,
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the brake
switch fuse is disconnected.
You need to replace the fuse with a new
one before starting the engine.
If that is not possible, you can start the
engine by pressing the Engine Start/
Stop button for 10 seconds in the ACC
position.
Shift to P to start engine
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if you try to
start the engine in any other position
except P (Park).
4-24
04
Door, Hood, Liftgate open indicator
Sunroof open indicator (if equipped)
OTM040032
This warning is displayed if any door or
hood or liftgate is left open. The warning
will indicate which door is open in the
display.
CAUTION
OTM040034
This warning is displayed if you turn off
the engine when the sunroof is open.
Close the sunroof securely before leaving
your vehicle.
Low tire pressure
Before driving the vehicle, you should
confirm that the door/ hood/liftgate are
fully closed.
Also, check there is no door/hood/
liftgate open warning light or message
displayed on the instrument cluster.
OTM040022L
This warning message is displayed if the
tire pressure is low. The corresponding
tire on the vehicle will be illuminated.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 8.
4-25
Instrument cluster
Lights
Low washer fluid
Type A
This message is displayed if the washer
fluid level in the reservoir is nearly empty.
Have the washer fluid reservoir refilled.
Type B
Low fuel
OJX1049007L
OJX1049062L
This indicator displays which exterior
light is selected using the lighting
control.
You can activate or deactivate Wiper/
Lights display function from the User
Settings menu in the cluster LCD display.
Select:
- 6HWXSƟ8VHUVHWWLQJVƟ&OXVWHUƟ
Wiper/Lights display
Wiper
Type A
Type B
OJX1049008L
OJX1049063L
This indicator displays which wiper speed
is selected using the wiper control.
You can activate or deactivate Wiper/
Lights display function from the User
Settings menu in the cluster LCD display.
Select:
- 6HWXSƟ8VHUVHWWLQJVƟ&OXVWHUƟ
Wiper/Lights display
4-26
This message is displayed if the fuel tank
is almost out of fuel.
When this message is displayed, the low
fuel level warning light in the cluster will
come on.
It is recommended to look for the nearest
fueling station and refuel as soon as
possible.
Low engine oil (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed when
the engine oil level should be checked.
If this warning message is displayed,
check the engine oil level as soon as
possible and add engine oil as required.
Slowly pour the recommended oil little
by little into a funnel.
Use only the specified engine oil. (Refer
to "Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities“ section in chapter 2.)
Do not overfill the engine oil. Make sure
the oil level is not above F (Full) mark on
the dipstick.
04
Engine overheated / Engine has
overheated (if equipped)
This message is displayed when the
engine coolant temperature is above
248°F (120°C). This means that the
engine is overheated and may be
damaged.
If your vehicle is overheated, refer to
“Overheating” section in chapter 8.
Check exhaust system (if equipped)
This message is displayed if there is a
problem with the GPF system. At this
time, the GPF warning light will also
blink. If this occurs, have the GPF system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
GPF : Gasoline Particulate Filter
Check headlight (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if the
headlights are not operating properly.
In addition, if a specific lamp(turn signal
lamp etc.) is not operating properly, the
warning message according to a specific
lamp (turn signal lamp etc.) is displayed.
A corresponding bulb may need to be
replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
Check turn signal (if equipped)
This message is displayed if the turn
signal lamps are not operating properly.
A lamp may need to be replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
Check headlight LED (if equipped)
This message is displayed if there is a
problem with the LED headlight. Have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
4-27
Instrument cluster
Check Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist system (if equipped)
Check Driver Attention Warning
system (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed
if there is a problem with Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist. Have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)” in
chapter 6.
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with Driver Attention
Warning. Have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Driver
Attention Warning (DAW)” in chapter 6.
Check Lane Keeping Assist system (if
equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the High Beam
Assist. Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “High Beam
Assist (HBA)” in chapter 5.
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with Lane Keeping
Assist. Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA)” in chapter 6.
Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed
if there is a problem with Blind-Spot
Collision Warning. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more details, refer to “Blind-Spot
Collision Warning (BCW) ” in chapter 6.
4-28
Check High Beam Assist system
(if equipped)
Check Smart Cruise Control system
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with Smart Cruise
Control. Have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Smart Cruise
Control (SCC)” in chapter 6.
04
LCD DISPLAY
LCD display control
OTM040050
The LCD display modes can be changed by using the control buttons.
Switch
Function
MODE button for changing modes
,
OK
MOVE switch for changing items
SELECT/RESET button for setting or resetting the selected item
Information
When the infotainment system is applied, only the User’s Setting mode on the
infotainment system is supported but the User’s Setting mode on the instrument cluster is
not supported.
4-29
Instrument cluster
View modes
View modes
Driving Assist
Symbol
Explanation
This mode displays the state of :
- Smart Cruise Control (SCC)
- Highway Driving Assist (HDA)
- Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
- Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
For more information, refer to "Smart Cruise Control
(SCC) ", "Highway Driving Assist (HDA) ", "Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA) ”, “Driver Attention Warning (DAW) ” in
chapter 7 and "4 Wheel Drive (4WD)" in chapter 6.
Trip
Computer
This mode displays driving information such as the
tripmeter, fuel economy, etc.
For more details, refer to "Trip Computer" in this chapter.
Turn By Turn
(TBT)
This mode displays the state of the navigation.
User Settings
In this mode, you can change settings of the doors, lamps,
etc.
Warning
The Warning mode displays warning messages related to
the vehicle when one or more systems are not operating
normally.
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-30
04
Trip computer mode
Driving Assist mode
OTMA060011
The trip computer mode displays
information related to vehicle driving
parameters including fuel economy,
tripmeter information and vehicle speed.
For more information, refer to "Trip
Computer" in this chapter.
Turn By Turn (TBT) mode
OIK047147N
Turn-by-turn navigation, distance/time
to destination information is displayed
when Turn by Turn view is selected.
OTMA040003
SCC/HDA/LKA
This mode displays the state of the Smart
Cruise Control (SCC), Highway Driving
Assist (HDA) and Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA).
For more details, refer to each system
information in chapter 7.
OIG059288L
Driver Attention Warning
This mode displays the state of the Driver
Attention Warning (DAW).
For more details, refer to “Driver
Attention Warning (DAW)” in chapter 7.
4-31
Instrument cluster
Master warning group
OTM040024
Driving force distribution (4WD)
This mode displays information related to
4WD driving force.
If the vehicle is in 4WD lock state, this
mode is not displayed.
For detailed information, refer to the
"Four Wheel Drive" in the chapter 6.
4-32
OIG059097L
This warning light informs the driver the
following situations.
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
malfunction (if equipped)
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
radar blocked (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning
malfunction (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
- LED headlight malfunction
(if equipped)
- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control malfunction (if
equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control radar blocked (if
equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction
The Master Warning Light illuminates
if one or more of the above warning
situations occur.
At this time, a Master Warning icon ( )
will appear beside the User Settings icon
( ), on the LCD display.
If the warning situation is solved, the
master warning light will be turned
off and the Master Warning icon will
disappear.
04
Shift to P to edit settings
This warning message illuminates if
you try to select an item from the User
Settings mode while driving.
ś Automatic transmission / Dual clutch
transmission.
For your safety, change the User
Settings after parking the vehicle,
applying the parking brake and
selecting the shift button to P(Park).
OTM080005L
Tire Pressure
This mode displays information related to
Tire Pressure.
For more details, refer to "Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)" in chapter
8.
Quick guide (Help)
This mode provides quick guides for the
systems in the User Settings mode.
Select an item, press and hold the OK
button.
For more details about each system,
refer to this Owner’s Manual.
User settings mode
Information
When the infotainment system is applied,
only the User’s Setting mode on the
infotainment system is supported but the
User’s Setting mode on the instrument
cluster is not supported.
OTM040060L
In this mode, you can change the
settings of the instrument cluster, doors,
lamps, etc.
1. Driver Assistance
2. Head-Up Display
3. Cluster
4. Lights
5. Door
6. Convenience
7. Units
The information provided may differ
depending on which functions are
applicable to your vehicle.
4-33
Instrument cluster
1. Driver Assistance
Items
SCC
Reaction
Explanation
To adjust the sensitivity of the Smart Cruise Control system.
śFast/Normal/Slow
For more details, refer to ''Smart Cruise Control (SCC)'' in chapter 7.
śLane Following Assist
To activate or deactivate the Lane Following Assist.
For more details, refer to the "Lane Following Assist (LFA)" in chapter 7.
śHighway Driving Assist
Driving
To activate or deactivate the Highway Driving Assist.
Convenience For more details, refer to the "Highway Driving Assist (HDA)" in chapter 7.
śAuto Highway Speed Control
To activate or deactivate the Auto Highway Speed Control.
For more details, refer to the "Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
(NSCC)" in chapter 7.
Warning
Timing
To adjust the warning timing of the driver assistance system.
śNormal / Later
Warning
Volume
To adjust the warning volume of the driver assistance system.
śHigh / Medium / Low / Off
Driver
Attention
Warning
Forward
safety
Lane safety
4-34
śLeading vehicle departure alert
To activate or deactivate the Leading vehicle departure alert.
For more details, refer to the "Leading vehicle departure alert" in chapter
7.
śInattentive Driving Warning
To alert the driver's inattentive driving.
For more details, refer to the "Driver attention Warning (DAW)" in
chapter 7.
To adjust the Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
śActive Assist
śWarning Only
śOff
For more details, refer to the "Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)"
in chapter 7.
To adjust the Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) function.
śAssist
śWarning Only
śOff
For more details, refer to the "Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)" in chapter 7.
04
Items
Explanation
śBlind-Spot View
To activate or deactivate the Blind-Spot View.
For more details, refer to the "Blind-Spot View Monitor (BVM)" in chapter
7.
Blind-Spot
safety
śSafe Exit Assist (SEA)
To activate or deactivate the Safe Exit Assistance.
For more details, refer to the "Safe Exit Assistance (SEA)" in chapter 7.
śActive Assist
śWarning Only
śOff
To activate or deactivate the Blind-Spot View.
For more details, refer to the "Blind-Spot View Monitor (BVM)" in chapter
7.
śSurround View Monitor Auto On
To activate or deactivate the Surround View Monitor Auto On.
For more details, refer to the "Surround View Monitor (SVM)" in chapter
7.
śParking Distance Warning Auto On
To activate or deactivate the Parking Distance Warning Auto On.
For more details, refer to the "Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning (PDW)" in chapter 7.
Parking
Safety
śRear Cross-Traffic Safety
To activate or deactivate the Rear Cross-Traffic Safety.
For more details, refer to the "Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist (RCCA)" in chapter 7.
śRear Active Assist
To activate or deactivate the Rear Active Assist.
For more details, refer to the "Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist
(PCA)" in chapter 7.
śRear Warning Only
To activate or deactivate the Rear Warning.
For more details, refer to the "Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist
(PCA)" in chapter 7.
śOff
To deactivate the Parking Safety.
4-35
Instrument cluster
2. Head-Up Display (if equipped)
Items
Enable
Head-up
display
Display
Height
Rotation
Explanation
If this item is checked, Head-Up Display will be activated.
To adjust the height of the image displayed.
To adjust the angle of the image displayed.
Brightness
To adjust the brightness of the image displayed.
Content
Selection
To select the content to be displayed.
3. Cluster
Items
Reset fuel
economy
Explanation
śAt vehicle start
śAfter refueling
śManually
To reset the fuel economy displayed.
To activate or deactivate the Wiper/ Light mode.
Wiper/Lights
When activated, the LCD display shows the selected Wiper/Light mode
Display
whenever you changed the mode.
Traffic Signs
To set the traffic signs displayed.
Icy Road
Warning
To activate or deactivate the icy road warning.
Welcome
Sound
To activate or deactivate the welcome sound.
Theme
Selection
You can select the theme of the cluster.
śType A Cluster : Theme A / Theme B / Theme C
śType B Cluster : Link to Drive Mode / Theme A / Theme B / Theme C /
Theme D
4-36
04
4. Lights
Items
Illumination
One Touch
Turn Signal
Ambient
Light
Brightness
(if equipped)
Ambient
Light Color
(if equipped)
Headlight
Delay
High Beam
Assist
Explanation
To adjust the illumination level.
śLevel 1~20
śOff : The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated.
ś3, 5, 7 Flashes : The turn signal indicator will blink 3, 5, or 7 times when
the turn signal lever is moved slightly.
For more details, refer to “Lighting” in chapter 5.
śOff
śLevel 1/2/3/4
śPolar White/Moon White/Ice Blue/Ocean Blue/Jade Green/Orchid Green/
Freesia Yellow/ Sunrise Red/Aurora Purple/Lightening Violet
To activate or deactivate the headlight delay function.
For more details, refer to "Lighting" in chapter 5.
To activate or deactivate High Beam Assist function.
For more details, refer to "High Beam Assist (HBA)" in chapter 5.
4-37
Instrument cluster
5. Door
Items
Explanation
śEnable on Shift : All doors will be automatically locked if the shift button
is shifted from the P (Park) position to the R (Reverse), N (Neutral), or D
Automatically (Drive) position. (only when the engine is running.)
śEnable on Speed : All doors will be automatically locked when the vehicle
Lock
speed exceeds 9.3mph (15km/h).
śOff : The auto door lock operation will be deactivated.
śOn Shift to P: All doors will be automatically unlocked if the shift button is
shifted to the P (Park) position. (only when the engine is running.)
Automatically śOn key out/On vehicle off : All doors will be automatically unlocked when
the ignition key is removed from the ignition switch or the Engine Start/
Unlock
Stop button is set to the OFF position.
śOff : The auto door unlock operation will be canceled.
Power
Liftgate
If this item is checked, the power liftgate function will be activated.
For more details, refer to "Power liftgate" in chapter 5.
Power
Liftgate
Opening
Speed
To adjust the power liftgate speed.
śFast/Normal
For more details, refer to "Power liftgate" in chapter 5.
Smart
Liftgate
To activate or deactivate the smart liftgate.
For more details, refer to "Smart liftgate" in chapter 5.
6. Convenience
Items
Explanation
Seat Easy
Access
śOff : The seat easy access function is deactivated.
śNormal/Extended : When you turn off the engine, the driver's seat will
automatically move rearward short (Normal) or long (Extended) for you to
enter or exit the vehicle more comfortably.
For more details, refer to "Driver Position Memory System" in chapter 5.
Rear
Occupant
Alert
To activate or deactivate the Rear Occupant Alert.
For more details, refer to "Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) system" in chapter
5.
śOn door unlock : The side view mirrors are unfolded and the welcome
light turns on automatically when the doors are unlocked.
Welcome śOn driver approach : The side view mirrors are unfolded and the welcome
Mirror/Light light turns on automatically when the vehicle is approached with the
smart key.
For more details, refer to ''Welcome System'' in chapter 5."
4-38
04
Items
Wireless
Charging
System
Explanation
To activate or deactivate the wireless charging system in the front seat.
For more details, refer to "Wireless cellular phone charging system" in
chapter 5.
To activate or deactivate the Auto Rear Wiper function.
Auto Rear If you move the shift button from D to R when the front wiper operates, the
Wiper (in R) rear wiper will operate automatically. Then, if you move the shift button
from R to D, the rear wiper will stop."
śService Interval
To activate or deactivate the service interval function.
Service
Interval
śAdjust Interval
If the service interval menu is activated, you may adjust the time and
distance.
śReset
To reset the service interval.
7. Units
Items
Speed Unit
Explanation
To select the speed unit. (km/h, MPH)
Temperature
To select the temperature unit. (°C,°F)
Unit
Fuel
Economy
Unit
To select the fuel economy unit. (km/L, L/100km, MPG)
Tire Pressure
To select the tire pressure unit. (psi, kPa, bar)
Unit
4-39
Instrument cluster
Trip computer (Type A)
Ŷ Type A
The trip computer is a microcomputercontrolled driver information system that
displays information related to driving.
Information
Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
Trip modes
Drive Info
śTULSGLstance
śAverDJHFXHOEconomy
ś,QstanWFXHOEconomy
Since Refueling
śTULSGLstance
śAverDJHFXHOEconomy
śInstanWFXHOEconomy
Accumulated Info
śTULSGLstance
śAverDJHFXHOEconomy
śInstanWFXHOEconomy
Auto Stop (if equipped)
Digital speedometer
4-40
Ŷ Type B
OTM040050
To change the trip mode, toggle the
" switch on the steering wheel
" ,
04
ś Manual reset
To clear the average fuel economy
manually, press the OK switch on the
steering wheel for more than 1 second
when the Average Fuel Economy is
displayed.
ś Automatic reset
To automatically reset the average
fuel economy, select between ‘After
Ignition’ or ‘After Refueling’ from
the Settings menu in the instrument
cluster.
- After Ignition: When the engine has
been OFF for 3 minutes or longer
the average fuel economy will reset
automatically.
- After Refueling: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically
after adding 6 liters (1.6 gallons) of
fuel or more and after driving speed
exceeds 1 mph (1 km/h).
à For 12.3-inch instrument cluster, you
can check the fuel economy in the
center bottom of the cluster.
Type A
Type B
OTMA040004
OTMA040005
Drive info
Trip distance (1), average fuel economy
(2), and instant fuel economy (3) are
displayed.
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the engine
has been OFF for 3 minutes or longer the
Drive Info screen will reset.
To reset manually, press the OK switch
on the steering wheel for more than 1
second when ‘Drive Info’ is displayed.
Type A
Type B
OTMA040006
OTMA040007
Since refuel(l)ing
Trip distance (1), average fuel economy
(2), and instant fuel economy (3) after the
vehicle has been refueled are displayed.
To reset manually, press the OK switch
on the steering wheel for more than
1 second when ‘Since Refueling’ is
displayed.
4-41
Instrument cluster
Type A
Type B
OTMA040009
OTMA040010
Accumulated info
Accumulated trip distance (1), average
fuel economy (2), and instant fuel
economy (3) are displayed.
The information is accumulated starting
from the last reset.
To reset manually, press the OK switch
on the steering wheel for more than
1 second when ‘Accumulated Info’ is
displayed.
OJX1069044
Auto stop (if equipped)
AUTO STOP display shows the elapsed
time of engine stop by Idle Stop and Go
system.
For more details, refer to “Idle Stop and
Go (ISG)” section in chapter 6.
4-42
OIK047151N
Digital speedometer
Digital speedometer display shows the
speed of the vehicle.
04
Trip computer (Type B)
Ŷ Type A
The trip computer is a microcomputercontrolled driver information system that
displays information related to driving.
Information
Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
Trip modes
Drive Info
Ŷ Type B
OTM040050
To change the trip mode, toggle the
" switch on the steering wheel
" ,
ś7ULSGLVWDQFH
ś$YHUDJH)XHO(FRQRP\
ś(ODSVHGWLPH
Since refueling
ś7ULSGLVWDQFH
ś$YHUDJH)XHO(FRQRP\
ś(ODSVHGWLPH
Accumulated Info
ś7ULSGLVWDQFH
ś$YHUDJH)XHO(FRQRP\
ś(ODSVHGWLPH
Auto Stop (if equipped)
Digital speedometer
4-43
Instrument cluster
ś Manual reset
To clear the average fuel economy
manually, press the OK switch on the
steering wheel for more than 1 second
when the Average Fuel Economy is
displayed.
ś Automatic reset
To automatically reset the average
fuel economy, select between ‘After
Ignition’ or ‘After Refueling’ from
the Settings menu in the instrument
cluster.
- After Ignition: When the engine has
been OFF for 3 minutes or longer
the average fuel economy will reset
automatically.
- After Refueling: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically
after adding 6 liters (1.6 gallons) of
fuel or more and after driving speed
exceeds 1 mph (1 km/h).
à For 12.3-inch instrument cluster, you
can check the fuel economy in the
center bottom of the cluster.
Type A
Type B
OTMA040012
OTMA040013
Drive info
Trip distance (1), average fuel economy
(2), and total driving time (3) are
displayed.
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the engine
has been OFF for 3 minutes or longer the
Drive Info screen will reset.
To reset manually, press the OK switch
on the steering wheel for more than 1
second when ‘Drive Info’ is displayed.
Type A
Type B
OTMA040014
OTMA040015
Since refuel(l)ing
Trip distance (1), average fuel economy
(2), and total driving time (3) after the
vehicle has been refueled are displayed.
To reset manually, press the OK switch
on the steering wheel for more than
1 second when ‘Since Refueling’ is
displayed.
4-44
04
Type A
Type B
OTMA040016
OTMA040017
Accumulated info
Accumulated trip distance (1), average
fuel economy (2), and total driving time
(3) are displayed.
The information is accumulated starting
from the last reset.
To reset manually, press the OK switch
on the steering wheel for more than
1 second when ‘Accumulated Info’ is
displayed.
OTMA040018
Digital speedometer
Digital speedometer display shows the
speed of the vehicle.
OJX1069044
Auto stop (if equipped)
AUTO STOP display shows the elapsed
time of engine stop by Idle Stop and Go
system.
For more details, refer to “Idle Stop and
Go (ISG)” section in chapter 6.
4-45
5. Convenience features
Accessing your vehicle ..................................................................................... 5-5
Remote key ...................................................................................................................5-5
Smart key ......................................................................................................................5-8
Immobilizer system .................................................................................................... 5-14
Hyundai Digital Key .....................................................................................................5-15
Door locks......................................................................................................... 5-31
Operating door locks from outside the vehicle.........................................................5-31
Operating door locks from inside the vehicle .......................................................... 5-32
Auto door lock/unlock features.................................................................................5-35
Child-protector rear door locks.................................................................................5-35
Electronic child safety lock ........................................................................................5-36
Theft-alarm system ......................................................................................... 5-38
Integrated memory system ............................................................................ 5-39
Storing memory positions .........................................................................................5-39
Recalling memory positions ..................................................................................... 5-40
Resetting the system ................................................................................................ 5-40
Easy access function .................................................................................................. 5-41
Steering wheel ................................................................................................ 5-42
Electric Power Steering (EPS)....................................................................................5-42
Tilt / Telescopic steering ............................................................................................5-43
Heated steering wheel ...............................................................................................5-43
Horn............................................................................................................................ 5-44
Mirrors ............................................................................................................. 5-45
Inside rearview mirror ................................................................................................5-45
Side View mirrors .......................................................................................................5-55
Reverse parking aid .................................................................................................... 5-57
Windows .......................................................................................................... 5-58
Power windows ..........................................................................................................5-59
Panoramic sunroof.......................................................................................... 5-62
Power sunshade .........................................................................................................5-63
Tilt open/close ............................................................................................................5-63
Slide open/close........................................................................................................ 5-64
Resetting the sunroof ................................................................................................5-65
Sunroof open warning .............................................................................................. 5-66
5
Exterior features.............................................................................................. 5-67
Hood............................................................................................................................5-67
Liftgate ....................................................................................................................... 5-68
Power liftgate .............................................................................................................5-70
Smart liftgate .............................................................................................................. 5-75
Fuel filler door............................................................................................................. 5-77
Head-Up Display (HUD) .................................................................................5-80
Head-up display settings .......................................................................................... 5-80
Head-up display information ................................................................................... 5-80
Precautions while using the head-up display .......................................................... 5-81
Lighting............................................................................................................ 5-82
Exterior lights..............................................................................................................5-82
High Beam Assist (HBA) ................................................................................5-86
System settings ......................................................................................................... 5-86
System operation .......................................................................................................5-87
System malfunction and limitations .........................................................................5-87
Interior lights ...................................................................................................5-89
5
Interior lamp AUTO cut ............................................................................................. 5-89
Front lamps ................................................................................................................ 5-89
Rear lamps ................................................................................................................. 5-90
Vanity mirror lamp..................................................................................................... 5-90
Luggage compartment lamp .................................................................................... 5-91
Puddle lamp................................................................................................................ 5-91
Welcome system ........................................................................................................5-92
Wipers and washers........................................................................................ 5-93
Windshield wipers ......................................................................................................5-93
Front windshield washers ..........................................................................................5-95
Rear window wiper and washer ............................................................................... 5-96
Manual climate control system ...................................................................... 5-97
Heating and air conditioning .................................................................................... 5-98
System operation ......................................................................................................5-101
System maintenance ............................................................................................... 5-103
Automatic climate control system ................................................................5-105
Automatic heating and air conditioning ................................................................. 5-106
Manual heating and air conditioning ...................................................................... 5-106
System operation .......................................................................................................5-111
System maintenance ................................................................................................ 5-113
5. Convenience features
Windshield defrosting and defogging ...........................................................5-115
Manual climate control system ................................................................................ 5-115
Automatic climate control system ........................................................................... 5-116
Auto defogging system (only for automatic climate control system) ................... 5-117
Rear window defroster ............................................................................................. 5-118
Climate control additional features ...............................................................5-119
Auto defogging system ............................................................................................. 5-119
Auto dehumidify ....................................................................................................... 5-120
Recirculating air when washer fluid is used ............................................................ 5-121
Sunroof inside air recirculation ................................................................................ 5-121
Auto. Controls That Use Climate Control Settings (for driver’s seat) .................... 5-121
Storage compartment ................................................................................... 5-122
Center console storage .............................................................................................5-122
Glove box ...................................................................................................................5-122
Tray .............................................................................................................................5-123
Luggage tray ..............................................................................................................5-123
Interior features ............................................................................................. 5-124
Cup holder ................................................................................................................ 5-124
Ashtray .......................................................................................................................5-125
Sunvisor .....................................................................................................................5-125
Power outlet ............................................................................................................. 5-126
USB charger ...............................................................................................................5-127
AC Inverter .................................................................................................................5-127
Wireless smart phone charging system.................................................................. 5-129
Clock .......................................................................................................................... 5-131
Coat hook................................................................................................................... 5-131
Floor mat anchor(s) ...................................................................................................5-132
Side curtain ............................................................................................................... 5-133
Luggage net holder .................................................................................................. 5-133
Cargo security screen .............................................................................................. 5-134
Exterior features.............................................................................................5-136
Roof side rails ........................................................................................................... 5-136
5
Infotainment system ...................................................................................... 5-137
USB Port .....................................................................................................................5-137
Antenna ......................................................................................................................5-137
Steering wheel remote controls ...............................................................................5-137
Infotainment system ................................................................................................ 5-138
Voice recognition ..................................................................................................... 5-138
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology ............................................................................. 5-139
How vehicle radio works.......................................................................................... 5-139
Infotainment System specifications ............................................................5-143
USB ............................................................................................................................ 5-143
Bluetooth .................................................................................................................. 5-144
Trademarks .....................................................................................................5-144
5
05
ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE
Remote key (if equipped)
WARNING
Do not leave the keys in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could place the
key in the ignition switch and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
Unlocking
OPD046001
Your HYUNDAI uses a remote key, which
you can use to lock or unlock the driver
and passenger doors or the liftgate.
1. Door Lock
2. Door Unlock
3. Liftgate Open
4. Panic
Locking
To lock :
1. Close all doors, engine hood and
liftgate.
2. Press the Door Lock button (1) on the
remote key.
3. The doors will lock. The hazard
warning lights will blink. Also, the side
view mirror will fold, if ‘Convenience
Ɵ:HOFRPHPLUURUOLJKWƟ2QGRRU
unlock’ is selected from the User
Settings mode on the LCD display. For
more details, refer to “LCD Display”
in chapter 4.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
To unlock:
1. Press the Door Unlock button (2) on
the remote key.
2. The doors will unlock. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times.
Also, the side view mirror will unfold,
LIœ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPHPLUURU
OLJKWƟ2QGRRUXQORFNŔLVVHOHFWHG
from the User Settings mode on the
LCD display. For more details, refer to
“LCD Display” in chapter 4.
Information
After unlocking the doors, the doors will
lock automatically after 30 seconds unless
a door is opened.
Panic alarm
The horn sounds and the hazard warning
lights blink for about 30 seconds if this
button is pressed for more than 0.5
seconds. To stop the horn and lights,
press any button on the transmitter.
5-5
Convenience features
Information
Mechanical key
The word “HOLD” is written on the
button to inform you that you must press
and hold the button for more than one
second.
Start-up
For detailed information refer to “Key
Ignition Switch” in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the remote key:
ś Keep the remote key away from
water or any liquid and fire. If
the inside of the remote key gets
damp (due to drinks or moisture),
or is heated, internal circuit may
malfunction, excluding the car from
the warranty.
ś Avoid dropping or throwing the
remote key.
ś Protect the remote key from extreme
temperatures.
OPD046003
If the remote key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the door
by using the mechanical key.
To unfold the key, press the release
button then the key will unfold
automatically.
To fold the key, fold the key manually
while pressing the release button.
NOTICE
Do not fold the key without pressing the
release button. This may damage the
key.
Remote key precautions
The remote key will not work if any of the
following occur:
ś The key is in the ignition switch.
ś You exceed the operating distance
limit (about 10 m [30 feet]).
ś The remote key battery is weak.
ś Other vehicles or objects may be
blocking the signal.
ś The weather is extremely cold.
ś The remote key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the remote key.
5-6
05
When the remote key does not work
correctly, open and close the door
with the mechanical key. If you have
a problem with the remote key, it is
recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the remote key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals.
This is especially important when the
phone is active such as making and
receiving calls, text messaging, and/ or
sending/receiving emails.
Avoid placing the remote key and your
mobile phone in the same location and
always try to maintain an adequate
distance between the two devices.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the device.
NOTICE
Keep the remote key away from
electromagnetic materials that block
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
Battery replacement
OPD046002
Battery Type: CR2032
1. Insert a slim tool into the slot and
gently pry open the cover.
2. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
3. Reinstall the rear cover of the remote
key.
If you suspect your remote key might
have sustained some damage, or you feel
your remote key is not working correctly,
it is recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A BUTTON
BATTERY.
If swallowed, a lithium button battery
can cause severe or fatal injuries within
2 hours. Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
If you think batteries may have been
swallowed or placed inside any part
of the body, seek immediate medical
attention.
5-7
Convenience features
Type C
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s)
and regulation.
Smart key (if equipped)
Type A
OTMA050022
Type D
OTM050003
Type B
OTMA050021
1.
2.
3.
4.
OTM050004
Your HYUNDAI uses a smart key, which
you can use to lock or unlock a door (and
liftgate) and even start the engine even
just carrying the key.
1. Door lock
2. Door unlock
3. Liftgate Open (Liftgate)
Liftgate Open / Close (Power liftgate)
4. Panic Open / Close
5. Remote Smart parking Assist
(Forward)
6. Remote Smart parking Assist
(Rearward)
7. Remote start
5-8
Door lock
Door unlock
Panic
Remote Smart Parking Assist
(Forward)
5. Remote Smart Parking Assist
(Rearward)
6. Remote start
05
Locking your vehicle (Button type)
Locking your vehicle (Touch sensor
type)
OTM048000
To lock :
1. Close all doors, engine hood and
liftgate.
2. Carry the smart key.
3. Either press the door handle button or
press the Door Lock button (1) on the
smart key.
4. The hazard warning lights will blink.
Also, the side view mirror will fold,
LIœ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPHPLUURU
OLJKWƟ2QGRRUXQORFNRU2QGULYHU
approach’ is selected from the User
Settings mode on the LCD display. For
more details, refer to “LCD Display”
in chapter 4.
5. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
OTMA050001
1. Close all of the doors, the hood and
the liftgate.
2. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession and touch either the
touch sensor on the door handle (the
engraved part) or press the Door Lock
button (1) on the smart key within 1
second.
3. The doors, hood and trunk are locked.
The chime will sound once and the
hazard warning lights will blink.
ś The door handle button will only
operate when the smart key is within
28~40 inches (0.7~1 m) from the
outside door handle.
ś Make sure the doors are locked by
pulling the door handle.
ś If you locked the door with the touch
sensor on the door handle, the doors
cannot be unlocked with the sensor
within 3 seconds.
5-9
Convenience features
Even though you press the outside
door handle button, the doors will not
lock and the chime will sound for three
seconds if any of the following occur:
ś The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
ś The Engine Start/Stop button is in
ACC or ON position.
ś Any door except the liftgate is open.
Unlocking your vehicle
Button type
CAUTION
When you leave your vehicle with
the smart key, make sure to press the
button on the front door handle or
touch the touch sensor on the front
door handle to lock the doors after
close all of the doors, the hood and the
trunk. If you do not press the button
or touch the touch sensor firmly, the
doors might not be locked so please use
caution.
OTM048000
Touch sensor type
WARNING
Do not leave the Smart Key in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could press the
Engine Start/ Stop button and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
5-10
OTM050005
1. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
2. Press the Door Unlock button (2) on
the smart key, press the button on the
front door handle or touch the door
unlock sensor inside of the front door
handle to unlock the doors.
3. All of the doors will unlock. When the
doors unlock, the hazard warning
lights will blink two times and the
chime will sound.
śThe door handle button will only
operate when the smart key is
within 28~40 inches (0.7~1 m) from
the outside door handle.
śIf you do not open the door after
unlocking within 30 seconds, it will
return to the lock mode.
śIf you unlocked the door with the
door handle, the doors cannot be
locked with the sensor within 2
seconds.
05
Opening the liftgate
To open the liftgate:
1. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
2. Press either the liftgate open/close
button on the vehicle or press and
hold the liftgate open button on the
smart key for more than one second.
The hazard warning lights will blink
two times and the liftgate will open.
Remotely starting vehicle
(if equipped)
You can start the vehicle using the
Remote Start button on the smart key.
To start the vehicle remotely:
1. Press the door lock button on the
smart key within 32 feet (10 m) from
the vehicle.
2. Press the Remote Start button for
more than 2 seconds within 4 seconds
after pressing the door lock button.
3. The hazard warning lights will blink
and the engine will start.
4. To turn off the remote start function,
press the Remote Start button once.
Information
ś The vehicle must be in P (Park) for the
remote start function to start.
ś The engine turns off if you get on the
vehicle without a registered smart key.
ś The engine turns off if you do not get
on the vehicle within 10 minutes after
remotely starting the vehicle.
ś The Remote Start button may not
operate if the smart key is not within 32
feet (10 m).
ś The vehicle will not remotely start if the
engine hood or liftgate is opened.
ś Do not idle the engine for a long period.
Remotely moving vehicle forward or
reverse (if equipped)
With the smart key, the driver can move
the vehicle forward or reverse using the
Forward or Reverse button on the smart
key.
For more details, refer to “Remote
Smart Parking Assist (RSPA)” section in
chapter 7.
Panic alarm
The horn sounds and the hazard warning
lights blink for about 30 seconds if this
button is pressed for more than 0.5
seconds. To stop the horn and lights,
press any button on the transmitter.
Start-up
You can start the vehicle without
inserting the key.
For more details, refer to the “Engine
Start/Stop Button” section in chapter 6.
Information
If the smart key is not moved for some
time, the detection function for smart key
operation will pause. Lift the smart key to
activate the detection again.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the smart key:
ś Keep the smart key in a cool,
dry place to avoid damage or
malfunction. Exposure to moisture
or high temperature may cause
the internal circuit of the smart key
to malfunction which may not be
covered under warranty.
ś Avoid dropping or throwing the
smart key.
ś Protect the smart key from extreme
temperatures.
5-11
Convenience features
Mechanical key
Loss of a smart key
If the Smart Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
driver’s door by using the mechanical
key.
To remove the mechanical key from the
smart key FOB:
A maximum of two smart keys can
be registered to a single vehicle. If
you happen to lose your smart key,
it is recommended that you should
immediately take the vehicle and
remaining key to your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or tow the vehicle, if
necessary.
Smart key precautions
OFE048007
Press and hold the release button (1) and
remove the mechanical key (2). Insert the
mechanical key into the key hole on the
door.
To reinstall the mechanical key, put the
key into the hole and push it until a click
sound is heard.
5-12
The smart key may not work if any of the
following occur:
ś The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the transmitter.
ś The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a mobile phone.
ś Another vehicle’s smart key is being
operated close to your vehicle.
If the smart key does not work correctly,
open and close the door with the
mechanical key. If you have a problem
with the smart key, it is recommended to
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the smart key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is specifically
relevant when the phone is active such
as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails. When possible, avoid keeping the
smart key and your mobile phone in the
same location such as a pants or jacket
pocket in order to avoid interference
between the two devices.
05
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the device.
Battery replacement
If the Smart Key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
ODN8059266
NOTICE
ś Keep the smart key away from
electromagnetic materials that
blocks electromagnetic waves to the
key surface.
ś Always have the smart key with
you when leaving the vehicle. If the
smart key is left near the vehicle, the
vehicle battery may be discharged.
If the Smart Key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Remove the smart key cover by turning
the screwdriver clockwise by inserting
the screwdriver (-) into the hole.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Remove the mechanical key.
2. Use a slim tool to pry open the rear
cover of the smart key.
3. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
4. Reinstall the rear cover of the smart
key.
If you suspect your smart key might have
sustained some damage, or you feel
your smart key is not working correctly,
it is recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-13
Convenience features
WARNING
THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A BUTTON
BATTERY.
If swallowed, a lithium button battery
can cause severe or fatal injuries within
2 hours. Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
If you think batteries may have been
swallowed or placed inside any part
of the body, seek immediate medical
attention.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
Immobilizer system
The immobilizer system helps protect
your vehicle from theft. If an improperly
coded key (or other device) is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
When the Engine Start/Stop button
is pressed to the ON position, the
immobilizer system indicator should
come on briefly, then go off. If the
indicator starts to blink, the system does
not recognize the coding of the key.
Press the Engine Start/Stop button to
the OFF position, then press the Engine
Start/Stop button to the ON position
again.
The system may not recognize your
key’s coding if another immobilizer
key or other metal object (for example,
key chain) is near the key. The engine
may not start because the metal may
interrupt the transponder signal from
transmitting normally.
If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of the key, it is
recommended that you contact your
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-14
Do not attempt to alter this system
or add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle inoperable.
WARNING
In order to prevent theft of your
vehicle, do not leave spare keys
anywhere in your vehicle. Your
immobilizer password is a customer
unique password and should be kept
confidential.
NOTICE
The transponder in your key is an
important part of the immobilizer
system. It is designed to give years
of trouble-free service, however you
should avoid exposure to moisture,
static electricity and rough handling.
Immobilizer system malfunction could
occur.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the device.
05
Hyundai Digital Key
Digital Key Application
To use Hyundai Digital Key mobile app,
you should install Hyundai digital key
application. Search ‘Hyundai digital key’
in the Google Play Store and download
the app. Please refer to the detailed
manual of the digital key app. The option
can be found under the following app
menu:
0HQXƟ$SSOLFDWLRQ,QIRƟ7XWRULDO
Please note the manual before using the
app.
à This service is only available for
Android smartphones. Please confirm
supported/compatible devices on our
website.
Digital key (smartphone) NFC
function
You can use the Digital Key NFC (Near
Field Communication) function after turn
your smartphone NFC settings on. And
you should unlock & turn on smartphone
screen to use it.
à To change the NFC mode of the
smartphone, please refer to the
smartphone manual or contact
to the customer service center of
smartphone manufacturers.
WARNING
For used vehicle
If any of the digital key (smartphone key
or card key) is already registered when
you press ON button after unlocking the
doors, the message ‘Digital key(s) active’
appears on the instrument cluster once.
If you buy a used vehicle, you should
confirm the message and delete the
registered smartphone key and card key.
In addition, please notify the Hyundai
Customer Care Center.
If the card key does not work properly,
please delete the card key and register
the smartphone key and re-register the
card key.
For vehicle maintenance
If you need to have your Digital Key
System repaired or replaced please
ensure you Smartphone Key is still active.
You may have to pair your phone again.
In the case, re-initialize your Digital Keys
using the Hyundai Digital Key mobile app.
5-15
Convenience features
Digital key (smartphone)
Information
The [Save] button will be disabled if the
digital key (Smartphone key) is already
saved.
Please refer to “Digital Key Delete” in this
manual and follow the digital key delete
procedure in your car before Digital key
save.
Please refer to the ‘Tutorial’ on your
Digital key app and delete the previous
saved key in your smartphone before save.
ODN8A059129
ODN8A059240
Hyundai Digital Key (Smartphone)
Pairing
1. Turn the vehicle on with the Smart key
and make sure to keep the smart key
inside the vehicle during digital key
registration.
2. Register your Digital key from the
vehicle user setting menu as follows.
à With Navigation screen :
From the infotainment screen menu,
go to [Setup] - [Vehicle] - [Digital Key]
- [Smart Phone Key] then select the
[Save] from submenu.
à Without navigation screen :
From cluster menu, go to [Digital Key]
- [Smart Phone Key] and select [Save].
3. Select the vehicle to save on your
Digital key application and activate
the save mode.
à Save mode is available only on
the vehicle owner’s Digital key
application.
4. Place the backside of smartphone
onto the wireless charging pad(invehicle authentication pad).
The saving process will begin
automatically.
5. Once the digital key save is complete,
a message will be shown on the
infotainment screen or cluster.
6. Remove the smartphone from the pad
and complete the saving process.
OTM050022
[A] : Indicator light
[B] : Wireless Charging Pad
(In-vehicle Authentication Pad)
5-16
05
ODN8A059129
3. Once the digital key delete is
complete, a message will be shown
on the infotainment screen or cluster.
4. Go to [Initialize Digital Key] menu on
the digital key application and select
the vehicle to delete the digital key
information.
ś 2SHQWKH+\XQGDL'LJLWDO.H\DSSƟ
0HQXƟ,QLWLDOL]H'LJLWDO.H\
à If the saved digital key information
in your car is deleted due to vehicle
maintenance, the digital key in your
smartphone should be deleted as well.
à For more information, please refer to
the ‘Tutorial’ on your Digital key app.
CAUTION
ODN8A059130
Hyundai Digital Key (Smartphone Key)
Deletion
1. Turn the vehicle on with the Smart
key and make sure to keep the smart
key inside the vehicle during delete
process.
2. Delete your Digital key from the
vehicle user setting menu as follows.
à With Navigation screen :
From the infotainment screen menu,
go to [Setup] - [Vehicle] - [Digital Key]
- [Smart Phone Key] then select the
[Delete] from submenu.
à Without navigation screen :
From cluster menu, go to [Digital
Key] - [Smart Phone Key] and select
[Delete].
Information
The [Delete] button will be disabled if there
is no digital key (Smartphone key) saved.
ś If the smartphone is removed
from the interior authentication
pad during enrollment, the saving
process will be cancelled.
ś If the infotainment or instrument
cluster screen is changed during
enrollment, the saving process will
be cancelled.
ś If the vehicle is turned off during
enrollment, the saving process will
be cancelled.
ś If the gear is shifted, the saving
process will be cancelled.
ś If you try to save the smartphone
which is not logged in with the
vehicle owner’s ID or if you try to
save the Card key, the saving process
will not begin.
ś If the NFC setting on your
smartphone is off, the saving process
will not begin.
ś If the smartphone screen is changed
to off or locked status, the saving
process will be cancelled.
ś If there is no Smart key during the
save process, the saving process will
not begin.
5-17
Convenience features
Set up main vehicle
You can manage multiple digital keys
from the Digital key app. From the list of
digital keys you own, select the vehicle
you want to make your priority vehicle.
For more information, please refer to
the ‘Tutorial’ on your Digital key app.
OTMA050020
[1] : Door handle authentication pad
NFC door lock/unlock
You should contact your smartphone’s
NFC antenna(backside of phone) to door
handle authentication pad (1) marked
position near by the lock button) of
driver’s (or front passenger’s) outside
door for 2 seconds to lock or unlock the
doors. If the Two Press Unlock feature
is applied (press twice for unlocking),
driver’s seat door will be unlocked by
contacting the digital key (smartphone
key). In this state, if you contact one
more time within 4 seconds, all the doors
unlock. Please make sure the doors are
locked. If you do not open any of the
doors after unlocking, it automatically
re-lock after 30 seconds.
Note that you cannot lock your vehicle
when you contact NFC antenna in the
smartphone to the door handle pad if
any of the following occurs:
ś The Proximity / Smart Key is in the
vehicle.
ś The Engine Start/Stop button is in
ACC or ON position.
ś Any of the doors, hood and trunk is
opened.
If the smartphone digital key does not
work, please remove the smartphone
more than 4 inches (0.1 m) from the door
handle authentication pad and try it
again.
5-18
05
After unlock the door or start up the
vehicle with digital key, even though
the driver tries to lock the doors by the
central door lock switch, the door lock
will be once locked and immediately
released at the moment of door closed.
Start-up with Digital Key
1. After placing your registered
smartphone onto the interior
authentication pad (wireless charger),
step on the brake and press the
Engine Start/Stop button.
2. After start-up, the digital key data
will be automatically updated. It
takes 5 to 20 seconds, after that,
the smartphone can be go into the
wireless charging mode automatically.
Once the engine started, you can
remove the smartphone from the pad.
The solution allows for offline mode usage
when the mobile data connection of the
smartphone is weak. When you are in the
place where the mobile data connection
of your smartphone is available and
place your smartphone on the interior
authentication pad (wireless charger) and
start up your vehicle or contact the digital
key on the door handle to lock or unlock
the door, the remote renewal of security
information starts automatically. Even
though the engine is turned on, please
wait until the remote renewal process
is completed and wireless charger is
converted to charging mode.
CAUTION
The engine can be turned on if the
registered smartphone or card key is
placed on the interior authentication
pad (wireless charger). Do not leave
unsupervised children or people who
are not aware of the system since it
can result in serious injury or death.
Always have the registered digital key
(smartphone) or card key with you to
prevent vehicle theft when leaving the
vehicle.
For more information, refer to the
Engine Start/Stop button in chapter 6.
OTM050022
[A] : Indicator light
[B] : Wireless Charging Pad
(In-vehicle Authentication Pad)
Information
After reconnecting the vehicle battery
power supply or charging the battery, it
may take time to operate due to remote
renewal of security information. When you
lock or unlock the door with NFC, please
contact and hold your smartphone on the
door handle until it works.
5-19
Convenience features
Remote Control with Digital Key
To use the remote control function with
your android smartphone, Bluetooth
must be turned on.
Remote Control Connection with Digital
Key
1. Open Hyundai digital key application
on the smartphone. Select the
vehicle to activate the remote control
function as a main vehicle.
2. Approach with the activated
smartphone app to your vehicle
and you can check whether the
connection is available. If it enables
your smartphone to connect, connect
with your vehicle by pressing the
connect button. The remote control
function is activated after completing
the process.
Remote Control Operation with Digital
Key
You can execute the remote control
operation including door lock/unlock,
panic on/off, remote start / remote
stop and trunk opening. The icon for
each function will be highlighted and
alarm/vibration also provided when the
operation is performed.
Note that you cannot lock your vehicle
using the Hyundai digital key app if any
of the following occurs:
ś The Engine Start/Stop button is in
ACC or ON position.
ś Any doors are open.
When the smartphone and the vehicle
are connected by the Bluetooth function
but the remote control command
cannot be received over 5 minutes, the
remote control connection is cancelled
automatically.
5-20
CAUTION
ś If metallic window tint was applied
to your vehicle, it may cause
bad Bluetooth connection or
performance degradation of the
digital key.
ś If multiple users operate the remote
control function simultaneously, the
connection between the digital key
and the vehicle might result in failed
commands. Please connect and
operate the remote control function
only the necessary user.
ś When using the remote control
operation, the driver (the remote
control user) should leave the vehicle
after confirming the door lock (the
chime sounds once and the hazard
warning lights blink).
ś The remote functions of the Digital
Key app enable the vehicle to be
controlled from a set distance. If
the digital key or the vehicle goes
beyond the operable distance, the
remote control function might be
disconnected or cancelled.
ś If the digital key (smartphone) is
connected with the vehicle for the
remote control, the driver with the
key goes far away from the vehicle,
the function might not work.
ś If the remote control operation
is executed where the mobile
connection is weak, Bluetooth
connection is poor due to several
Bluetooth devices or there is an
object such as metal or concrete, it
might be delayed or the operable
distance might decrease. You should
not cover the smartphone with your
hand or place other devices which
can cause frequency interference. It
may result in poor performance.
ś If the remote control function is not
available, please use NFC function to
lock or unlock the doors.
05
Remote Start with Digital Key
ś When the shift button of your vehicle
is in P (Park) and all of the doors
including trunk and hood is locked
and the vehicle is off, press the Door
Lock button in the Hyundai Digital
Key app then press the Remote Start
button within 4 seconds.
You can confirm the engine is on if the
hazard warning lights blinks two times
and the chime sounds.
ś If you want to turn off the engine,
press Remote Engine Stop. Air
Conditioner / Heating system
maintains the same status as when
you last used the vehicle.
ś Unless you put the registered digital
key(smartphone) on the interior
authentication pad (wireless charger)
when the remote start function is on,
the engine will turn off.
ś If you do not get on the vehicle within
10 minutes after the engine turns on,
the vehicle will turn off.
For more information, refer to the Engine
Start/Stop button in chapter 6.
Vehicle information Display
The digital key application displays
the vehicle information such as
driving or door conditions through the
communication with the vehicle.
ś How to check : Select the vehicle
what you want to check and touch
the vehicle image, then vehicle
information display page will be
shown.
ś Contents : accumulated odometer,
latest fuel economy, driving range,
fuel remaining, tire pressure, doors
lock/unlock status and last data
updated time.
à Displayed vehicle date could be
differed from the current vehicle
condition.
à For more information, please refer to
the ‘Tutorial’ on your Digital key app.
Smartphone change/App deletion
If you change your smartphone or delete
the Hyundai Digital Key App, please refer
to the following to set up your Digital
Key:
Smartphone Change/ Reset
If you change or reset the smartphone,
the registered digital key in your previous
smartphone may not be used. Please
refer to following procedure to use the
digital key.
1. Install the digital key application and
log in.
2. If you are the owner, retry the Digital
key save process.
3. If you are the sharer, need to re-share
the key from owner.
App delete & reinstall/ Delete App data
You can re-download the digital key
from server in these cases as follow
procedure.
1. Reinstall the application and log in.
2. Input the PIN number for user
verification.
3. If PIN is correct, digital key data
will be re-downloaded to your
smartphone and you can use it
without any further registration or
sharing.
Smartphone operability with Digital Key
The digital key application may not
be available to old type smartphones.
Please check the available smartphone
models with your dealer. NFC antenna
position on the smartphone can be
confirmed on each smartphone’s manual
or contact to customer service center of
the smartphone manufacture.
5-21
Convenience features
CAUTION
ś Do not leave the registered digital
key (smartphone) and card key in
your vehicle. Please carry around
your keys all the times.
ś If you happen to lose your digital
key (smartphone) or card key
registered as a main user’s key, you
should immediately delete the key
on the vehicle’s key menu. For more
information, refer to the Digital Key
Deletion in this chapter.
ś If you registered your digital key
(smartphone) or card key in the
vehicle, a message appears on the
instrument cluster and let you know
the key is registered.
(Message: Digital key(s) active.)
ś If you buy a used vehicle, you should
confirm the message and delete the
registered smartphone key and card
key. In this case, you should carry
your smart key.
ś If you keep place the NFC card
of the digital key on the interior
authentication pad (wireless
charger) while driving, it may cause a
malfunction of the NFC card.
ś You should remove your NFC card
of the digital key on the interior
authentication pad after turning on
the engine.
ś Hyundai digital key app may not
work properly when the NFC or
Bluetooth communication between
smartphone and car is not good.
ś If the remote control operation
is executed where the mobile
connection is weak, Bluetooth
connection is poor due to lots of
Bluetooth devices or there is an
object such as metal or concrete, it
might be delayed or the operable
distance might decrease. Especially,
you should not cover the smartphone
with your hand or place other
devices which can cause frequency
interference. It may result in poor
performance.
5-22
ś If the remote control function is not
activated, please use NFC function to
lock or unlock the doors
ś You should be careful not to
press the remote control button
on the digital key (smartphone)
accidentally.
ś If the digital key (smartphone) is
discharged or defective or you
cannot use the digital key since the
vehicle battery is discharged, use the
inside door lock button to lock all of
the doors.
CAUTION
ś Hyundai digital key app on the
smartphone and card key may not
work if any of the following occurs:
- Hyundai digital key app on the
smartphone is deleted. (Required
to reinstall the app)
- Account log in information of
Hyundai digital key app is expired.
(Required to re-log in)
- When you try to log in to another
smartphone instead of the
registered smartphone with same
user account.
- Smartphone rooting or app
hacking is detected.
- Smartphone battery or the vehicle
battery is discharged.
- Smartphone’s screen is off or
locked.
- NFC or Bluetooth is turned off on
the smartphone settings.
- Smartphone’s mobile network
setting is off or airplane mode is
activated.
- A credit card is overlapped in the
back of your smartphone or metal
or thick case is used.
- Use the card key with insert it
into the wallet or card holder or
overlapping with other cards.
05
- If you use a smart phone cover that
uses wireless communication or is
made of metal, the digital key NFC
function may not work properly.
Remove the smart phone cover
before using the digital key NFC
function.
Digital key (Card key)
śThe vehicle may not be controlled by
the smartphone if any of the following
occurs:
Ã
Ã
Ã
Ã
Ã
- Basic and necessary functions of
the smartphone manufacturer are
operating. (General call, urgent
call, audio or NFC payment)
- Wireless earphone is operating.
(General call, urgent call or audio)
- The digital key app function such
as basic setting or app launching
is limited by prior policy according
to the manufacturer while using a
smartphone produced by domestic
and foreign manufactures.
If you change the smartphone
number, you should modify the user
account information on the HYUNDAI
customer web site to use the digital
key app.
If the vehicle owner changes
the smartphone device, the new
smartphone should be registered in
the car after deleting the registered
digital key(smartphone).
If a sharer changes or reset the
smartphone, the key should be reshared from owner.
Some of the old smartphone may
not work properly. Please check the
available smartphone models with
your dealer.
NFC antenna position on the
smartphone can be confirmed
on each smartphone’s manual or
contact to customer service center
of the smartphone manufacture.
ODN8A059243
ODN8A059131
Digital key (Card key) save
1. Install Hyundai digital key app in
main user’s smartphone and register
the digital key (smartphone). Please
refer to the registration method of the
digital key (smartphone).
2. Using the [Pair Card Key] menu on
the digital key application, you can
activate the Card Key registration
mode.
à NFC authentication : enter the NFC
authentication menu and contact
the smartphone on the outside door
handle.
à Bluetooth authentication : enter the
Bluetooth authentication menu and
press the [OK] button for activation.
If you activate the registration mode,
you should complete the Card saving
process with in 5 minutes.
à If you have not registered the digital
key (smartphone), please register the
digital key (card key) with two smart
keys.
5-23
Convenience features
Ã
3. Register the NFC card key on the
User’s Settings menu after turning on
the vehicle.
à With Navigation screen : From the
infotainment screen menu, go to
[Setup] - [Vehicle] - [Digital Key] [Card Key] then select the [Save] from
submenu.
à Without navigation screen : From
cluster menu, go to [Digital Key] [Card Key] and select [Save].
The [Save] button will be disabled if
the digital key (Card key) is already
saved.
Please refer to “Digital Key Delete” in
this manual and follow the digital key
delete procedure in your car before
Digital key save.
4. Place the NFC card key onto the
interior authentication pad (wireless
charger). The saving process will
begin automatically.
5. If the key is enrolled, the message
will be displayed on the infotainment
screen or instrument cluster.
ś Once the card key registration mode
is activated, the process should be
completed within 5 minutes. After
then, you should reactivate once
again for registration.
ś For the digital key(card key) saving,
the smart key(fob) must be exist inside
of vehicle.
ś Once a Card key is registered, it
cannot be reuse onto another vehicle.
5-24
ODN8A059243
ODN8A059132
Digital key (Card key) deletion
You should have the smart key to delete
the digital key (card key) so please carry
around the key.
1. Get on the vehicle with the smart key.
2. Delete the NFC card key on the User’s
Settings menu after turning on the
engine.
à With Navigation screen : From the
infotainment screen menu, go to
[Setup] - [Vehicle] - [Digital Key] [Card Key] then select the [Delete]
from submenu.
à Without navigation screen : From
cluster menu, go to [Digital Key] [Card Key] and select [Delete].
If there is no saved digital key(card key),
[Delete] menu will not be activated.
05
ś To delete the saved digital key (card
key), the smart key must be exist
inside the vehicle.
ś The deleted digital key (card key) can
be re-registered before registering a
new digital key (card key).
ś If you try to register a new digital key
(card key), the previously registered
digital key (card key) cannot be used
again.
OTMA050020
[1] : Door handle authentication pad
NFC door lock/unlock
You should contact digital key (card key)
to door handle authentication pad (1,
marked position near by the lock button)
of driver’s (or front passenger’s) outside
door for 2 seconds to lock or unlock the
doors. If the Two Press Unlock feature
is applied (press twice for unlocking),
driver’s seat door will be unlocked by
contacting the digital key (card key). In
this state, if you contact one more time
within 4 seconds, all the doors unlock.
Inoperable condition
If you do not contact the digital key (card
key) to the center of the door handle
authentication pad accurately., it may
not work. In addition, if you overlap and
use the key with NFC-enabled cards such
as transportation card or credit card, it
does not work.
Note that if you try to lock your vehicle
with digital key (card key) in following
cases, the doors will not be locked and
chime will sound for 3 seconds.
ś The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
ś The Engine Start/Stop button is in
ACC or ON position.
ś Any of the doors, hood and trunk are
open
5-25
Convenience features
If the digital key (card key) does not
work, please detach the key around
4 inches (0.1 m) from the handle
authentication pad and retry to contact.
The card key may be damaged by the
impact. It would not work properly if
the key is damaged. You should buy a
new card and register again. Long-time
exposure to high temperature may cause
the card key to malfunction. Please be
careful not to expose the key to direct
sunlight or high temperature.
After unlock the door or start up the
vehicle with digital key, even though
the driver tries to lock the doors by the
central door lock switch, the door lock
will be once locked and immediately
released at the moment of door closed.
5-26
Start-up with Card key
After placing your registered card key
onto the interior authentication pad
(wireless charger), step on the brake and
press the Engine Start/Stop button.
WARNING
ś If you do not place the digital key
(card key) onto the center of the
interior authentication pad (wireless
charger) exactly, the card key may
not be recognized. If the engine is
not turned on, adjust and place the
key again.
ś If you overlap and use the key
with NFC-enabled cards such as
transportation card or credit card,
the card key may not be recognized.
ś If the digital key (card key) does not
work, please detach the key around
4 inches (0.1 m) from the handle
authentication pad and retry to
contact.
ś The card key may be damaged due to
impact. It would not work properly if
the key is damaged. You should buy a
new card and register again.
For more information, refer to the
Engine Start/Stop button in chapter 6.
05
Type A
CAUTION
ODN8A059133
Type B
If you uncheck Enable digital keys, it is
impossible to lock or unlock the doors
or start up the vehicle with digital keys
such as smartphone and card key. If
you check Enable digital keys again, the
registered digital keys(smartphone and
card key) are available. Even though
you stop the digital key function, the
registered keys (smartphone and card
key) are not deleted.
Personalized profile and vehicle
settings
ODN8A059247
Digital key application/cancellation
Connect the registered digital key with
personalized profile. Then in case you
lock or unlock the door with the digital
key NFC function or unlock the door
remotely by digital key application
Bluetooth connection, the vehicle
will play the personalized user profile
settings. Profile connection and
personalization are available for Driver 1
and Driver 2.
If you do not want to use the digital key
(smartphone and card key), you can
disable the function temporarily. You
should have the smart key when you
change the settings
à With Navigation screen :
From the infotainment screen menu,
go to [Setup] - [Vehicle] - [Digital Key]
- [Enable Digital Keys] (deselect)
à Without navigation screen :
From cluster menu, go to [Digital Key]
- [Enable Digital Keys] (deselect)
Information
For the digital key disable, the smart key
must be exist inside the car. For the digital
key enable, the smart key does not need.
5-27
Convenience features
Profile link/unlinked
Profile link
6HOHFW6HWXSƟ8VHU3URILOHƟ
3URILOH6HWWLQJVƟ/LQN'LJLWDO.H\
(Smartphone) on the infotainment
system menu.
2. Unlock and place your smartphone on
the wireless charger according to a
message and it automatically starts to
interwork.
3. It begins the profile link with a
message.
4. If you select Link, the registered
phone number’s digital key and the
user’s profile are linked.
5. The interconnection process is
completed with a message.
Profile unlink
1. Select Digital Key information on
infotainment Vehicle Settings menu. It
is possible to unlink only if the profile
is interconnected.
2. Profile unlink is completed with a
message.
Information
If you connect both Driver 1 and Driver 2
with a single smartphone, the smartphone
digital key always works as Driver 1.
If you unlink the Driver 1, personalization
function will operate as Driver 2.
5-28
PRECAUTION for vehicle profile link and
unlink
When you link or unlink the profile of
digital key, you should be careful of the
following.
ś Profile link is possible to use with the
digital key. (Infotainment Vehicle
6HWWLQJV0RGHƟ'LJLWDO.H\Ɵ(QDEOH
Digital Keys)
ś Profile link information remains even
when you set the digital key function
disable.
ś Only the smart phone with digital key
app enables you to link your profile.
(Impossible to link with NFC card)
ś Profile link works only when the
smart phone and the digital key are
registered to the vehicle. The smart
phone with another vehicle’s digital
key cannot link profile.
ś If you remove the smart phone
from the wireless charger before
completing the profile link, it does not
work.
ś To unlink the profile, the smart phone
does not need to be on the wireless
charger.
05
Vehicle personalization operation
The personalization function linked with
digital key works as following conditions:
ś Contact the driver’s door handle with
the profile linked smart phone to lock
or unlock the doors (Personalization
does not operate when locking or
unlocking the front passenger door.)
ś Remote door unlock with the profile
linked smartphone digital key app.
The profile linked with digital key can be
changed manually in the infotainment
system setup screen.
Precaution for digital key profile link and
unlink
Profile operation according to door lock/
unlock system is as follows.
Item
Initial value
Profile linked
smart phone
key
Profile unlinked
smart phone
key
NFC card key
Smart key
Personalization
Operation
Guest
Linked profile
Recently activated
profile
ś The personalization function using
the digital key can be operated
after linking the digital key on the
infotainment system profile menu.
ś You should use the personalization
function during stopping your vehicle
safely.
5-29
Convenience features
Vehicle personalization with digital key
The available personalization function in the vehicle is as follows.
System
Personalization Item
HUD
Position adjustment of image, Information display
selection, Size and color of speedometer
Lamp
Blink number of one-touch signal lamps
Cluster
USM
Information display on the cluster, Voice volume,
Welcome sound
Seat position, O/S mirror position, Easy Access
Seat/Mirror
Intelligent driving posture assist (Smart IMS)
Convenience
Door
AVN
Air conditioning
Wireless charging system on/off
Automatic door lock/unlock, Two Press Unlock
Navigation
Preferred volume of the navigation system, Recent
destination
User preset
My menu list settings, Radio preset
Phone
connectivity
Bluetooth preferential connect
CarPlay/Android Auto/MirrorLink On/Off
Latest operation setup of the following functions:
Operating
condition
Temperature, AUTO, air flow direction, air volume,
air conditioner, air intake control, SYNC, Front
windshield defroster, OFF
For more information of personalization, refer to the infotainment system manual.
CAUTION
If you leave the digital key after locking or unlocking the doors or starting up the
vehicle with the smart key, the doors can be locked by the central door lock. Please
carry around the digital key all the time.
5-30
05
DOOR LOCKS
Operating door locks from
outside the vehicle
Remote key
Mechanical key
Remote key
OTMA050015MX
OTM048001L
Smart key
To lock the doors, press the Door Lock
button (1) on the remote key.
To unlock the doors, press the Door
Unlock button (2) on the remote key.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
OTM050083
[A] : Unlock, [B] : Lock
First, pull the outside door handle (1)
and push the hook (2) located inside
of outside door handle by using the
mechanical key. And remove the cover
(3).
Turn the key toward the rear of the
vehicle to lock and toward the front of
the vehicle to unlock.
If you lock/unlock the driver’s door with
a key, a driver’s door will lock/unlock.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
5-31
Convenience features
Smart key
Operating door locks from inside
the vehicle
With the door lock button
OTM048000
To lock the doors, press the button on
the outside door handle while carrying
the smart key with you or press the door
lock button on the smart key.
To unlock the doors, press the button on
the outside door handle while carrying
the smart key with you or press the door
unlock button on the smart key.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
Information
ś In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
ś If the door is locked/unlocked multiple
times in rapid succession with either
the vehicle key or door lock switch, the
system may stop operating temporarily
in order to protect the circuit and
prevent damage to system components.
5-32
OTM048003
ś To unlock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Unlock” position.
The red mark (2) on the door lock
button will be visible.
ś To lock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Lock” position. If the
door is locked properly, the red mark
(2) on the door lock button will not be
visible.
ś To open a door, pull the door handle
(3) outward.
ś Front doors cannot be locked if the
key is in the ignition switch and any
front door is open.
ś Doors cannot be locked if the smart
key is in the vehicle and any door is
open.
05
Information
If a power door lock ever fails to function
while you are in the vehicle try one or
more of the following techniques to exit:
Operate the door unlock feature
repeatedly (both electronic and manual)
while simultaneously pulling on the door
handle.
Operate the other door locks and handles.
Lower a front window and use the
mechanical key to unlock the door from
outside.
With the central door lock/unlock
switch
OTM050215
When pressing the ( ) portion (1) on the
switch, all vehicle doors will lock.
ś If any door is opened, the doors will
not lock even though the lock button
(1) of the central door lock switch is
pressed.
ś If the smart key is in the vehicle and
any door is opened, the doors will
not lock even though the lock button
(1) of the central door lock switch is
pressed.
When pressing the ( ) portion (2) on the
switch, all vehicle doors will unlock.
5-33
Convenience features
WARNING
ś The doors should always be fully
closed and locked while the
vehicle is in motion. If the doors
are unlocked, the risk of being
thrown from the vehicle in a crash is
increased.
ś Do not pull the inner door handle of
the driver’s or passenger’s door while
the vehicle is moving.
WARNING
Do not leave the elderly, children or
animals unattended in your vehicle. An
enclosed vehicle can become extremely
hot, causing death or serious injury
to the elderly, unattended children
or animals who cannot escape from
the vehicle. Children might operate
features of the vehicle that could injure
them, or they could encounter other
harm, possibly from someone gaining
entry to the vehicle.
WARNING
Always secure your vehicle.
Leaving your vehicle unlocked increases
the potential risk to you or others from
someone hiding in your vehicle.
To secure your vehicle, while
depressing the brake, shift the gear
to the P (Park) position, engage the
parking brake, and press the Engine
Start/Stop button to the OFF position,
close all windows, lock all doors, and
always take the key with you.
5-34
CAUTION
Opening a door when something is
approaching may cause damage or
injury. Be careful when opening doors
and watch for vehicles, motorcycles,
bicycles or pedestrians approaching the
vehicle in the path of the door.
WARNING
If you stay in the vehicle for a long time
while the weather is very hot or cold,
there are risks of injuries or danger to
life. Do not lock the vehicle from the
outside when someone is in the vehicle.
05
Auto door lock/unlock features
Your vehicle is equipped with features
that will automatically lock or unlock
your vehicle based on settings you select
in the infotainment system screen.
Child-protector rear door locks
(if equipped)
Auto LOCK Enable on speed
When this feature is set in the
infotainment system screen, all the doors
will be locked automatically when the
vehicle exceeds 9 mph (15 km/h).
Auto LOCK Enable on shift
When this feature is set in the
infotainment system screen, all the doors
will be locked automatically when the
vehicle is shifted out of P (Park) while the
engine is running.
Auto UNLOCK On Shift to P
When this feature is set in the
infotainment system screen, all the doors
will be unlocked automatically when the
vehicle is shifted back into P (Park) while
the engine is running.
Auto UNLOCK Vehicle off
When this feature is set in the
infotainment system screen, all the doors
will be unlocked automatically when the
vehicle is turned off.
See additional information in supplied
Infotainment Manual.
OTM048005
The child safety lock is provided to help
prevent children seated in the rear from
accidentally opening the rear doors. The
rear door safety locks should be used
whenever children are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock is located on the
edge of each rear door. When the child
safety lock is in the lock position, the
rear door will not open if the inner door
handle is pulled.
To lock the child safety lock, insert a
small flat blade tool (like a screwdriver or
similar) (1) into the slot and turn it to the
lock position as shown.
To allow a rear door to be opened from
inside the vehicle, unlock the child safety
lock.
WARNING
Additional unlock safety feature air
bag deployment
As an additional safety feature, all doors
will be automatically unlocked when an
impact causes the air bags to deploy.
If children accidently open the rear
doors while the vehicle is in motion,
they could fall out of the vehicle. The
rear door safety locks should always
be used whenever children are in the
vehicle.
5-35
Convenience features
Electronic child safety lock (if
equipped)
OTM050084L
When the electronic child safety lock
button is pressed and the indicator
light on the button illuminates, the rear
doors cannot be opened from inside the
vehicle.
ś The rear door window cannot be
opened or closed while the electronic
child safety lock button is in the LOCK
position (indicator light ON).
For more details, refer to “Windows”
section in this chapter.
ś Electronic child safety lock does not
automatically turn on unless the driver
presses the electronic child safety
lock button.
ś If 3 minutes passes after the Engine
Start/Stop button is pressed to the
OFF or ACC, the indicator on the
button turns off, and the driver cannot
turn off electronic child safety lock by
pressing the button. To turn off the
function, press the Engine Start/Stop
button to the ON position, and then
press the electronic child safety lock
button.
5-36
ś If the power is supplied again after
removing the battery or battery is
discharged while the electronic child
safety lock button is in the LOCK
position, press the button once more
to match the state of the indicator on
the electronic child safety lock button
and actual status of the electronic
child safety lock function.
ś If the airbag is activated while the
electronic child safety lock button
is in the LOCK position (indicator
light ON), the rear doors will unlock
automatically.
ś Vehicles equipped with the electronic
child safety lock feature is not
provided with a manual child safety
lock.
WARNING
If children accidentally opens the rear
door while the vehicle is in motion, they
could fall out of the vehicle. Electronic
child safety lock should always be used
whenever children are in the vehicle.
05
NOTICE
Child safety lock failure / Child safety
lock error
Type A
Type B
OJX1059018L
Safe Exit Assist (if equipped with
electronic child safety lock)
Safe Exit Assist helps prevent the rear
occupant from opening the rear door.
When an approaching vehicle from the
rear area is detected after the vehicle
stops, the rear doors will not unlock even
when the driver tries to unlock the rear
doors using the electronic child safety
lock button.
For more details, refer to “Safe Exit
Assist (SEA)” section in chapter 7.
OJX1059254L
When electronic child safety lock does
not work even though the button is
pressed, the message will be displayed
and an alarm will sound. If this occurs,
have the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-37
Convenience features
7+()7ǘ$/$506<67(0
This system helps to protect your vehicle
and valuables. The horn will sound and
the hazard warning lights will blink
continuously if any of the following
occur:
- A door is opened without using the
smart key.
- The liftgate is opened without using
the smart key.
- The engine hood is opened.
The alarm continues for 30 seconds, then
the system resets. To turn off the alarm,
unlock the doors with the smart key.
The Theft Alarm System automatically
sets 30 seconds after you lock the
doors and the liftgate. For the system to
activate, you must lock the doors and
the liftgate from outside the vehicle with
the smart key or by touching the touch
sensor on the outside of the door handle
with the smart key in your possession.
The hazard warning lights will blink and
the chime will sound once to indicate the
system is armed.
Once the security system is set, opening
any door, the liftgate, or the hood
without using the smart key will cause
the alarm to activate.
The Theft Alarm System will not set if the
hood, the liftgate, or any door is not fully
closed. If the system will not set, check
the hood, the liftgate, or the doors are
fully closed.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it.
5-38
Information
ś Do not lock the doors until all
passengers have left the vehicle. If the
remaining passenger leaves the vehicle
when the system is armed, the alarm
will be activated.
ś If the vehicle is not disarmed with the
smart key, open the doors by using the
mechanical key and start the engine by
directly pressing the Engine Start/Stop
button with the smart key.
ś If the system is disarmed by unlocking
the vehicle, but neither a door or the
liftgate is opened within 30 seconds, the
doors will relock and the system will
rearm automatically.
05
,17(*5$7('0(025<6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Information
ś If the battery is disconnected, the
memory settings will be erased.
ś If integrated memory system does not
operate normally, have the system
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Storing memory positions
OTM050087
Integrated Memory System for the
driver’s seat is provided to store and
recall the following memory settings with
a simple button operation.
ś Driver’s seat position
ś Side View mirror position
WARNING
Never attempt to operate the
integrated memory system while the
vehicle is moving.
This could result in loss of control, and
an accident causing death, serious
injury, or property damage.
1. Shift to P (Park) while the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON
position.
2. Adjust the driver’s seat position,
side view mirror position, steering
wheel position, instrument panel
illumination intensity and head-up
display height/brightness to the
desired position.
3. Press the SET button. The system
will beep once and notify you ‘Press
button to save settings’ on the cluster
LCD display.
4. Press one of the memory buttons (1
or 2) within 4 seconds. The system
will beep twice when the memory has
been successfully stored.
5. ‘Driver 1 (or 2) settings saved’ will
appear on the cluster LCD display. The
message appears only for the driver’s
seat position memory setting.
5-39
Convenience features
Recalling memory positions
Resetting the system
1. Shift to P (Park) while the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON
position.
2. Press the desired memory button (1
or 2). The system will beep once, and
then the driver’s seat position, side
view mirror position, steering wheel
position, instrument panel illumination
intensity and head-up display height/
brightness will automatically adjust to
the stored positions.
3. ‘Driver 1 (or 2) settings applied’ will
appear on the cluster LCD display.
Take the following procedures to reset
integrated memory system, when it does
not operate properly.
Information
ś If you press the SET button or the
corresponding button which the
setting is being recalled, the setting will
temporarily deactivate. If you press the
other buttons, the setting of the pressed
button will activate.
For example, if you press the SET
button or number 1 button with the
number 1 setting in operation, the
setting will temporarily deactivate. If
you press the number 2 button, the
number 2 setting will activate.
ś If you adjust the seat, rearview mirror,
steering wheel, instrument panel
illumination or head-up display while
recalling the stored positions, the preset settings will become ineffective.
5-40
Resetting integrated memory
system
1. Stop the vehicle and open the driver’s
door with the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ON position and the
vehicle shifted to P (Park).
2. Adjust the driver’s seat and seatback
to the foremost position.
3. Press the SET button and push
forward the driver’s seat movement
switch over 2 seconds simultaneously.
While resetting integrated memory
system
1. Resetting starts with a notification
sound.
2. The driver’s seat and seatback is
adjusted to the rearward position with
the notification sound.
3. The driver’s seat and seatback is
re-adjusted to the default position
(central position) with the notification
sound.
However, in the following cases, the
resetting procedure and the notification
sound may stop.
ś The memory button is pressed.
ś The seat control switch is operated.
ś The gear is shifted out of P (Park).
ś The driving speed exceeds
2 mph (3km/h).
ś The driver’s door is closed.
05
NOTICE
ś While integrated memory system
is being reset, if the resetting
and notification sound stops
incompletely, restart the resetting
procedure again.
ś Make sure that there is no objects
around the driver’s seat in advance
of resetting the integrated memory
system.
Easy access function
The system will move the driver’s seat
automatically as follows:
ś With remote key
- It will move the driver’s seat
rearward when the ignition key is
removed.
- It will move the driver’s seat forward
when the ignition key is inserted.
ś With smart key
- It will move the driver’s seat
rearward when the Engine Start/
Stop button is pressed to the OFF
position.
- It will move the driver’s seat forward
when the Engine Start/Stop button
is pressed to the ACC or START
position.
You can activate or deactivate the Easy
Access Function from the User Settings
mode on the LCD display. ‘Convenience
Ɵ6HDW(DV\$FFHVVƟ2II1RUPDO
Extended’.
For more details, refer to “LCD Display”
In chapter 4.
CAUTION
Driver should be cautious when using
this function to assure no injury to
passenger or child on the back seat.
In case of emergency the driver has to
stop movement of front seat (when easy
access feature is activated) by pressing
SET button or any of the driver seat
control switches.
5-41
Convenience features
STEERING WHEEL
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
The system assists you with steering the
vehicle. If the vehicle is turned off or
if the power steering system becomes
inoperative, you may still steer the
vehicle, but it will require increased
steering effort.
Should you notice any change in the
effort required to steer during normal
vehicle operation, have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
CAUTION
If Electric Power Steering does not
warning light
operate normally, the
and the message ‘Check motor driven
power steering’ will illuminate on the
instrument cluster. You may steer the
vehicle, but it will require increased
steering efforts. Take your vehicle to
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or to
a service station and have the system
checked as soon as possible.
5-42
Information
The following symptoms may occur during
normal vehicle operation:
ś The steering effort may be high
immediately after pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button to the ON position.
This happens as the system performs
the EPS system diagnostics. When the
diagnostics are completed, the steering
wheel effort will return to its normal
condition.
ś When the battery voltage is low, you
might have to put more steering effort.
However, it is a temporary condition so
that it will return to normal condition
after charging the battery.
ś A click noise may be heard from the
EPS relay after the Engine Start/Stop
button is in the ON or OFF position.
ś Motor noise may be heard when the
vehicle is at a stop or at a low driving
speed.
ś When you operate the steering wheel
in low temperatures, abnormal noise
may occur. If the temperature rises, the
noise will disappear. This is a normal
condition.
ś When an error is detected from EPS,
the steering effort assist function will
not be activated in order to prevent
fatal accidents. Instrument cluster
warning lights may be on or the
steering effort may be high. If these
symptoms occur, drive the vehicle to
a safe area as soon as it is safe to do
so. Have the system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
05
Tilt / Telescopic steering
Information
When adjusting the steering wheel to a
comfortable position, adjust the steering
wheel so that it points toward your chest,
not toward your face. Make sure you can
see the instrument cluster warning lights
and gauges. After adjusting, push the
steering wheel both up and down to be
certain it is locked in position.
Always adjust the position of the steering
wheel before driving.
Sometimes the lock release lever may not
engage completely. This may occur when
the gears of the locking mechanism do not
completely mesh. If this occurs, pull down
on the lock-release lever, readjust the
steering wheel again, and then pull back
up on the release lever to lock the steering
wheel in place.
Heated steering wheel
(if equipped)
WARNING
NEVER adjust the steering wheel while
driving. This may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
OTM050009
OTM050008
To adjust the steering wheel angle and
height:
1. Pull down the lock-release lever (1).
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the
desired angle (2) and distance
forward/back (3).
3. Pull up the lock-release lever to lock
the steering wheel in place.
When the ignition switch is in the ON
position or when the engine is running,
press the heated steering wheel button
to warm the steering wheel.
The indicator on the button will
illuminate.
To turn the heated steering wheel off,
press the button again. The indicator on
the button will turn off.
5-43
Convenience features
ś Auto Comfort Control (for driver’s
seat) (if equipped)
- The heated steering wheel
automatically controls the steering
wheel temperature depending on
the ambient temperature and the
set climate control temperature
when the engine is running. If the
heated steering wheel switch is
pushed, the heated steering wheel
will have to be controlled manually.
To use this function, it must be
activated from the Settings menu in
the AVN system screen.
- The heated steering wheel defaults
to the OFF position whenever the
ignition switch is ON. However, if
the Auto Comfort Control function
is ON, the heated steering wheel
will turn on and off depending on
the ambient temperature and the
set climate control temperature.
For more details, contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
The heated steering wheel will turn off
automatically approximately 30 minutes
after the heated steering wheel is turned
on.
NOTICE
Do not install any cover or accessory
on the steering wheel. This cover or
accessory could cause damage to the
heated steering wheel system.
5-44
Horn
OTM050088
To sound the horn, press the area
indicated by the horn symbol on your
steering wheel (see illustration). The
horn will operate only when this area is
pressed.
NOTICE
Do not strike the horn severely to
operate it, or hit it with your fist. Do not
press on the horn with a sharp-pointed
object.
05
0,55256
Inside rearview mirror
Before driving your vehicle, check to
see that your inside rearview mirror is
properly positioned. Adjust the rearview
mirror so that the view through the rear
window is properly centered.
Electric Chromic Mirror (ECM)
(if equipped)
WARNING
Make sure your line of sight is not
obstructed. Do not place objects in the
rear seat, cargo area, or behind the rear
headrests which could interfere with
your vision through the rear window.
OTM050019
[A] : Indicator
WARNING
To prevent serious injury during an
accident or deployment of the air bag,
do not modify the rearview mirror and
do not install a wide mirror.
WARNING
NEVER adjust the mirror while driving.
This may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
NOTICE
When cleaning the mirror, use a paper
towel or similar material dampened
with glass cleaner. Do not spray glass
cleaner directly on the mirror as this
may cause the liquid cleaner to enter
the mirror housing.
Some vehicles come equipped with an
electrochromic mirror that helps control
glare while driving at night or under low
light driving conditions.
When the engine is running, the glare is
automatically controlled by the sensor
mounted in the rearview mirror. The
sensor detects the light level around the
vehicle, and automatically adjusts to
control the headlight glare from vehicles
behind you.
Whenever the the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse), the mirror will automatically
go to the brightest setting in order to
improve the driver’s view behind the
vehicle.
5-45
Convenience features
Day/night rearview mirror
(if equipped)
OTMA050002
OTM050018
[A]: Day, [B]: Night
Make this adjustment before you start
driving and while the day/night lever is in
the day position.
Pull the day/night lever towards you to
reduce glare from the headlights of the
vehicles behind you during night driving.
Remember that you lose some rearview
clarity in the night position.
Electrochromic mirror (ECM) with
HomeLink® system (if equipped)
Your vehicle may be equipped with
a Gentex Automatic-Dimming Mirror
with an Integrated HomeLink® Wireless
Control System.
During nighttime driving, this feature
will automatically detect and reduce
rearview mirror glare. The HomeLink®
Universal Transceiver allows you to
activate your garage door(s), electric
gate, home lighting, etc.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
HomeLink Channel 1
HomeLink Channel 2
HomeLink Channel 3
Garage Door Opener Status Indicator:
Closing or Closed
(5) HomeLink Operation Indicator
(6) Garage Door Opener Status Indicator:
Opening or Opened
(7) HomeLink User Interface Indicator
Automatic-Dimming Night Vision Safety™
(NVS®) Mirror (if equipped)
The NVS® Mirror automatically reduces
glare by monitoring light levels in the
front and the rear of the vehicle. Any
object that obstructs either light sensor
will degrade the automatic dimming
control feature.
For more information regarding NVS®
mirrors and other applications, please
refer to the Gentex website:
www.gentex.com
Your mirror will automatically dim
upon detecting glare from the vehicles
traveling behind you.
The mirror defaults to the ON position
each time the vehicle is started.
5-46
05
Integrated HomeLink® Wireless Control
System
The HomeLink® Wireless Control System
provides a convenient way to replace
up to three hand held radio-frequency
transmitters used to activate compatible
devices such as gate operators, garage
door openers, entry door locks, security
systems, and home lighting.
NOTICE
HomeLink® operates while the ignition
switch is in the ACC or ON position
for safety reasons. It is to prevent
unintentional security problems from
happening when the vehicle is parked
outside the garage.
1. Programming HomeLink®
The following steps show how to
program HomeLink. If you have any
questions or are having difficulty
programming your HomeLink buttons,
refer to the HomeLink website or call the
HomeLink customer support toll-free
number. Do this before going back to the
dealer who sold you the car.
ś Visit the HomeLink website at: www.
homelink.com. Then at the top of the
page, choose your vehicle make. Then
watch the You Tube video, and/or
access additional website information.
ś If you choose to access the website
via your cell phone, scan the QR code.
WARNING
Before programming HomeLink® to a
garage door opener or gate operator,
make sure people and objects are out
of the way of the device to prevent
potential harm or damage. Do not
use the HomeLink® with any garage
door opener that lacks the safety
stop and reverse features required
by U.S. federal safety standards (this
includes any garage door opener model
manufactured before April 1, 1982).
A garage door that cannot detect an
object - signaling the door to stop and
reverse - does not meet current U.S.
federal safety standards. Using a garage
door opener without these features
increases the risk of serious injury or
death.
For more information, contact
HomeLink® at www.homelink.com, or
call Home-Link customer support at
1-800-355-3515.
It is also recommended that a new
battery be replaced in the handheld
transmitter of the device being trained
to HomeLink® for quicker training and
accurate transmission of the radio
frequency.
ś Or call HomeLink customer support
at 1-800-355-3515 (Please have the
vehicle make/model and the opener
device make/model readily available.)
5-47
Convenience features
1) Programming Preparation
OTMA050005
OTMA050003
1. When programming a garage door
opener, it is advised to park the
vehicle outside of the garage.
2. It is recommended that a new battery
be placed in the handheld transmitter
of the device being programmed to
HomeLink for quicker training and
accurate transmission of the radiofrequency signal.
3. Place the ignition switch to the ACC
(Accessory) position for programming
of HomeLink.
2) Programming a New HomeLink®
OTMA050004
1. Press and release the HomeLink
button (1), (2) or (3), you would like
to program. The HomeLink indicator
light (7) will flash orange slowly (if
not, perform the steps of “Erasing
HomeLink Buttons” section, and start
over).
5-48
2. Position the garage door opener
remote 1 – 3 inches (2 – 8cm) away
from the HoleLink buttons.
3. While the HomeLink indicator light (7)
is flashing orange, press and hold the
hand-held remote button. Continue
pressing the handheld remote button
until the HomeLink indicator light (7)
light changes from orange to green.
You may now release the handheld
remote button.
4. Wait until your garage door comes
to a complete stop, regardless of
position, before proceeding to the
next steps.
5. Press and release the HomeLink
button you are programming and
observe the indicator light.
śIf the indicator light remains solid
green, your device should operate
when the HomeLink button is
pressed. At this point, if your device
operates, programming is complete.
śIf the indicator light rapidly
flashes green, firmly press, hold
for two seconds and release the
HomeLink button up to three times
in a row slowly to complete the
programming process. Do not press
the HomeLink button rapidly. At
this point if your device operates,
programming is complete. If the
device does not operate, continue
with step 6.
05
6. At the garage door opener motor,
(security gate motor, etc.) locate the
“Learn”, “Smart”, “Set” or “Program”
button. This can usually be found
where the hanging antenna wire is
attached to the motor-head unit (see
the device’s manual to identify this
button). The name and color of the
button may vary by manufacturer.
ODL3A040504
à A ladder and/or second person may
simplify the following steps.
7. Firmly press and release the “Learn”,
“Smart”, “Set” or “Program” button.
You now have up to 30 seconds in
which to complete the next step.
8. Return to the vehicle and firmly press,
hold for two seconds and release,
the HomeLink button up to three
times in a row slowly. Do not press
the HomeLink button rapidly. As soon
as you see the garage door start to
move, stop pressing any buttons
until a few seconds after the garage
door has come to a complete stop,
regardless of position. At this point,
programming is complete and your
device should operate when the
HomeLink button is pressed and
released.
3) Two-Way Communication
Programming (For select garage door
openers)
If your garage door opener has the
‘myQ’ logo on its side, your opener
likely has Two-Way Communication
capability. HomeLink has the capability
to establish Two-Way Communication
with your garage door opener. HomeLink
can receive and display “closing”
or “opening” status messages from
compatible garage door openers. At
any time, Home-Link can also recall
and display the last recorded status
communicated by the garage door
opener to indicate your garage door
being “closed” or “opened”.
To check if your garage door opener is
compatible with this feature, refer to
www.homelink.com/compatible/Twoway-Communication. If your garage
door opener has this functionality, AND
the Two-Way Communication indicators
(4), (6) in the mirror appear while the
garage door is opening/closing, then
no further steps are needed. Two-Way
Communication Programming is already
complete. However, if your garage door
opener has this functionality, AND the
Two-Way Communication indicators (4),
(6) in the mirror DO NOT appear while
the garage door is opening/closing, use
the following instructions to enable this
functionality.
1. In your vehicle, press and hold the
programmed HomeLink button for 2
seconds, then release. Confirm that
the garage door is moving. AFTER it
stops, you will have one minute to
complete the following steps:
à A ladder and/or second person may
simplify the following steps.
5-49
Convenience features
2. On your garage door opener in your
garage, locate the “Learn” button
(usually near where the hanging
antenna wire is attached to the garage
door opener). If there is difficulty
locating this button, reference the
device’s owner’s manual.
3. Press and release the “Learn” button.
4. A light on your garage door opener
may flash, and your Two-Way
Communication indicators (4), (6) in
your vehicle may flash, confirming
completion of the process.
5. Return to the vehicle and firmly
press and release the programmed
HomeLink button to activate
your garage door. The Two-Way
Communication indicators (4), (6)
flash in orange when the door is
moving. Do not make any additional
button presses until AFTER the garage
door has come to a complete stop.
6. Your Two-Way Communication
programming is now complete.
Information
If your garage door opener has TwoWay Communication functionality,
it is possible for HomeLink to stop
functioning the garage door shortly
after initial programming, IF the TwoWay Communication Programming
wasn’t properly completed. This
usually happens after the first 10 times
a programmed HomeLink button is
pressed. If you experience this, completing
the “Programming a New HomeLink
Button” and “Two-Way Communication
Programming” will restore door
operation.
5-50
4) Canadian Programming
Canadian radio-frequency laws require
transmitter remote signals to “timeout” (or quit) after a couple seconds of
transmission, which may not be long
enough for HomeLink to pick up the signal
during programming.
If you live in Canada or you are having
difficulties programming a gate operator
or garage door opener by using the
programming procedures, replace
“Programming a New HomeLink Button”
step 3 with the following:
While the HomeLink indicator light (7) is
flashing orange, press and release (“cycle”)
your device’s handheld remote every two
seconds until the HomeLink indicator light
(7) changes from orange to green. You may
now release the hand-held remote button.
Then proceed with “Programming a New
HomeLink Button” step 4.
05
2. Operating HomeLink®
1) Operating HomeLink®
OTMA050007
OTMA050004
1. Press and release the desired
programmed HomeLink button (1, 2
or 3).
Information
The HomeLink indicator (7) should
light green, solid or flashing, and your
programmed device should operate.
If your device does not operate, the
HomeLink programming was not
successful, and you’ll need to reprogram
the button.
2) Two-Way Communication Display
Behavior
2. The indicator (4) and (6) operates as
below, if your garage door opener
has Two-Way Communication
functionality.
ś If the indicator (4) flashes in Orange,
it indicates that the garage door is
“Closing”.
ś The indicator (4) turns solid green
once the garage door has closed.
ś If the indicator (6) flashes in Orange,
it indicates that the garage door is
“Opening”.
ś The indicator (6) turns solid green
once the garage door has fully
opened.
ś If the indicator (4) or (6) does not
turn to green, it indicates that the
last status of garage door was not
received properly. The HomeLink
mirror tries to receive the last known
status of the garage door for a few
seconds.
OTMA050006
1. Press and release one of the
programmed HomeLink buttons (1, 2
or 3).
5-51
Convenience features
3) Recalling Garage Door Status
HomeLink mirror with Two-Way
Communication provides a way to view
the last stored message from the garage
door opener. In order to recall the last
known status of the last activated device,
press the buttons “1 and 2” OR “2 and 3”
simultaneously.
ś If the indicator (4) appears solid
Green, it indicates that the last
activated device was “closed”
properly.
ś If the indicator (6) appears solid
Green, it indicates that the last
activated device was “open” properly.
3. Erasing HomeLink® Buttons
1) Erasing and Reprogramming a Single
HomeLink® Button:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink
button you want to re-program. DO
NOT release the button.
2. The HomeLink indicator light (7) will
illuminate solid green. Release the
button as soon as the HomeLink
indicator light (7) begins to flash
orange, usually about 20 seconds.
3. Proceed with the steps in the
“Programming a New HomeLink
Button” section.
Information
If you do not complete the reprogramming of a new device to the
button, it will revert to the previously
stored programming.
5-52
2) The following instructions will erase
ALL HomeLink® programming from
ALL buttons:
OTMA050008
1. Press and hold the buttons (1) and (3)
simultaneously.
2. The HomeLink indicator light (7) will
illuminate solid Orange for about 10
seconds.
3. Release the buttons once the
HomeLink indicator light (7) changes
to Green and flashes rapidly.
4. Now all three HomeLink buttons
(1), (2) and (3) are cleared of any
programming.
Information
HomeLink® and the HomeLink® House
logo are registered trademarks of Gentex
Corporation.
The myQ logo is a registered trademark of
The Chamberlain Group, Inc.
05
FCC (USA) and ISED (Canada)
This device complies with FCC rules
part 15 and Innovation, Science, and
Economic Development Canada RSS210. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions: (1) This device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) This
device must accept any interference that
may be received including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
WARNING: The transmitter has been
tested and complies with FCC and
ISED rules. Changes or modifications
not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void
the user’s authority to operate the
device.
This equipment complies with FCC
and ISED radiation exposure limits set
forth for an uncontrolled environment.
End Users must follow the specific
operating instructions for satisfying RF
exposure compliance. This transmitter
must be at least 20cm from the user and
must not be co-located or operating in
conjunction with any other antenna or
transmitter.
FCC (Htats-Unis) et ISED (Canada)
Cet appareil est conforme aux
règlements de la FCC, section 15, et
au CNR-210 d’Innovation, Sciences et
Dhveloppement économique Canada. Le
fonctionnement est assujetti aux deux
conditions suivantes : (1) cet appareil ne
doit pas causer d’interférences nuisibles
et (2) cet appareil doit accepter toute
interférence reçue, y compris celle qui
pourrait entraîner un dysfonctionnement.
MISE EN GARDE : L’émetteur a subi des
tests et est conforme aux règlements de
la FCC et d’ISDE. Les changements ou
modifications non approuvés explicitement
par la partie responsable de la conformité
pourraient rendre caduque l’autorisation de
l’utilisateur de se servir du dispositif.
Cet appareil est conforme aux limites
d’exposition aux radiations de la FCC et
d’ISDE établies pour un environnement
non contrôlé. Les utilisateurs finaux doivent
respecter les instructions d’utilisation
spécifiques pour satisfaire aux exigences
de conformité aux expositions de RF.
L’émetteur doit se trouver à 20 cm au
minimum de l’utilisateur et ne doit pas
être situé au même endroit que tout autre
émetteur ou antenne ni fonctionner avec
un autre émetteur ou antenne.
Méjico
La operación de este equipo está sujeta
a las siguientes dos condiciones: (1) es
posible que este equipo o dispositivo
pueda no causar interferencia dañina, y
(2) este dispositivo o dispositivos deben
aceptar cualquier interferencia, que
incluye la interferencia que puede causar
su operación no deseada.
5-53
Convenience features
HomeLink 5 Programing Flow Chart
OOS040475N
5-54
05
Side View mirrors
WARNING
Do not adjust or fold the side view
mirrors while driving. This may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
NOTICE
OTM048015
Your vehicle is equipped with both lefthand and right-hand side view mirrors.
The mirrors can be adjusted remotely
with the mirror adjustment control
switch. The side view mirrors can be
folded to help prevent damage when
going through an automatic car wash or
when passing through a narrow street.
The right side view mirror is convex.
Objects seen in the mirror are closer than
they appear.
Use the inside rear view mirror or look
back directly to determine the actual
distance of other vehicles prior to
changing lanes.
Make sure to adjust the side view mirrors
to your desired position before you begin
driving.
ś Do not scrape ice off the mirror face;
this may damage the surface of the
glass.
ś If the mirror is jammed with ice, do
not adjust the mirror by force. Use
an approved de-icer (not radiator
antifreeze) spray, or a sponge or soft
cloth with very warm water, or move
the vehicle to a warm place and
allow the ice to melt.
ś Do not clean the mirror with harsh
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum
based cleaning products.
5-55
Convenience features
Adjusting the side view mirrors
OTM050089
1. Move the lever (1) either to the L (left
side) or R (right side) to select the side
view mirror you would like to adjust.
2. Use the mirror adjustment control (2)
to position the selected mirror up,
down, left or right.
3. After adjustment, move the lever (1)
to the middle to prevent inadvertent
adjustment.
Folding the side view mirror
OTM048430L
Manual type
To fold the side view mirror, grasp the
housing of the mirror and then fold it
toward the rear of the vehicle.
NOTICE
ś The mirrors stop moving when
they reach the maximum adjusting
angles, but the motor continues to
operate while the switch is pressed.
Do not press the switch longer than
necessary, because this can damage
the motor.
ś Do not attempt to adjust the side
view mirrors by hand, because this
can damage the motor.
5-56
OTM050090
Electric type
The side view mirror can be folded or
unfolded by pressing the switch.
05
ś ,Iœ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPHPLUURU
OLJKWƟ2QGRRUXQORFNŔLVVHOHFWHGLQ
the User Settings mode on the LCD
display, the outside mirror will fold or
unfold automatically as follows:
- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the smart key.
- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the button on the outside door
handle.
ś ,Iœ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPH
PLUURUOLJKWƟ2QGRRUXQORFNŔDQG
œ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPHPLUURUOLJKW
Ɵ2QGULYHUDSSURDFKŔLVVHOHFWHGLQ
the User Settings mode on the LCD
display, the outside mirror will unfold
automatically when you approach the
vehicle (all doors closed and locked)
with a smart key in possession.
NOTICE
The electric type side view mirror
operates even though the ignition
switch is in the OFF position. However,
to prevent unnecessary battery
discharge, do not adjust the mirrors
longer than necessary while the engine
is not running.
NOTICE
Do not fold the electric type side view
mirror by hand. It could cause motor
failure.
Reverse parking aid (if equipped)
OTM050020
When the gear is shifted to the R
(Reverse) position, the side view mirror(s)
will rotate downwards to aid with driving
in reverse.
The position of the side view mirror
switch (1) determines whether or not the
mirrors will move:
Left/Right : When either the L (Left) or
R (Right) switch is selected,
both side view mirrors will
move.
Neutral : When neither switch is
selected, the outside rearview
mirrors will not move.
The side view mirrors will automatically
revert to their original positions if any of
the following occur:
ś The Engine Start/Stop button is
pressed to either the OFF position or
the ACC position.
ś The gear is shifted to any position
except R (Reverse).
ś The side view mirror adjustment
button is not selected.
5-57
Convenience features
WINDOWS
OTMA050018
(1) Driver’s door power window switch
(2) Front passenger’s door power
window switch*
(3) Rear door (left) power window
switch*
(4) Rear door (right) power window
switch*
5-58
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window*
(7) Power window lock switch
* : if equipped
05
Power windows
Auto up/down window (if equipped)
The ignition switch must be in the ON
position to be able to raise or lower
the windows. Each door has a Power
Window switch to control that door’s
window. The driver has a Power Window
Lock switch which can block the
operation of rear passenger windows.
The power windows will operate for
approximately 3 minutes after the
ignition switch is placed in the ACC or
OFF position. However, if the front doors
are opened, the Power Windows cannot
be operated even within the 3 minutes
period.
Pressing or pulling up the power window
switch momentarily to the second
detent position (6) completely lowers or
lifts the window even when the switch
is released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is in
operation, pull up or press down and
release the switch.
Window opening and closing
Resetting the power windows
If the power windows do not operate
normally, the automatic power window
system must be reset as follows:
1. Press the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Close the window and continue
pulling up on the power window
switch for at least one second.
If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, have the system
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
OTM050213
To open:
Press the window switch down to the
first detent position (5). Release the
switch when you want the window to
stop.
The automatic reverse feature doesn’t
activate while resetting the power
window system.Make sure body parts
or other objects are safely out of the
way before closing the windows to
avoid injuries or vehicle damage.
To close:
Pull the window switch up to the first
detent position (5). Release the window
switch when you want the window to
stop.
5-59
Convenience features
Automatic reverse (if equipped)
WARNING
Make sure body parts or other objects
are safely out of the way before closing
the windows to avoid injuries or vehicle
damage.
Objects less than 0.16 in (4 mm) in
diameter caught between the window
glass and the upper window channel
may not be detected by the automatic
reverse window and the window will
not stop and reverse direction.
OTM050091
If a window senses any obstacle while it
is closing automatically, it will stop and
lower approximately 12 in. (30 cm) to
allow the object to be cleared.
If the window detects the resistance
while the power window switch is
pulled up continuously, the window
will stop upward movement then lower
approximately 1 in. (2.5 cm).
If the power window switch is pulled
up continuously again within 5 seconds
after the window is lowered by the
automatic window reverse feature,
the automatic window reverse will not
operate.
Information
The automatic reverse feature is only
active when the “Auto Up” feature is used
by fully pulling up the switch to the second
detent.
NOTICE
Do not install any accessories on the
windows. The automatic reverse
feature may not operate.
5-60
Power window lock button
OTM050092L
The driver can disable the power window
switches on the rear passenger doors by
pressing the power window lock button.
When the power window lock button is
pressed:
ś The driver’s master control can
operate all the power windows.
ś The front passenger’s control can
operate the front passenger’s power
window.
ś The rear passenger’s control cannot
operate the rear passengers’ power
window.
05
à If the power window lock button is
operated (indicator turns on), rear
passenger cannot open the rear door
(if equipped with the Electronic Child
Safety Lock System).
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Child Safety Lock System” system in this
chapter.
WARNING
Do not allow children to play with the
power windows. Keep the driver’s
door power window lock button in the
LOCK position. Serious injury or death
can result from unintentional window
operation by a child.
NOTICE
ś To prevent possible damage to the
power window system, do not open
or close two windows or more at the
same time. This will also ensure the
longevity of the fuse.
ś Never try to operate the main
switch on the driver’s door and the
individual door window switch in
opposite directions at the same time.
If this is done, the window will stop
and cannot be opened or closed.
5-61
Convenience features
3$125$0,&681522)ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
If your vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, you can slide or tilt your sunroof
with the sunroof control switch located
on the overhead console.
OTM050226L
The sunroof can only be operated when
the ignition switch or Engine Start/Stop
button is in the ON or START position.
The sunroof can be operated for
approximately 3 minutes after the
ignition switch or Engine Start/Stop
button is in the ACC or LOCK/OFF
position.
However, if the front door is open, the
sunroof cannot be operated even within
the 3 minute period.
5-62
WARNING
ś Never adjust the sunroof or sunshade
when your vehicle stops. This could
result in loss of control and an
accident that may cause, serious
injury, or property damage.
ś Do not leave the engine running
and the key in your vehicle with
unsupervised children. Unattended
children could operate the sunroof,
which could result in serious injury.
ś Do not sit on the top of the vehicle. It
may cause injury or vehicle damage.
NOTICE
Do not operate the sunroof when roof
bars are installed on the vehicle or
when there is luggage on the roof.
05
Power sunshade
Tilt open/close
OTM050023
Use the power sunshade to block direct
sunlight coming through the sunroof
glass.
- Push the sunroof switch rearward to the
first detent position, the power sunshade
automatically slides open.
- Push the sunroof switch forward to the
first detent position, the power sunshade
automatically closes. However, if the
sunroof glass is open, the glass will close
first.
OTM052025L
ś Push the sunroof switch upward, the
sunroof glass tilts open. However, if
the power sunshade is closed, the
sunshade will open first.
ś Push the sunroof switch forward, the
sunroof glass automatically closes.
To stop the sunroof movement at any
point, push the sunroof switch in any
direction.
To stop the power sunshade at any point,
push the sunroof switch in any direction.
NOTICE
Do not pull or push the power sunshade
by hand as such action may damage
the power sunshade or cause it to
malfunction.
Information
Wrinkles formed on the power sunshade
are normal due to material characteristic.
5-63
Convenience features
Automatic reversal
Slide open/close
ODH043039
OTM050024
ś Push the sunroof switch rearward, the
sunroof glass slides open. However,
if the power sunshade is closed, the
power sunshade will open first.
Push the sunroof switch forward, the
sunroof glass closes.
ś Push the sunroof switch forward or
rearward to the first detent position,
the sunroof glass moves until the
switch is released.
ś Push the sunroof switch forward
or rearward to the second detent
position, the sunroof glass operates
automatically (auto slide feature).
To stop the sunroof movement at any
point, push the sunroof switch in any
direction.
5-64
If the power sunshade or sunroof glass
senses any obstacle while it is closing
automatically, it will reverse direction
then stop at a certain position.
The auto reverse function may not
work if an object thin or soft is caught
between the sliding power sunshade or
sunroof glass and sunroof sash.
WARNING
ś Make sure heads, hands, arms or
any other body parts or objects are
out of the way before operating the
sunroof. Body parts or objects may
get caught causing injuries or vehicle
damage.
ś Never deliberately use your body
parts to test the automatic reversal
function. The power sunshade or
sunroof glass may reverse direction,
but there is a risk of injury.
05
NOTICE
ś Do not continue to push the sunroof
switch after the sunroof is fully
opened, closed, or tilted. Damage to
the sunroof motor could occur.
ś Continuous operations such as slide
open/close, tilt open/close, etc., may
cause the motor or sunroof system to
malfunction.
ś Regularly remove any accumulated
dust on the sunroof rail.
ś Dust accumulated between the
sunroof and roof panel can make
noise Open the sunroof and remove
dust regularly using a clean cloth.
ś Do not try to open the sunroof when
the temperature is below freezing
or when the sunroof is covered
with snow or ice. The sunroof may
not work properly and may break if
opened by force.
ś Do not open or drive with the sunroof
glass open immediately after rain or
washing the vehicle. Water may wet
the interior of the vehicle.
ś Do not extend any luggage outside
the sunroof while driving. Vehicle
damage may occur if the vehicle
suddenly stops.
Resetting the sunroof
OTM050029
In some circumstances resetting the
sunroof operation may need to be
performed. Some instances where
resetting the sunroof may be required
include:
- When the 12-volt battery is either
disconnected or discharged
- When the sunroof fuse is replaced
- If the sunroof one-touch AUTO OPEN/
CLOSE operation is not functioning
properly
WARNING
Do not extend your head, arms, body
parts or objects outside the sunroof
while driving. Injuries may occur if the
vehicle suddenly stops.
5-65
Convenience features
Sunroof resetting procedure:
1. It is recommended to perform the
reset procedure with the vehicle
engine running. Start the vehicle in P
(Park).
2. Make sure the power sunshade and
sunroof glass are in the fully closed
position. If the power sunshade
and sunroof glass are open, push
the switch forward until the power
sunshade and sunroof glass are fully
closed.
3. Release the switch when the power
sunshade and sunroof glass are fully
closed.
4. Push the switch forward until the
power sunshade and sunroof glass
move slightly. Then release the switch.
5. Once again push and hold the sunroof
switch forward until the power
sunshade and sunroof glass slide open
and close. Do not release the switch
until the operation is completed.
If you release the switch during
operation, start the procedure again
from step 2.
Information
If the sunroof is not reset when the vehicle
battery is disconnected or discharged, or
the sunroof fuse is blown, the sunroof may
not operate normally.
5-66
Sunroof open warning
OTM048118
If the driver turns off the engine when
the sunroof is not fully closed, the
warning chime will sound for several
seconds and the sunroof open warning
will appear on the cluster LCD display.
Close the sunroof securely when leaving
your vehicle.
CAUTION
Make sure the sunroof is closed fully
when leaving your vehicle.
If the sunroof is left open, rain or snow
may wet the interior of the vehicle.
Also, leaving the sunroof open when the
vehicle is unattended may invite theft.
05
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Hood
Closing the hood
Opening the hood
1. Before closing the hood, check in and
around the engine compartment to
ensure the following:
- Any tools or other loose objects
are removed from the engine room
area or hood opening area
- All glove, rags, or other
combustible material is removed
from the engine compartment
- All filler caps are tightly and
correctly installed
2. Lower the hood halfway (lifted
approximately 12 in. (30 cm) from the
closed position) and push down to
securely lock in place. Then double
check to be sure the hood is secure.
If the hood can be raised slightly, it is
not securely locked. Open it again and
close it with more force.
OTM050032
1. Park the vehicle and set the parking
brake.
2. Pull the release lever to unlatch the
hood. The hood should pop open
slightly.
WARNING
OTM050069
3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise the
hood slightly, push up the secondary
latch (1) inside of the hood center and
lift the hood.
After the hood has been lifted halfway,
it will raise completely by itself.
ś Before closing the hood, ensure
all obstructions are removed from
around the hood opening.
ś Always double check to be sure that
the hood is firmly latched before
driving away. Check there is no
hood open warning light or message
displayed on the instrument cluster.
Driving with the hood opened may
cause a total loss of visibility, which
might result in an accident.
ś Do not move the vehicle with the
hood in the raised position, as vision
is obstructed, which might result in
an accident, and the hood could fall
or be damaged.
5-67
Convenience features
Closing the liftgate
Liftgate
Opening the liftgate
OTMPH051004N
OTM050047
Make sure the vehicle is in P (Park) and
set the parking brake.
Then do one of the following:
1. Unlock all doors with the Door Unlock
button on your remote key or smart
key. Press the liftgate handle button
and open the liftgate.
2. Press and hold the liftgate open
button on the remote key or smart
key. Press the liftgate handle button
and open the liftgate.
3. With the Smart Key in your
possession, press the liftgate handle
button and open the liftgate.
Lower the liftgate lid and press down
until it locks. To be sure the liftgate lid is
securely fastened, always check by trying
to pull it up again without pressing the
liftgate handle button.
WARNING
Always keep the liftgate lid completely
closed while the vehicle is in motion. If
it is left open or ajar, poisonous exhaust
gases containing carbon monoxide
(CO) may enter the vehicle and serious
illness or death may result.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the liftgate lift
cylinders and the attached hardware,
always close the liftgate before driving.
Information
In cold and wet climates, liftgate lock
and liftgate mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
5-68
05
Emergency liftgate safety release
WARNING
OTMPH051006N
OTM050041
Do not hold the part (gas lifter) that
supports the liftgate. Be aware that
the deformation of the part may cause
vehicle damage and a risk of injury.
WARNING
ś NEVER allow anyone to occupy the
luggage compartment of the vehicle
at any time. If the liftgate is partially
or totally latched and the person
is unable to get out, serious injury
or death could occur due to lack
of ventilation, exhaust fumes and
rapid heat build-up, or because of
exposure to cold weather conditions.
The luggage compartment is also
a highly dangerous location in the
event of a crash because it is not a
protected occupant space but is a
part of the vehicle’s crush zone.
ś Your vehicle should be kept locked
and keys should be kept out of
the reach of children. Parents
should teach their children about
the dangers of playing in luggage
compartments.
Your vehicle is equipped with the
emergency liftgate safety release lever
located on the bottom of the liftgate.
When someone is inadvertently locked
in the luggage compartment. The liftgate
can be opened by doing as follows:
1. Remove the cover.
2. Push the release lever to the right by
a key.
3. Push up the liftgate.
WARNING
ś For emergencies, be fully aware
of the location of the emergency
liftgate safety release lever in the
vehicle and how to open the liftgate
if you are accidentally locked in the
luggage compartment.
ś No one should be allowed to occupy
the luggage compartment of the
vehicle at any time. The luggage
compartment is a very dangerous
location in the event of a crash.
ś Use the release lever for
emergencies only. Use with extreme
caution, especially while the vehicle
is in motion.
5-69
Convenience features
Power Liftgate (if equipped)
Power liftgate operating conditions
The power liftgate operates when
the gear is in P (Park) with the engine
running. However, the power liftgate will
operate regardless of the gear position
when the engine is off. Also, the liftgate
can be opened only when vehicle speed
is below 1.8 mph (3 km/h).
For safety, before attempting to open or
close the liftgate, make sure the vehicle
is in P (Park).
WARNING
ś Never leave children or animals
unattended in your vehicle. Children
may operate the power liftgate.
Doing so can result in injury to
themselves or others and can
damage the vehicle.
ś
OTM050046
Make sure that there are no people
or objects in the path of the power
liftgate or smart liftgate prior to
use. Serious injury, damage to the
vehicle or damage to surrounding
objects (for example, walls, ceilings,
vehicles, etc.) may result if contact
with the liftgate occurs.
5-70
NOTICE
ś Do not close or open the liftgate
manually. This may cause damage to
the power liftgate. If it is necessary
to close or open the liftgate manually
when the battery is discharged or
disconnected, do not apply excessive
force.
ś Do not operate the power liftgate
more than 10 times continuously
when the engine is not running. Use
the power liftgate with the engine
running when the power liftgate is
used repeatedly to prevent battery
discharge.
ś Do not leave the power liftgate open
for a long period of time. This may
drain the battery.
ś Do not apply excessive force when
the power liftgate is operating. Doing
so could result in vehicle damage.
ś
OTM050046
Do not grab or hold on to the liftgate
support struts at any time. Damage
to the liftgate support struts could
result. Deformation of the liftgate
support struts may cause vehicle
damage and personal injury may
occur.
05
ś Do not modify or repair any part
of the power liftgate by yourself.
This must be done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Do not operate the power liftgate
under the following conditions.
The power liftgate may not operate
properly.
- One side of the vehicle is lifted to
inspect the vehicle or change a tire
- Parking on an uneven road such as
a slope, etc.
ś Close the liftgate completely and
lock all doors and liftgate using the
central door lock button before using
an automatic car wash.
ś Do not spray high pressure water
directly on the power liftgate outside
open/close button. The liftgate may
open unintentionally.
Information
ś If the liftgate is not fully closed and
vehicle speed is at or above 3 km/h (1.8
mph), a warning will sound 10 times.
Immediately park the vehicle at a safe
place, close the liftgate, and check
that the liftgate open warning on the
instrument cluster is turned off.
ś In cold and wet climates, the outside
power liftgate open/close button may
not work properly due to freezing
conditions. If this occurs, remove the
ice before using the outside power
liftgate open/close button or use the
power liftgate open/close button on the
smart key or the instrument panel.
ś Operating the power liftgate more
than 5 times continuously could cause
damage to the operating motor. If
this occurs, the power liftgate will not
operate to prevent the motor from
overheating. If any of the power liftgate
buttons are pressed to try to open the
liftgate, the chime will sound 3 times,
but the liftgate will remain closed.
Allow the power liftgate system to cool
for about 1 minute before operating the
system again.
5-71
Convenience features
Operating the power liftgate
OTM050036
OTM050046
OTM050050
Power liftgate open/close button (Smart
key, Instrument panel)
Press the power liftgate open/close
button for 1 second. The liftgate opens or
closes with a warning sound.
While the liftgate is opening or closing,
press the button to stop liftgate
operation.
If the smart key is not within operation
range (approximately 10 m) from the
vehicle, liftgate operation will stop with a
warning sound for 5 seconds.
Power liftgate open/close button (Outside
the power liftgate)
When the liftgate is closed, press the
power liftgate open/close button to open
the liftgate.
If the vehicle is locked, press the power
liftgate open/close button with the smart
key in your possession.
If the liftgate is unlocked, the liftgate
will open or close with a warning sound
when the power liftgate open/close
button is pressed without carrying the
smart key.
OTMPH051007N
Power liftgate open/close button (Inside
the power liftgate)
Press the power liftgate open/close
button. The liftgate opens or closes with
a warning sound.
5-72
05
Automatic reverse
During power liftgate operation if the
power liftgate senses any obstacle,
the liftgate will stop or will fully open.
The automatic reverse feature may
not operate properly, or it may operate
unexpectedly under the following
circumstances:
ś The automatic reverse feature may
not detect the resistance if the
detected resistance is below a certain
level, or if the liftgate is almost fully
closed near the latched position.
ś The automatic reverse feature may
operate if a strong impact is applied
with no obstructions placed.
WARNING
Never intentionally place any object
or part of your body in the path of
the power liftgate to make sure the
automatic reverse feature operates.
Serious injury, or damage to the vehicle
or object may occur.
Setting the power liftgate
To use each feature, you must select the
opening speed or opening height from
the settings menu. Deselect the settings
when you do not want to use the feature.
Power liftgate opening speed
To adjust the power liftgate speed,
VHOHFWœ6HWXSƟ9HKLFOH6HWWLQJVƟ'RRU
/LIWJDWHƟ3RZHU/LIWJDWH2SHQLQJ6SHHG
Ɵ)DVW6ORZŔLQWKHLQIRWDLQPHQWV\VWHP
(Default setting is ‘Fast’.)
User height setting
1. Position the liftgate manually to the
height you prefer.
2. Press the power liftgate open/close
button located inside the liftgate for
more than 3 seconds.
If ‘User Height Setting’ is selected for
the power liftgate opening height, the
power liftgate will automatically open
to the height manually set by you.
Information
Information
The power liftgate may stop operating if
the automatic reverse feature operates
more than two times while attempting to
open or close the liftgate. If this occurs,
carefully open or close the liftgate
manually, and then after 30 seconds try to
operate the power liftgate automatically
again.
ś If the power liftgate opening height
has not been manually set, the power
liftgate will fully open when ‘User
Height Setting’ from the infotainment
system is selected.
ś If one of the height setting (Full Open/
Level 3/Level 2/Level 1) is selected from
the settings menu in the infotainment
system, and then ‘User Height Setting’
is selected, the liftgate will open to the
height manually set by you.
ś The power liftgate opening speed
and opening height settings change
according to the linked User Profile.
If the User Profile is changed, power
liftgate opening speed and opening
height settings will change accordingly.
5-73
Convenience features
Resetting the power liftgate
Emergency liftgate safety release
In some circumstances resetting the
power liftgate operation may need to
be performed. Some instances where
resetting the power liftgate may be
required include:
ś When the 12-volt battery is recharged
ś When the 12-volt battery is reinstalled
after removal or replacement
ś When the related fuse is reinstalled
after removal or replacement
OTM050042
To unlock and open the liftgate manually
from inside the luggage compartment,
perform the following procedure:
1. Insert a long, flat object, such as a key
into the opening at the bottom of the
liftgate.
2. Slide the latch in the direction of the
arrow to unlock the liftgate.
3. Push the liftgate to open.
OTMPH051009N
1. With the engine off or running, put the
gear in P (Park).
2. Press the power liftgate open/close
inner button (A) and outer button (B)
simultaneously until a chime sounds.
3. Slowly close the liftgate manually.
4. Press the power liftgate open/close
outer button. The power liftgate will
open with a chime sound.
Wait until the liftgate fully opens to
complete resetting. If the liftgate
stops before it is fully open, resetting
cannot be completed.
Information
If the power liftgate does not operate
properly after the above procedure, have
the system inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-74
WARNING
ś For emergencies, be fully aware
of the location of the emergency
liftgate safety release latch in the
vehicle and how to open the liftgate
if you are accidentally locked in the
luggage compartment.
ś No one, including animals, should
be allowed to occupy the luggage
compartment of the vehicle at any
time. The luggage compartment is a
very dangerous location in the event
of an accident.
ś Use the release latch for
emergencies only. Use extreme
caution, especially while the vehicle
is in motion.
05
Smart liftgate (if equipped)
OTMPH051010N
On a vehicle equipped with a smart key,
the liftgate can be opened with handsfree activation using the smart liftgate
system.
Using smart liftgate
The hands-free smart liftgate system
can be opened automatically when the
following conditions are met:
ś The smart liftgate option is enabled in
the Settings menu in the infotainment
system screen.
ś The smart liftgate is activated and
ready 15 seconds after all the doors
are closed and locked.
ś The smart liftgate will open when
the smart key is detected in the area
behind the vehicle for 3 seconds.
Information
The smart liftgate will NOT operate when:
ś A door is not locked or closed.
ś The smart key is detected within
15 seconds from when the doors were
closed and locked.
ś The smart key is detected within
15 seconds after the doors are closed
and locked, and within 60 in. (1.5
m) from the front door handles. (for
vehicles equipped with Welcome Light).
ś The smart key is in the vehicle.
1. Settings
To activate the Smart Liftgate, go to
User Settings Mode and select Smart
Liftgate on the LCD display.
2. Detect and Alert
The smart liftgate detecting area
extends approximately 20~40 in.
(50~100 cm) behind the vehicle. If you
are positioned in the detecting area
and are carrying the smart key, the
hazard warning lights will blink and
the chime will sound to alert you that
the smart liftgate will open.
5-75
Convenience features
Information
Do not approach the detecting area if you
do not want the liftgate to open. If you
have unintentionally entered the detecting
area and the hazard warning lights and
chime starts to operate, move away from
the area behind the vehicle with the smart
key. The liftgate will remain closed.
3. Automatic opening
After the hazard warning lights blink
and the chime sounds 6 times, the
smart liftgate will open.
Deactivating smart liftgate
Type A
Type B
OTMA050009
OTMA050010
1. Door lock
2. Door unlock
3. Liftgate open (Liftgate)
Liftgate open / close (Power liftgate)
5-76
If you press any button on the smart key
during the Detect and Alert stage, the
smart liftgate will be deactivated.
Make sure to be aware of how to
deactivate the smart liftgate for
emergency situations.
ś If you press the door unlock button
(2), the smart liftgate will be
deactivated temporarily. But, if you do
not open any door for 30 seconds, the
smart liftgate will be activated again.
ś If you press the liftgate open button
(3) for more than 1 second, the liftgate
opens.
ś The smart liftgate will still be activated
if you press the door lock button (1) or
liftgate open/close button (3) on the
smart key as long as the smart liftgate
is not already in the Detect and Alert
stage.
ś In case you have deactivated the
smart liftgate by pressing the smart
key button and opened a door, the
smart liftgate can be activated again
by closing and locking all doors.
05
Detecting area
Fuel filler door
Opening the fuel filler door
OTM050060
ś The smart liftgate detecting area
extends approximately 20~40 in.
(50~100 cm) behind the vehicle. If
you are positioned in the detecting
area and are carrying the smart key,
the hazard warning lights will blink
and the chime will sound for about 3
seconds to alert you that the liftgate
will open.
ś The alert stops once the smart key is
moved outside of the detecting area
within the 3 second period.
OTM050063L
1. Turn the engine off.
2. Ensure Driver’s door is unlocked.
3. Press the rear center edge of the fuel
filler door.
Information
ś Smart liftgate may not operate
properly if any of the following occur:
- The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the transmitter.
- The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a mobile phone.
- Another vehicle’s smart key is being
operated close to your vehicle.
ś Smart liftgate detecting area may
change when:
- The vehicle is parked on an incline
or slope.
- One side of the vehicle is raised or
lowered relative to the opposite side.
OTM048041
4. Pull the fuel filler door (1) outward to
access the fuel tank cap.
5. To remove the fuel tank cap (2), turn
it counterclockwise. You may hear a
hissing noise as the pressure inside
the tank equalizes.
6. Place the cap on the fuel filler door.
5-77
Convenience features
Information
The fuel filler door will unlock when
Driver’s door is unlocked.
To unlock fuel filler door:
ś Press the unlock button on your smart
key
ś Press the Central Door unlock button
on armrest trim of driver’s door
The fuel filler door will lock when Driver’s
door is locked.
To lock fuel filler door:
ś Press the lock button on your smart key
ś Press the Central Door lock button on
armrest trim of driver’s door
à All doors will automatically lock after
the vehicle speed exceeds 9 mph. Fuel
filler door is also locked when vehicle
speed exceeds 9 mph.
Information
If the fuel filler door does not open
because ice has formed around it, tap
lightly or push on the door to break the
ice and release the door. Do not pry on the
door. If necessary, spray around the door
with an approved deicer fluid (do not use
radiator antifreeze) or move the vehicle to
a warm place and allow the ice to melt.
5-78
Closing the fuel filler door
1. To install the fuel tank cap, turn it
clockwise until it “clicks” one time.
2. Close the fuel filler door until it is
latched securely.
Information
Make the vehicle door to LOCK position
and the fuel filler door completely closed
in order to lock the fuel filler door.
If the fuel filler door is not completely
closed, the fuel filler door will not be
locked.
CAUTION
Keep the door into LOCK position
when the vehicle is being washed
(for example, high pressure washer,
automatic car washer, etc.)
WARNING
Automotive fuel is highly flammable
and explosive. Failure to follow these
guidelines may result in SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH:
ś Read and follow all warnings posted
at the gas station.
ś Before refueling, note the location
of the Emergency Fuel Shut-Off, if
available, at the gas station.
ś Before touching the fuel nozzle, you
should eliminate the potential buildup of static electricity by touching
a metal part of the vehicle, a safe
distance away from the fuel filler
neck, nozzle, or other gas source,
with your bare hand.
ś Do not use mobile phones while
refueling. Electric current and/or
electronic interference from cellular
phones can potentially ignite fuel
vapors and cause a fire.
05
ś Do not get back into a vehicle
once you have begun refueling.
You can generate a buildup of
static electricity by touching,
rubbing or sliding against any item
or fabric capable of producing
static electricity. Static electricity
discharge can ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire. If you must re-enter
the vehicle, you should once again
eliminate potentially dangerous
static electricity discharge by
touching a metal part of the vehicle,
away from the fuel filler neck, nozzle
or other fuel source, with your bare
hand.
ś When using an approved portable
fuel container, be sure to place the
container on the ground prior to
refueling. Static electricity discharge
from the container can ignite fuel
vapors causing a fire.
Once refueling has begun, contact
between your bare hand and the
vehicle should be maintained until
the filling is complete.
ś Use only approved portable plastic
fuel containers designed to carry and
store fuel.
ś When refueling, always shift the
gear to the P (Park) position, set
the parking brake, and press the
Engine Start/Stop button to the
OFF position. Sparks produced by
electrical components related to the
engine can ignite fuel vapors causing
a fire.
ś Do not use matches or a lighter and
do not smoke or leave a lit cigarette
in your vehicle while at a gas station,
especially during refueling.
ś Do not over-fill or top-off your
vehicle tank, which can cause fuel
spillage.
ś If a fire breaks out during refueling,
leave the vicinity of the vehicle, and
immediately contact the manager
of the gas station and then contact
the local fire department. Follow any
safety instructions they provide.
ś If pressurized fuel sprays out, it can
cover your clothes or skin and thus
subject you to the risk of fire and
burns. Always remove the fuel cap
carefully and slowly. If the cap is
venting fuel or if you hear a hissing
sound, wait until the condition stops
before completely removing the cap.
ś Always check that the fuel cap is
installed securely to prevent fuel
spillage in the event of an accident.
Information
Make sure to refuel your vehicle according
to the “Fuel Requirements” section in
suggested in chapter 1.
NOTICE
ś Do not spill fuel on the exterior
surfaces of the vehicle. Any type of
fuel spilled on painted surfaces may
damage the paint.
ś If the fuel filler cap requires
replacement, use only a genuine
HYUNDAI cap or the equivalent
specified for your vehicle. An
incorrect fuel filler cap can result
in a serious malfunction of the fuel
system or emission control system.
5-79
Convenience features
+($'ǘ83',63/$<ǣ+8'Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Head-up display information
OTMA050019
The Head-Up Display is an optional
feature that allows the driver to view
information projected onto a transparent
screen while still keeping your eyes
safely on the road ahead while driving.
Head-up display settings
OTMA050016
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Turn by Turn (TBT) navigation
Traffic
Speedometer
SCC set speed
SCC Vehicle distance
Highway Driving Assist
Lane Following Assist
Lane Safety
Blind-Spot Safety
Highway Auto Speed Change
Information
OIK047152N
ś Head-up display can be enabled from
the Settings menu in the User Settings
mode on the instrument cluster LCD
display. Select:
- 6HWXSƟ+HDG8S'LVSOD\Ɵ(QDEOH
Head-Up Display
ś After turning on the head-up
display, you can change the settings
of ‘Display Height’ and ‘Content
Selection’ of the Head-Up Display.
5-80
If you select Turn By Turn (TBT)
navigation information as Head-Up
Display contents, the Turn By Turn
(TBT) navigation information will not be
displayed in the instrument cluster LCD
display.
05
Precautions while using the
head-up display
ś It may sometimes be difficult to read
information on the Head-Up Display in
the following situations.
- The driver is improperly positioned
in the driver’s seat
- The driver wears polarizing-filter
sunglasses
- An object is located above the
head-up display cover
- The vehicle is driven on a wet road
- Any improper lighting accessory is
installed inside the vehicle, or there
is incoming light from outside of the
vehicle
- The driver wears glasses
- The driver wears contact lenses
When it is difficult to read the HeadUp Display information, adjust the
image height or brightness level from
the Settings menu in the infotainment
system screen.
ś For your safety, make sure to stop the
vehicle before adjusting the settings.
ś Do not tint the front windshield glass
or add other types of metallic coating.
Otherwise, the Head-Up Display
image may be invisible.
ś Do not place any accessories on the
crash pad or attach any objects on the
windshield glass.
ś When replacing the front windshield
glass, replace it with a windshield
glass designed for Head-Up Display
operation. Otherwise, duplicated
images may be displayed on the
windshield glass.
WARNING
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
warnings on the Head-Up Display are
supplemental. Do not solely depend on
them to change lanes. Always take a
look around before changing lanes.
5-81
Convenience features
LIGHTING
Exterior lights
Lighting control
To operate the lights, turn the knob at
the end of the control lever to one of the
following positions:
OTM050098
OAD045402
1.
2.
3.
4.
OFF
AUTO headlight
Position lamp
Headlight
Daytime Running Light (DRL)
The Daytime Running Lights (DRL) can
make it easier for others to see the front
of your vehicle during the day, especially
after dawn and before sunset.
The DRL system will turn the dedicated
lamp OFF when :
ś The headlights are ON.
ś The parking brake is applied.
ś The vehicle is turned off.
5-82
AUTO headlight
The position lamp and headlight will
be turned ON or OFF automatically
depending on the amount of daylight as
measured by the ambient light sensor (1)
at the upper end of the windshield glass.
Even with the AUTO headlight feature
in operation, it is recommended to
manually turn ON the headlights when
driving at night or in a fog, driving in the
rain, or when you enter dark areas, such
as tunnels and parking facilities.
NOTICE
ś Do not cover or spill anything on the
sensor (1) located at the upper end of
the windshield glass.
ś Do not clean the sensor using
a window cleaner, the cleanser
may leave a light film which could
interfere with sensor operation.
ś If your vehicle has window tint or
other types of metallic coating on the
front windshield, the AUTO headlight
system may not work properly.
05
High beam operation
OIG046412
Position lamp ( )
The position lamp, license plate lamp
and instrument panel lamp are turned
ON.
OOS047407N
To turn on the high beam headlight, push
the lever away from you. The lever will
return to its original position.
The high beam indicator will light when
the headlight high beams are switched
on.
To turn off the high beam headlight, pull
the lever towards you. The low beams
will turn on.
OIG046413
Headlight ( )
The headlight, position lamp, license
plate lamp and instrument panel lamp
are turned ON.
Information
The ignition switch must be in the ON
position to turn on the headlight.
OIG046414
To flash the high beam headlight, pull the
lever towards you, then release the lever.
The high beams will remain ON as long
as you hold the lever towards you.
5-83
Convenience features
Turn signals and lane change signals
OIG046417
To signal a turn, push down on the lever
for a left turn or up for a right turn in
position (A).
If an indicator stays on and does not flash
or if it flashes abnormally, one of the turn
signal bulbs may be burned out and will
require replacement.
One touch turn signal
To use One Touch Turn Signal push the
turn signal lever up or down to position
(B) and then release it.
The lane change signals will blink 3, 5 or
7 times.
You can enable the One Touch Turn
Signal function or choose the number
RIEOLQNLQJE\VHOHFWLQJœ6HWXSƟ8VHU
6HWWLQJVƟ/LJKWVƟ2QH7RXFK7XUQ6LJQDO
Ɵ2IIIODVKHVIODVKHVIODVKHVŔLQWKH
instrument panel LCD cluster.
5-84
Battery saver function
The purpose of this feature is to prevent
the battery from being discharged.
The system automatically turns off the
position lamp when the driver turns the
vehicle off and opens the driver-side
door.
With this feature, the position lamps will
turn off automatically if the driver parks
on the side of road at night.
However, the position lamps stay ON
even when the driver-side door is opened
if the headlight switch is turned to the
position lamp or AUTO (if equipped)
position after the engine is turned off.
If necessary, to keep the lamps on
turn the position lamps OFF and ON
again using the headlight switch on
the steering column after the engine is
turned off.
05
Headlight delay function
(if equipped)
If you place the ignition switch to the
ACC position or the OFF position with
the headlights ON, the headlights (and/
or position lamps) remain on for about
5 minutes. However, if the driver’s door
is opened and closed, the headlights
are turned off after 15 seconds. Also,
with the vehicle off if the driver’s door is
opened and closed, the headlights (and/
or position lamps) are turned off after 15
seconds.
The headlights (and/or position lamps)
can be turned off by pressing the lock
button on the remote key or smart key
twice or turning the headlight switch to
the OFF or AUTO position.
You can enable the headlight delay
IXQFWLRQE\VHOHFWLQJœ6HWXSƟ8VHU
6HWWLQJVƟ/LJKWVƟ+HDGOLJKW'HOD\
Traffic change (if equipped)
The low beam light distribution is
asymmetric. If you go abroad to a
country with opposite traffic direction,
this asymmetric part will dazzle
oncoming car driver.
To prevent dazzle, ECE regulation
demand several technical solutions (ex.
automatic change system, adhesive
sheet, down aiming). These headlights
are designed not to dazzle opposite
drivers.
You can activate or deactivate the Traffic
Change feature from the User Settings
PRGHRQWKH/&'GLVSOD\*RWRœ/LJKWVƟ
Travel Mode’.
For more details, refer to “LCD Display”
In chapter 4.
NOTICE
If the driver exits the vehicle through
another door besides the driver
door, the battery saver function
does not operate and the headlight
delay function does not turn OFF
automatically.
This may cause the battery to
discharge. To avoid battery discharge,
turn OFF the headlights manually from
the headlight switch before exiting the
vehicle.
5-85
Convenience features
+,*+%($0$66,67ǣ+%$Ǥ
NOTICE
Always keep the front view camera in
good condition to maintain optimal
performance of High Beam Assist.
For more details on the precautions
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
High Beam Assist Settings
OIK047090
High Beam Assist will automatically
adjust the headlight range (switches
between high beam and low beam)
depending on the brightness of detected
vehicles and certain road conditions.
Detecting sensor (Front view
camera)
OTM070001
[1] : Front view camera
The front view camera is used as a
detecting sensor to detect ambient light
and brightness while driving.
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting sensor.
5-86
:LWKWKHHQJLQHRQVHOHFWœ/LJKWVƟ+LJK
Beam Assist (or HBA (High Beam Assist))’
from the Settings menu to turn on High
Beam Assist and deselect to turn off the
system.
WARNING
For your safety, change the Settings
after parking the vehicle at a safe
location.
05
High Beam Assist Operation
Display and control
ś After selecting ‘High Beam Assist’
in the Settings menu, High Beam
Assist will operate by following the
procedure below.
- Place the headlight switch in
the AUTO position and push
the headlight lever towards the
instrument cluster. The High Beam
Assist ( ) indicator light will
illuminate on the cluster and the
system will be enabled.
- When the system is enabled, high
beam will turn on when vehicle
speed is above 25mph (40km/h).
When vehicle speed is below 15mph
(25km/h), high beam will not turn
on.
) indicator light
- The High Beam (
will illuminate on the cluster when
high beam is on.
ś When High Beam Assist is operating,
if the headlight lever or switch is used,
the system operates as follow:
- If the headlight lever is pulled
towards you when the high beam
is off, the high beam will turn on
without High Beam Assist canceled.
When you let go of the headlight
lever, the lever will move to the
middle and the high beam will turn
off.
- If the headlight lever is pulled
towards you when the high beam is
on by High Beam Assist, low beam
will be on and the system will turn
off.
- If the headlight switch is placed
from AUTO to another position
(headlight/position/off), High
Beam Assist will turn off and the
corresponding lamp will turn on.
ś When High Beam Assist is operating,
high beam switches to low beam if
any of the following conditions occur:
- When the headlight of an oncoming
vehicle is detected.
- When the tail lamp of a vehicle in
front is detected.
- When the headlight or tail lamp of a
motorcycle or a bicycle is detected.
- When the surrounding ambient light
is bright enough that high beams
are not required.
- When streetlights or other lights are
detected.
High Beam Assist Malfunction
and Limitations
High Beam Assist Malfunction
Type A
Type B
OTM050218N
OTM050218L
When High Beam Assist is not working
properly, the ‘Check High Beam Assist
(HBA) system’ or ‘Check HBA (High
Beam Assist system’ warning message
will appear and warning light will
illuminate on the cluster. Have the
system be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-87
Convenience features
Limitations of High Beam Assist
High Beam Assist may not work properly
in the following situations:
ś Light from a vehicle is not detected
because of lamp damage, or because
it is hidden from sight, etc.
ś Headlight of a vehicle is covered with
dust, snow or water.
ś A vehicle’s headlights are off but the
fog lamps are on and etc.
ś There is a lamp that has a similar
shape as a vehicle’s lamp.
ś Headlights have been damaged or not
repaired properly.
ś Headlights are not aimed properly.
ś Driving on a narrow curved road,
rough road, uphill or downhill.
ś Vehicle in front is partially visible on a
crossroad or curved road.
ś There is a traffic light, reflecting sign,
flashing sign or mirror ahead.
ś There is a temporary reflector or flash
ahead (construction area).
ś The road conditions are bad such as
being wet, iced or covered with snow.
ś A vehicle suddenly appears from a
curve.
ś The vehicle is tilted from a flat tire or
is being towed.
ś Light from a vehicle is not detected
because of exhaust fume, smoke, fog,
snow, etc.
For more details on the limitations
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
5-88
WARNING
ś At times, High Beam Assist may not
work properly. It is the responsibility
of the driver for safe driving
practices and always check the road
conditions for your safety.
ś When High Beam Assist does not
operate normally, change the
headlight position manually between
high beam and low beam.
05
INTERIOR LIGHTS
WARNING
Front lamps
Do not use the interior lights when
driving in the dark. The interior lights
may obscure your view and cause an
accident.
NOTICE
Do not use the interior lights for
extended periods when the vehicle is
turned off or the battery will discharge.
Interior lamp AUTO cut
The interior lamps will automatically go
off approximately 10 minutes after the
vehicle is turned off and the doors are
closed. If a door is opened, the lamp
will go off 40 minutes after the vehicle
is turned off. If the doors are locked by
the smart key and the vehicle enters the
armed stage of the theft alarm system,
the lamps will go off five seconds later.
OTM050227L
Front map lamp (
):
Touch either icons to turn the map lamp
on or off. This light produces a spot
beam for convenient use as a map lamp
at night or as a personal lamp for the
driver and the front passenger.
):
Door lamp (
The front or rear room lamps come on
when the front or rear doors are opened.
When doors are unlocked by the smart
key, the front and rear lamps come on
for approximately 30 seconds as long as
any door is not opened. The front and
rear room lamps go out gradually after
approximately 30 seconds when the
door is closed. However, if the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON position
or all doors are locked, the front and rear
lamps will turn off. If a door is opened
with the ignition switch in the ACC
position or the OFF position, the front
and rear lamps will stay on for about 10
minutes.
)
Room lamp (
Press the button to turn ON the room
lamp for the front/rear seats.
5-89
Convenience features
Rear lamps
Vanity mirror lamp
Type A
OTM048076
Type B
Push the switch to turn the light on or off.
: The lamp will turn on if this
ś
button is pressed.
: The lamp will turn off if this
ś
button is pressed.
OTM048409
Rear room lamp switch :
Press this button to turn the room lamp
on and off.
5-90
OTM050200
05
Luggage compartment lamp
Puddle lamp
OTMPH051012N
ś ON : The luggage compartment lamp
stays on at all times.
ś DOOR : The luggage compartment
lamp comes on when the liftgate is
opened.
ś OFF : The luggage compartment lamp
is off.
OTM050080
Welcome light
When all doors (and liftgate) are closed
and locked, the puddle lamp will turn on
for 15 seconds if the door is unlocked by
the smart key or when you put your hand
in the outside door handle with the smart
key in possession.
For more details, refer to “Welcome
System” in this chapter.
Escort light
When the Engine Start/Stop button is in
the OFF position and the driver’s door is
opened, the puddle lamp will turn on for
30 seconds. If the driver’s door is closed
within the 30 second period, the puddle
lamp will turn off after 15 seconds. If the
driver’s door is closed and locked, the
puddle lamp will turn off immediately.
The Puddle Lamp Escort Light will turn
on only the first time the driver’s door is
opened after the engine is turned off.
5-91
Convenience features
Headlight and position lamp
Welcome system
When the headlight (lamp switch in the
headlight or AUTO position) is on and
all doors (and liftgate) are locked and
closed, the position lamp and headlight
will come on for 15 seconds when the
door unlock button is pressed on the
remote key or smart key.
At this time, if you press the door lock
or unlock button, the position lamp and
headlight will turn off immediately.
OTM050075
Welcome system helps keep the driver
visible by turning on vehicle lights when
the driver approaches the vehicle.
Puddle lamp and door handle lamp
When all the doors (and liftgate) are
closed and locked, the puddle lamp
and door handle lamp will turn on for
approximately 15 seconds if any of the
below is performed.
1. ,Iœ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPHPLUURU
OLJKWƟ2QGRRUXQORFNŔLVVHOHFWHGLQ
the User Settings mode on the LCD
display,
śthe lamps will turn on when the
door lock button is pressed on the
smart key.
śthe lamps will turn on when the
button of the outside door handle
is pressed with the smart key in
possession.
2. ,IERWKœ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPH
PLUURUOLJKWƟ2QGRRUXQORFNŔDQG
œ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:HOFRPHPLUURUOLJKW
Ɵ2QGULYHUDSSURDFKŔLVVHOHFWHGLQ
the User Settings mode on the LCD
display, the lamps will turn on when
the vehicle is approached with the
smart key in possession.
You can activate or deactivate Welcome
Light function from the User Settings
mode on the LCD display.
5-92
Interior lamp
When the interior lamp switch is in the
position and all doors (and liftgate)
are closed and locked, the room lamp
will come on for 30 seconds if any of the
below is performed.
- When the door unlock button is
pressed on the remote key or smart
key.
- When you put your hand in the
outside door handle while carrying the
smart key.
At this time, if you press the door lock
or unlock button on the smart key the
lamps will turn off immediately.
05
:,3(56$1':$6+(56
Windshield wipers
Front windshield wiper/washer
OTLE045161
Rear windshield wiper/washer
Operates as follows when the ignition
switch is turned ON.
MIST :
For a single wiping cycle,
move the lever upward and
release it. The wipers will
operate continuously if the
lever is held in this position.
OFF :
Wipers are not in operation.
INT :
Wipers operate intermittently
at the same wiping intervals.
Use this mode in light rain
or mist. To vary the speed
setting, turn the speed
control knob.
LO :
The wiper runs at a lower speed.
HI :
The wiper runs at a higher speed.
Information
OTLE045508
A. Wiper speed control (front)
śMIST – Single wipe
śOFF – Off
śINT – Intermittent wipe
AUTO* – Auto control wipe
śLO– Low wiper speed
śHI – High wiper speed
B. Intermittent control wipe time
adjustment
C. Wash with brief wipes (front)
(pull lever towards you)
D. Rear wiper control*
śHI – High wiper speed
śLO– Low wiper speed
śOFF – Off
E. Wash with brief wipes (rear)
(pull lever towards you)
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
or ice on the windshield, defrost the
windshield for about 10 minutes, or until
the snow and/or ice is removed before
using the windshield wipers to ensure
proper operation.
If you do not remove the snow and/or ice
before using the wiper and washer, it may
damage the wiper and washer system.
* : if equipped
5-93
Convenience features
AUTO (Automatic) control
(if equipped)
The rain sensor located on the upper
end of the windshield glass senses
the amount of rainfall and controls the
wiping cycle for the proper interval.
The wiper operation time will be
automatically controlled depends on
rainfall.
When the rain stops, the wiper stops.
To vary the sensitivity setting, turn the
sensitivity control knob.
If the wiper switch is set in AUTO mode
when the Engine Start/Stop button is in
the ON position, the wiper will operate
once to perform a self-check of the
system. Set the wiper to the OFF (O)
position when the wiper is not in use.
5-94
WARNING
To avoid personal injury from the
windshield wipers, when the engine
is running and the windshield wiper
switch is placed in the AUTO mode:
ś Do not touch the upper end of the
windshield glass facing the rain
sensor.
ś Do not wipe the upper end of the
windshield glass with a damp or wet
cloth.
ś Do not put pressure on the
windshield glass.
NOTICE
ś When washing the vehicle, set the
wiper switch in the OFF (O) position
to stop the auto wiper operation. The
wiper may operate and be damaged
if the switch is set in the AUTO mode
while washing the vehicle.
ś Do not remove the sensor cover
located on the upper end of the
passenger side windshield glass.
Damage to system components
could occur and may not be covered
by your vehicle warranty.
ś Because of using a photo sensor,
temporary malfunction could occur
according to sudden ambient light
change made by stone and dust
while driving.
05
Front windshield washers
WARNING
When the outside temperature is below
freezing, ALWAYS warm the windshield
using the defroster to help prevent
the washer fluid from freezing on the
windshield and obscuring your vision
which could result in an accident and
serious injury or death.
NOTICE
OTLE045164
In the OFF position, pull the lever gently
toward you to spray washer fluid on the
windshield and to run the wipers 1-3
cycles. The spray and wiper operation
will continue until you release the lever. If
the washer does not work, you may need
to add washer fluid to the washer fluid
reservoir.
ś To prevent possible damage to the
washer pump, do not operate the
washer when the fluid reservoir is
empty.
ś To prevent possible damage to the
wipers or windshield, do not operate
the wipers when the windshield is
dry.
ś To prevent damage to the wiper
arms and other components, do
not attempt to move the wipers
manually.
ś To prevent possible damage to the
wipers and washer system, use antifreezing washer fluids in the winter
season or cold weather.
5-95
Convenience features
Rear window wiper and washer
Auto rear wiper (if equipped)
The rear wiper will operate while the
vehicle is in reverse with the front wiper
ON by selecting the function from the
Settings menu on the LCD display.
Select:
- 6HWXSƟ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ&RQYHQLHQFH
Ɵ$XWR5HDU:LSHU LQ5
OTLE045165
The rear window wiper and washer
switch is located at the end of the wiper
and washer switch lever. Turn the switch
to the desired position to operate the
rear wiper and washer.
HI – High wiper speed
LO – Low wiper speed
OFF – Off
OTLE045166
Push the lever away from you to spray
rear washer fluid and to run the rear
wipers 1~3 cycles. The spray and wiper
operation will continue until you release
the lever.
5-96
05
0$18$/&/,0$7(&21752/6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OTM050121L
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Fan speed control knob
Temperature control knob
Mode selection button
Front windshield defroster button
Rear window defroster button
6. Air conditioning button
7. Air intake control button
5-97
Convenience features
Heating and air conditioning
1. Start the engine.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
To improve the effectiveness of
heating and cooling, select:
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
5. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the
air conditioning system on.
Mode selection (3)
The actual shape of air conditioner may differ from the illustration.
OTMA050100
The mode selection button controls the direction of the air flow through the ventilation
system.
5-98
05
Face-Level (B, C, E)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E, F, G)
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
Floor-Level (A, C, D, E, F, G)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and side
window defrosters.
Floor/Defrost-Level
(A, C, D, E, F, G)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
Front defroster (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
A/C MAX-Level (B, D) (if equipped)
To operate the A/C MAX, turn the
temperature control knob to extreme
left. Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face.
In this mode, the air conditioning and the
recirculated air position will be selected
automatically.
After the interior has cooled sufficiently,
whenever possible, move the
temperature knob away from A/C MAX
and press the A/C button.
5-99
Convenience features
Recirculated air position
With the recirculated air
position selected, air from the
passenger compartment will
be drawn through the heating
system and heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
Front
Outside (fresh) air position
OTM050124
Type A
Rear
Type B
With the outside (fresh) air
position selected, air enters
the vehicle from outside
and is heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
Information
OTM048308
Instrument panel vents
The outlet vents can be opened or closed
separately using the vent control lever.
If you move the vent control lever to the
left end, the outlet vents can be closed.
Temperature control
The temperature will increase by turning
the knob to the right. The temperature
will decrease by turning the knob to the
left.
Air intake control
This is used to select outside (fresh) air
position or recirculated air position. To
change the air intake control position,
press the control button.
5-100
Using the system in the fresh air position is
recommended.
Prolonged operation of the heater in the
recirculated air position (without air
conditioning selected) can cause fogging of
the windshield and side windows and the
air within the passenger compartment will
become stale.
In addition, prolonged use of the air
conditioning with the recirculated air
position selected will result in excessively
dry air in the passenger compartment.
05
WARNING
ś Continued climate control system
operation in the recirculated air
position may allow humidity to
increase inside the vehicle which
may fog the glass and obscure
visibility.
ś Do not sleep in a vehicle with the air
conditioning or heating system on. It
may cause serious harm or death due
to a drop in the oxygen level and/or
body temperature.
ś Continued climate control system
operation in the recirculated air
position can cause drowsiness
or sleepiness, and loss of vehicle
control. Set the air intake control
to the outside (fresh) air position as
much as possible while driving.
Fan speed control
Turn the knob to the right to increase
the fan speed and airflow. Turn the knob
to the left to decrease fan speed and
airflow.
Setting the fan speed control knob to the
“0” position turns off the fan.
NOTICE
Operating the fan speed when the
ignition switch is in the ON position
could cause the battery to discharge.
Operate the fan speed when the engine
is running.
Air conditioning (A/C) (if equipped)
Press the A/C button to turn the air
conditioning system on (indicator light
will illuminate). Press the button again to
turn the air conditioning system off.
System operation
Ventilation
1. Set the mode to the
position.
2. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
1. Set the mode to the
position.
2. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If dehumidified heating is desired,
turn the air conditioning system (if
equipped) on.
If the windshield fogs up, set the mode
or
position.
to the
Operation Tips
ś To help keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through the
ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculated
air position. Be sure to return the
control to the fresh air position when
the irritation has passed to keep fresh
air in the vehicle. This will help keep
the driver alert and comfortable.
ś To prevent interior fog on the
windshield, set the air intake control
to the fresh air position and fan speed
to the desired position, turn on the air
conditioning system, and adjust the
temperature control to the desired
temperature.
5-101
Convenience features
Air conditioning
HYUNDAI Air Conditioning Systems are
filled with R-1234yf refrigerant.
1. Start the engine. Push the air
conditioning button.
position.
2. Set the mode to the
3. Set the air intake control to the
outside air or recirculated air position.
4. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
NOTICE
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the temperature gauge closely
while driving up hills or in heavy traffic
when outside temperatures are high.
Air conditioning system operation may
cause engine overheating. Continue to
use the fan but turn the air conditioning
system off if the temperature gauge
indicates engine overheating.
5-102
Air conditioning system operation tips
ś If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
ś After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from the
recirculated air to the fresh outside air
position.
ś To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
ś Use the air conditioning system every
month for a few minutes to ensure
maximum system performance.
ś If you operate the air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield to
fog up, causing loss of visibility. In this
case, set the mode selection knob to
position and set the fan speed
the
control knob to the lowest speed
setting.
05
Checking the amount of air
conditioner refrigerant and
compressor lubricant
System maintenance
Cabin air filter
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the
performance of the air conditioning system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is found,
have the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Cabin air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
The cabin air filter is installed behind
the glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle through
the heating and air conditioning system.
Have the cabin air filter be replaced by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer according
to the maintenance schedule.
If the vehicle is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty or rough roads,
more frequent climate control filter
inspections and changes are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
have the system be checked at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
It is important that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, damage to the compressor
and abnormal system operation may
occur. To prevent damage, the air
conditioning system in your vehicle
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
5-103
Convenience features
NOTICE
ś The refrigerant system should only
be serviced by trained and certified
technicians to insure proper and safe
operation.
ś The refrigerant system should be
serviced in a well-ventilated place.
ś The air conditioning evaporator
(cooling coil) shall never be repaired
or replaced with one removed from
a used or salvaged vehicle and new
replacement MAC evaporators shall
be certified (and labeled) as meeting
SAE Standard J2842.
OTM050040L
Air Conditioning refrigerant label
You can find out which air conditioning
refrigerant is applied to your vehicle on
the label located inside of the hood.
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-1234yf
Since the refrigerant is
mildly flammable and
operated at high pressure,
the air conditioning system
should only be serviced
by trained and certified
technicians. It is important
that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant
are used.
All refrigerants should be reclaimed
with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to the
atmosphere is harmful to individuals
and environment. Failure to heed these
warnings can lead to serious injuries.
5-104
Example
OHYK059001
Each symbols and specification on
the air conditioning refrigerant label is
represented as below:
1. Classification of refrigerant
2. Amount of refrigerant
3. Classification of compressor lubricant
4. Caution
5. Flammable refrigerant
6. To require registered technician to
service air conditioning system
05
$8720$7,&&/,0$7(&21752/6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
The actual shape of air conditioner may differ from the illustration.
OTMA050101
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Driver’s temperature control knob
Passenger’s temperature control knob
AUTO (automatic control) button
Front windshield defroster button
Rear window defroster button
Air conditioning button
7. SYNC button
8. OFF button
9. Fan speed button
10. Mode selection button
11. Climate control button
12. Air intake control button
5-105
Convenience features
Automatic heating and air
conditioning
The Automatic Climate Control System
is controlled by setting the desired
temperature.
1. Press the AUTO button. (3)
The modes, fan speeds, air intake and
air-conditioning will be controlled
automatically by the temperature
setting you select.
2. Turn the temperature control knob
(1, 2) to the desired temperature. If
the temperature is set to the lowest
setting (Lo), the air conditioning
system will operate continuously.
After the interior has cooled
sufficiently, adjust the knob to
a higher temperature set point
whenever possible.
To turn the automatic operation off,
select any button of the following:
- Mode selection button
- Front windshield defroster button
(Press the button one more time
to deselect the front windshield
defroster function. The ‘AUTO’ sign
will illuminate on the information
display once again.)
- Fan speed control button
The selected function will be
controlled manually while other
functions operate automatically.
For your convenience and to improve
the effectiveness of the climate control,
use the AUTO button and set the
temperature to 73°F (23°C).
5-106
OTM050052
Information
Never place anything near the sensor to
ensure better control of the heating and
cooling system.
Manual heating and air
conditioning
The heating and cooling system can be
controlled manually by pushing buttons
other than the AUTO button. In this case,
the system works sequentially according
to the order of buttons selected. When
pressing any button except the AUTO
button while using automatic operation,
the functions not selected will be
controlled automatically.
1. Start the engine.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
For improving the effectiveness of
heating and cooling, select:
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
5. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the
air conditioning system on.
7. Press the AUTO button to convert to
full automatic control of the system.
05
Mode selection (12)
The actual shape of air conditioner may differ from the illustration.
OTMA050100
The mode selection button controls the direction of the air flow through the ventilation
system.
5-107
Convenience features
Front
Face-Level (B, C, E)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E, F, G)
OTM050124
Rear
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
Floor-Level (A, C, D, E, F, G)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and side
window defrosters.
Floor/Defrost-Level
(A, C, D, E, F, G)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
Defrost-Level (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
5-108
OTM050201
Instrument panel vents
The outlet vents can be opened or closed
separately using the vent control lever.
If you move the vent control lever to the
left end, the outlet vents can be closed.
05
Temperature control
Adjusting the driver and passenger side
temperature individually
ś Press the “SYNC” button again to
adjust the driver and passenger side
temperature individually. The button
indicator will turn off.
OTM050103
The temperature will increase by pushing
the knob upward. The temperature
will decrease by pushing the knob
downward.
Temperature conversion
If the battery has been discharged or
disconnected, the temperature mode
display will reset to Centigrade.
To change the temperature unit from °C
to °F or °F to °C :
- Automatic climate control system
Press the AUTO button for 3 seconds
while pressing the OFF button.
- Instrument cluster
*RWR8VHU6HWWLQJV0RGHƟ8QLWVƟ
Temperature Unit.
The temperature unit on both the cluster
LCD display and the climate control
screen will change.
OTM050108
Adjusting the driver and passenger side
temperature equally
ś Press the “SYNC” button to adjust
the driver and passenger side
temperature equally.
The passenger side temperature will
be set to the same temperature as the
driver side temperature.
ś Turn the driver side temperature
control knob. The driver and
passenger side temperature will be
adjusted equally.
5-109
Convenience features
Air intake control
This is used to select the outside (fresh)
air position or recirculated air position.
To change the air intake control position,
push the control button.
Recirculated air position
With the recirculated air
position selected, air from the
passenger compartment will
be drawn through the heating
system and heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
Outside (fresh) air position
Type A
Type B
5-110
With the outside (fresh) air
position selected, air enters
the vehicle from outside
and is heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
Information
Using the system in the fresh air position is
recommended.
Prolonged operation of the heater in the
recirculated air position (without air
conditioning selected) can cause fogging of
the windshield and side windows and the
air within the passenger compartment will
become stale.
In addition, prolonged use of the air
conditioning with the recirculated air
position selected will result in excessively
dry air in the passenger compartment.
WARNING
ś Continued climate control system
operation in the recirculated air
position may allow humidity to
increase inside the vehicle which
may fog the glass and obscure
visibility.
ś Do not sleep in a vehicle with the air
conditioning or heating system on. It
may cause serious harm or death due
to a drop in the oxygen level and/or
body temperature.
ś Continued climate control system
operation in the recirculated air
position can cause drowsiness
or sleepiness, and loss of vehicle
control. Set the air intake control
to the outside (fresh) air position as
much as possible while driving.
05
Fan speed control
System operation
The fan speed can be set as desired by
pushing the fan speed control button.
More air is delivered with higher fan
speeds.
Pressing the OFF button turns off the fan.
Ventilation
NOTICE
Operating the fan when the ignition
switch is in the ON position could cause
the battery to discharge. Operate the
fan when the engine is running.
Air conditioning
Push the A/C button to turn the air
conditioning system on (indicator light
will illuminate).
Push the button again to turn the air
conditioning system off.
OFF mode
Push the OFF button to turn the climate
control system off. However, you can still
operate the mode and air intake buttons
as long as the ignition switch is in the ON
position.
1. Set the mode to the
position.
2. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
1. Set the mode to the
position.
2. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If dehumidified heating is desired,
turn the air conditioning system on.
If the windshield fogs up, set the mode
or
position.
to the
Operation Tips
ś To help keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through the
ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculated
air position. Be sure to return the
control to the fresh air position when
the irritation has passed to keep fresh
air in the vehicle. This will help keep
the driver alert and comfortable.
ś To prevent interior fog on the
windshield, set the air intake control
to the fresh air position and fan speed
to the desired position, turn on the air
conditioning system, and adjust the
temperature control to the desired
temperature.
5-111
Convenience features
Air conditioning
HYUNDAI Air Conditioning Systems are
filled with R-1234yf refrigerant.
1. Start the engine. Push the air
conditioning button.
position.
2. Set the mode to the
3. Set the air intake control to the
outside air or recirculated air position.
4. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
NOTICE
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the temperature gauge closely
while driving up hills or in heavy traffic
when outside temperatures are high.
Air conditioning system operation may
cause engine overheating. Continue to
use the fan but turn the air conditioning
system off if the temperature gauge
indicates engine overheating.
5-112
Air conditioning system operation tips
ś If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
ś After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from the
recirculated air to the fresh outside air
position.
ś To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
ś Use the air conditioning system every
month for a few minutes to ensure
maximum system performance.
ś If you operate the air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield to
fog up, causing loss of visibility. In this
case, set the mode selection button to
position and set the fan speed
the
control knob to the lowest speed
setting.
05
Checking the amount of air
conditioner refrigerant and
compressor lubricant
System maintenance
Cabin air filter
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the
performance of the air conditioning system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is found,
have the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Cabin air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
The cabin air filter is installed behind
the glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle through
the heating and air conditioning system.
Have the cabin air filter be replaced
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
according to the maintenance schedule.
If the vehicle is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty or rough roads,
more frequent climate control filter
inspections and changes are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
have the system be checked at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
It is important that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, damage to the compressor
and abnormal system operation may
occur. To prevent damage, the air
conditioning system in your vehicle
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
5-113
Convenience features
NOTICE
ś The refrigerant system should only
be serviced by trained and certified
technicians to insure proper and safe
operation.
ś The refrigerant system should be
serviced in a well-ventilated place.
ś The air conditioning evaporator
(cooling coil) shall never be repaired
or replaced with one removed from
a used or salvaged vehicle and new
replacement MAC evaporators shall
be certified (and labeled) as meeting
SAE Standard J2842.
OTM050040L
Air Conditioning refrigerant label
You can find out which air conditioning
refrigerant is applied to your vehicle on
the label located inside of the hood.
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-1234yf
Since the refrigerant is
mildly flammable and
operated at high pressure,
the air conditioning system
should only be serviced
by trained and certified
technicians. It is important
that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant
are used.
All refrigerants should be reclaimed
with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to the
atmosphere is harmful to individuals
and environment. Failure to heed these
warnings can lead to serious injuries.
5-114
Example
OHYK059001
Each symbols and specification on
the air conditioning refrigerant label is
represented as below:
1. Classification of refrigerant
2. Amount of refrigerant
3. Classification of compressor lubricant
4. Caution
5. Flammable refrigerant
6. To require registered technician to
service air conditioning system
05
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING
WARNING
Windshield heating
position during
Do not use the
cooling operation in extremely humid
weather. The difference between the
temperature of the outside air and that
of the windshield could cause the outer
surface of the windshield to fog up,
causing loss of visibility could cause
an accident resulting in serious injury
or death. In this case, set the mode
position
selection button to the
and fan speed control knob to a lower
speed.
ś For maximum defrost performance,
set the temperature control to the
highest temperature setting and
the fan speed control to the highest
setting.
ś If warm air to the floor is desired while
defrosting or defogging, set the mode
to the floor-defrost position.
ś Before driving, clear all snow and ice
from the windshield, rear window,
side view mirrors, and all side
windows.
ś Clear all snow and ice from the
hood and air inlet in the cowl grill
to improve heater and defroster
efficiency and to reduce the
probability of fogging up the inside of
the windshield.
Manual climate control system
To defog inside windshield
OTM050115
1. Select any fan speed except “0”
position.
2. Select the desired temperature.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The outside (fresh) air will be selected
automatically. Additionally, the
air conditioning (if equipped) will
automatically operate if the mode is
position.
selected to the
If the air conditioning and outside
(fresh) air position are not selected
automatically, press the corresponding
button manually.
NOTICE
If the engine temperature is still cold
after starting, then a brief engine warm
up period may be required for the
vented air flow to become warm or hot.
5-115
Convenience features
To defrost outside windshield
Automatic climate control
system
To defog inside windshield
OTM050126
1. Set the fan speed to the highest
(extreme right) position.
2. Set the temperature to the extreme
hot position.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The outside (fresh) air and air
conditioning (if equipped) will be
selected automatically.
5-116
OTM050116
1.
2.
3.
4.
Select the desired fan speed.
Select the desired temperature.
Press the defroster button ( ).
The air-conditioning will turn on
according to the detected ambient
temperature, outside (fresh) air
position and higher fan speed will be
selected automatically.
If the air-conditioning, outside (fresh)
air position and higher fan speed are
not selected automatically, adjust the
corresponding button or knob manually.
position is selected, lower fan
If the
speed is controlled to higher fan speed.
05
To defrost outside windshield
Auto defogging system (only
for automatic climate control
system, if equipped)
Auto defogging help reduce the
possibility of fogging up the inside of the
windshield by automatically sensing the
moisture on inside the windshield.
The auto defogging system operates
when the heater or air conditioning is on.
Information
OTM050117
1. Set fan speed to the highest position.
2. Set temperature to the extreme hot
(HI) position.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The air-conditioning will turn
on according to the detected
ambient temperature and outside
(fresh) air position will be selected
automatically.
position is selected, lower fan
If the
speed is controlled to higher fan speed.
The auto defogging system may not
operate normally, when the outside
temperature is below 14°F(-10°C).
To cancel or set the Auto Defogging
System, keep the front defroster button
pressed for 3 seconds. The “ADS OFF”
symbol will be shown in the climate
display to inform you that the system
is deactivated. To re-activate the auto
defogging system, follow the procedure
mentioned above and the “ADS OFF”
symbol will disappear.
If the battery has been disconnected
or discharged, it resets to the auto
defogging status.
Information
For efficiency, do not select recirculated
air position while the Auto defogging
system is operating.
NOTICE
Do not remove the sensor cover located
on the top of the windshield glass.
Damage to system parts could occur
and may not be covered by your vehicle
warranty.
5-117
Convenience features
Rear window defroster
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the rear window
defroster conducting elements bonded
to the inside surface of the rear window,
never use sharp instruments or window
cleaners containing abrasives to clean
the window.
The defroster heats the
window to remove frost, fog
and thin ice from the interior
and exterior of the rear
window, while the engine is
running.
ś To activate the rear window defroster,
press the rear window defroster
button located in the center control
panel. The indicator on the rear
window defroster button illuminates
when the defroster is ON.
ś To turn off the defroster, press the rear
window defroster button again.
5-118
Information
ś If there is heavy accumulation of snow
on the rear window, brush it off before
operating the rear defroster.
ś The rear window defroster
automatically turns off after
approximately 20 minutes or when the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the OFF
position.
Side view mirror defroster (if
equipped)
If your vehicle is equipped with the Side
view mirror defrosters, they will operate
at the same time you turn on the rear
window defroster.
05
&/,0$7(&21752/$'',7,21$/)($785(6
When the Auto Defogging
System operates, the indicator
will illuminate.
Auto defogging system
OTM050039
Auto defogging helps reduce the
possibility of fogging up the inside of the
windshield by automatically sensing the
moisture on inside the windshield.
The auto defogging system operates
when the heater or air conditioning is on.
If a high amount of humidity is detected
in the vehicle, the Auto Defogging
System will be enabled. The following
steps will be performed automatically:
Step 1) Air conditioning will turn ON.
Step 2) Air intake control will change to
Fresh mode.
Step 3) Mode will change to defrost to
direct airflow to the windshield.
Step 4) Fan speed will be set to MAX.
If the air conditioning is off or
recirculation mode is manually selected
while Auto Defogging System is ON, the
Auto Defogging System indicator will
blink 3 times to signal that the manual
operation has been canceled.
Information
The auto defogging system may not
operate normally, when the outside
temperature is below 14°F (10°C).
5-119
Convenience features
Turning the Auto Defogging System
ON or OFF
Climate control system
Press the front windshield defroster
button for 3 seconds when the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON position.
When the Auto Defogging System is
turned off, the ADS OFF symbol will blink
3 times and ADS OFF will be displayed on
the climate control information screen.
When the Auto Defogging System is
turned on, the ADS OFF symbol will blink
6 times without a signal.
Infotainment system
Auto Defogging System can be turned
RQDQGRIIE\VHOHFWLQJœ6HWXSƟ
9HKLFOH6HWWLQJVƟ&OLPDWHƟ'HIRJ
'HIURVW2SWLRQVƟ$XWR'HIRJŔIURPWKH
infotainment system screen.
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment
system manual.
Information
ś When the air conditioning is turned
on by Auto Defogging System, if you
try to turn off the air conditioning, the
indicator will blink 3 times and the air
conditioning will not be turned off.
ś To maintain the effectiveness and
efficiency of the Auto Defogging
System, do not select Recirculation
mode while the system is operating.
ś When Auto Defogging System is
operating, fan speed adjustment,
temperature adjustment, and air intake
control selection are all disabled.
5-120
NOTICE
Do not remove the sensor cover located
on the upper end of the windshield
glass.
Damage to system parts could occur
and may not be covered by your vehicle
warranty.
Auto dehumidify (if equipped)
To increase cabin air quality and reduce
windshield misting, recirculation mode
switches off automatically after about 5
to 30 minutes, depending on the outside
temperature, and the air intake will
change to fresh mode.
Turning Auto Dehumidify ON or OFF
Climate control system
To turn the Auto Dehumidify feature
on or off, select Face level ( ) mode
)
and press the air intake control (
button at least five times within three
seconds. When Auto Dehumidify is
turned on, the air intake control button
indicator will blink 6 times. When turned
off, the indicator will blink 3 times.
Infotainment system
Auto Dehumidify can be turned on and
RIIE\VHOHFWLQJœ6HWXSƟ9HKLFOH6HWWLQJV
Ɵ&OLPDWHƟ$XWRPDWLF9HQWLODWLRQƟ
Auto Dehumidify’ from the infotainment
system screen.
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment
system manual.
05
Recirculating air when washer
fluid is used
Sunroof inside air recirculation
(if equipped)
Recirculation mode automatically
activates to reduce any objectionable
scent of the washer fluid from entering
the cabin when the windshield washer is
used.
When the is sunroof opened, fresh
mode will be automatically selected.
At this time, if you press the air intake
control button, recirculation mode will
be selected but will change back to fresh
mode after 3 minutes. When the sunroof
is closed, the air intake position will
return to the original position that was
selected.
Turning Activate upon Washer Fluid
Use ON or OFF
Climate control system
To turn the Activate upon Washer Fluid
Use feature on or off, select Floor level
) mode, and then press the air
(
) button four times
intake control (
within two seconds while pressing the
A/C icon.
When Activate upon Washer Fluid Use
ON is turned on, the air intake control
button indicator will blink 6 times. When
turned off, the indicator will blink 3
times.
Infotainment system
Activate upon Washer Fluid Use can be
WXUQHGRQDQGRIIE\VHOHFWLQJœ6HWXSƟ
9HKLFOH6HWWLQJVƟ&OLPDWHƟ5HFLUFXODWH
$LUƟ$FWLYDWHXSRQ:DVKHU)OXLG8VH
(or Interlocking washer fluid)’ from the
infotainment system screen.
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment
system manual.
Auto. Controls That Use Climate
Control Settings (for driver’s
seat)
The temperature of the driver’s seat
warmer, air ventilated seat and heated
steering wheel is automatically
controlled depending on the inside and
outside temperature of the vehicle when
the engine is running.
To use these features, it must be
enabled from the Settings menu in the
infotainment system screen. Select:
- 6HWXSƟ9HKLFOH6HWWLQJVƟ6HDWƟ
+HDWHG9HQWLODWHG)HDWXUHVƟ+HDWHG
9HQWLODWHG)HDWXUHVƟ$XWR&RQWUROV
That Use Climate Control Settings
For more details on Auto Comfort
Control, refer to “Seat Warmers” and
“Air ventilation seats” section in chapter
3 and “Heated Steering Wheel” section
in chapter 5.
However, in cold weather to prevent
the windshield from fogging up, the
recirculation mode may not be selected.
5-121
Convenience features
6725$*(&203$570(17
WARNING
Center console storage
Never store cigarette lighters, propane
cylinders, or other flammable/explosive
materials in the vehicle. These items
may catch fire and/or explode if the
vehicle is exposed to hot temperatures
for extended periods.
WARNING
ALWAYS keep the storage compartment
covers closed securely while driving.
Items inside your vehicle are moving as
fast as the vehicle. If you have to stop
or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the
items may fly out of the compartment
and may cause an injury if they strike
the driver or a passenger.
OTM050037
To open:
Press the button.
Glove box
NOTICE
To avoid possible theft, do not leave
valuables in the storage compartments.
OTM050223L
To open:
Pull the lever (1).
WARNING
ALWAYS close the glove box door after
use.
An open glove box door can cause
serious injury to the passenger in an
accident, even if the passenger is
wearing a seat belt.
5-122
05
Tray
Luggage tray (if equipped)
Type A
OTM050034
OTM050202
Type B
WARNING
Do not place the heavy, sharp or
breakable objects in the tray. Such
objects can be thrown from the
tray in the event of a sudden stop
or an accident, possibly injuring the
passengers in the vehicle.
OTM050203
You can place a first aid kit, a reflector
triangle (front tray), tools, etc., in the box
for easy access.
ś Grasp the handle on the top of the
cover and lift it.
5-123
Convenience features
INTERIOR FEATURES
Cup holder
WARNING
Front
OTM050030L
Rear
ś Avoid abrupt starting and braking
when the cup holder is in use to
prevent spilling your drink. If hot
liquid spills, you could be burned.
Such a burn to the driver could cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Do not place uncovered or unsecured
cups, bottles, cans, etc., in the cup
holder containing hot liquid while
the vehicle is in motion. Injuries may
result in the event of a sudden stop
or collision.
ś Only use soft cups in the cup holders.
Hard objects can injure you in an
accident.
ś Do not forcefully open the cover. It
may damage if you forcefully open
the cover with your fingers, etc..
WARNING
OTMPH051013N
Cups or small beverages cups may be
placed in the cup holders.
Keep cans or bottles out of direct sun
light and do not put them in a hot
vehicle. It may explode.
NOTICE
ś Keep your drinks sealed while
driving to prevent spilling your drink.
If liquid spills, it may get into the
vehicle’s electrical/electronic system
and damage electrical/electronic
parts.
ś When cleaning spilled liquids do not
use hot air to blow out or dry the cup
holder. This may damage the interior.
5-124
05
Ashtray (if equipped)
Sunvisor
OPDE046419
To use the ashtray, open the cover.
To clean the ashtray:
The plastic receptacle should be
removed by lifting the plastic ashtray
receptacle upward after turning the
cover counterclockwise and pulling it
out.
WARNING
Putting lit cigarettes or matches in
an ashtray with other combustible
materials may cause a fire.
OTM048089
To use the sunvisor, pull it downward.
To use the sunvisor to block the sun
from the side window, pull it downward,
release it from the bracket (1) and swing
it to the side (2) towards the window.
To use the vanity mirror, pull down the
sunvisor and slide the mirror cover (3).
Adjust the sunvisor forward or backward
(4) as needed (if equipped). Use the
ticket holder (5) to hold tickets.
Close the vanity mirror cover securely
and return the sunvisor to its original
position after use.
WARNING
For your safety, do not block your view
when using the sunvisor.
NOTICE
The tab (5) adjacent to the vanity mirror
on the sunvisor can be used for toll
road tickets or self parking tickets. Use
caution when inserting tickets into the
ticket holder to avoid damage. Refrain
from putting several tickets in the ticket
holder as this could also damage the
retaining tab.
5-125
Convenience features
Power outlet
CAUTION
Front
OTM050026
Rear
OTM050031
The power outlet is designed to provide
power for mobile telephones or other
devices designed to operate with vehicle
electrical systems. The devices should
draw less than 180 watts with the engine
running.
WARNING
Avoid electrical shocks. Do not place
your fingers or foreign objects (pin, etc.)
into a power outlet or touch the power
outlet with a wet hand.
5-126
To prevent damage to the power
outlets:
ś Use the power outlet only when the
engine is running and remove the
accessory plug after use. Using the
accessory plug for prolonged periods
of time with the engine off could
cause the battery to discharge.
ś Only use 12 volts electric accessories
which are less than 180 watts in
electric capacity.
ś Adjust the air-conditioner or heater
to the lowest operating level when
using the power outlet.
ś Close the cover when not in use.
ś Some electronic devices can
cause electronic interference
when plugged into a vehicle’s
power outlet. These devices may
cause excessive audio static and
malfunctions in other electronic
systems or devices used in your
vehicle.
ś Push the plug in as far as it will go. If
good contact is not made, the plug
may overheat and the fuse may open.
ś Plug in battery equipped electrical/
electronic devices with reverse
current protection. The current
from the battery may flow into the
vehicle’s electrical/electronic system
and cause system malfunction.
05
USB charger
AC Inverter (if equipped)
Front
OTMA050011
OTM050028
Rear
The AC inverter supplies 115V/150W
electric power to operate electric
accessories or equipments.
Information
OTM050058
The USB charger is designed to recharge
batteries of small size electrical devices
using a USB cable.
The electrical devices can be recharged
when the Engine Start/Stop button is in
the ACC or ON (or START) position.
The battery charging state may be
monitored on the electrical device.
Disconnect the USB cable from the USB
port after use.
ś A smart phone or a tablet PC may
get warmer during the re-charging
process. It does not indicate any
malfunction with the charging system.
ś A smart phone or a tablet PC, which
adopts a different re-charging
method, may not be properly recharged. In this case, use an exclusive
charger of your device.
ś The charging terminal is only to
recharge a device. Do not use the
charging terminal either to turn ON
an audio or to play media In the
infotainment system.
OJX1070288L
ś Rated voltage : AC 115 volts
ś Maximum electric power : 150 watts
ś In order to avoid an electrical system
failure, electric shock, etc., be sure to
read owner’s manual before use.
ś Be sure to close the cover except the
time of use.
5-127
Convenience features
WARNING
To reduce a risk of serious or fatal
injuries:
ś Do not use a heated electric device
such as a coffeepot, toaster, heater,
iron, etc.
ś Do not insert foreign objects into the
outlet and do not touch the outlet as
you may get shocked.
ś Do not let children touch the AC
inverter.
5-128
NOTICE
ś To help prevent the battery from
being discharged, do not use the
AC inverter while the engine is not
running.
ś When not using the AC inverter,
make sure to close the AC inverter
cover.
ś After using an electric accessory
or equipment, pull the plug out.
Leaving the accessory or equipment
plugged in for a long time may cause
battery discharge.
ś Do not use an electric accessory or
equipment the power consumption
of which is greater than 220
volts/200 watts.
ś Some electric accessories or
equipment can cause electronic
interference. It may cause excessive
audio noise and malfunctions in
other electric systems or devices in
the vehicle.
ś Do not use broken electric
accessories or equipment, which
may damage the AC inverter and
electrical systems of the vehicle.
ś Do not use two or more electric
accessories or equipment at the
same time. It may cause damage to
the electrical systems of the vehicle.
ś When the input voltage is lower,
outlet LED will blink and the AC
inverter will turn off automatically. If
the input voltage goes up to normal,
the AC inverter will turn on again.
05
Wireless smart phone charging
system (if equipped)
OTM050022
[A] : Indicator light, [B] : Charging pad
On certain models, the vehicle comes
equipped with a wireless smart phone
charger.
The system is available when all doors
are closed, and when the Engine Start/
Stop button is in the ACC or ON (or
START) position.
To charge a cellular phone
The wireless smart phone charging
system charges only the Qi-enabled
smart phones ( ). Read the label on
the smart phone accessory cover or
visit your smart phone manufacturer’s
website to check whether your smart
phone supports the Qi technology.
The wireless charging process starts
when you put a Qi-enabled smart phone
on the wireless charging unit.
1. Remove other items, including the
smart key, from the wireless charging
unit. If not, the wireless charging
process may be interrupted. Place
the smart phone on the center of the
charging pad.
2. The indicator light is orange when the
smart phone is charging. The indicator
light will turn blue when phone
charging is complete.
3. You can turn ON or OFF the wireless
charging function from the Settings
menu on the instrument cluster.
Select:
- 6HWXSƟ8VHUVHWWLQJVƟ
&RQYHQLHQFHƟ:LUHOHVV&KDUJLQJ
If your smart phone is not charging:
- Slightly change the position of the
smart phone on the charging pad.
- Make sure the indicator light is
orange.
5-129
Convenience features
The indicator light will blink orange for 10
seconds if there is a malfunction in the
wireless charging system.
In this case, temporarily stop the
charging process, and re-attempt to
charge your smart phone again.
The system warns you with a message on
the LCD display if the smart phone is still
on the wireless charging unit after the
vehicle is turned OFF and the front door
is opened.
For some manufacturer’s smart phones,
the system may not warn you even
though the smart phone is left on the
wireless charging unit. This is due to the
particular characteristic of the smart
phone and not a malfunction of the
wireless charging.
Information
For some manufacturers’ cellular phones,
the system may not warn you even though
the cellular phone is left on the wireless
charging unit. This is due to the particular
characteristic of the cellular phone and
not a malfunction of the wireless charging.
5-130
NOTICE
ś The wireless smart phone charging
system may not support certain
smart phones, which are not verified
for the Qi specification ( ).
ś When placing your smart phone on
the charging pad, position the phone
in the middle of the mat for optimal
charging performance. If your smart
phone is off to the side, the charging
rate may be less and in some cases
the smart phone may experience
higher heat conduction.
ś In some cases, the wireless charging
may stop temporarily when the
smart key is used, either when
starting the vehicle or locking/
unlocking the doors, etc.
ś When charging certain smart
phones, the charging indicator may
not change to blue when the smart
phone is fully charged.
ś The wireless charging process may
temporarily stop, when temperature
abnormally increases inside the
wireless smart phone charging
system. The wireless charging
process restarts, when temperature
falls to a certain level.
ś The wireless charging process may
temporarily stop when there is
any metallic item, such as a coin,
between the wireless smart phone
charging system and smart phone.
05
ś When charging some smart phones
with a self-protection feature,
the wireless charging speed may
decrease and the wireless charging
may stop.
ś If the smart phone has a thick cover,
the wireless charging may not be
possible.
ś If the smart phone is not completely
contacting the charging pad,
wireless charging may not operate
properly.
ś Some magnetic items like credit
cards, phone cards or rail tickets may
be damaged if left with the smart
phone during the charging process.
ś When any smart phone without
a wireless charging function or a
metallic object is placed on the
charging pad, a small noise may
sound. This small sound is due to the
vehicle discerning compatibility of
the object placed on the charging
pad. It does not affect your vehicle or
the smart phone in any way.
Clock
The clock can be set from the
infotainment system.
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment
system manual.
WARNING
Do not attempt to adjust the clock
while driving. Doing so may result in
distracted driving which may lead to
an accident involving personal injury or
death.
Coat hook
Information
If the Ignition switch is in the OFF
position, the charging also stops.
OTM048095
These hooks are not designed to hold
large or heavy items.
Information
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
5-131
Convenience features
WARNING
WARNING
OTM048096
Do not hang other objects such
as hangers or hard objects except
clothes. Also, do not put heavy, sharp
or breakable objects in the clothes
pockets. In an accident or when the
curtain air bag is inflated, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury.
Floor mat anchor(s)
ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors to
attach the front floor mats to the vehicle.
The anchors on the front floor carpet
keep the floor mats from sliding forward.
WARNING
Do not overlay additional mats or liners
over the floor mats. If using All Weather
mats, remove the carpeted floor mats
before installing them. Only use floor
mats designed to connect to the
anchors.
5-132
The following must be observed when
installing ANY floor mat to the vehicle.
ś Ensure to remove a protective
film attached on the carpet
before attaching a floor mat on
the front floor carpet. Otherwise,
the floor mat may move freely on
the protective film and it could
result in unintentional braking or
accelerating.
ś Ensure that the floor mats are
securely attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchor(s) before driving
the vehicle.
ś Do not use ANY floor mat that cannot
be firmly attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchors.
ś Do not stack floor mats on top of one
another (for example, all-weather
rubber mat on top of a carpeted floor
mat). Only a single floor mat should
be installed in each position.
IMPORTANT - Your vehicle was
manufactured with driver’s side floor
mat anchors that are designed to
securely hold the floor mat in place.
To avoid any interference with pedal
operation, HYUNDAI recommends that
the HYUNDAI floor mat designed for use
in your vehicle be installed.
05
Side curtain (if equipped)
Luggage net holder (if equipped)
Type A
OTMPH051014N
OTM050206
To use the side curtain:
1. Lift the curtain by the hook (1).
2. Hang the curtain on both sides of the
hook.
Type B
CAUTION
ś Always hang both sides of the
curtain on the hook. This could cause
damage to the side curtain if only
one side of the curtain is hooked.
ś Do not let any foreign material get
in between the vehicle and side
curtain. The side curtain may not be
lifted up.
OTMPH051015N
To keep items from shifting in the
luggage compartment, you can use the 4
holders located in the luggage side trim
to attach the luggage net.
Make sure the luggage net is securely
attached to the holders in the luggage
board.
If necessary, contact your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer to obtain a luggage net.
5-133
Convenience features
Using the cargo security screen
WARNING
Avoid eye injury. DO NOT overstretch
the luggage net. ALWAYS keep your
face and body out of the luggage net’s
recoil path. DO NOT use the luggage net
when the strap has visible signs of wear
or damage.
Use the luggage net to keep only light
items from shifting in the luggage
compartment.
Cargo security screen (if
equipped)
OTMPH051017N
1. Pull the cargo security screen towards
the rear of the vehicle by the handle
(1).
2. Insert the guide pin (2) into the guide
(3).
Information
Pull out the cargo security screen with the
handle in the center to prevent the guide
pin from falling out of the guide.
OTMPH051016N
Use the cargo security screen to cover
items stored in the cargo area.
When the cargo security screen is not in
use:
1. Pull the cargo security screen
backward and up to release it from
the guides.
2. The cargo security screen will
automatically slide back in.
Information
The cargo security screen may not
automatically slide back in if the cargo
security screen is not fully pulled out. Pull
the cargo screen out all the way and then
slowly allow the screen to retract back in.
5-134
05
NOTICE
Since the cargo security screen may
be damaged or malformed, do not put
luggage on it when it is used.
WARNING
ś Do not place objects on the cargo
security screen. Such objects may be
thrown about inside the vehicle and
possibly injure vehicle occupants
during an accident or when braking.
ś Never allow anyone to ride in the
luggage compartment. It is designed
for luggage only.
ś Maintain the balance of the vehicle
and locate the weight as forward as
possible.
5-135
Convenience features
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Roof side rails
WARNING
ś The following specification is the
maximum weight that can be loaded
onto the roof side rails. Distribute the
load as evenly as possible onto the
roof side rails and secure the load
firmly.
Loading cargo or luggage in excess
of the specified weight limit on the
roof side rails may damage your
vehicle.
OTM050017
If your vehicle comes with roof side rails,
then roof side rails crossbars can be
installed on top of your vehicle.
The roof side rails crossbars are an
accessory and are available at your
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
If the vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, be sure not to position cargo
onto the roof side rails in such a way
that it could interfere with sunroof
operation.
NOTICE
ś When carrying cargo on the roof side
rails, take the necessary precautions
to make sure the cargo does not
damage the roof of the vehicle.
ś When carrying large objects on the
roof side rails, make sure they do
not exceed the overall roof length or
width.
5-136
ROOF SIDE
RAILS
220 lbs. (100 kg)
EVENLY DISTRIBUTED
ś The vehicle center of gravity will be
higher when items are loaded onto
the roof side rails. Avoid sudden
starts, braking, sharp turns, abrupt
maneuvers or high speeds that may
result in loss of vehicle control or
rollover resulting in an accident.
ś Always drive slowly and turn corners
carefully when carrying items on the
roof side rails. Severe wind updrafts,
caused by passing vehicles or natural
causes, can cause sudden upward
pressure on items loaded on the
roof side rails. This is especially true
when carrying large, flat items such
as wood panels or mattresses. This
could cause the items to fall off the
roof side rails and cause damage to
your vehicle or others around you.
ś To prevent damage or loss of cargo
while driving, check frequently
before or while driving to make sure
the items on the roof side rails are
securely fastened.
05
,1)27$,10(176<67(0
NOTICE
Antenna
ś If you install an aftermarket HID
head lamp, your vehicle’s audio and
electronic devices may not function
properly.
ś Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand
cleaner, and air freshener from
contacting the interior parts
because they may cause damage or
discoloration.
Shark fin antenna
USB Port
OTM049420
The shark fin antenna receives
transmitted data. (for example: AM/FM,
DAB, GPS)
Steering wheel remote controls
OTM050016
You can use an USB cable to connect
audio devices to the vehicle USB port.
Information
When using a portable audio device
connected to the power outlet, noise may
occur during playback. If this happens,
use the portable audio device’s power
source.
OTM050207
NOTICE
Do not operate multiple audio remote
control buttons simultaneously.
5-137
Convenience features
VOLUME (VOL + / VOL -) (1)
Infotainment system
ś Rotate the VOLUME scroll up to
increase volume.
ś Rotate the VOLUME scroll down to
decrease volume.
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment system
manual.
SEEK/PRESET (
/
Voice recognition
) (2)
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up
or down and held for 0.8 second or more,
it will function in the following modes:
ś RADIO mode
It will function as the AUTO SEEK
select button. It will SEEK until you
release the button.
ś MEDIA mode
It will function as the FF/RW button.
OTM050209
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up
or down, it will function in the following
modes:
ś RADIO mode
It will function as the PRESET STATION
UP/DOWN button.
ś MEDIA mode
It will function as the TRACK UP/
DOWN button.
MODE (3)
Press the MODE button to toggle
through Radio or Media modes.
MUTE (
) (4)
ś Press the MUTE button to mute the
sound.
ś Press the MUTE button again to
activate the sound.
Information
See additional information in supplied
Infotainment Manual.
5-138
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment
system manual.
05
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
How vehicle radio works
FM reception
OTM050208
OJF045308L
OTM050224L
(1) Call / Answer button
(2) Call end button
(3) Microphone
For detailed information, refer to the
separately supplied infotainment
system manual.
AM and FM radio signals are broadcast
from transmitter towers located around
your city. They are intercepted by the
radio antenna on your vehicle. This signal
is then received by the radio and sent to
your vehicle speakers.
When a strong radio signal has reached
your vehicle, the precise engineering
of your audio system ensures the best
possible quality reproduction. However,
in some cases the signal coming to your
vehicle may not be strong and clear.
This can be due to factors, such as
the distance from the radio station,
closeness of other strong radio stations
or the presence of buildings, bridges or
other large obstructions in the area.
CAUTION
To avoid driver distractions, do not
excessively operate the device while
driving the vehicle which may lead to
an accident.
5-139
Convenience features
AM (MW, LW) reception
FM radio station
OJF045309L
AM broadcasts can be received at
greater distances than FM broadcasts.
This is because AM radio waves are
transmitted at low frequencies. These
long, low frequency radio waves can
follow the curvature of the earth rather
than travelling straight out into the
atmosphere.
In addition, they curve around
obstructions so that they can provide
better signal coverage.
OJF045310L
FM broadcasts are transmitted at high
frequencies and do not bend to follow
the earth’s surface. Because of this, FM
broadcasts generally begin to fade at
short distances from the station. Also, FM
signals are easily affected by buildings,
mountains, or other obstructions. These
can result in certain listening conditions
which might lead you to believe a
problem exists with your radio.
The following conditions are normal and
do not indicate radio trouble :
JBM004
ś Fading - As your vehicle moves away
from the radio station, the signal will
weaken and sound will begin to fade.
When this occurs, we suggest that you
select another stronger station.
5-140
05
ś Flutter/Static - Weak FM signals
or large obstructions between the
transmitter and your radio can disturb
the signal causing static or fluttering
noises to occur. Reducing the treble
level may lessen this effect until the
disturbance clears.
Using a cellular phone or a twoway
radio
When a cellular phone is used inside
the vehicle, noise may be produced
from the audio system. This does not
mean that something is wrong with the
audio equipment. In such a case, use
the cellular phone at a place as far as
possible from the audio equipment.
NOTICE
OJF045311L
ś Station Swapping - As a FM signal
weakens, another more powerful
signal near the same frequency may
begin to play. This is because your
radio is designed to lock onto the
clearest signal. If this occurs, select
another station with a stronger signal.
ś Multi-Path Cancellation - Radio
signals being received from several
directions can cause distortion or
fluttering. This can be caused by a
direct and reflected signal from the
same station, or by signals from two
stations with close frequencies. If this
occurs, select another station until the
condition has passed.
When using a communication system
such as a cellular phone or a radio set
inside the vehicle, a separate external
antenna must be fitted. When a cellular
phone or a radio set is used with an
internal antenna alone, it may interfere
with the vehicle’s electrical system and
adversely affect safe operation of the
vehicle.
WARNING
Do not use a cellular phone while
driving. Stop at a safe location to use a
cellular phone.
5-141
Convenience features
iPod®
iPod® is a registered trademark of Apple
Inc.
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos
are registered trademarks owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such
marks by HYUNDAI is under license.
Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
A Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
enabled cell phone is required to use
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology.
5-142
05
,1)27$,10(176<67(063(&,),&$7,216
USB
Supported audio formats
ś Audio file specification
- WAVeform audio format
- MPEG1/2/2.5 Audio Layer3
- Windows Media Audio Ver 7.X/8.X
ś Bit rates
- MPEG1 (Layer3):
32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160
/192/224/256/320 kbps
- MPEG2 (Layer3):
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112
/128/144/160 kbps
- MPEG2.5 (Layer3):
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112
/128/144/160 kbps
- WMA (High Range):
48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps
ś Bits Per Sample
- WAV (PCM(Stereo)): 24 bit
- WAV (IMA ADPCM): 4 bit
- WAV (MS ADPCM): 4 bit
ś Sampling frequency
- MPEG1: 44100/48000/32000 Hz
- MPEG2: 22050/24000/16000 Hz
- MPEG2.5: 11025/12000/8000 Hz
- WMA: 32000/44100/48000 Hz
- WAV: 44100/48000 Hz
ś Maximum length of folder/file names
(Based on Unicode): 40 English or
Korean characters
ś Supported characters for folder/
file names (Unicode support): 2,604
Korean characters, 94 alphanumeric
characters, 4,888 Chinese characters
in common use, 986 special
characters
ś Maximum number of folders: 1,000
ś Maximum number of files: 5,000
NOTICE
ś Files that are not in a supported
format may not be recognised or
played, or information about them,
such as the file name, may not be
displayed properly.
ś Only files with .mp3/.wma/.wav
extensions can be recognised by the
system. If the file is not in supported
format, change the file format by
using the latest encoding software.
ś The device will not support files
locked by DRM (Digital Rights
Management).
ś For MP3/WMA compression files and
WAV file, differences in sound quality
will occur depending on the bitrate.
(Music files with a higher bitrate
have a better sound quality.)
ś Japanese or Simplified Chinese
characters in folder or file names
may not be displayed properly.
5-143
Convenience features
75$'(0$5.6
Supported USB storage devices
ś Byte/Sector: 64 kbyte or less
ś Format system: FAT12/16/32
(recommended), exFAT/NTFS
NOTICE
ś Operation is guaranteed only for a
metal cover type USB storage device
with a plug type connector.
- USB storage devices with a plastic
plug may not be recognised.
- USB storage devices in memory
card types, such as CF card or SD
cards, may not be recognised.
ś USB hard disk drives may not be
recognised.
ś When you use a large capacity USB
storage device with multiple logical
drives, only files stored on the first
drive will be recognised.
ś If an application program is loaded
on a USB storage device, the
corresponding media files may not
play.
ś Use USB 2.0 devices for better
compatibility.
Bluetooth
ś
ś
ś
ś
Bluetooth Power Class 2: -6 to 4 dBm
Aerial power: Max 3 mW
Frequency range: 2400 to 2483.5 MHz
Bluetooth patch RAM software
version: 1
5-144
Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
ś The Bluetooth®
word mark and
logos are registered
trademarks owned
by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc. and any use
of such marks by
HYUNDAI is under
licence.
6. Driving your vehicle
Before driving .................................................................................................... 6-4
Before entering the vehicle ........................................................................................ 6-4
Before starting ............................................................................................................. 6-4
Ignition switch................................................................................................... 6-5
Key ignition switch .......................................................................................................6-5
Key ignition switch positions ...................................................................................... 6-6
Starting the engine....................................................................................................... 6-7
Engine Start/Stop button .................................................................................6-9
Engine Stop/Start button positions .......................................................................... 6-10
Starting the engine...................................................................................................... 6-11
Turning off the engine................................................................................................ 6-12
Remote start ............................................................................................................... 6-13
Vehicle auto-shut off .......................................................................................6-14
Operating Conditions ................................................................................................ 6-14
Deactivating Conditions ........................................................................................... 6-14
System Operation ....................................................................................................... 6-14
Automatic transmission ..................................................................................6-15
Automatic transmission operation............................................................................ 6-15
LCD display message (button type) ......................................................................... 6-20
Paddle shifter (Manual shift mode)........................................................................... 6-21
Good driving practices...............................................................................................6-22
Dual clutch transmission ................................................................................ 6-24
Dual clutch transmission operation ..........................................................................6-24
Parking ........................................................................................................................ 6-31
LCD display message (button type) .......................................................................... 6-31
Paddle shifter (Manual shifter mode) .......................................................................6-33
Good driving practices ..............................................................................................6-34
Braking system ................................................................................................ 6-35
Power-assist brakes ...................................................................................................6-35
Disc brakes wear indicator ....................................................................................... 6-36
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) ................................................................................ 6-36
Auto Hold ................................................................................................................... 6-40
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)................................................................................... 6-44
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) ............................................................................ 6-45
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) ..................................................................... 6-48
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) ................................................................................. 6-49
Downhill Brake Control (DBC) ................................................................................. 6-49
Good braking practices..............................................................................................6-52
6
Four wheel drive (4WD) .................................................................................. 6-53
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) operation .......................................................................... 6-54
Emergency precautions ............................................................................................ 6-59
Reducing the risk of a rollover.................................................................................. 6-60
Idle Stop and Go (ISG) .................................................................................... 6-62
ISG system operation ................................................................................................ 6-62
ISG system off............................................................................................................ 6-65
Forced to restart engine ........................................................................................... 6-65
ISG malfunction......................................................................................................... 6-66
Calibrating the Battery Sensor .............................................................................. 6-66
Drive mode integrated control system (2WD) ............................................. 6-67
Drive mode .................................................................................................................6-67
Drive mode integrated control system (4WD) ............................................. 6-70
Drive mode .................................................................................................................6-70
Special driving conditions .............................................................................. 6-73
6
Hazardous driving conditions ................................................................................... 6-73
Rocking the vehicle .................................................................................................... 6-73
Smooth cornering ...................................................................................................... 6-74
Driving at night ........................................................................................................... 6-74
Driving in the rain ....................................................................................................... 6-74
Driving in flooded areas ............................................................................................. 6-75
Highway driving ......................................................................................................... 6-75
Reducing the risk of a rollover................................................................................... 6-75
Winter driving.................................................................................................. 6-76
Snow or icy conditions...............................................................................................6-76
Winter precautions.....................................................................................................6-78
Trailer towing...................................................................................................6-80
If you decide to pull a trailer? .................................................................................... 6-81
Trailer towing equipment.......................................................................................... 6-84
Driving with a trailer .................................................................................................. 6-85
Maintenance when towing a trailer ......................................................................... 6-88
Vehicle load limit.............................................................................................6-89
The Loading Information Label ................................................................................ 6-90
06
WARNING
Carbon monoxide (CO) gas is toxic. Breathing CO can cause unconsciousness and
death.
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide which cannot be seen or smelled.
Do not inhale engine exhaust.
If at any time you smell engine exhaust inside the vehicle, open the windows
immediately. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and death by asphyxiation.
Be sure the exhaust system does not leak.
The exhaust system should be checked whenever the vehicle is raised to change the
oil or for any other purpose. If you hear a change in the sound of the exhaust or if you
drive over something that strikes the underneath side of the vehicle, have the exhaust
system be checked as soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not run the engine in an enclosed area.
Letting the engine idle in your garage, even with the garage door open, is a hazardous
practice. Run the engine only long enough to start the engine and to move the vehicle
out of the garage.
Avoid idling the engine for prolonged periods with people inside the vehicle.
If it is necessary to idle the engine for a prolonged period with people inside the
vehicle, be sure to do so only in an open area with the air intake set at “Fresh” and fan
control set to high so fresh air is drawn into the interior.
Keep the air intakes clear.
To assure proper operation of the ventilation system, keep the ventilation air intakes
located in front of the windshield clear of snow, ice, leaves, or other obstructions.
If you must drive with the liftgate open:
Close all windows.
Open instrument panel air vents.
Set the air intake control at “Fresh”, the air flow control at “Floor” or “Face”, and the fan
control set to high.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING
Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automobile components including
components found in the interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain or emit harmful
chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California
to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.
6-3
Driving your vehicle
BEFORE DRIVING
Before entering the vehicle
ś Be sure all windows, outside mirror(s),
and outside lights are clean and
unobstructed.
ś Remove frost, snow, or ice.
ś Visually check the tires for uneven
wear and damage.
ś Check under the vehicle for any sign
of leaks.
ś Be sure there are no obstacles behind
you if you intend to back up.
Before starting
ś Make sure the hood, the liftgate, and
the doors are securely closed and
locked.
ś Adjust the position of the seat and
steering wheel.
ś Adjust the inside and side view
mirrors.
ś Verify all the lights work.
ś Fasten your seat belt. Check that all
passengers have fastened their seat
belts.
ś Check the gauges and indicators
in the instrument panel and the
messages on the instrument display
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position.
ś Check that any items you are carrying
are stored properly or fastened down
securely.
6-4
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
ś ALWAYS wear your seat belt. All
passengers must be properly belted
whenever the vehicle is moving.
For more information, refer to “Seat
Belts” section in chapter 3.
ś Always drive defensively. Assume
other drivers or pedestrians may be
careless and make mistakes.
ś Stay focused on the task of driving.
Driver distraction can cause
accidents.
ś Leave plenty of space between you
and the vehicle in front of you.
WARNING
NEVER drink or take drugs and drive.
Drinking or taking drugs and driving
is dangerous and may result in an
accident and SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH.
Drunk driving is the number one
contributor to the highway death
toll each year. Even a small amount
of alcohol will affect your reflexes,
perceptions and judgment. Just
one drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions and
emergencies and your reaction time
gets worse with each additional drink.
Driving while under the influence
of drugs is as dangerous or more
dangerous than driving under the
influence of alcohol.
You are much more likely to have a
serious accident if you drink or take
drugs and drive. If you are drinking or
taking drugs, don’t drive. Do not ride
with a driver who has been drinking
or taking drugs. Choose a designated
driver or call a taxi.
06
IGNITION SWITCH
WARNING
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
ś NEVER allow children or any person
who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the ignition switch or related
parts. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur.
ś NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the ignition switch, or any
other control, while the vehicle is in
motion. The presence of your hand
or arm in this area may cause a loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Key ignition switch (if equipped)
ś NEVER turn the ignition switch to
the LOCK or ACC position while the
vehicle is in motion except in an
emergency.
This will result in the engine turning
off and loss of power assist for the
steering and brake systems. This may
lead to loss of directional control and
braking function, which could cause
an accident.
ś Before leaving the driver's seat,
always make sure the shift button is
in 1st gear (for manual transmission
vehicle) or P (Park, for automatic
transmission vehicle) position, apply
the parking brake, and turn the
ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Unexpected vehicle movement may
occur if these precautions are not
followed.
NOTICE
Never use after market keyhole covers.
This may generate start-up failure due
to communication failure.
OTM060051L
[A] : LOCK, [B] : ACC
[C] : ON, [D] : START
Whenever the front door is opened, the
ignition switch will illuminate, provided
the ignition switch is not in the ON
position. The light will go off immediately
when the ignition switch is turned on or
go off after about 30 seconds when the
door is closed. (if equipped)
6-5
Driving your vehicle
Key ignition switch positions
Switch
Position
LOCK
ACC
ON
START
6-6
Action
Notes
To turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position, push the key in at the ACC
position and turn the key towards the
LOCK position.
The ignition key can be removed in
the LOCK position.
The steering wheel locks to protect
the vehicle from theft. (if equipped)
Some electrical accessories are
If difficulty is experienced turning the
usable. The steering wheel unlocks.
ignition switch to the ACC position,
turn the key while turning the steering
wheel right and left to release.
This is the normal key position when
Do not leave the ignition switch in the
the engine has started. All features
ON position when the engine is not
and accessories are usable.
running to prevent the battery from
The warning lights can be checked
discharging.
when you turn the ignition switch
from ACC to ON.
To start the engine, turn the ignition
The engine will crank until you release
switch to the START position. The
the key.
switch returns to the ON position
when you let go of the key.
06
Starting the engine
WARNING
ś Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle. Unsuitable
shoes, such as high heels, ski boots,
sandals, flip-flops, etc., may interfere
with your ability to use the brake,
accelerator and clutch pedals.
ś Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed. The
vehicle can move which can lead to
an accident.
ś Wait until the engine rpm is normal.
The vehicle may suddenly move if
the brake pedal is released when the
rpm is high.
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift button is in P
(Park).
3. Depress the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of
10 seconds) until the engine starts and
release it.
Information
ś Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine
speeds. (Steep accelerating and
decelerating should be avoided.)
ś Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not race the engine while warming
it up.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
ś Do not hold the ignition key in the
START position for more than 10
seconds. Wait 5 to 10 seconds before
trying again.
ś Do not turn the ignition switch to
the START position with the engine
running. It may damage the starter.
ś If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the shift button in the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle
is still moving and turn the ignition
switch to the START position in an
attempt to restart the engine.
ś Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
NOTICE
If the engine does not start within 10
seconds after preheating is completed,
turn the ignition switch once more
to the LOCK position and wait for 10
seconds. Then turn the ignition switch
to the ON position in order to preheat
the engine again.
6-7
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
Do not turn off the engine immediately
after it has been subjected to a heavy
load. Doing so may cause severe
damage to the engine or turbo charger
unit.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
ś Do not hold the ignition key in the
START position for more than 10
seconds. Wait 5 to 10 seconds before
trying again.
ś Do not turn the ignition switch to
the START position with the engine
running. It may damage the starter.
ś If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the shift button in the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle
is still moving and turn the ignition
switch to the START position in an
attempt to restart the engine.
ś Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
6-8
06
(1*,1(67$576723%87721ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
WARNING
OTM060001
Whenever the front door is opened, the
Engine Start/Stop button will illuminate
and will go off 30 seconds after the door
is closed.
WARNING
To turn the vehicle off in an emergency:
Press and hold the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than two seconds OR
Rapidly press and release the Engine
Start/Stop button three times (within
three seconds).
If the vehicle is still moving, you can
restart the vehicle without depressing
the brake pedal by pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button with the gear in the N
(Neutral) position.
ś NEVER press the Engine Start/Stop
button while the vehicle is in motion
except in an emergency. This will
result in the vehicle turning off and
loss of power assist for the steering
and brake systems. This may lead
to loss of directional control and
braking function, which could cause
an accident.
ś Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the gear is in the
P (Park) position, set the parking
brake, press the Engine Start/Stop
button to the OFF position, and take
the Smart Key with you. Unexpected
vehicle movement may occur if these
precautions are not followed.
ś NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the Engine Start/Stop
button or any other control while the
vehicle is in motion. The presence
of your hand or arm in this area
may cause a loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
6-9
Driving your vehicle
Engine Stop/Start button positions
Button
Position
OFF
ACC
ON
START
6-10
Action
To turn off the engine, press the
Engine Start/Stop button with the
vehicle shifted to P (Park).
If the Engine Start/Stop button is
pressed with the vehicle shifted to D
(Drive), R (Reverse), or N (Neutral), the
gear automatically shifts to P (Park).
Press the Engine Start/Stop button
when the button is in the OFF position
without depressing the brake pedal.
Some of the electrical accessories are
usable.
The steering wheel unlocks.
Press the Engine Start/Stop button
while it is in the ACC position without
depressing the brake pedal.
The warning lights can be checked
before the engine is started.
To start the engine, depress the brake
pedal and press the Engine Start/ Stop
button with the gear shifted to the P
(Park) position.
Notes
If the steering wheel is not locked
properly when you open the driver’s
door, the warning chime will sound.
śIf you leave the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ACC position for more
than one hour, the battery power will
turn off automatically to prevent the
battery from discharging.
śIf the steering wheel doesn’t
unlock properly, the Engine Start/
Stop button will not work. Press
the Engine Start/Stop button while
turning the steering wheel right and
left to release.
Do not leave the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ON position when the
engine is not running to prevent the
battery from discharging.
If you press the Engine Start/Stop
button without depressing the brake
pedal, the engine does not start and
the Engine Start/Stop button changes
as follows:
2))Ɵ$&&Ɵ21Ɵ2))RU$&&
06
Starting the engine
WARNING
ś Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle. Unsuitable
shoes, such as high heels, ski boots,
sandals, flipflops, etc., may interfere
with your ability to use the brake and
accelerator pedals.
ś Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle can move which can lead
to an accident.
ś Wait until the engine rpm is normal.
The vehicle may suddenly move if
the brake pedal is released when the
rpm is high.
Information
ś The vehicle will start by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button, only when
the smart key is in the vehicle.
ś Even if the smart key is in the vehicle,
and when it is far away from the driver,
the engine may not start.
ś When the Engine Start/Stop button
is in the ACC or ON position, if any
door is open, the system checks for the
smart key. When the smart key is not
” indicator
in the vehicle, the “
will blink and the warning 'Key not in
vehicle' will come on. When all doors
are closed, the chime will also sound for
about 5 seconds. Keep the smart key in
the vehicle.
Starting the gasoline engine
1. Always carry the smart key with you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the shift button is in
P(Park).
4. Depress the brake pedal.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button.
Information
ś Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine
speeds. Steep accelerating and
decelerating should be avoided.
ś Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not race the engine while warming
it up.
6-11
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
Emergency starting
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
ś If the engine stalls while you are in
motion, do not attempt to shift the
gear to the P (Park) position.
If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the gear in N (Neutral)
while the vehicle is still moving and
press the Engine Start/Stop button in
an attempt to restart the engine.
ś Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the vehicle.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
Do not press the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than 10 seconds except
when the stop lamp fuse is blown.
When the stop lamp fuse is blown,
you cannot normally start the engine.
Replace the fuse with a new one. If you
are not able to replace the fuse, you
can start the engine by pressing and
holding the Engine Start/Stop button
for 10 seconds with the Engine Start/
Stop button in the ACC position.
For your safety always depress the
brake pedal before starting the vehicle.
6-12
OTM060002
If the smart key battery is weak or the
smart key does not work correctly, you
can start the vehicle by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button with the smart
key in the direction of the picture above.
Turning off the engine
1. Stop the vehicle and depress the
brake pedal fully.
2. Make sure the shift button is in
P(Park).
3. Press the Engine Start/Stop button
to the OFF position and apply the
parking brake.
06
Remote start (if equipped)
Type A
OTM060003
Type B
OTM060004
You can start the vehicle using the
Remote Start button of the smart key.
To start the vehicle remotely:
1. Press the door lock button within 10 m
(32 feet) from the vehicle.
2. Press the remote start ( ) button for
over 2 seconds within 4 seconds after
locking the doors. The hazard warning
lights will blink.
3. To turn off the remote start function,
press the remote start ( ) button
once.
ś The remote start ( ) button may not
operate if the smart key is not within
10 m (32 feet).
ś The vehicle will not remotely start if
the engine hood or liftgate is opened.
ś The vehicle must be in P (Park) for the
remote start function to start.
ś The engine turns off if you get in the
vehicle without a registered smart key.
ś The engine turns off if you do not get
in the vehicle within 10 minutes after
remotely starting the vehicle.
ś Do not idle the engine for a long
period.
6-13
Driving your vehicle
9(+,&/($872ǘ6+872))ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
If your vehicle is parked and the engine
is left on for a long period of time, the
engine will turn off automatically to help
reduce fuel consumption and prevent
accidents caused by carbon dioxide
poisoning.
System Operation
Operating Conditions
Vehicle Auto-Shut Off timer operates
when all the following conditions are
satisfied:
ś Vehicle speed is below 1.8 mph (3
km/h), and the gear is shifted to P
(Park)
ś The brake pedal and accelerator pedal
are not depressed
ś The driver’s seat belt is unfastened
ś The passenger seat is empty
ś The infotainment system is not being
updated
Deactivating Conditions
Vehicle Auto-Shut Off timer turns off
when one of the situation occur:
ś Vehicle speed is above 1.8 mph (3
km/h)
ś The gear is shifted to R (Reverse), D
(Drive) or N (Neutral)
ś The brake pedal or accelerator pedal
is depressed
ś The driver’s seat belt is fastened
ś A passenger is in the passenger’s seat
6-14
OJK041087N
When all the conditions are satisfied, the
Vehicle Auto-Shut Off operates and turns
the engine off automatically after 60
minutes.
A timer appears on the instrument
cluster 30 minutes before vehicle shut
off.
Resetting cluster timer
To reset the cluster timer, do one of
following:
ś Release the accelerator pedal or brake
pedal after Vehicle Auto-Shut Off is
complete.
ś Press the OK button on the steering
wheel while the timer appears on the
instrument cluster.
CAUTION
Do not leave a passenger or a pet in
the vehicle in hot weather since the air
conditioning system turns off when the
engine is off.
06
$8720$7,&75$160,66,21ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OTM060005
Automatic transmission operation
The automatic transmission has eight forward speeds and one reverse speed.
The Individual forward speeds are selected automatically in the D (Drive) position.
6-15
Driving your vehicle
The indicator in the instrument cluster
displays the shift button position when
the ignition switch is in the ON position.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death:
ś ALWAYS check the surrounding
areas near your vehicle for people,
especially children, before shifting a
vehicle into D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
ś Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift button
is in the P (Park) position, then set
the parking brake, and place the
ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur if these
precautions are not followed.
ś When using the paddle shifter
(manual shift mode), do not use
engine braking (shifting from a
high gear to lower gear) rapidly on
slippery roads. The vehicle may slip
causing an accident.
P (Park)
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into P (Park).
To shift from P (Park), you must depress
firmly on the brake pedal and make sure
your foot is off the accelerator pedal.
The shift button must be in P (Park)
before turning the engine off.
6-16
WARNING
ś Shifting into P (Park) while the
vehicle is in motion may cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
ś After the vehicle has stopped, always
make sure the shift button is in P
(Park), apply the parking brake, and
turn the engine off.
ś When parking on an incline, shift
the gear to P (Park) and apply the
parking brake to prevent the vehicle
from rolling downhill.
ś Do not use the P (Park) position in
place of the parking brake.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
NOTICE
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into or out of R (Reverse); you
may damage the transmission if you
shift into R (Reverse) while the vehicle is
in motion.
When the vehicle is stopped in R
(Reverse) or D (Drive) position, if you
open the driver’s door with the seat
belt unfastened, the gear is shifted to P
(Park) position automatically.
However when the vehicle moves in R
(Reverse) or D (Drive) position, if you
open the driver’s door with the seat belt
unfastened, the gear may be not shifted
to P (Park) position automatically for
protecting the automatic transmission.
06
N (Neutral)
The wheels and transmission are not
engaged.
Use N (Neutral) if you need to restart a
stalled engine, or if it is necessary to stop
with the engine ON. Shift into P (Park)
if you need to leave your vehicle for any
reason.
Always depress the brake pedal when
you are shifting from N (Neutral) to
another gear.
WARNING
To stay in N (Neutral) when vehicle is
OFF (button type)
OTM060006
Do not shift into gear unless your foot is
firmly on the brake pedal. Shifting into
gear when the engine is running at high
speed can cause the vehicle to move
very rapidly. You could lose control of
the vehicle and hit people or objects.
OTM060060L
If you want to stay in N (Neutral) after the
engine is OFF (in the ACC state), do the
following.
1. Turn off Auto Hold and release
Electronic Parking Brake when the
engine is running.
2. Push the N (neutral) button while
depressing the brake pedal.
3. When you take your foot off the brake
pedal, the message ‘Press and hold
OK button to stay in Neutral when
vehicle is Off’ (or 'Hold OK button to
stay in neutral gear position when
vehicle is Off') will appear on the
cluster LCD display.
6-17
Driving your vehicle
4. Press and hold the OK button on
the steering wheel for more than 1
second.
5. When the message ‘Vehicle will stay in
(N). Change gear to cancel’ (or ‘N will
stay engaged when the vehicle is Off’)
will appear on the cluster LCD display,
press the Engine Start/Stop button
while depressing the brake pedal.
However, if you open the driver’s or
front passenger’s door, the gear will
automatically shift to P (Park) and the
Engine Start/ Stop button will change
to the OFF position.
NOTICE
With the gear in N (Neutral) the Engine
Start/Stop button will be in the ACC
position. In the ACC position, the doors
cannot be locked. The battery may
discharge if left in the ACC position for
a long time.
D (Drive)
This is the normal driving position. The
transmission will automatically shift
through an 8-gear sequence, providing
the best fuel economy and power.
To start the vehicle forward, push the D
(Drive) button by depressing the brake
pedal with the engine ON. (button type)
Then depress the accelerator pedal
smoothly.
For extra power when passing another
vehicle or driving uphill, depress the
accelerator fully. The transmission will
automatically down shift to the next
lower gear (or gears, as appropriate).
When the vehicle is stopped in D (Drive)
position, if you open the driver’s door
with the seat belt unfastened, the gear is
shifted to P (Park) position automatically.
(button type)
However while the vehicle is moving in D
(Drive) position, if you open the driver’s
door with the seat belt unfastened, the
gear may not shift to P (Park) position
automatically to protect the automatic
transmission.
The DRIVE MODE switch, located on the
shift button console, allows the driver to
switch from NORMAL/COMFORT mode
to SPORT or ECO mode. (if equipped)
For more Details, refer to "Drive Mode
Integrated Control System" later in this
chapter.
6-18
06
Shift-lock system
Parking
For your safety, the automatic
transmission has a shift-lock system
which prevents shifting the transmission
from P (Park) into R (Reverse) unless the
brake pedal is depressed.
To shift the transmission from P (Park)
into R (Reverse):
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the engine or place the ignition
switch in the ON position.
3. Depress the brake pedal and push the
R (Reverse) button. (button type)
Always come to a complete stop and
continue to depress the brake pedal.
Move the shift button into the P (Park)
position, apply the parking brake, and
place the ignition switch in the LOCK/
OFF position. Take the Key with you
when exiting the vehicle.
Ignition key interlock system
(if equipped)
The ignition key cannot be removed
unless the shift button is in the P (Park)
position.
When the battery is discharged:
WARNING
When you stay in the vehicle with
the engine running, be careful not to
depress the accelerator pedal for a long
period of time. The engine or exhaust
system may overheat and start a fire.
The exhaust gas and the exhaust system
are very hot. Keep away from the
exhaust system components.
Do not stop or park over flammable
materials, such as dry grass, paper or
leaves. They may ignite and cause a fire.
The shift buttons will not function when
the battery is discharged.
In emergencies, do the following to
move the shift button to N (Neutral) on a
level ground.
1. Connect the battery cables from
another vehicle or from a another
battery to the jump-starting terminals
inside the engine compartment.
For more details, refer to “Jump
Starting” in chapter 7.
2. Release the parking brake with the
ignition switch in the ON position.
3. Shift the gear to the N(Neutral)
position refer to the “Stay in Neutral
when vehicle is Off” in this chapter.
6-19
Driving your vehicle
LCD display message (button
type)
Press and hold the OK button on the
steering wheel to stay in Neutral
Shifting conditions not met. Reduce
speed, then shift
The warning message appears on
the LCD display, when pushing the
N(Neutral) button. If you want to stay
N(Neutral) after turning off the engine,
press and hold the “OK” button on the
steering wheel more than 1 second.
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when engine RPM is too
high, or when driving speed is too fast to
shift the gear.
We recommend you decrease the engine
speed or slow down before shifting the
gear.
Vehicle will stay in (N). Change gear
to cancel
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the brake pedal is not
depressed while shifting the gear.
We recommend you to depress the brake
pedal and then shift the gear.
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when pushing the “OK”
button on the steering wheel after the
message (“Press and hold OK button
to stay in Neutral when vehicle is Off”)
appears on the cluster LCD display. The
gear stays in N(Neutral) position after
turning off the engine.
Shift to P after stopping
NEUTRAL engaged
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) while the vehicle is moving.
Stop the vehicle before shifting to P
(Park).
The message appears on the LCD
display, when the N (Neutral) position is
engaged.
Press brake pedal to change gear
PARK engaged
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) while the vehicle is moving.
Stop the vehicle before shifting to P
(Park).
6-20
Gear already selected
The message appears on the LCD
display, when pushing the current shift
button again.
06
Shift button held down
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the shift button is
pressed continuously or the shift button
does not properly operate. Clean the
surroundings of gear shift button.
If this message appears again, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Paddle shifter (Manual shift
mode)
Shifter system malfunction! Service
immediately
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the transmission
or the shift button does not properly
operate in the P (Park) position.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
immediately by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Check shift controls
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when there is a malfunction
with transmission shift button.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
immediately by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
OTM058130L
The paddle shifter is available when the
shift button is in the D (Drive) position or
the manual shift mode.
With the shift button in the D position
The paddle shifter will operate when the
vehicle speed is more than 6 mph.
Pull the [+] or [-] paddle shifter once
to shift up or down one gear and the
system changes from automatic mode to
manual shift mode.
In the manual shift mode, pull the [+]
or [-] paddle shifter once to shift up or
down one gear.
To change back to automatic shift mode
from manual shift mode, do one of the
followings :
- Pull the [+] paddle shifter for more
than one second
- Press the D button.
6-21
Driving your vehicle
The manual shift mode also changes
back to automatic shift mode in one of
following situations
- When the accelerator pedal is gently
depressed for more than 6 seconds
while driving
- When the vehicle stops
Information
If the [+] and [-] paddle shifters are pulled
at the same time, gear shift may not occur.
6-22
Good driving practices
ś Never move the shift button from
P (Park) or N (Neutral) to any other
position with the accelerator pedal
depressed.
ś Never move the shift button into P
(Park) when the vehicle is in motion.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
ś Do not shift the gear to N (Neutral)
when driving. If the gear is shifted to
N (Neutral) while driving, the vehicle
loses the ability to provide engine
braking. Doing so may increase the
risk of an accident.
Also, shifting the gear back to
D (Drive) while the vehicle is
moving may severely damage the
transmission.
ś When driving uphill or downhill,
always shift to D (Drive) for driving
forward or shift to R (Reverse) for
driving rearwards. After selecting
D (Drive) or R (Reverse), check the
gear position indicated on the cluster
before driving. If the vehicle moves in
the opposite direction of the selected
gear, the engine may turn off and a
serious accident might occur due to
degraded brake performance.
ś Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can result
in the brakes overheating, brake wear
and possibly even brake failure.
ś When driving with shifter paddles,
slow down before shifting to a lower
gear. Otherwise, the lower gear may
not be engaged if the engine rpms are
outside of the allowable range.
ś Always apply the parking brake when
leaving the vehicle. Do not depend on
placing the transmission in P (Park) to
keep the vehicle from moving.
06
ś Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. On a
slippery surface, an abrupt change
in vehicle speed can cause the drive
wheels to lose traction and may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ś ALWAYS wear your seatbelt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
ś Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
ś Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
ś The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
ś Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
ś In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
ś HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
6-23
Driving your vehicle
'8$/&/87&+75$160,66,21ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OTM060005
Dual clutch transmission operation
The dual clutch transmission has eight forward speeds and one reverse speed.
The individual speeds are selected automatically when the shift button is in the D
(Drive) position.
6-24
06
ś The dual clutch transmission can be
thought of as an automatically shifting
manual transmission. It gives the
driving feel of a manual transmission,
yet provides the ease of a fully
automatic transmission.
ś When D (Drive) is selected, the
transmission will automatically
shift through the gears similar to a
conventional automatic transmission.
Unlike a traditional automatic
transmission, the gear shifting can
sometimes be felt and heard as the
actuators engage the clutches and the
gears are selected.
ś The dual clutch transmission
incorporates a wet-type dual clutch
mechanism, which allows for better
acceleration performance and
increased fuel efficiency while driving.
But it differs from a conventional
automatic transmission because
it does not incorporate a torque
converter. Instead, the transition from
one gear to the next is managed by
clutch slip, especially at lower speeds.
As a result, shifts are sometimes more
noticeable, and a light vibration can
be felt as the transmission shaft speed
is matched with the engine shaft
speed. This is a normal condition of
the dual clutch transmission.
ś The wet-type clutch transfers torque
more directly and provides a directdrive feeling which may feel different
from a conventional automatic
transmission. This may be more
noticeable when launching the vehicle
from a stop or when traveling at low,
stop-and-go vehicle speeds.
ś When rapidly accelerating from a
lower vehicle speed, the engine
rpm may increase dramatically as a
result of clutch slip as the dual clutch
transmission selects the correct gear.
This is a normal condition.
ś When accelerating from a stop on
an incline, press the accelerator
smoothly and gradually to avoid any
shudder feeling or jerkiness.
ś When traveling at a lower vehicle
speed, if you release the accelerator
pedal quickly, you may feel engine
braking before the transmission
changes gears. This engine braking
feeling is similar to operating a
manual transmission at low speed.
ś When driving downhill, you may
wish to move the gear shift button to
Manual Shift mode and downshift to
a lower gear in order to control your
speed without using the brake pedal
excessively.
ś When you turn the engine on and off,
you may hear clicking sounds as the
system goes through a self-test. This
is a normal sound for the dual clutch
transmission.
ś During the first 1000 miles (1,500km),
you may feel that the vehicle may not
be smooth when accelerating at low
speed. During this break-in period, the
shift quality and performance of your
new vehicle is continuously optimized.
6-25
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death:
ś ALWAYS check the surrounding
areas near your vehicle for people,
especially children, before shifting a
vehicle into D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
ś Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift button
is in the P (Park) position, then set
the parking brake, and place the
ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur if these
precautions are not followed.
ś Do not use aggressive engine braking
(shifting from a higher gear to a
lower gear) on slippery roads. This
could cause the tires to slip and may
result in an accident.
NOTICE
ś Always come to a complete stop
before shifting into D (Drive) or R
(Reverse).
ś Do not put the shift button in N
(Neutral) while driving.
WARNING
Due to transmission failure, you may
not continue to drive and the position
indicator and the position indicator (D,
P) on the instrument cluster will blink.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
and have the system checked.
6-26
DCT warning messages
This warning message is displayed when
vehicle is driven slowly on a grade and
the vehicle detects that the brake pedal
is not applied.
OOSH069010L
Steep grade! Press brake pedal
Driving up hills or on steep grades:
ś To hold the vehicle on an incline use
the foot brake or the parking brake.
ś When in stop-and-go traffic on an
incline, allow a gap to form ahead
of you before moving the vehicle
forward. Then hold the vehicle on the
incline with the foot brake.
ś If the vehicle is held or creeping
forward on an incline by applying
the accelerator pedal, the clutch and
transmission may overheat which
can result in damage. At this time, a
warning message will appear on the
LCD display.
ś If the LCD warning is active, the foot
brake must be applied.
ś Ignoring the warnings can lead to
damage to the transmission.
06
Type A
OOSH069012L
Transmission high temperature
ś Under certain conditions, such as
repeated stop-and-go launches
on steep grades, sudden take off
or acceleration, or other harsh
driving conditions, the transmission
clutch temperatures will increase
excessively.
ś When the clutch temperatures are too
high, the “Transmission temp. is high!
Stop safely” warning message will
appear on the LCD display, a chime
will sound, and the transmission
shifting may not be smooth.
ś If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes and
shift the vehicle to P (Park), and allow
the transmission to cool.
ś If you ignore this warning, the driving
condition may become worse.
You may experience abrupt shifts,
frequent shifts, or jerkiness.
ś When the message “Trans cooled.
Resume driving.” appears you can
continue to drive your vehicle.
ś When possible, drive the vehicle
smoothly.
Type B
OTMA060009
OOSH069013L
OTMA060010
Transmission overheated
ś If the vehicle continues to be driven
and the clutch temperatures reach
the maximum temperature limit, the
“Transmission Hot! Park with engine
on” warning will be displayed. When
this occurs the clutch is disabled
until the clutch cools to normal
temperatures.
ś The warning will display a time to wait
for the transmission to cool.
ś If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes and
shift the vehicle to P (Park), and allow
the transmission to cool.
6-27
Driving your vehicle
ś When the message “Trans cooled.
Resume driving.” appears you can
continue to drive your vehicle.
ś When possible, drive the vehicle
smoothly.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
If any of the warning messages in the
LCD display continue to blink, for your
safety, contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked.
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into or out of R (Reverse); you
may damage the transmission if you
shift into R (Reverse) while the vehicle is
in motion.
Transmission ranges
The indicator in the instrument cluster
displays the shift button position when
the ignition switch is in the ON position.
P (Park)
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into P (Park).
To shift from P (Park), you must depress
firmly on the brake pedal and make sure
your foot is off the accelerator pedal.
The shift button must be in P (Park)
before turning the engine off.
WARNING
ś Shifting into P (Park) while the
vehicle is in motion may cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
ś After the vehicle has stopped, always
make sure the shift button is in P
(Park), apply the parking brake, and
turn the engine off.
ś When parking on an incline, place
the shift button in P (Park) and apply
the parking brake to prevent the
vehicle from rolling downhill.
ś For safety, always engage the
parking brake with the shift button
in the P (Park) position except for the
case of emergency parking.
6-28
NOTICE
When the vehicle is stopped in
R (Reverse) position, if you open
the driver’s door with the seat belt
unfastened, the gear is shifted to P (Park)
position automatically.
However if the vehicle is moving in
R(Reverse) position, if the driver's door
is opened with the seat belt unfastened,
the gear may not be shifted into P (Park)
position automatically to protect the dual
clutch transmission.
N (Neutral)
The wheels and transmission are not
engaged.
Use N (Neutral) if you need to restart a
stalled engine, or if it is necessary to stop
with the engine ON. Shift into P (Park)
if you need to leave your vehicle for any
reason.
Always depress the brake pedal when
you are shifting from N (Neutral) to
another gear.
WARNING
Do not shift into gear unless your foot is
firmly on the brake pedal. Shifting into
gear when the engine is running at high
speed can cause the vehicle to move
very rapidly. You could lose control of
the vehicle and hit people or objects.
06
To stay in N (Neutral) when vehicle is
OFF (button type)
OTM060006
2. Push the N(Neutral) button by
depressing the brake pedal. If the
message (“Press and hold the OK
button on the steering wheel to stay in
Neutral ”) appears on the cluster LCD
display, press and hold the OK button
on the steering wheel for more than 1
second.
3. When the message ‘Vehicle will stay in
(N). Change gear to cancel’ (or ‘N will
stay engaged when the vehicle is Off’)
will appear on the cluster LCD display,
press the Engine Start/Stop button
while depressing the brake pedal.
However, if you open the driver's
door, the gear will automatically
shift to P (Park) and the Engine Start/
Stop button will change to the OFF
position.
NOTICE
OTM040050
If you want to stay in N (Neutral) after the
engine is OFF (in the ACC state), do the
following.
1. Turn off Auto Hold and release
Electronic Parking Brake when the
engine is running.
With the gear in N (Neutral) the Engine
Start/Stop button will be in the ACC
position. Note that the doors cannot
be locked in the ACC position or the
battery may discharge if left in the ACC
position for a long period.
6-29
Driving your vehicle
D (Drive)
This is the normal driving position. The
transmission will automatically shift
through a 8-gear sequence, providing
the best fuel economy and power.
To start the vehicle forward, push the D
(Drive) button by depressing the brake
pedal with the engine ON. Then depress
the accelerator pedal smoothly. For extra
power when passing another vehicle or
driving uphill, depress the accelerator
fully. The transmission will automatically
downshift to the next lower gear (or
gears, as appropriate). When the vehicle
is stopped in D (Drive) position, if you
open the driver’s door with the seat belt
unfastened, the gear is shifted to P (Park)
position automatically.
However when the vehicle moves in D
(Drive) position, if you open the driver’s
door with the seat belt unfastened,
the gear may be not shifted to P (Park)
position automatically for protecting the
dual clutch transmission.
The DRIVE MODE switch, located on the
shift button console, allows the driver to
switch from NORMAL/ COMFORT mode
to SPORT or ECO mode. (if equipped)
For more details, refer to “Drive Mode
Integrated Control System” later in this
chapter.
6-30
Shift-lock system
For your safety, the automatic
transmission has a shift-lock system
which prevents shifting the transmission
from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R
(Reverse) or D (Drive) unless the brake
pedal is depressed.
To shift the transmission from P (Park)
into R (Reverse):
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the engine or place the ignition
switch in the ON position.
3. Depress the brake pedal and push the
R (Reverse) button.
When the battery is discharged:
The shift buttons will not function when
the battery is discharged.
In emergencies, do the following to
move the shift button to N (Neutral) on a
level ground.
1. Connect the battery cables from
another vehicle or from a another
battery to the jump-starting terminals
inside the engine compartment.
For more details, refer to “Jump
Starting” in chapter 8.
2. Release the parking brake with the
ignition switch in the ON position.
3. Shift the gear to the N(Neutral)
position refer to the “Stay in Neutral
when vehicle is Off” in this chapter.
06
Parking
Always come to a complete stop and
continue to depress the brake pedal.
Press the P (Park) button, apply the
parking brake, and place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF position. Take
the Key with you when exiting the
vehicle.
WARNING
When you stay in the vehicle with
the engine running, be careful not to
depress the accelerator pedal for a long
period of time. The engine or exhaust
system may overheat and start a fire.
The exhaust gas and the exhaust system
are very hot. Keep away from the
exhaust system components.
Do not stop or park over flammable
materials, such as dry grass, paper or
leaves. They may ignite and cause a fire.
LCD display message (button
type)
Shifting conditions not met. Reduce
speed, then shift
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when engine RPM is too
high, or when driving speed is too fast to
shift the gear.
We recommend you decrease the engine
speed or slow down before shifting the
gear.
Press brake pedal to change gear
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the brake pedal is not
depressed while shifting the gear.
We recommend you to depress the brake
pedal and then shift the gear.
Shift to P after stopping
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) while the vehicle is moving.
Stop the vehicle before shifting to P
(Park).
PARK engaged
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) while the vehicle is moving.
Stop the vehicle before shifting to P
(Park).
6-31
Driving your vehicle
Press and hold the OK button on the
steering wheel to stay in Neutral
The warning message appears on
the LCD display, when pushing the
N(Neutral) button. If you want to stay
N(Neutral) after turning off the engine,
press and hold the “OK” button on the
steering wheel more than 1 second.
Vehicle will stay in (N). Change gear
to cancel
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when pushing the “OK”
button on the steering wheel after the
message (“Press and hold OK button
to stay in Neutral when vehicle is Off”)
appears on the cluster LCD display. The
gear stays in N(Neutral) position after
turning off the engine.
NEUTRAL engaged
The message appears on the LCD
display, when the N (Neutral) position is
engaged.
Gear already selected
The message appears on the LCD
display, when pushing the current shift
button again.
6-32
Shift button held down
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the shift button is
pressed continuously or the shift button
does not properly operate. Clean the
surroundings of gear shift button.
If this message appears again, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Shifter system malfunction! Service
immediately
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when the transmission
or the shift button does not properly
operate in the P (Park) position.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
immediately by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Check shift controls
The warning message appears on the
LCD display, when there is a malfunction
with transmission shift button.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
immediately by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
06
Paddle shifter (Manual shifter
mode)
To change back to automatic shift mode
from manual shift mode, do one of the
followings:
Pull the [+] paddle shifter for more than
one second Press the D button.
The manual shift mode also changes
back to automatic shift mode in one of
following situations
- When the accelerator pedal is gently
depressed for more than 6 seconds
while driving
- When the vehicle stops
OOSH069012L
The paddle shifter is available when the
shift button is in the D (Drive) position or
the manual shift mode.
Information
If the [+] and [-] paddle shifters are pulled
at the same time, gear shift may not occur.
With the shift button in the D
position
The paddle shifter will operate when the
vehicle speed is more than 6 mph.
Pull the [+] or [-] paddle shifter once
to shift up or down one gear and the
system changes from automatic mode to
manual shift mode.
In the manual shift mode, pull the [+]
or [-] paddle shifter once to shift up or
down one gear.
6-33
Driving your vehicle
Good driving practices
ś Never move the shift button from
P (Park) or N (Neutral) to any other
position with the accelerator pedal
depressed.
ś Never move the shift button into P
(Park) when the vehicle is in motion.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
ś Do not move the shift button to N
(Neutral) when driving. Doing so
may result in an accident because
of a loss of engine braking and the
transmission could be damaged.
ś Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can result
in the brakes overheating, brake wear
and possibly even brake failure.
ś Always apply the parking brake when
leaving the vehicle. Do not depend on
placing the transmission in P (Park) to
keep the vehicle from moving.
ś Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. On a
slippery surface, an abrupt change
in vehicle speed can cause the drive
wheels to lose traction and may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
6-34
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ś ALWAYS wear your seatbelt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
ś Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
ś Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
ś The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
ś Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
ś In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
ś HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
06
BRAKING SYSTEM
Power-assist brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes
that adjust automatically through normal
usage.
If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the brakes will not work. You can still
stop your vehicle by applying greater
force to the brake pedal than typical.
The stopping distance, however, will be
longer than with power brakes.
When the engine is not running, the
reserve brake power is partially depleted
each time the brake pedal is applied.
Do not pump the brake pedal when the
power assist has been interrupted.
Information
ś When the brake pedal is depressed
under certain driving conditions
or weather conditions, you may
temporarily hear a noise. This is
normal and does not indicate a problem
with your brakes.
ś While driving on a road with deicing
chemicals, brake noise or abnormal
tire wear may occur due to deicing
chemicals. In a safe traffic condition,
additionally apply the brakes to remove
deicing chemicals on the brake discs
and pads.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
ś Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. This will create
abnormal high brake temperatures,
excessive brake lining and pad wear,
and increased stopping distances.
ś When descending down a long or
steep hill, use the paddle shifter
and manually downshift to a
lower gear in order to control your
speed without using the brake
pedal excessively. Applying the
brakes continuously will cause
the brakes to overheat and could
result in a temporary loss of braking
performance.
ś Wet brakes may impair the vehicle's
ability to safely slow down; the
vehicle may also pull to one side
when the brakes are applied.
Applying the brakes lightly will
indicate whether they have been
affected in this way. Always test your
brakes in this fashion after driving
through deep water. To dry the
brakes, lightly tap the brake pedal to
heat up the brakes while maintaining
a safe forward speed until brake
performance returns to normal.
Avoid driving at high speeds until the
brakes function correctly.
6-35
Driving your vehicle
Disc brakes wear indicator
When your brake pads are worn and new
pads are required, you will hear a high
pitched warning sound from your front
or rear brakes. You may hear this sound
come and go or it may occur whenever
you depress the brake pedal.
Emergency braking
If there is a problem with the brake
pedal while driving, emergency braking
is possible by pulling up and holding
the EPB switch. Braking is possible only
while you are holding the EPB switch.
However, braking distance will be longer
than normal.
NOTICE
To avoid costly brake repairs, do not
continue to drive with worn brake pads.
Information
Always replace brake pads as complete
front or rear axle sets.
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
Applying the parking brake
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH, do not operate the EPB
while the vehicle is moving except
in an emergency situation. It could
damage the brake system and lead to
an accident.
Information
During emergency braking, the Parking
Brake warning light will illuminate to
indicate that the system is operating.
NOTICE
If you continuously notice a noise or
burning smell when the EPB is used for
emergency braking, have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
OTM060007
To apply EPB (Electronic Parking Brake):
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Pull up the EPB switch.
Make sure the Parking Brake warning
light comes on.
EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) may be
automatically applied when:
ś Requested by other systems
ś The driver turns the vehicle off while
Auto Hold is operating.
6-36
06
Releasing the parking brake
Information
ś For your safety, you can engage EPB
even though the Engine Stop/Start
button is in the OFF position (only if
battery power is available), but you
cannot release it.
ś For your safety, depress the brake
pedal and release the parking brake
manually with the EPB switch when
you drive downhill or when backing up
the vehicle.
OTM060048L
To release EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake):
1. Press the Engine Start/Stop button to
the ON or START position.
2. Press the EPB switch while depressing
the brake pedal.
Make sure the Parking Brake warning
light goes off.
NOTICE
ś If the Parking Brake warning light is
still on even though the EPB has been
released, have the system checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Do not drive your vehicle with EPB
applied. It may cause excessive brake
pad and brake rotor wear.
ś Satisfy the following conditions
1. Ensure seat belts are fastened and the
doors, hood and liftgate are closed.
2. With the engine running, depress the
brake pedal and shift out of P (Park) to
R (Reverse), D (Drive) or Manual shift
mode.
3. Depress the accelerator pedal.
Make sure the Parking Brake warning
light goes off.
6-37
Driving your vehicle
ś NEVER allow anyone who is
unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch
the EPB switch. If EPB is released
unintentionally, serious injury may
occur.
ś Only release EPB when you are
seated inside the vehicle with your
foot firmly on the brake pedal.
Warning messages
NOTICE
OTM058132L
To release EPB, fasten seatbelt and close
door, hood and liftgate
ś If you try to drive with EPB applied, a
warning will sound and a message will
appear.
ś If the driver's seat belt is unfastened
and the engine hood or liftgate is
opened, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
ś If there is a problem with the vehicle,
a warning may sound and a message
may appear.
If the situation occurs, depress the brake
pedal and release EPB by pressing the
EPB switch.
WARNING
ś Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the
brake pedal.
Shift the gear into P (Park), pull
up the EPB switch, and press the
Engine Start/Stop button to the OFF
position. Take the Key with you when
leaving the vehicle.
Vehicles not fully engaged in P (Park)
with the parking brake set are at risk
for moving inadvertently and causing
injury to yourself or others.
6-38
ś Do not apply the accelerator pedal
while the parking brake is engaged.
If you depress the accelerator pedal
with EPB engaged, a warning will
sound and a message will appear.
Damage to the parking brake may
occur.
ś Driving with the parking brake on
can overheat the braking system and
cause premature wear or damage
to brake parts. Make sure EPB is
released and the Parking Brake
warning light is off before driving.
Information
ś A clicking sound may be heard while
operating or releasing the EPB. These
conditions are normal and indicate that
EPB is functioning properly.
ś When leaving your keys with a parking
attendant or assistant, make sure to
inform him/her how to operate EPB.
06
EPB malfunction
OIK060067L
AUTO HOLD turning Off!
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold to
EPB is not working properly a warning
will sound and a message will appear.
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) warning
light illuminates if the Engine Start/Stop
button is pressed to the ON position and
goes off in approximately 3 seconds if
the system is operating normally.
If the EPB warning light remains on,
comes on while driving, or does not
come on when the Engine Start/Stop
button is pressed to the ON position,
this indicates that the EPB may have
malfunctioned.
If this occurs, have the system checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The EPB warning light may illuminate
when the ESC indicator comes on to
indicate that ESC is not working properly,
but it does not indicate a malfunction of
EPB.
NOTICE
OIK060069L
Parking brake automatically engaged
When EPB is applied while Auto Hold
is activated, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
ś If the EPB warning light is still on,
have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś If the Parking Brake warning light
does not illuminate or blinks even
though the EPB switch was pulled
up, EPB may not be applied.
ś If the Parking Brake warning light
blinks when the EPB warning light is
on, press the switch, and then pull it
up. Repeat this one more time. If the
EPB warning does not go off, have
the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
6-39
Driving your vehicle
Parking brake warning light
Auto Hold (if equipped)
Check the Parking Brake
warning light by pressing the
Engine Stop/Start button to the
ON position.
This light will be illuminated when the
parking brake is applied with the Engine
Stop/Start button in the START or ON
position.
Before driving, be sure the parking
brake is released and the Parking Brake
warning light is OFF.
If the Parking Brake warning light
remains on after the parking brake is
released while the engine is running,
there may be a malfunction in the
brake system. Immediate attention is
necessary.
If at all possible, cease driving the vehicle
immediately. If that is not possible,
use extreme caution while operating
the vehicle and only continue to drive
the vehicle until you can reach a safe
location.
Auto Hold maintains the vehicle in a
standstill even though the brake pedal is
not depressed after the driver brings the
vehicle to a complete stop by depressing
the brake pedal.
When the EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake) does not release
If the EPB does not release normally,
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
by loading the vehicle on a flatbed tow
truck and have the system checked.
6-40
To apply:
OTM060010
1. With the driver’s door, engine hood
and liftgate (vehicle equipped with
shift button) closed, then press the
AUTO HOLD switch. The white AUTO
HOLD indicator will come on and the
system will be in the standby position.
06
To cancel:
OTM060057L
2. When you stop the vehicle completely
by depressing the brake pedal, Auto
Hold maintains the brake pressure
to hold the vehicle stationary. The
indicator changes from white to
green.
3. The vehicle will remain stationary
even if you release the brake pedal.
4. If EPB is applied, Auto Hold will be
released.
To release:
If you depress the accelerator pedal
with the gear in D (Drive), R (Reverse,
vehicle equipped with shift button) or
Manual shift mode or R(vehicle equipped
with shift button), the Auto Hold will be
released automatically and the vehicle
will start to move. The AUTO HOLD
indicator changes from green to white.
OTM060012
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Press the AUTO HOLD switch.
The AUTO HOLD indicator will turn off.
WARNING
To prevent, unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement, ALWAYS press your
foot on the brake pedal to cancel the
Auto Hold before you:
- Drive downhill.
- Drive the vehicle in R (Reverse,
vehicle equipped with shift button).
- Park the vehicle.
WARNING
When Auto Hold is automatically
released by depressing the accelerator
pedal, always take a look around your
vehicle.
Slowly depress the accelerator pedal
for a smooth start.
6-41
Driving your vehicle
Information
ś The Auto Hold does not operate when:
- The driver's door is opened
- The engine hood is opened
- The liftgate is opened (vehicle
equipped with shift button)
- The gear is in P (Park)
- The gear is in R (Reverse, vehicle
equipped with shift lever)
- EPB is applied
ś For your safety, the Auto Hold
automatically switches to EPB when:
- The driver's door is opened
- The engine hood is opened
- The vehicle is in a standstill for more
than 10 minutes
- The vehicle is standing on a steep
slope
- The vehicle moved several times
- The liftgate is opened
In these cases, the Parking Brake
warning light comes on, the AUTO
HOLD indicator changes from green
to white, and a warning sound and a
message will appear to inform you that
EPB has been automatically engaged.
Before driving off again, depress the
brake pedal, check the surrounding
area near your vehicle and release the
parking brake manually with the EPB
switch.
ś While operating Auto Hold, you may
hear mechanical noise. However, it is
normal operating noise.
NOTICE
If the AUTO HOLD indicator changes
to yellow, Auto Hold is not working
properly. Contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
6-42
WARNING
ś Depress the accelerator pedal slowly
when you start the vehicle.
ś For your safety, cancel Auto Hold
when you drive downhill, back up the
vehicle or park the vehicle.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
driver's door or engine hood open
detection system, Auto Hold may not
work properly. Contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Warning messages
Type A
Type B
OJX1069028L
OJX1069066L
Parking brake automatically engaged /
Parking brake automatically applied
When EPB is applied while Auto Hold
is activated, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
06
OOSH069024L
Deactivating AUTO HOLD... Press brake
pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold to
EPB is not working properly a warning
will sound and a message will appear.
When this message is displayed, Auto
Hold and EPB may not operate. For your
safety, depress the brake pedal.
OTM060049L
AUTO HOLD conditions not met.
Close door, hood and liftgate.
When you press the AUTO HOLD switch,
if the driver's door and engine hood are
not closed, a warning will sound and a
message will appear on the cluster LCD
display.
Press the AUTO HOLD switch after
closing the driver's door and hood.
OJX1069035L
Press brake pedal to deactivate AUTO
HOLD
If you did not apply the brake pedal when
you release Auto Hold by pressing the
AUTO HOLD switch, a warning will sound
and a message will appear.
6-43
Driving your vehicle
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) or
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system will not prevent accidents
due to improper or dangerous driving
maneuvers. Even though vehicle
control is improved during emergency
braking, always maintain a safe
distance between you and objects
ahead of you. Vehicle speeds should
always be reduced during extreme
road conditions. The braking distance
for vehicles equipped with ABS or ESC
may be longer than for those without
these systems in the following road
conditions.
Drive your vehicle at reduced speeds
during the following conditions:
ś Rough, gravel or snow-covered
roads.
ś On roads where the road surface is
pitted or has different surface height.
ś Tire chains are installed on your
vehicle.
The safety features of ABS or ESC
equipped vehicle should not be tested
by high speed driving or cornering. This
could endanger the safety of yourself or
others.
ABS is an electronic braking system that
helps prevent a braking skid. ABS allows
the driver to steer and brake at the same
time.
6-44
Using ABS
To obtain the maximum benefit from
your ABS in an emergency situation,
do not attempt to modulate your brake
pressure and do not try to pump your
brakes. Depress your brake pedal as hard
as possible.
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your ABS is active.
ABS does not reduce the time or distance
it takes to stop the vehicle.
Always maintain a safe distance from the
vehicle in front of you.
ABS will not prevent a skid that results
from sudden changes in direction, such
as trying to take a corner too fast or
making a sudden lane change. Always
drive at a safe speed for the road and
weather conditions.
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability.
Always steer moderately when braking
hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel
movement can still cause your vehicle to
veer into oncoming traffic or off the road.
On loose or uneven road surfaces,
operation of the anti-lock brake system
may result in a longer stopping distance
than for vehicles equipped with a
conventional brake system.
) warning light will stay
The ABS (
on for several seconds after the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON position.
06
During that time, ABS will go through
self-diagnosis and the light will go off if
everything is normal. If the light stays on,
you may have a problem with your ABS.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
as soon as possible.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
WARNING
If the ABS (
) warning light is on and
stays on, you may have a problem with
the ABS. Your power brakes will work
normally. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, contact your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
When you drive on a road having poor
traction, such as an icy road, and apply
your brakes continuously, ABS will be
)
active continuously and the ABS (
warning light may illuminate. Pull your
vehicle over to a safe place and turn the
vehicle off.
Restart the vehicle. If the ABS warning
light is off, then your ABS system is
normal.
Otherwise, you may have a problem
with your ABS system. Contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
Information
OTM060013
Electronic Stability Control helps to
stabilize the vehicle during cornering
maneuvers.
ESC checks where you are steering and
where the vehicle is actually going. ESC
applies braking pressure to any one of
the vehicle's brakes and intervenes in the
engine management system to assist the
driver with keeping the vehicle on the
intended path. It is not a substitute for
safe driving practices. Always adjust your
speed and driving to the road conditions.
WARNING
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions when cornering. ESC will not
prevent accidents.
Excessive speed in turns, abrupt
maneuvers, and hydroplaning on wet
surfaces can result in severe accidents.
When you jump start your vehicle because
)
of a drained battery, the ABS (
warning light may turn on at the same
time. This happens because of the low
battery voltage. It does not mean your
ABS is malfunctioning. Have the battery
recharged before driving the vehicle.
6-45
Driving your vehicle
ESC operation
ESC ON condition
When the Engine Start/Stop button is
in the ON position, ESC and the ESC
OFF indicator lights illuminate for
approximately three seconds. After both
lights go off, ESC is enabled.
When operating
When ESC is in operation, the
ESC indicator light blinks:
ś When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in
the brake pedal. This is normal and it
means your ESC is active.
ś When ESC activates, the engine may
not respond to the accelerator as it
does under routine conditions.
ś If Cruise Control was in use when ESC
activates, Cruise Control automatically
disengages. Cruise Control can be
reengaged when the road conditions
allow. See “Cruise Control System”
later in this chapter (if equipped).
ś When moving out of the mud or
driving on a slippery road, the engine
rpm (revolutions per minute) may
not increase even if you press the
accelerator pedal deeply. This is to
maintain the stability and traction of
the vehicle and does not indicate a
problem.
6-46
ESC OFF condition
To cancel ESC operation:
ś State 1
Press the ESC OFF button briefly. The
ESC OFF indicator light and/or message
'Traction Control disabled' will illuminate.
In this state, the traction control function
of ESC (engine management) is disabled,
but the brake control function of ESC
(braking management) still operates.
ś State 2
Press and hold the ESC OFF button
continuously for more than 3 seconds.
The ESC OFF indicator light and/or
message 'Traction & Stability Control
disabled' illuminates and a warning
chime sounds. In this state, both the
traction control function of ESC (engine
management) and the brake control
function of ESC (braking management)
are disabled.
If the Engine Start/Stop button is pressed
to the OFF position when ESC is off, ESC
remains off. Upon restarting the vehicle,
ESC will automatically turn on again.
06
Indicator lights
Ŷ ESC indicator light (blinks)
Ŷ ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before replacing
tires, make sure all four tires and wheels
are the same size. Never drive the
vehicle with different sized wheels and
tires installed.
ESC OFF usage
When the Engine Start/Stop button is
pressed to the ON position, the ESC
indicator light illuminates, then goes off
if the ESC system is operating normally.
The ESC indicator light blinks whenever
ESC is operating.
If the ESC indicator light stays on, your
vehicle may have a malfunction with
the ESC system. When this warning light
illuminates have the vehicle be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
The ESC OFF indicator light comes on
when ESC is turned off.
WARNING
When ESC is blinking, this indicates ESC
is active:
Drive slowly and NEVER attempt to
accelerate. NEVER turn ESC off while
the ESC indicator light is blinking or you
may lose control of the vehicle resulting
in an accident.
When Driving
The ESC OFF mode should only be used
briefly to help free the vehicle if stuck in
snow or mud, by temporarily stopping
operation of ESC, to maintain wheel
torque.
To turn ESC off while driving, press the
ESC OFF button while driving on a flat
road surface.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the transmission:
ś Do not allow wheel(s) of one axle to
spin excessively while the ESC, ABS,
and Parking Brake warning lights
are displayed. The repairs would not
be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Reduce engine power and do not
spin the wheel(s) excessively while
these lights are displayed.
ś When operating the vehicle
on a dynamometer, make sure
ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light
illuminated).
Information
Turning ESC off does not affect ABS or
standard brake system operation.
6-47
Driving your vehicle
Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM)
Vehicle Stability Management is a
function of the Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) system. It helps the vehicle
stay stable when accelerating or braking
suddenly on wet, slippery and rough
roads where traction over the four tires
can suddenly become uneven.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Vehicle Stability Management:
ś ALWAYS check the speed and the
distance to the vehicle ahead. VSM
is not a substitute for safe driving
practices.
ś Never drive too fast for the road
conditions. VSM will not prevent
accidents. Excessive speed in bad
weather, on slippery and uneven
roads can result in severe accidents.
VSM operation
When operating
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may activate ESC, you
may hear sounds from the brakes, or feel
a corresponding sensation in the brake
pedal. This is normal and it means your
VSM is active.
Information
VSM does not operate when:
ś Driving on a banked road such as
gradient or incline.
ś Driving in reverse.
ś The ESC OFF indicator light is on.
ś The EPS (Electric power steering)
warning light ( ) is on or blinks.
6-48
VSM OFF condition
To cancel VSM operation, press the ESC
OFF button. ESC OFF ( ) indicator light
will illuminate.
To turn on VSM, press the ESC OFF
button again. The ESC OFF indicator light
will go out.
WARNING
If the ESC ( ) indicator light or EPS
( ) warning light stays illuminated
or blinks, your vehicle may have a
malfunction with the VSM system.
When the warning light illuminates
have the vehicle be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the VSM
system to malfunction. Before replacing
tires, make sure all four tires and wheels
are the same size. Never drive the
vehicle with different sized tires and
wheels installed.
06
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
Downhill Brake Control (DBC)
Hill-Start Assist Control helps prevent
the vehicle from rolling backwards
when starting a vehicle from a stop on
a hill. The system operates the brakes
automatically for approximately 2
seconds and releases the brake after 5
seconds or when the accelerator pedal is
depressed.
WARNING
Always be ready to depress the
accelerator pedal when starting off
an incline. Hill-Start Assist Control
activates only for approximately 2
seconds.
Information
ś Hill-Start Assist Control does not
operate when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) or N (Neutral).
ś Hill-Start Assist Control activates even
when the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) is off. However, it does not
activate, when ESC does not operate
normally.
OTM060014
Downhill Brake Control assists the driver
to descend down a steep hill without
having to depress the brake pedal.
The system automatically applies the
brakes to maintain vehicle speed below
a certain speed and allows the driver
to concentrate on steering the vehicle
down hill.
The system is turned off whenever the
engine is turned off.
Press the button to turn on the system
and press the button again to turn it off.
6-49
Driving your vehicle
System operation
Mode
Indicator
Description
Green light on
Press the Downhill Brake Control button when vehicle
speed is under 37 mph (60 km/h). Downhill Brake
Control will turn on and enter the standby mode. The
system does not turn on if vehicle speed is over 37 mph
(60 km/h).
Standby
Activated
In the standby mode, Downhill Brake Control will
activate under the following conditions:
śThe hill is steep enough.
śThe brake pedal or accelerator pedal is not depressed.
śVehicle speed is within 2~25 mph (4~40 km/h) range
(within 1.5~5 mph (2.5~8 km/h) when reversing).
Green light blink Within the activation speed range 2~25 mph (4~40
km/h), the driver can control the vehicle speed by
depressing the brake pedal or accelerator pedal.
Green light off
Downhill Brake Control will turn off under the following
conditions:
śThe Downhill Brake Control button is pressed again.
śVehicle speed is over 37 mph (60 km/h).
Deactivated
Green light on
System
malfunction
Yellow light on
6-50
Downhill Brake Control will be deactivated but maintain
the standby mode under the following conditions:
śThe hill is not steep enough.
śVehicle speed is between 25~37 mph (40~60 km/h).
The yellow warning light illuminates when the system
may have malfunctioned or may not work properly
during activation. If this occurs, Downhill Brake Control
is deactivated. Have the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
06
Information
OJX1069039L
Downhill Brake Control disabled. Control
vehicle speed (manually)
When Downhill Brake Control is not
working properly this warning message
will appear on the cluster LCD display
and you will hear a warning sound. If
this occurs, control vehicle speed by
depressing the brake pedal.
ś Downhill Brake Control may not
deactivate on steep inclines even though
the brake pedal or accelerator pedal is
depressed.
ś Downhill Brake Control may not
always maintain vehicle speed at a
certain speed.
ś Downhill Brake Control does not
operate when:
- The gear is in P (Park).
- ESC is activated.
ś Noise or vibration may occur from the
brakes when Downhill Brake Control is
activated.
ś The rear stop light comes on when
Downhill Brake Control is activated.
WARNING
Always turn off Downhill Brake Control
on normal roads. The system might
activate inadvertently from the standby
mode when driving through speed
bumps or making sharp curves.
6-51
Driving your vehicle
Good braking practices
WARNING
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the brake
pedal. Shift the gear to the P (Park)
position, then apply the parking brake,
and press the Engine Start/Stop button
to the OFF position.
Vehicles parked with the parking brake
not applied or not fully engaged may
roll inadvertently and may cause injury
to the driver and others. ALWAYS apply
the parking brake before exiting the
vehicle.
6-52
Wet brakes can be dangerous! The
brakes may get wet if the vehicle is
driven through standing water or if it
is washed. Your vehicle will not stop as
quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet brakes
may cause the vehicle to pull to one side.
To dry the brakes, apply the brakes
lightly until the braking action returns to
normal. If the braking action does not
return to normal, stop as soon as it is safe
to do so and call an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for assistance.
DO NOT drive with your foot resting on
the brake pedal. Even light, but constant
pedal pressure can result in the brakes
overheating, brake wear, and possibly
even brake failure.
If a tire goes flat while you are driving,
apply the brakes gently and keep the
vehicle pointed straight ahead while you
slow down. When you are moving slowly
enough for it to be safe to do so, pull off
the road and stop in a safe location.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal
when the vehicle is stopped to prevent
the vehicle from rolling forward.
06
)285:+((/'5,9(ǣ:'Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) delivers engine
power to front and rear wheels for
maximum traction. 4WD is useful when
extra traction is required, such as when
driving on, muddy, wet, or snow-covered
roads.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ś Do not drive in conditions that
exceed the vehicles intended
design such as challenging off-road
conditions.
ś Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
ś Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
ś The risk of a rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
ś Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
ś In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
NOTICE
ś Do not drive in water if the level
is higher than the bottom of the
vehicle.
ś Check your brake condition once
you are out of mud or water. Depress
the brake pedal several times as you
move slowly until you feel normal
braking return.
ś Shorten your scheduled
maintenance interval if you drive in
off-road conditions such as sand,
mud or water (see "Maintenance
Under Severe Usage Conditions"
section in chapter 9).
ś Always wash your vehicle thoroughly
after off road use, especially the
bottom of the vehicle.
ś Be sure to equip the vehicle with four
tires of the same size and type.
ś Make sure that a full time 4WD
vehicle is towed by a flat bed tow
truck.
6-53
Driving your vehicle
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) operation
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) mode selection
Transfer
mode
4WD AUTO
(4WD LOCK is
deactivated)
Selection
button
Indicator
light
Description
In the 4WD AUTO mode, under normal
operating conditions, onventional 2WD
vehicles. If the system determines
there is a need for four wheel drive, the
engine’s driving power is distributed to
all four wheels automatically.
(not
illuminated)
4WD LOCK
(illuminated)
Use this mode when driving on normal
roads.
If you select the "Driving force
distribution" in the cluster, Driving force
distribution (4WD) state is displayed.
In the 4WD LOCK mode, the system is
deactivated when vehicle speed is over
37 mph (60 km/h) and the mode is shifted
to 4WD AUTO mode. If the vehicle speed
slows down to 37 mph (60 km/h), the
mode shifts back to the 4WD LOCK mode.
If 4WD Lock is activated, the driving force
distribution in the cluster is not displayed.
Use this mode when driving up or down
steep inclines, driving off-road, driving on
sandy and muddy roads, etc., to maximize
traction
WARNING
If 4WD warning light ( ) stays on the instrument cluster, your vehicle may have a
malfunction with the 4WD system. When the 4WD warning light ( ) illuminates have
the vehicle be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
6-54
06
CAUTION
When driving on normal roads,
deactivate the 4WD LOCK mode by
pushing the 4WD LOCK button (4WD
LOCK indicator light goes off). Driving
on normal roads with the 4WD LOCK
mode, especially, when cornering
may cause mechanical noise or
vibration. The noise and vibration will
disappear when the 4WD LOCK mode is
deactivated. Prolonged driving with the
noise and vibration may damage some
parts of the power train.
Auto Four Wheel Drive mode (normal
driving) (if equipped)
If the 4WD system determines there is a
need for four wheel drive, the engine's
driving power is distributed to all four
wheels automatically.
NOTICE
ś When the 4WD LOCK mode is
deactivated, a sensation may be felt
as the driving power is delivered
entirely to the front wheels.
6-55
Driving your vehicle
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) selection
(if equipped)
OTMA060012
Selected mode
Auto 4WD
(Normal driving)
SNOW
Description
-
śUse this mode when driving on normal roads.
śUnder normal operating conditions, the vehicle
operates similar to conventional 2WD vehicles. If the
system determines there is a need for four wheel
drive, the engine's driving power is distributed to all
four wheels automatically.
śUse this mode when driving on slippery roads.
śThe engine’s driving power is properly distributed to
the wheels, to help start the vehicle stably on slippery
roads or keep tires from slipping.
Be sure to maintain Auto 4WD mode when driving on normal roads. If you drive with
the 4WD Lock mode on normal roads or curved roads, it may damage 4WD parts and
cause vibration and noise. However, vibration and noise are normal conditions that will
disappear when Auto 4WD mode is selected. Also, when the vehicle is changed from
4WD Lock to Auto 4WD, a sensation may be felt as driving power is delivered to the
rear wheels.
6-56
06
For safe 4WD operation
Before driving
ś Make sure all passengers are wearing
seat belts.
ś Sit upright and closer to the steering
wheel than usual. Adjust the steering
wheel to a position comfortable for
you to drive.
Driving on snow-covered or icy roads
ś Start off slowly by applying the
accelerator pedal gently.
ś Use snow tires or tire chains.
ś Keep sufficient distance between your
vehicle and the vehicle in front of you.
ś Apply engine braking during
deceleration by using the paddle
shifter (manual shift mode) and
manually selecting a lower gear.
ś Avoid speeding, rapid acceleration,
sudden brake applications, and sharp
turns to prevent skids.
Information
When using Snow Tires, mount them on
all four wheels.
If a full set of chains is not available for
an 4WD vehicle when using tire chains,
chains may be installed on the front wheels
only.
For more details on Snow Tires and Tire
Chains, refer to "Winter Driving" section
later in this chapter.
Driving in sand or mud
ś Maintain slow and constant speed.
Operate the accelerator pedal slowly
to ensure safe driving (wheel-slip
prevention).
ś Keep sufficient distance between your
vehicle and the vehicle in front of you.
ś Reduce vehicle speed and always
check the road condition.
ś Avoid speeding, rapid acceleration,
sudden brake applications, and sharp
turns to prevent getting stuck.
ś When the vehicle is stuck in snow,
sand or mud, the tires may not
operate.
ś This is to protect the transmission and
not a malfunction.
NOTICE
Moving the vehicle forcibly to get out
of mud or sand can cause damage/
overheat of the engine or damage/
breakdown of the transmission,
differential or 4WD system as well as
damage to tires. If excessive wheel slip
occurs after entering a sandy/muddy
road, the vehicle may fall into the sand/
mud. When it happens, put a stone or
a tree branch under the tire, and then
try to pull out the vehicle, or try to get it
unstuck by repeatedly moving forwards
and backwards.
CAUTION
Mud or snow
If one of the front or rear wheels
begins to spin in mud, snow, etc., the
vehicle can sometimes be driven out by
engaging the accelerator pedal further;
however avoid running the engine
continuously at high rpm because doing
so could damage the AWD system.
6-57
Driving your vehicle
ś When the message “Trans cooled.
Resume driving” appears you can
continue to drive your vehicle.
ś If the warning messages in the LCD
display continue to blink, for your
safety, have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OTMA060009
Driving up or down hills
ś Driving uphill
- Before starting off, check if it is
possible to drive uphill.
- Drive as straight as possible.
ś Driving downhill
- Do not change gear while driving
downhill. Select gear before driving
downhill.
- Drive slowly using engine braking
while driving downhill.
- Drive straight as possible.
OTMA060010
Transmission overheated
ś When driving on muddy and sandy
roads under the severe condition, the
transmission could be overheated.
ś When the transmission is overheated,
the safe protection mode engages
and the “Transmission Hot! Park with
engine on: warning message will
appear on the LCD display with a
chime.
ś If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes and
shift the vehicle to P (Park), and allow
the transmission to cool.
ś If you ignore this warning, the driving
condition may become worse.
You may experience abrupt shifts,
frequent shifts, or jerkiness. To return
to the normal driving condition, stop
the vehicle and apply the foot brake
or shift into P (Park). Then allow the
transmission to cool for a few minutes
with engine on, before driving off.
6-58
WARNING
Exercise extreme caution driving up or
down steep hills. The vehicle may flip
over depending on the grade, terrain,
water and mud conditions.
WARNING
Do not drive across the contour of steep
hills. A slight change in the wheel angle
can destabilize the vehicle, or a stable
vehicle may lose stability if the vehicle
stops its forward motion. Your vehicle
may roll over and lead to a serious injury
or death.
06
Driving through water
ś Try to avoid driving in deep standing
water. It may stall your engine and
clog your exhaust pipes.
ś Do not change gear while driving in
water.
CAUTION
Always drive slowly in water. If you
drive too fast, water may get into the
engine compartment and wet the
ignition system causing your vehicle to
suddenly stop.
Additional driving conditions
ś Become familiar with the off-road
conditions before driving.
ś Always pay attention when driving offroad and avoid dangerous areas.
ś Drive slowly when driving in heavy
wind.
ś Reduce vehicle speed when
cornering. The center of gravity
of 4WD vehicles is higher than
conventional 2WD vehicles, making
them more likely to roll over when you
rapidly turn corners.
ś Always hold the steering wheel firmly
when you are driving off-road.
Emergency precautions
Tires
When replacing tires, be sure to equip
all four tires with the same size, type,
tread patterns, brand and load-carrying
capacity.
WARNING
Do not use tire and wheel with different
size and type from the one originally
installed on your vehicle. It can affect
the safety and performance of your
vehicle, which could lead to steering
failure or rollover causing serious injury.
In an emergency situation, a compact
spare tire (if equipped) or Tire Mobility
Kit (if equipped) may be used. But,
do not use the compact spare tire
continuously. Repair or replace the
original tire as soon as possible to avoid
failure of the differential or 4WD system.
WARNING
Never start or run the engine while
an 4WD vehicle is raised on a jack.
The vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack
causing serious injury or death to you or
those nearby.
WARNING
Do hold the steering wheel tightly
when you are driving off-road. You may
hurt your arm by a sudden steering
maneuver or from steering wheel
rebound due to an impact with objects
on the ground. You could lose control
of the steering wheel which may lead to
serious injury or death.
6-59
Driving your vehicle
Towing
WARNING
4WD vehicles must be towed with
a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed
equipment with all the wheels off the
ground. For more details, refer to
"Towing" section in chapter 8.
Vehicle inspection
ś If the vehicle needs to be operated on
a vehicle lift do not attempt to stop
any of the four wheels from turning.
This could damage the 4WD system.
ś Never engage the parking brake while
running the engine on a car lift. This
may damage the 4WD system.
Dynamometer testing
An 4WD vehicle must be tested on a
special four wheel chassis dynamometer.
OTM060016L
[A] : Roll tester (Speedometer),
[B] : Temporary free roller
An 4WD vehicle should not be tested
on a 2WD roll tester. If a 2WD roll tester
must be used, perform the following
procedure:
1. Check the tire pressures
recommended for your vehicle.
2. Place the rear wheels on the roll tester
for a speedometer test as shown in
the illustration.
3. Release the parking brake.
4. Place the front wheels on the
temporary free roller as shown in the
illustration.
6-60
Keep away from the front of the vehicle
while the vehicle is in gear on the
dynamometer. The vehicle can jump
forward and cause serious injury or
death.
Reducing the risk of a rollover
Your multi-purpose passenger vehicle is
defined as a Sports Utility Vehicle (SUV).
SUV’s have higher ground clearance
and a narrower track to make them
capable of performing in a wide variety
of off-road applications. The specific
design characteristics give them a higher
center of gravity than ordinary vehicles
making them more likely to roll over if
you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles
have a significantly higher rollover rate
than other types of vehicles. Due to this
risk, driver and passengers are strongly
recommended to buckle their seat belts.
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person
is significantly more likely to die than a
person wearing a seat belt.
There are steps that a driver can make
to reduce the risk of a rollover. If at all
possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt
maneuvers, do not load your roof rack
with heavy cargo, and never modify your
vehicle in any way.
06
WARNING
Rollover
As with other Sports Utility Vehicle
(SUV), failure to operate this vehicle
correctly may result in loss of control,
an accident or vehicle rollover.
ś Utility vehicles have a significantly
higher rollover rate than other types
of vehicles.
ś Specific design characteristics
(higher ground clearance, narrower
track, etc.) give this vehicle a higher
center of gravity than ordinary
vehicles.
ś A SUV is not designed for cornering
at the same speeds as conventional
vehicles.
ś Avoid sharp turns or abrupt
maneuvers.
ś In a rollover crash, an unbelted
person is significantly more likely to
die than a person wearing a seat belt.
Make sure everyone in the vehicle is
properly buckled up.
WARNING
Your vehicle is equipped with tires
designed to provide safe ride and
handling capability. Do not use a size
and type of tire and wheel that is
different from the one that is originally
installed on your vehicle. It can affect
the safety and performance of your
vehicle, which could lead to steering
failure or rollover and serious injury.
When replacing the tires, be sure to
equip all four tires with the tire and
wheel of the same size, type, tread,
brand and load-carrying capacity.
If you nevertheless decide to equip
your vehicle with any tire/wheel
combination not recommended by
HYUNDAI for off road driving, you
should not use these tires for highway
driving.
WARNING
Jacked vehicle
While a full-time 4WD vehicle is being
raised on a jack, never start the engine
or cause the tires to rotate.
There is a danger that rotating tires
touching the ground could cause the
vehicle to fall off the jack and to jump
forward or rearward.
6-61
Driving your vehicle
,'/(6723$1'*2ǣ,6*Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Idle Stop and Go helps reduce fuel
consumption by automatically shutting
down the engine, when the vehicle is
at a standstill (for example, red stop
light, stop sign, and traffic jam) subject
to certain prerequisite conditions being
satisfied as listed below.
The engine is automatically started upon
satisfying the starting conditions.
ISG system is always active, when the
engine is running.
Information
When the engine is automatically started
by ISG system, warning lights (for
example, ABS, ESC, ESC OFF, EPS,
and parking brake warning light) may
illuminate for a few seconds due to low
battery voltage.
However, it does not indicate a
malfunction with ISG system.
ISG system operation
Prerequisite for activation
ISG system operates in the following
situations.
ś The driver's seatbelt is fastened
ś The driver's door and hood are closed
ś The brake vacuum pressure is
adequate
ś The battery sensor is activated and
the battery is sufficiently charged
ś Outside temperature is not too low or
too high
ś The vehicle is driven over a constant
speed and stops
ś The climate control system satisfies
the conditions
ś The vehicle is sufficiently warmed up
ś ISG related parts are working properly
ś The incline is gradual
ś The steering wheel is turned less than
180 degrees and then the vehicle
stops
Information
If the ISG light (white) is turned on on the
instrument cluster and does not meet the
ISG system operating conditions, the ISG
system is not activated.
When the ISG light (yellow) is on while the
ISG system meets operating conditions,
have the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-62
06
Auto stop
When ISG is on the engine will be
stopped automatically when both of the
following occurs:
1. Vehicle speed decreases to 0 mph (0
km/h) full stop condition.
2. Brake pedal is depressed and gear is
in D (Drive) or N (Neutral).
The Auto Stop ( ) indicator illuminates
in green on the instrument cluster, when
the engine stops.
In the Auto Stop mode, if the engine
hood is opened, ISG system will be
deactivated.
Information
Idle stop cannot reoccur again until the
vehicle speed goes above 3 mph (5 km/h)
and then returns again to the automatic
stop conditions as previously mentioned.
OTM060017
When the system is deactivated, the ISG
off button indicator will illuminate and
a message ‘Auto Stop is off. Shift to P or
N to start engine manually’ appears on
the cluster LCD display with a warning
sound.
If this occurs, depress the brake pedal
and restart the engine manually.
Auto start
When the engine stops automatically by
ISG, the engine will restart if one of the
following is done.
- Release the brake pedal.
- When Auto Hold is activated, take
your foot off the brake pedal and then
depress the accelerator pedal.
- While depressing the brake pedal,
shift the gear from N (Neutral) or D
(Drive) to R (Reverse) or P (Park).
- While depressing the brake pedal,
shift the gear from N (Neutral) to D
(Drive).
The Auto Stop ( ) indicator goes to
white on the instrument cluster, when
the engine is restarted.
6-63
Driving your vehicle
LCD display messages
Type A
Type B
The messages are displayed on the
instrument cluster to help use ISG
system.
OJX1069071L
OJX1069042L
Auto Stop is Off. Shift to P or N to start
engine
When the system is deactivated, the ISG
off button indicator will illuminate and
a message will appear on the cluster
LCD display with a warning sound in the
following situations.
- When the engine hood is opened.
- When ISG system is not working
normally.
If this occurs, depress the brake pedal
and restart the engine manually. For your
safety, restart the vehicle in the P (Park)
position.
OJX1069070L
Press brake pedal before driving on / Press
brake pedal for Auto Start
When the gear is shifted from N (Neutral)
to R (Reverse), D (Drive) or Manual
shift mode without the brake pedal
depressed, a message will appear on
the cluster LCD display. To activate auto
start, depress the brake pedal.
OJX1069044
AUTO STOP elapsed time
AUTO STOP display shows the elapsed
time of engine stop by the Idle Stop and
Go system.
You may check AUTO STOP elapsed time
in the Utility view on the instrument
cluster.
Refer to “View Modes” section in
chapter 4.
6-64
06
ISG system off
Forced to restart engine
OTM060017
Press the ISG OFF button to turn off ISG
system. The ISG OFF button indicator will
illuminate. To use the system, press the
ISG OFF button again.
The engine is automatically restarted in
the following situations.
ś The brake vacuum pressure is low
ś The engine has stopped for about 5
minutes
ś The air conditioning is ON with the fan
speed set to a certain high level
ś The front defroster is ON
ś The battery is weak
ś The cooling and heating performance
of the climate control system is
unsatisfactory
ś The vehicle is shifted to P (Park) or R
(Reverse) when Auto Hold is activated
ś The door is opened or the seatbelt
is unfastened when Auto Hold is
activated
ś The EPB switch is pressed when Auto
Hold is activated
The Auto Stop ( ) indicator blinks in
green for 5 seconds on the instrument
cluster when the engine is restarted.
WARNING
When the engine is in Idle Stop mode,
the engine may restart without the
driver taking any action. Before leaving
the vehicle or working on the engine
compartment, turn off the engine by
pressing the ENGINE START/STOP
button to the OFF position.
6-65
Driving your vehicle
ISG malfunction
Calibrating the Battery Sensor
ISG system may not operate when there
is a malfunction with the ISG sensors or
ISG system.
The following will occur, when there is a
malfunction with the ISG system:
ś The Auto Stop ( ) indicator will
illuminate in yellow on the instrument
cluster.
ś The light on the ISG OFF button will
illuminate.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OTMA060001
[A] : Battery sensor
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Disconnect all electronic devices
that were additionally installed after
the vehicle was delivered, such as
navigation, dashcam, etc.
3. After 4 hours with the engine off, turn
the engine on and off 3 to 4 times.
Information
The ISG system may not operate in the
following situations.
- There is a malfunction with the ISG
system.
- The battery is weak.
- The brake vacuum pressure is low.
If this occurs, have the ISG system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
ś Use only a genuine HYUNDAI ISG
battery for replacement. If not,
the ISG system may not properly
operate.
ś Do not recharge the ISG battery with
a general battery charger. It may
damage or explode the ISG battery.
ś Do not remove the battery cap. The
battery electrolyte, which is harmful
to the human body, may leak out.
6-66
06
'5,9(02'(,17(*5$7('&21752/6<67(0ǣ:'Ǥ
ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
SPORT mode
OTM060058L
Drive mode may be selected according
to the driver's preference or road
condition.
Drive mode
The mode changes whenever the DRIVE
MODE knob is rotated.
SPORT mode provides sporty
but firm riding.
In SPORT mode, the fuel
efficiency may decrease.
ś When SPORT mode is selected, the
SPORT indicator will illuminate on the
instrument cluster.
ś Whenever the engine is restarted,
the drive mode will revert back to
COMFORT mode. If SPORT mode is
desired, re-select SPORT mode.
ś When SPORT mode is activated:
- The engine rpm will tend to remain
raised over a certain length of time
even after releasing the accelerator
- Upshifts are delayed when
accelerating
COMFORT mode
COMFORT mode provides smooth
driving and comfortable riding.
6-67
Driving your vehicle
SMART mode
SMART mode selects the
proper driving mode among
ECO, COMFORT and SPORT
by judging the driver's driving
habits (for example, mild or
dynamic) from the brake pedal
depression or the steering
wheel operation.
ś Press the DRIVE MODE button to
activate SMART mode. When SMART
mode is activated, the indicator
illuminates on the instrument cluster.
ś The vehicle starts in SMART mode,
when the engine was turned OFF in
SMART mode.
ś SMART mode automatically controls
gear shifting patterns, engine torque,
in accordance with the driver's driving
habits.
Information
ś When you mildly drive the vehicle
in SMART mode, the driving mode
changes to ECO mode to improve fuel
efficiency. However, the actual fuel
efficiency may differ in accordance
with your driving situations (for
example, upward/downward slope,
vehicle deceleration/acceleration).
ś When you dynamically drive the
vehicle in SMART mode by abruptly
decelerating or sharply curving, the
driving mode changes to SPORT mode.
However, it may adversely affect fuel
economy.
6-68
Various driving situations, which you may
encounter in SMART mode
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to ECO mode after a certain
period of time, when you gently
depress the accelerator pedal (Your
driving is categorized to be mild.).
ś The driving mode automatically
changes from SMART ECO mode
to SMART COMFORT mode after a
certain period of time, when you
sharply or repetitively depress the
accelerator pedal.
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to SMART COMFORT mode
with the same driving patterns, when
the vehicle starts to drive on an
upward slope of a certain angle. The
driving mode automatically returns to
SMART ECO mode, when the vehicle
enters a leveled road.
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to SMART SPORT, when
you abruptly accelerate the vehicle
or repetitively operate the steering
wheel (Your driving is categorized
to be sporty.). In this mode, your
vehicle drives in a lower gear for
abrupt accelerating/decelerating
and increases the engine brake
performance.
ś You may still sense the engine brake
performance, even when you release
the accelerator pedal in SMART
SPORT mode. It is because your
vehicle remains to be in a lower gear
over a certain period of time for next
acceleration. Thus, it is a normal
driving situation, not indicating any
malfunction.
06
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to SMART SPORT mode
only in harsh driving situations. In
most of the normal driving situations,
the driving mode sets to be either
in SMART ECO mode or in SMART
COMFORT mode.
Limitation of SMART mode
The SMART mode may be limited in
following situations. (The OFF indicator
illuminates in those situations.)
ś The driver manually moves the shift
button : It deactivates SMART mode.
The vehicle drives, as the driver
manually moves the shift button.
ś The cruise control is activated : The
cruise system may deactivate the
SMART mode. When a higher system
is set by the cruise system, it starts to
control vehicle speed and deactivates
SMART mode. (SMART mode is not
deactivated just by activing the cruise
system.)
ś The transmission oil temperature is either
extremely low or extremely high : The
SMART mode can be active in most of
the normal driving situations. However,
an extremely high/ low transmission oil
temperature may temporarily deactivate
the SMART mode, because the
transmission condition is out of normal
operation condition.
6-69
Driving your vehicle
'5,9(02'(,17(*5$7('&21752/6<67(0ǣ:'Ǥ
ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
SPORT mode
Drive mode
OTMA060012
Drive mode may be selected according
to the driver's preference or road
condition.
The mode changes whenever the DRIVE
knob is rotated.
COMFORT mode
COMFORT mode provides smooth
driving and comfortable riding.
6-70
SPORT mode provides sporty
but firm riding.
In SPORT mode, the fuel
efficiency may decrease.
ś When SPORT mode is selected, the
SPORT indicator will illuminate on the
instrument cluster.
ś Whenever the engine is restarted,
the drive mode will revert back to
COMFORT mode. If SPORT mode is
desired, re-select SPORT mode.
ś When SPORT mode is activated:
- The engine rpm will tend to remain
raised over a certain length of time
even after releasing the accelerator
- Upshifts are delayed when
accelerating
06
SMART mode
SMART mode selects the
proper driving mode among
ECO, COMFORT and SPORT
by judging the driver's driving
habits (for example, mild or
dynamic) from the brake pedal
depression or the steering
wheel operation.
ś Press the DRIVE MODE button to
activate SMART mode. When SMART
mode is activated, the indicator
illuminates on the instrument cluster.
ś The vehicle starts in SMART mode,
when the engine was turned OFF in
SMART mode.
ś SMART mode automatically controls
gear shifting patterns, engine torque,
in accordance with the driver's driving
habits.
Information
ś When you mildly drive the vehicle
in SMART mode, the driving mode
changes to ECO mode to improve fuel
efficiency. However, the actual fuel
efficiency may differ in accordance
with your driving situations (for
example, upward/downward slope,
vehicle deceleration/acceleration).
ś When you dynamically drive the
vehicle in SMART mode by abruptly
decelerating or sharply curving, the
driving mode changes to SPORT mode.
However, it may adversely affect fuel
economy.
Various driving situations, which you may
encounter in SMART mode
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to ECO mode after a certain
period of time, when you gently
depress the accelerator pedal (Your
driving is categorized to be mild.).
ś The driving mode automatically
changes from SMART ECO mode
to SMART COMFORT mode after a
certain period of time, when you
sharply or repetitively depress the
accelerator pedal.
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to SMART COMFORT mode
with the same driving patterns, when
the vehicle starts to drive on an
upward slope of a certain angle. The
driving mode automatically returns to
SMART ECO mode, when the vehicle
enters a leveled road.
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to SMART SPORT, when
you abruptly accelerate the vehicle
or repetitively operate the steering
wheel (Your driving is categorized
to be sporty.). In this mode, your
vehicle drives in a lower gear for
abrupt accelerating/decelerating
and increases the engine brake
performance.
ś You may still sense the engine brake
performance, even when you release
the accelerator pedal in SMART
SPORT mode. It is because your
vehicle remains to be in a lower gear
over a certain period of time for next
acceleration. Thus, it is a normal
driving situation, not indicating any
malfunction.
ś The driving mode automatically
changes to SMART SPORT mode
only in harsh driving situations. In
most of the normal driving situations,
the driving mode sets to be either
in SMART ECO mode or in SMART
COMFORT mode.
6-71
Driving your vehicle
Limitation of SMART mode
The SMART mode may be limited in
following situations. (The OFF indicator
illuminates in those situations.)
ś The driver manually moves the shift
button : It deactivates SMART mode.
The vehicle drives, as the driver
manually moves the shift button.
ś The cruise control is activated : The
cruise system may deactivate the
SMART mode. When a higher system
is set by the cruise system, it starts to
control vehicle speed and deactivates
SMART mode. (SMART mode is not
deactivated just by activing the cruise
system.)
ś The transmission oil temperature is either
extremely low or extremely high : The
SMART mode can be active in most of
the normal driving situations. However,
an extremely high/ low transmission oil
temperature may temporarily deactivate
the SMART mode, because the
transmission condition is out of normal
operation condition.
6-72
06
SPECIAL DRIVING CONDITIONS
Hazardous driving conditions
Rocking the vehicle
When hazardous driving elements
are encountered such as water, snow,
ice, mud and sand, take the following
precautions:
ś Drive cautiously and maintain a longer
braking distance.
ś Avoid abrupt braking or steering.
ś When your vehicle is stuck in
snow, mud, or sand, use second
gear. Accelerate slowly to avoid
unnecessary wheel spin.
ś Put sand, rock salt, tire chains or other
non-slip materials under the wheels to
provide additional traction while the
vehicle becomes stuck in ice, snow,
or mud.
If it is necessary to rock the vehicle to
free it from snow, sand, or mud, first turn
the steering wheel right and left to clear
the area around your front wheels. Then,
shift back and forth between R (Reverse)
and a forward gear.
Try to avoid spinning the wheels, and do
not race the engine.
To prevent transmission wear, wait until
the wheels stop spinning before shifting
gears. Release the accelerator pedal
while shifting, and press lightly on the
accelerator pedal while the transmission
is in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in
forward and reverse directions causes a
rocking motion that may free the vehicle.
WARNING
Downshifting with an automatic
transmission while driving on slippery
surfaces can cause an accident. The
sudden change in tire speed could
cause the tires to skid. Be careful when
downshifting on slippery surfaces.
WARNING
If the vehicle is stuck and excessive
wheel spin occurs, the temperature
in the tires can increase very quickly.
If the tires become damaged, a tire
blow out or tire explosion can occur.
This condition is dangerous - you and
others may be injured. Do not attempt
this procedure if people or objects are
anywhere near the vehicle.
If you attempt to free the vehicle, the
vehicle can overheat quickly, possibly
causing an engine compartment fire
or other damage. Try to avoid spinning
the wheels as much as possible to
prevent overheating of either the tires
or the engine. DO NOT allow the vehicle
to spin the wheels above 35 mph (56
km/h).
Information
The ESC system must be turned OFF
before rocking the vehicle.
6-73
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
If you are still stuck after rocking the
vehicle a few times, have the vehicle
pulled out by a tow vehicle to avoid
engine overheating, possible damage to
the transmission, and tire damage. See
“Towing” section in chapter 8.
Smooth cornering
Avoid braking or gear changing in
corners, especially when roads are wet.
Ideally, corners should always be taken
under gentle acceleration.
Driving at night
Night driving presents more hazards than
driving in the daylight. Here are some
important tips to remember:
ś Slow down and keep more distance
between you and other vehicles, as it
may be more difficult to see at night,
especially in areas where there may
not be any street lights.
ś Adjust your mirrors to reduce the glare
from other drivers’ headlights.
ś Keep your headlights clean and
properly aimed. Dirty or improperly
aimed headlights will make it much
more difficult to see at night.
ś Avoid staring directly at the headlights
of oncoming vehicles. You could be
temporarily blinded, and it will take
several seconds for your eyes to
readjust to the darkness.
Driving in the rain
Rain and wet roads can make driving
dangerous. Here are a few things to
consider when driving in the rain or on
slick pavement:
ś Slow down and allow extra following
distance. A heavy rainfall makes
it harder to see and increases the
distance needed to stop your vehicle.
ś Turn OFF your Cruise Control. (if
equipped)
ś Replace your windshield wiper blades
when they show signs of streaking or
missing areas on the windshield.
ś Be sure your tires have enough tread.
If your tires do not have enough tread,
making a quick stop on wet pavement
can cause a skid and possibly lead to
an accident. See “Tire Tread” section
in chapter 9.
ś Turn on your headlights to make it
easier for others to see you.
ś Driving too fast through large puddles
can affect your brakes. If you must go
through puddles, try to drive through
them slowly.
ś If you believe your brakes may be wet,
apply them lightly while driving until
normal braking operation returns.
Hydroplaning
If the road is wet enough and you are
going fast enough, your vehicle may
have little or no contact with the road
surface and actually ride on the water.
The best advice is SLOW DOWN when
the road is wet.
The risk of hydroplaning increases as
the depth of tire tread decreases, refer
to “Tire Tread” section in chapter 9.
6-74
06
Driving in flooded areas
Reducing the risk of a rollover
Avoid driving through flooded areas
unless you are sure the water is no
higher than the bottom of the wheel hub.
Drive through any water slowly. Allow
adequate stopping distance because
brake performance may be reduced.
After driving through water, dry the
brakes by gently applying them several
times while the vehicle is moving slowly.
Your multi-purpose passenger vehicle is
defined as a Sports Utility Vehicle (SUV).
SUV’s have higher ground clearance
and a narrower track to make them
capable of performing in a wide variety
of off-road applications. The specific
design characteristics give them a higher
center of gravity than ordinary vehicles
making them more likely to roll over if
you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles
have a significantly higher rollover rate
than other types of vehicles. Due to this
risk, driver and passengers are strongly
recommended to buckle their seat belts.
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person
is significantly more likely to die than a
person wearing a seat belt.
There are steps that a driver can make
to reduce the risk of a rollover. If at all
possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt
maneuvers, do not load your vehicle
with heavy cargo on the roof, and never
modify your vehicle in any way.
Highway driving
Tires
Adjust the tire inflation, as specified.
Under-inflation may overheat or damage
the tires.
Do not install worn-out or damaged tires,
which may reduce traction or fail the
braking operation.
Information
Never over-inflate your tires above the
maximum inflation pressure, as specified
on your tires.
Fuel, engine coolant and engine oil
Driving at higher speeds on the highway
consumes more fuel and is less efficient
than driving at a slower, more moderate
speed. Maintain a moderate speed in
order to conserve fuel when driving on
the highway.
Be sure to check both the engine coolant
level and the engine oil before driving.
Drive belt
A loose or damaged drive belt may
overheat the engine.
WARNING
Utility vehicles have a significantly
higher rollover rate than other types of
vehicles. To prevent rollovers or loss of
control:
ś Take corners at slower speeds than
you would with a passenger vehicle.
ś Avoid sharp turns and abrupt
maneuvers.
ś Do not modify your vehicle in any
way that you would raise the center
of gravity.
ś Keep tires properly inflated.
ś Do not carry heavy cargo on the roof.
WARNING
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person
is significantly more likely to die than a
person wearing a seat belt. Make sure
all passengers are wearing their seat
belts.
6-75
Driving your vehicle
WINTER DRIVING
The severe weather conditions of winter quickly wear out tires and cause other
problems. To minimize winter driving problems, you should take the following
suggestions:
Snow or icy conditions
You need to keep sufficient distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in front of
you.
Apply the brakes gently. Speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden brake applications, and
sharp turns are potentially very hazardous practices. During deceleration, use engine
braking to the fullest extent. Sudden brake applications on snowy or icy roads may
cause the vehicle to skid.
To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it may be necessary to use snow tires or to install
tire chains on your tires.
Always carry emergency equipment. Some of the items you may want to carry include
tire chains, tow straps or chains, a flashlight, emergency flares, sand, a shovel, jumper
cables, a window scraper, gloves, ground cloth, coveralls, a blanket, etc.
Snow tires
WARNING
Snow tires should be equivalent in size and type to the vehicle’s standard tires.
Otherwise, the safety and handling of your vehicle may be adversely affected.
We recommend that you use snow tires when road temperature is below 45°F (7°C).
If you mount snow tires on your vehicle, make sure to use the same Inflation pressure
as the original tires. Mount snow tires on all four wheels to balance your vehicle’s
handling in all weather conditions. The traction provided by snow tires on dry roads
may not be as high as your vehicle’s original equipment tires. Check with the tire dealer
for maximum speed recommendations.
6-76
06
When using tire chains, attach them to
the drive wheels as follows.
2WD : Front wheels
4WD : All four wheels
If a full set of chains is not
available for an 4WD vehicle,
chains may be installed on the
front wheels only.
Tire chains
Type A
WARNING
OTM060025
Type B
OTM060045
Since the sidewalls of radial tires are
thinner than other types of tires, they
may be damaged by mounting some
types of tire chains on them. Therefore,
the use of snow tires is recommended
instead of tire chains. If tire chains must
be used, use genuine HYUNDAI Parts
and install the tire chain after reviewing
the instructions provided with the tire
chains. Damage to your vehicle caused
by improper tire chain use is not covered
by your vehicle manufacturer’s warranty.
Fabric-type chains must be used on the
vehicle with 19”/20” tires.
The use of tire chains may adversely
affect vehicle handling:
ś Drive less than 20 mph (30 km/h)
or the chain manufacturer’s
recommended speed limit,
whichever is lower.
ś Drive carefully and avoid bumps,
holes, sharp turns, and other road
hazards, which may cause the
vehicle to bounce.
ś Avoid sharp turns or locked wheel
braking.
Information
ś Install tire chains only in pairs and on
the front tires. It should be noted that
installing tire chains on the tires will
provide a greater driving force, but will
not prevent side skids.
ś Do not install studded tires without
first checking local and municipal
regulations for possible restrictions
against their use.
6-77
Driving your vehicle
Chain Installation
When installing tire chains, follow the
manufacturer’s instructions and mount
them as tightly possible. Drive slowly
(less than 20 mph (30 km/h)) with
chains installed. If you hear the chains
contacting the body or chassis, stop and
tighten them. If they still make contact,
slow down until the noise stops. Remove
the tire chains as soon as you begin
driving on cleared roads.
When mounting snow chains, park the
vehicle on level ground away from traffic.
Turn on the vehicle Hazard Warning
Flasher and place a triangular emergency
warning device behind the vehicle (if
available). Always place the vehicle in P
(Park), apply the parking brake and turn
off the engine before installing snow
chains.
NOTICE
When using tire chains:
ś Wrong size chains or improperly
installed chains can damage your
vehicle’s brake lines, suspension,
body and wheels.
ś Use SAE “S” class or wire chains.
ś If you hear noise caused by chains
contacting the body, retighten the
chain to prevent contact with the
vehicle body.
ś To prevent body damage, retighten
the chains after driving 0.3~0.6 miles
(0.5~1.0 km).
ś Do not use tire chains on vehicles
equipped with aluminum wheels. If
unavoidable, use a wire type chain.
ś Use wire chains less than 0.47 in.
(12mm) thick to prevent damage to
the chain’s connection.
6-78
Winter precautions
Use high quality ethylene glycol coolant
Your vehicle is delivered with high
quality ethylene glycol coolant in the
cooling system. It is the only type of
coolant that should be used because it
helps prevent corrosion in the cooling
system, lubricates the water pump and
prevents freezing. Be sure to replace or
replenish your coolant in accordance
with the maintenance schedule in
chapter 9. Before winter, have your
coolant tested to assure that its freezing
point is sufficient for the temperatures
anticipated during the winter.
Check battery and cables
Winter temperatures affect battery
performance. Inspect the battery and
cables, as specified in chapter 9. The
battery charging level can be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or in a
service station.
Change to “winter weight” oil if
necessary
In some regions during winter, it is
recommended to use the “winter
weight” oil with lower viscosity In
addition, replace the engine oil and filter
if it is close to the next maintenance
interval. Fresh engine oil ensures
optimum engine operation during the
winter months. For further information,
refer to chapter 2. When you are not sure
about a type of winter weight oil, consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
06
Check spark plugs and ignition system
Inspect the spark plugs, as specified in
chapter 8. If necessary, replace them.
Also check all ignition wirings and
components for any cracks, wear-out,
and damage.
To prevent locks from freezing
To prevent the locks from being frozen,
spray approved de-icing fluid or glycerin
into key holes. When a lock opening is
already covered with ice, spray approved
de-icing fluid over the ice to remove it.
When an internal part of a lock freezes,
try to thaw it with a heated key. Carefully
use the heated key to avoid an injury.
Use approved window washer antifreeze solution in system
To prevent the window washer from
being frozen, add authorized window
washer anti-freeze solution, as specified
on the window washer container.
Window washer anti-freeze solution is
available from an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer, and most vehicle accessory
outlets. Do not use engine coolant or
other types of anti-freeze solution, to
prevent any damage to the vehicle paint.
Drive your vehicle when water vapor
condenses and accumulates inside the
exhaust pipes
When the vehicle is stopped for a
long time in winter while the engine is
running, water vapor may condense and
accumulate inside the exhaust pipes.
Water in the exhaust pipes may cause
noise, etc., but it is drained driving at
medium to high speed.
Do not let your parking brake freeze
Under some conditions your parking
brake can freeze in the engaged position.
This is most likely to happen when there
is an accumulation of snow or ice around
or near the rear brakes or if the brakes
are wet. When there is the risk that your
parking brake may freeze, temporarily
apply it with the gear in P (Park). Also,
block the rear wheels in advance, so the
vehicle may not roll. Then, release the
parking brake.
Do not let ice and snow accumulate
underneath
Under some conditions, snow and ice
can build up under the fenders and
interfere with the steering. When driving
in such conditions during the severe
winter, you should check underneath
the vehicle on a regular basis, to ensure
that the front wheels and the steering
components is unblocked.
Carry emergency equipment
In accordance with weather conditions,
you should carry appropriate emergency
equipment, while driving. Some of the
items you may want to carry include tire
chains, tow straps or chains, flashlight,
emergency flares, sand, shovel, jumper
cables, window scraper, gloves, ground
cloth, coveralls, blanket, etc.
Do not place objects or materials in the
engine compartment
Putting objects or materials in the engine
compartment may cause an engine
failure or combustion, because they may
block the engine cooling. Such damage
will not be covered by the manufacturer’s
warranty.
6-79
Driving your vehicle
TRAILER TOWING
If you are considering to tow with
your vehicle, you should first know
your country’s legal requirements. As
laws vary the requirements for towing
trailers, cars, or other types of vehicles or
apparatus may differ. When you are not
sure about a type of winter weight oil,
consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Remember that trailering is different
than just driving your vehicle by
itself. Trailering means changes in
handling, durability, and fuel economy.
Successful, safe trailering requires
correct equipment, and it has to be used
properly. Damage to your vehicle caused
by improper trailer towing is not covered
by your vehicle manufacturer’s warranty.
This section contains time-tested,
important trailering tips and safety
rules. Many of these are important for
your safety and that of your passengers.
Please read this section carefully before
you pull a trailer.
6-80
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
ś If you don’t use the correct
equipment and/or drive improperly,
you can lose control of the vehicle
when you are pulling a trailer. For
example, if the trailer is too heavy,
the braking performance may be
reduced. You and your passengers
could be seriously or fatally injured.
Pull a trailer only if you have followed
all the steps in this section.
ś Before towing, make sure the
total trailer weight, GCW (Gross
Combination Weight), GVW (Gross
Vehicle Weight), GAW (Gross Axle
Weight) and trailer tongue load are
all within the limits.
ś When you tow a trailer, make sure to
turn off the Idle Stop and Go system.
06
If you decide to pull a trailer?
Here are some important points if you
decide to pull a trailer:
ś Consider using a sway control. You
can ask a trailer hitch dealer about
sway control.
ś Do not do any towing with your
vehicle during its first 1,200 miles
(2,000 km) in order to allow the
engine to properly break in. Failure to
heed this caution may result in serious
engine or transmission damage.
ś When towing a trailer, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
further information on additional
requirements such as a towing kit, etc.
ś Always drive your vehicle at a
moderate speed (less than 60 mph
(100 km/h)) or posted towing speed
limit.
ś On a long uphill grade, do not exceed
45 mph (70 km/h) or the posted
towing speed limit, whichever is
lower.
ś Carefully observe the weight and load
limits provided in the following pages.
Trailer weight
Tongue Load
Total Trailer Weight
OOSH069129L
What is the maximum safe weight of a
trailer? It should never weigh more than
the maximum trailer weight with trailer
brakes. But even that can be too heavy.
It depends on how you plan to use your
trailer. For example, speed, altitude,
road grades, outside temperature and
how often your vehicle is used to pull a
trailer are all important. The ideal trailer
weight can also depend on any special
equipment that you have on your vehicle.
6-81
Driving your vehicle
Tongue load
Gross Axle Weight
WARNING
Gross Vehicle Weight
OOSH069130L
The tongue load is an important weight
to measure because it affects the
total Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) of
your vehicle. The trailer tongue should
weigh a maximum of 10% of the total
loaded trailer weight, within the limits
of the maximum trailer tongue load
permissible.
After you’ve loaded your trailer,
weigh the trailer and then the tongue,
separately, to see if the weights are
proper. If they aren’t, you may be able
to correct them simply by moving some
items around in the trailer.
6-82
Take the following precautions:
ś Never load a trailer with more weight
in the rear than in the front. The front
should be loaded with approximately
60% of the total trailer load; the rear
should be loaded with approximately
40% of the total trailer load.
ś Never exceed the maximum weight
limits of the trailer or trailer towing
equipment. Improper loading can
result in damage to your vehicle and/
or personal injury. Check weights
and loading at a commercial scale or
highway patrol office equipped with
scales.
Information
With increasing altitude the engine
performance decreases. From 1,000 m
above sea level and for every 1,000 m
thereafter 10% of vehicle/trailer weight
(trailer weighter + gross vehicle weight)
must be deducted.
06
Reference weight and distance when towing a trailer
Smartstream
G2.5 GDI
A/T
Smartstream
G2.5 TGDI
DCT
Without brake system
1,653 (750)
1,653 (750)
With brake system (PKG OPT)
2,000 (907)
2,000 (907)
2,800 (1,270)
3,500 (1,588)
280 (127)
350 (159)
Item
Maximum trailer
weight
lbs. (kg) With brake system (STD)
Maximum permissible static vertical load on the
coupling device
lbs. (kg)
Recommended distance from rear wheel center
to coupling point
inch (mm)
49.1 (1,248)
6-83
Driving your vehicle
Trailer towing equipment
Hitches
OTM060050L
Information
The mounting hole for hitches are located
on both sides of the underbody behind the
rear tires.
It’s important to have the correct hitch
equipment. Crosswinds, large trucks
going by, and rough roads are a few
reasons why you’ll need the right hitch.
Here are some rules to follow:
ś Do you have to make any holes in
the body of your vehicle when you
install a trailer hitch? If you do, then
be sure to seal the holes later when
you remove the hitch. If you don’t seal
them, carbon monoxide (CO) from
your exhaust can get into your vehicle,
as well as dirt and water.
ś The bumpers on your vehicle are not
intended for hitches. Do not attach
rental hitches or other bumper-type
hitches to them. Use only a framemounted hitch that does not attach to
the bumper.
6-84
ś Any part of the rear number plate or
lighting devices of the vehicle must
not be obscured by the mechanical
coupling device.
If the rear number plate and/or
lighting devices can be obscured
partially by any part of the mechanical
coupling device, mechanical coupling
devices that can not be easily
removed or repositioned without use
of any tools, except an easily operated
(for example, an effort not exceeding
20Nm) release key which is supplied
by the manufacturer of the coupling
device, are not permitted for use.
Please note that the mechanical
coupling device that is fitted and
not in use must always be removed
or repositioned if the rear number
plate and/or rear lighting devices
are obscured by any part of the
mechanical coupling device.
ś A HYUNDAI trailer hitch accessory is
available at an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
06
Safety chains
Driving with a trailer
You should always attach chains between
your vehicle and your trailer.
Instructions about safety chains may
be provided by the hitch manufacturer
or trailer manufacturer. Follow the
manufacturer’s recommendation for
attaching safety chains. Always leave just
enough slack so you can turn with your
trailer. And, never allow safety chains to
drag on the ground.
Towing a trailer requires a certain
amount of experience. Before setting
out for the open road, you must get to
know your trailer. Acquaint yourself with
the feel of handling and braking with the
added weight of the trailer. And always
keep in mind that the vehicle you are
driving is now longer and not nearly as
responsive as your vehicle is by itself.
Before you start, check the trailer hitch
and platform, safety chains, electrical
connector(s), lights, tires and brakes.
During your trip, occasionally check
to be sure that the load is secure, and
that the lights and trailer brakes are still
working.
Trailer brakes
If your trailer is equipped with a braking
system, make sure it conforms to
your country’s regulations and that
it is properly installed and operating
correctly.
If your trailer weighs more than the
maximum trailer weight without trailer
brakes loaded, then it needs its own
brakes and they must be adequate. Be
sure to read and follow the instructions
for the trailer brakes so you’ll be able
to install, adjust and maintain them
properly. Be sure not to modify your
vehicle’s brake system.
WARNING
Do not use a trailer with its own brakes
unless you are absolutely certain that
you have properly set up the brake
system. This is not a task for amateurs.
Use an experienced, competent trailer
shop for this work.
Distance
Stay at least twice as far behind the
vehicle ahead as you would when driving
your vehicle without a trailer. This can
help you avoid situations that require
heavy braking and sudden turns.
Passing
You will need more passing distance up
ahead when you’re towing a trailer. And,
because of the increased vehicle length,
you’ll need to go much farther beyond
the passed vehicle before you can return
to your lane.
6-85
Driving your vehicle
Backing up
Hold the bottom of the steering wheel
with one hand. Then, to move the trailer
to the left, move your hand to the left. To
move the trailer to the right, move your
hand to the right. Always back up slowly
and, if possible, have someone guide
you.
Making turns
When you’re turning with a trailer, make
wider turns than normal. Do this so your
trailer won’t strike soft shoulders, curbs,
road signs, trees, or other objects. Avoid
jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in
advance.
Turn signals
When you tow a trailer, your vehicle has
to have a different turn signal flasher and
extra wiring. The green arrows on your
instrument panel will flash whenever you
signal a turn or lane change. Properly
connected, the trailer lights will also flash
to alert other drivers you’re about to turn,
change lanes, or stop.
When towing a trailer, the green arrows
on your instrument panel will flash for
turns even if the bulbs on the trailer
are burned out. Thus, you may think
drivers behind you are seeing your
signals when, in fact, they are not. It’s
important to check occasionally to be
sure the trailer bulbs are still working.
You must also check the lights every time
you disconnect and then reconnect the
wires.
6-86
WARNING
Do not connect a trailer lighting system
directly to your vehicle’s lighting
system. Use an approved trailer wiring
harness. Failure to do so could result
in damage to the vehicle electrical
system and/or personal injury. Consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
Driving on hills
Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear
before you start down a long or steep
downgrade. If you don’t shift down, you
might have to use your brakes so much
that they would get overheated and may
not operate efficiently.
On a long uphill grade, shift down and
reduce your speed to around 45 mph (70
km/h) to reduce the possibility of engine
and transmission overheating.
If your trailer weighs more than the
maximum trailer weight without trailer
brakes and you have a automatic
transmission, you should drive in D
(Drive) when towing a trailer.
Operating your vehicle in D (Drive)
when towing a trailer will minimize heat
build-up and extend the life of your
transmission.
06
NOTICE
To prevent engine and/or transmission
overheating:
ś When towing a trailer on steep
grades (in excess of 6%) pay close
attention to the engine coolant
temperature gauge to ensure the
engine does not overheat. If the
needle of the coolant temperature
gauge moves towards “H” (HOT),
pull over and stop as soon as it is
safe to do so, and allow the engine
to idle until it cools down. You may
proceed once the engine has cooled
sufficiently.
ś If you tow a trailer with the maximum
gross vehicle weight and maximum
trailer weight, it can cause the
engine or transmission to overheat.
When driving in such conditions,
allow the engine to idle until it cools
down. You may proceed once the
engine or transmission has cooled
sufficiently.
ś When towing a trailer, your vehicle
speed may be much slower than the
general flow of traffic, especially
when climbing an uphill grade. Use
the right hand lane when towing a
trailer on an uphill grade. Choose
your vehicle speed according to the
maximum posted speed limit for
vehicles with trailers, the steepness
of the grade, and your trailer weight.
Parking on hills
Generally, if you have a trailer attached
to your vehicle, you should not park your
vehicle on a hill.
However, if you ever have to park your
trailer on a hill, here’s how to do it:
1. Pull the vehicle into the parking space.
Turn the steering wheel in the
direction of the curb (right if headed
down hill, left if headed up hill).
2. Shift the gear to P (Park).
3. Set the parking brake and shut off the
vehicle.
4. Place wheel chocks under the trailer
wheels on the down hill side of the
wheels.
5. Start the vehicle, hold the brakes, shift
to neutral, release the parking brake
and slowly release the brakes until the
trailer chocks absorb the load.
6. Reapply the brakes and parking
brakes.
7. Shift the gear to P (Park) when the
vehicle is parked on a uphill grade and
in R (Reverse) on a downhill.
8. Shut off the vehicle and release the
vehicle brakes but leave the parking
brake set.
WARNING
To prevent serious or fatal injury:
ś Do not get out of the vehicle without
the parking brake firmly set. If you
have left the engine running, the
vehicle can move suddenly. You and
others could be seriously or fatally
injured.
ś Do not apply the accelerator pedal to
hold the vehicle on an uphill.
6-87
Driving your vehicle
Driving the vehicle after it has been
parked on a hill
1. With the gear in P (Park), apply your
brakes and hold the brake pedal down
while you:
śStart your engine;
śShift into gear; and
śRelease the parking brake.
2. Slowly remove your foot from the
brake pedal.
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of
the chocks.
4. Stop and have someone pick up and
store the chocks.
Maintenance when towing a
trailer
Your vehicle will need service more
often when you regularly pull a trailer.
Important items to pay particular
attention to include engine oil,
transmission fluid, axle lubricant and
cooling system fluid. Brake condition
is another important item to frequently
check. If you’re trailering, it’s a good
idea to review these items before
you start your trip. Don’t forget to
also maintain your trailer and hitch.
Follow the maintenance schedule that
accompanied your trailer and check it
periodically. Preferably, conduct the
check at the start of each day’s driving.
Most importantly, all hitch nuts and bolts
should be tight.
6-88
NOTICE
To prevent vehicle damage:
ś Due to higher load during trailer
usage, overheating might occur on
hot days or during uphill driving.
If the coolant gauge indicates
over-heating, switch off the air
conditioner and stop the vehicle in a
safe area to cool down the engine.
ś Do not switch off the engine while
the coolant gauge indicates overheating.
(Keep the engine idle to cool down
the engine)
ś When towing check transmission
fluid more frequently.
ś If your vehicle is not equipped with
an air conditioner, you should install
a condenser fan to improve engine
performance when towing a trailer.
06
VEHICLE LOAD LIMIT
Two labels on your driver’s door sill show
how much weight your vehicle was
designed to carry: the Tire and Loading
Information Label and the Certification
Label.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize
yourself with the following terms for
determining your vehicle’s weight
ratings, from the vehicle’s specifications
and the Certification Label:
Base Curb Weight
This is the weight of the vehicle
including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not
include passengers, cargo, or optional
equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight
This is the weight of your new vehicle
when you picked it up from your dealer
plus any aftermarket equipment.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
that can be carried by a single axle (front
or rear). These numbers are shown on
the Certification Label. The total load on
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
This is the Base Curb Weight plus actual
Cargo Weight plus passengers.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
of the fully loaded vehicle (including
all options, equipment, passengers
and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the
Certification Label located on the driver’s
door sill.
Cargo Weight
This figure includes all weight added to
the Base Curb Weight, including cargo
and optional equipment.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight)
This is the total weight placed on each
axle (front and rear) - including vehicle
curb weight and all payload.
6-89
Driving your vehicle
The Loading Information Label
18 inch
Type A
19 inch
Type A
OTMA060004
OTMA060002
Type B
Type B
OTMA060005
OTMA060003
6-90
06
Vehicle capacity weight
20 inch
Type A
5 persons : 903 lbs. (410 kg)
Vehicle capacity weight is the maximum
combined weight of occupants and
cargo. If your vehicle is equipped with a
trailer, the combined weight includes the
tongue load.
Seating capacity
OTMA060006
Type B
OTMA060007
The label located on the driver’s door
sill gives the original tire size, cold
tire pressures recommended for your
vehicle, the number of people that can
be in your vehicle and vehicle capacity
weight.
Total : 5 persons (Front seat : 2 persons,
Rear seat : 3 persons)
Seating capacity is the maximum
number of occupants including a driver,
your vehicle may carry. However, the
seating capacity may be reduced based
upon the weight of all of the occupants,
and the weight of the cargo being carried
or towed. Do not overload the vehicle as
there is a limit to the total weight, or load
limit including occupants and cargo, the
vehicle can carry.
Towing capacity
With brake system (PKG OPT) : 2,000 lbs
(907 kg)
With brake system (STD) : 2,800 lbs
(1,270 kg) (GDI) / 3,500 lbs (1,588 kg)
(T-GDI)
Towing capacity is the maximum trailer
weight including its cargo weight, your
vehicle can tow.
Cargo capacity
The cargo capacity of your vehicle will
increase or decrease depending on the
weight and the number of occupants
and the tongue load, if your vehicle is
equipped with a trailer.
6-91
Driving your vehicle
Steps for determining correct load
limit
1. Locate the statement "The combined
weight of occupants and cargo should
never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on
your vehicle's placard.
2. Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will be
riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from XXX kg or
XXX lbs.
4. The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example,
if the "XXX" amount equals 1400
lbs. and there will be five 150 lb
passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and
luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
(1400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
5. Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo and
luggage load capacity calculated in
Step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult
this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
6-92
WARNING
Do not overload the vehicle as there
is a limit to the total weight, or load
limit, including occupants and cargo,
the vehicle can carry. Overloading can
shorten the life of the vehicle. If the
GVWR or the GAWR is exceeded, parts
on the vehicle can be broken and it can
change the handling of your vehicle.
These could cause you to lose control
and result in an accident.
06
Example 1
ŧ
+
Cargo Weight
(1100 lbs.)
(499 kg)
Passenger Weight
(150 lbs. × 2 = 300 lbs.)
(68 kg × 2 = 136 kg)
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
Example 2
ŧ
+
Cargo Weight
(650 lbs.)
(295 kg)
Passenger Weight
(150 lbs. × 5 = 750 lbs.)
(68 kg × 5 = 340 kg)
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
Example 3
ŧ
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
+
Passenger Weight
(172 lbs. × 5 = 860 lbs.)
(78 kg × 5 = 390 kg)
Cargo Weight
(540 lbs.)
(245 kg)
6-93
Driving your vehicle
Certification label
WARNING
OBH059070
The certification label is located on the
driver's door sill at the center pillar and
shows the maximum allowable weight of
the fully loaded vehicle. This is called the
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating). The
GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle,
all occupants, fuel and cargo.
This label also tells you the maximum
weight that can be supported by the
front and rear axles, called Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR).
The total weight of the vehicle, including
all occupants, accessories, cargo, and
trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or
the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
To find out the actual loads on your front
and rear axles, you need to go to a weigh
station and weigh your vehicle. Be sure
to spread out your load equally on both
sides of the centerline.
6-94
Overloading
ś Never exceed the GVWR for your
vehicle, the GAWR for either the front
or rear axle and vehicle capacity
weight. Exceeding these ratings
can affect your vehicle's handling
and braking ability, and cause an
accident.
ś Do not overload your vehicle.
Overloading your vehicle can cause
heat buildup in your vehicle's tires
and possible tire failure, increased
stopping distances and poor vehicle
handling-all of which may result in a
crash.
NOTICE
Overloading your vehicle may cause
damage. Repairs would not be covered
by your warranty. Do not overload your
vehicle.
WARNING
If you carry items inside your vehicle
(for example, suitcases, tools, packages,
or anything else), they are moving as
fast as the vehicle. If you have to stop
or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the
items will keep going and can cause
an injury if they strike the driver or a
passenger.
ś Put items in the cargo area of your
vehicle. Try to spread the weight
evenly.
ś Do not stack items like suitcases
inside the vehicle above the tops of
the seats.
ś Do not leave an unsecured child
restraint in your vehicle.
ś When you carry something inside the
vehicle, secure it.
7. Driver assistance system
Due to the infotainment software update, the description of each function of the driver assistance
system may differ from the owner's manual. In this case, for detailed information on updates, refer
to the separately supplied infotainment system manual.
Driving Safety
Forward Collision–Avoidance Assist (FCA) (Sensor fusion) .................................... 7-2
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) .......................................................................................7-18
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA) ........................................................ 7-25
Safe Exit Assist (SEA) ............................................................................................... 7-39
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) ............................................................................ 7-45
Blind-Spot View Monitor (BVM) ..............................................................................7-51
Driving Convenience
Smart Cruise Control (SCC) .................................................................................... 7-53
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control (NSCC) .................................................. 7-70
Lane Following Assist (LFA) .....................................................................................7-77
Highway Driving Assist (HDA) .................................................................................7-81
Parking Safety
Rear View Monitor (RVM) .......................................................................................7-88
Surround View Monitor (SVM) ............................................................................... 7-92
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist (RCCA) ......................................... 7-97
Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) .......................................................... 7-108
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) ............................................. 7-111
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist (PCA) .............................................. 7-116
Remote Smart Parking Assist (RSPA) ....................................................................7-123
Declaration of conformity .....................................................................................7-135
7
Driver assistance system
)25:$5'&2//,6,21Ǚ$92,'$1&($66,67ǣ)&$Ǥǣ6(1625
)86,21Ǥ
Basic function
Detecting sensor
OJX1070255L
OTM071001L
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist is
designed to help detect and monitor the
vehicle ahead or help detect a pedestrian
or cyclist in the roadway and warn the
driver that a collision is imminent with
a warning message and an audible
warning, and if necessary, apply
emergency braking.
Junction Turning function (if equipped)
OTM070022
[1] : Front view camera,
[2] : Front radar
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
OJX1070257L
Junction Turning function will help avoid
a collision with an oncoming vehicle in
an adjacent lane when turning left at
a crossroad with the turn signal on by
applying emergency braking.
7-2
07
CAUTION
Take the following precautions to
maintain optimal performance of the
detecting sensor:
ś Never disassemble the detecting
sensor or sensor assembly, or apply
any impact on it.
ś If the detecting sensors have been
replaced or repaired, have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Never install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield, or
tint the front windshield.
ś Exercise extreme caution to keep the
front view camera dry.
ś Never place any reflective objects
(for example, white paper, mirror)
over the dashboard. Any light
reflection may prevent Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist from
functioning properly.
ś Do not place any objects near the
front windshield or install any
accessories on the front windshield.
It can affect the performance of the
defogging and defrosting function
of the climate control system, which
may prevent the Driver Assistance
systems from operating.
ś Do not apply license plate frame or
objects, such as a bumper sticker,
film or a bumper guard, near the
front radar cover.
ś Always keep the front radar and
cover clean and free of dirt and
debris.
Use only a soft cloth to wash the
vehicle. Do not spray pressurized
water directly on the sensor or
sensor cover.
ś If unnecessary force has been
applied to the radar or around the
radar, Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not properly operate
even though a warning message
does not appear on the cluster.
Have the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Use only genuine parts to repair or
replace a damaged front radar cover.
Do not apply paint to the front radar
cover.
7-3
Driver assistance system
Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist Settings
Forward Safety
WARNING
When the engine is restarted, Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist will always
turn on. However, if ‘Off’ is selected
after the engine is restarted, the
driver should always be aware of the
surroundings and drive safely.
CAUTION
OTM070090N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ)RUZDUG6DIHW\ŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to set whether or not to
use each function.
- ,Iœ$FWLYH$VVLVWŔLVVHOHFWHG)RUZDUG
Collision-Avoidance Assist
- will warn the driver with a warning
message and an audible warning
depending on the collision risk
levels. Braking assist will be applied
depending on the collision risk.
- ,Iœ:DUQLQJ2QO\ŔLVVHOHFWHG)RUZDUG
Collision-Avoidance Assist will warn
the driver with a warning message
and an audible warning depending on
the collision risk levels. Braking will
not be assisted.
- ,Iœ2IIŔLVVHOHFWHG)RUZDUG&ROOLVLRQ
Avoidance Assist will turn off. The
warning light will illuminate on the
cluster.
The driver can monitor Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist ON/OFF status from the
warning light
Settings menu. If the
remains ON when Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist is ON, have the vehicle
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
7-4
ś If ‘Warning Only’ is selected, braking
is not assisted.
ś The settings for Forward Safety
include ‘Basic function’ and ‘Junction
Turning’ (if equipped).
Information
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will turn off when ESC is turned off by
pressing and holding the ESC OFF button
warning
for more than 3 seconds. The
light will illuminate on the cluster.
07
Warning Timing
Warning Volume
OTM070140N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the initial
warning activation time for Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist.
When the vehicle is first delivered,
:DUQLQJ7LPLQJLVVHWWRœ1RUPDOŔ,I\RX
change the Warning Timing, the warning
time of other Driver Assistance systems
may change.
OTM070141N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist.
If you change the warning volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
CAUTION
ś The setting of the Warning Timing
and Warning Volume applies to
all functions of Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist.
ś Even though ‘Normal’ is selected for
Warning Timing, if the front vehicle
suddenly stops, the initial warning
activation time may seem late.
ś Select ‘Late’ for Warning Timing
when traffic is light and when driving
speed is slow.
Information
If the engine is restarted, Warning Timing
and Warning Volume will maintain the
last setting.
7-5
Driver assistance system
Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist operation
Basic function
The basic function for Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist is to help warn and
control the vehicle depending on the
FROOLVLRQOHYHOœ&ROOLVLRQ:DUQLQJŔ
œ(PHUJHQF\%UDNLQJŔDQGœ6WRSSLQJ
YHKLFOHDQGHQGLQJEUDNHFRQWUROŔ
OTM070144N
Emergency Braking
OTM070143N
Collision Warning
ś To warn the driver of a collision, the
œ&ROOLVLRQ:DUQLQJŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
will appear on the cluster and an
audible warning will sound.
ś If a vehicle is detected in front,
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle speed
is between approximately 6~112 mph
(10~180 km/h).
ś If a pedestrian or cyclist is detected
in front, Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist will operate when your vehicle
speed is between approximately 6~53
mph (10~85 km/h).
ś ,Iœ$FWLYH$VVLVWŔLVVHOHFWHGEUDNLQJ
may be assisted.
7-6
ś To warn the driver that emergency
braking will be assisted, the
œ(PHUJHQF\%UDNLQJŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster
and an audible warning will sound.
ś If a vehicle is detected in front,
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle speed
is between approximately 6~47 mph
(10~75 km/h).
ś If a pedestrian or cyclist is detected
in front, Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist will operate when your vehicle
speed is between approximately 6~40
mph (10~65 km/h).
ś In emergency braking situation,
braking is assisted with strong braking
power by Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist to help prevent collision with
the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist
ahead.
07
Junction Turning function (if
equipped)
Junction Turning function will help warn
and control the vehicle depending on
WKHFROOLVLRQOHYHOœ&ROOLVLRQ:DUQLQJŔ
œ(PHUJHQF\%UDNLQJŔDQGœ6WRSSLQJ
YHKLFOHDQGHQGLQJEUDNHFRQWUROŔ
Left-hand drive
Right-hand drive
OTM070059L
Stopping vehicle and ending brake control
ś When the vehicle is stopped due
to emergency braking, the ‘Drive
FDUHIXOO\ŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
appear on the cluster.
For your safety, the driver should
depress the brake pedal immediately
and check the surroundings.
ś Brake control will end after the vehicle
is stopped by emergency braking for
approximately 2 seconds.
OTM070008N
OTM070200N
Collision Warning
ś To warn the driver of a collision, the
œ&ROOLVLRQ:DUQLQJŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
will appear on the cluster and an
audible warning will sound.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle
speed is between approximately
6~19 mph (10~30 km/h)and the
oncoming vehicle speed is between
approximately 19~44 mph (30~70
km/h).
ś ,Iœ$FWLYH$VVLVWŔLVVHOHFWHGEUDNLQJ
may be assisted.
7-7
Driver assistance system
Left-hand drive
OTM070009N
Right-hand drive
OTM070201N
OTM070059L
Emergency Braking
Stopping vehicle and ending brake control
ś To warn the driver that emergency
braking will be assisted, the
œ(PHUJHQF\%UDNLQJŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster
and an audible warning will sound.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle
speed is between approximately
6~19 mph (10~30 km/h) and the
oncoming vehicle speed is between
approximately 19~44 mph (30~70
km/h).
ś In an emergency braking situation,
braking is assisted with strong braking
power by Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist to help prevent a collision with
the oncoming vehicle.
ś When the vehicle is stopped due
to emergency braking, the ‘Drive
FDUHIXOO\ŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
appear on the cluster.
For your safety, the driver should
depress the brake pedal immediately
and check the surroundings.
ś Brake control will end after the vehicle
is stopped by emergency braking for
approximately 2 seconds.
Information
If the driver's seat is on the left side,
Junction Turning function will operate
only when the driver turns left. If the
driver's seat position is on right side, the
function will operate only when you turn
right.
7-8
07
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist:
ś For your safety, only change the
Settings after parking the vehicle at a
safe location.
ś With ‘Active Assist’ or ‘Warning Only’
selected, when ESC is turned off by
pressing and holding the ESC OFF
button for more than 3 seconds,
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will turn off automatically. In this
case, Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist cannot be set from the
warning
Settings menu and the
light will illuminate on the cluster
which is normal. If ESC is turned on
by pressing the ESC OFF button,
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will maintain the last setting.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
does not operate in all situations and
cannot avoid all collisions.
ś The driver has the responsibility to
control the vehicle. Do not solely
depend on Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist. Rather, maintain
a safe braking distance, and if
necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce driving speed or to stop
the vehicle.
ś Never deliberately operate Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist on people,
animal, objects, etc. It may cause
serious injury or death.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate if the driver
depresses the brake pedal to avoid
collision.
ś Depending on the road and driving
conditions, Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist may warn the driver
late or may not warn the driver.
ś During Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist operation, the vehicle may
stop suddenly injuring passengers
and shifting loose objects. Always
have the seat belt on and keep loose
objects secured.
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or audible
warning is generated, Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist warning
message may not be displayed
and audible warning may not be
generated.
ś You may not hear the warning sound
of Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist if the surroundings are noisy.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist may turn off or may not
operate properly or may operate
unnecessarily depending on the road
conditions and the surroundings.
WARNING
ś Even if there is a problem with
Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist, the vehicle’s basic braking
performance will operate normally.
ś During emergency braking, braking
control by Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist will automatically
cancel when the driver excessively
depresses the accelerator pedal or
sharply steers the vehicle.
7-9
Driver assistance system
CAUTION
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist operating speed range may
reduce due to the conditions of
the vehicle or pedestrian in front
or surroundings. Depending on the
speed, Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist may only warn the driver, or it
may not operate.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate under certain conditions
by judging the risk level based on
the condition of the oncoming
vehicle, driving direction, speed and
surroundings.
Information
ś In a situation where collision is
imminent, braking may be assisted by
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
when braking is insufficient by the
driver.
ś The images and colors in the
instrument cluster may differ
depending on the cluster type or theme
selected from the instrument cluster.
7-10
Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist malfunction and
limitations
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
malfunction
Type A
Type B
OTM070094N
OTM070094L
When Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist is not working properly, the ‘Check
)RUZDUG6DIHW\V\VWHP V ŔZDUQLQJ
and
message will appear, and the
warning lights will illuminate on the
cluster. Have the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
07
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
disabled
OTM070093N
OTM070095N
When the front windshield where the
front view camera is located, front radar
cover or sensor is covered with foreign
material, such as snow or rain, it can
reduce the detecting performance and
temporarily limit or disable Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist.
If this occurs the ‘Forward Safety
V\VWHP V GLVDEOHG&DPHUDREVFXUHGŔRU
the ‘Forward Safety system(s) disabled.
5DGDUEORFNHGŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
and
warning lights will
and the
illuminate on the cluster.
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist will
operate normally when when such snow,
rain or foreign material is removed.
If Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
does not operate normally after
obstruction (snow, rain, or foreign
material) is removed, have the vehicle
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
ś Even though the warning message or
warning light does not appear on the
cluster, Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not properly operate.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not properly operate in an area
(for example, open terrain), where
any substance are not detected after
turning ON the engine.
Limitations of Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not operate normally, or Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist may operate
unexpectedly under the following
circumstances:
ś The detecting sensor or the
surroundings are contaminated or
damaged
ś The temperature around the front
view camera is high or low due to
surrounding environment
ś The camera lens is contaminated due
to tinted, filmed or coated windshield,
damaged glass, or stuck of foreign
material (sticker, bug, etc.) on the
glass
ś Moisture is not removed or frozen on
the windshield
ś Washer fluid is continuously sprayed,
or the wiper is on
ś Driving in heavy rain or snow, or thick
fog
ś The field of view of the front view
camera is obstructed by sun glare
ś Street light or light from an oncoming
vehicle is reflected on the wet road
surface, such as a puddle on the road
ś An object is placed on the dashboard
7-11
Driver assistance system
ś Your vehicle is being towed
ś The surrounding is very bright
ś The surrounding is very dark, such as
in a tunnel, etc.
ś The brightness changes suddenly, for
example when entering or exiting a
tunnel
ś The brightness outside is low, and the
headlights are not on or are not bright
ś Driving through steam, smoke or
shadow
ś Only part of the vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist is detected
ś The vehicle in front is a bus, heavy
truck, truck with a unusually shaped
luggage, trailer, etc.
ś The vehicle in front has no tail lights,
tail lights are located unusually, etc.
ś The brightness outside is low, and the
tail lamps are not on or are not bright
ś The rear of the front vehicle is small
or the vehicle does not look normal,
such as when the vehicle is tilted,
overturned, or the side of the vehicle
is visible, etc.
ś 7KHIURQWYHKLFOHŔVJURXQGFOHDUDQFHLV
low or high
ś A vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist
suddenly cuts in front
ś The bumper around the front radar is
impacted, damaged or the front radar
is out of position
ś The temperature around the front
radar is high or low
7-12
ś Driving through a tunnel or iron bridge
ś Driving in large areas where there
are few vehicles or structures (for
example, desert, meadow, suburb,
etc.)
ś Driving near areas containing metal
substances, such as a construction
zone, railroad, etc.
ś A material is near that reflects very
well on the front radar, such as a
guardrail, nearby vehicle, etc.
ś The cyclist in front is on a bicycle
made of material that does not reflect
on the front radar
ś The vehicle in front is detected late
ś The vehicle in front is suddenly
blocked by an obstacle
ś The vehicle in front suddenly changes
lane or suddenly reduces speed
ś The vehicle in front is bent out of
shape
ś 7KHIURQWYHKLFOHŔVVSHHGLVIDVWRU
slow
ś The vehicle in front steers in the
opposite direction of your vehicle to
avoid a collision
ś With a vehicle in front, your vehicle
changes lane at low speed
ś The vehicle in front is covered with
snow
ś You are departing or returning to the
lane
ś Unstable driving
ś You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front is not detected
ś You are continuously driving in a circle
ś The vehicle in front has an unusual
shape
ś The vehicle in front is driving uphill or
downhill
07
ś The pedestrian or cyclist is not
fully detected, for example, if the
pedestrian is leaning over or is not
fully walking upright
ś The pedestrian or cyclist is wearing
clothing or equipment that makes it
difficult to detect as a pedestrian or
cyclist
OADAS044
The illustration above shows the image
the front view camera is capable of
detecting as a vehicle, pedestrian and
cyclist.
ś The pedestrian or cyclist in front is
moving very quickly
ś The pedestrian or cyclist in front is
short or is posing a low posture
ś The pedestrian or cyclist in front has
impaired mobility
ś The pedestrian or cyclist in front is
moving intersected with the driving
direction
ś There is a group of pedestrians,
cyclists or a large crowd in front
ś The pedestrian or cyclist is wearing
clothing that easily blends into the
background, making it difficult to
detect
ś The pedestrian or cyclist is difficult to
distinguish from the similar shaped
structure in the surroundings
ś You are driving by a pedestrian,
cyclist, traffic sign, structure, etc.,
near the intersection
ś Driving in a parking lot
ś Driving through a tollgate,
construction area, unpaved road,
partial paved road, uneven road,
speed bumps, etc.
ś Driving on an incline road, curved
road, etc.
ś Driving through a roadside with trees
or streetlights
ś The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
ś Your vehicle height is low or high
due to heavy loads, abnormal tire
pressure, etc.
ś Driving through a narrow road where
trees or grass are overgrown
ś There is interference by
electromagnetic waves, such as
driving in an area with strong radio
waves or electrical noise
7-13
Driver assistance system
WARNING
ś Driving on a curved road
OADAS015
OADAS014
OADAS017
OADAS016
OADAS018
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not detect other vehicles,
pedestrians or cyclists in front of you
on curved roads adversely affecting
the performance of the sensors. This
may result in no warning or braking
assist when necessary.
When driving on a curve, you must
maintain a safe braking distance,
and if necessary, steer the vehicle
and depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
7-14
OADAS019
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may detect a vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist in the next lane or outside the
lane when driving on a curved road.
If this occurs, Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist may unnecessarily
warn the driver and control the
brake. Always check the traffic
conditions around the vehicle.
07
ś Driving on an inclined road
ś Changing lanes
OADAS012
OADAS010
OADAS030
OADAS011
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not detect other vehicles,
pedestrians or cyclists in front of
you while driving uphill or downhill
adversely affecting the performance
of the sensors.
This may result in unnecessary
warning or braking assist, or no
warning or braking assist when
necessary.
Also, vehicle speed may rapidly
decrease when a vehicle, pedestrian
or cyclist ahead is suddenly
detected.
Always have your eyes on the road
while driving uphill or downhill and
if necessary, steer your vehicle and
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
[A] : Your vehicle,
[B] : Lane changing vehicle
When a vehicle moves into your lane
from an adjacent lane, it cannot
be detected by the sensor until it
is in the sensor's detection range.
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not immediately detect the
vehicle when the vehicle changes
lanes abruptly. In this case, you must
maintain a safe braking distance,
and if necessary, steer your vehicle
and depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
7-15
Driver assistance system
ś Detecting vehicle
OTM070147
OADAS031
[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Lane changing vehicle,
[C] : Same lane vehicle
When a vehicle in front of you
merges out of the lane, Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist may not
immediately detect the vehicle that
is now in front of you. In this case,
you must maintain a safe braking
distance, and if necessary, steer your
vehicle and depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
7-16
If the vehicle in front of you has
cargo that extends rearward from
the cab, or when the vehicle in front
of you has higher ground clearance,
additional special attention is
required. Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist may not be able
to detect the cargo extending from
the vehicle. In these instances,
you must maintain a safe braking
distance from the rearmost object,
and if necessary, steer your vehicle
and depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain distance.
07
WARNING
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, we recommend that
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist is
turned off due to safety reasons.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may operate if objects that are
similar in shape or characteristics to
vehicles, pedestrians and cyclists are
detected.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
does not operate on bicycles,
motorcycles, or smaller wheeled
objects, such as luggage bags,
shopping carts, or strollers.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate normally if
interfered by strong electromagnetic
waves.
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not operate for 15 seconds after
the vehicle is started, or the front
view camera is initialized.
Information
In some instances, Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist may be cancelled when
subjected to electromagnetic interference.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the device.
7-17
Driver assistance system
/$1(.((3,1*$66,67ǣ/.$Ǥ
Lane Keeping Assist is designed to help
detect lane markings (or road edges)
while driving over a certain speed. Lane
Keeping Assist will warn the driver if the
vehicle leaves the lane without using the
turn signal, or will automatically assist
WKHGULYHUŔVVWHHULQJWRKHOSSUHYHQWWKH
vehicle from departing the lane.
Lane Keeping Assist Settings
Lane Safety
Detecting sensor
OTM070184N
OTM071001L
[1] : Front view camera
The front view camera is used as a
detecting sensor to detect lane markings
(or road edges).
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting sensor.
CAUTION
For more details on the precautions
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
7-18
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ/DQH6DIHW\ŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to set whether or not to
use each function.
- ,Iœ$VVLVWŔLVVHOHFWHG/DQH.HHSLQJ
Assist will automatically assist the
GULYHUŔVVWHHULQJZKHQODQHGHSDUWXUH
is detected to help prevent the vehicle
from moving out of its lane.
- If 'Warning Only' is selected, Lane
Keeping Assist will warn the driver
with an audible warning when lane
departure is detected. The driver must
steer the vehicle.
- ,Iœ2IIŔLVVHOHFWHG/DQH.HHSLQJ$VVLVW
indicator light
will turn off. The
will turn off on the cluster.
WARNING
ś If 'Warning Only' is selected, steering
is not assisted.
ś Lane Keeping Assist does not control
the steering wheel when the vehicle
is driven in the middle of the lane.
ś The driver should always be aware
of the surroundings and steer the
vehicle if ‘Off’ is selected.
07
Warning Volume
Turning Lane Keeping Assist On/Off
(Lane Safety button)
OTM070141N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Lane Keeping Assist.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may be changed.
OTMA070001C
With the engine on, press and hold
the Lane Safety button located on
the instrument panel to turn on Lane
indicator
Keeping Assist. The white
light will illuminate on the cluster.
Press and hold the button again to turn
off the function.
If the engine is restarted, Lane Keeping
Assist will maintain the last setting.
Information
When Lane Keeping Assist is turned off
with the Lane Safety button, Lane Safety
settings will turn off.
7-19
Driver assistance system
Turning Lane Keeping Assist On/Off
(Lane Driving Assist button)
Lane Keeping Assist Operation
Warning and control
Lane Keeping Assist will help warn
and help control the vehicle with Lane
Departure Warning and Lane Keeping
Assist.
Left
Right
OTM070063
With the engine on, press and hold the
Lane Driving Assist button located on the
steering wheel to turn on Lane Keeping
indicator light will
Assist. The white
illuminate on the cluster.
Press and hold the button again to turn
off the function.
If the engine is restarted, Lane Keeping
Assist will maintain the last setting.
CAUTION
When the Lane Driving Assist button is
pressed shortly, Lane Following Assist
will turn on and off.
7-20
OTM070027
OTM070028
Lane Departure Warning
ś To warn the driver that the vehicle is
departing from the projected lane in
indicator light
front, the green
will blink on the cluster, the lane line
will blink on the cluster depending on
which direction the vehicle is veering,
and an audible warning will sound.
ś Lane Keeping Assist will operate
when your vehicle speed is between
approximately 40~120 mph (60~200
km/h).
07
Lane Keeping Assist
ś To warn the driver that the vehicle
is departing from the projected lane
indicator
in front, the green
light will blink on the cluster, and the
steering wheel will make adjustments
to keep the vehicle inside the lane.
ś Lane Keeping Assist will operate
when your vehicle speed is between
approximately 40~120 mph (60~200
km/h).
OTM070037N
WARNING
ś The steering wheel may not be
assisted if the steering wheel is held
very tight or the steering wheel is
steered over a certain degree.
ś Lane Keeping Assist does not operate
at all times. It is the responsibility of
the driver to safely steer the vehicle
and to maintain the vehicle in its
lane.
ś The hands–off warning message
may appear late depending on road
conditions. Always have your hands
on the steering wheel while driving.
ś If the steering wheel is held very
lightly, the hands–off warning
message may appear because Lane
Keeping Assist may not recognize
that the driver has their hands on the
steering wheel.
ś If you attach objects to the steering
wheel, the hands-off warning may
not work properly.
Hands-off warning
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds, the
œ3ODFHKDQGVRQWKHVWHHULQJZKHHOŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster, and an audible warning will
sound in stages.
7-21
Driver assistance system
Information
ś You may change settings from the
instrument cluster (User Settings) or
infotainment system (Vehicle Settings),
whichever option that is provided with
your vehicle. For more details, see
"User Settings" section in chapter 4, or
"Vehicle Settings" section in supplied
Infotainment Manual.
ś When lane markings (or road edges)
are detected, the lane lines on the
cluster will change from grey to white
indicator light will
and the green
illuminate.
Lane undetected
Lane detected
Lane Keeping Assist Malfunction
and Limitations
Lane Keeping Assist Malfunction
OTM070035N
When Lane Keeping Assist is not working
properly, the ‘Check Lane Keeping Assist
/.$ V\VWHPŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
indicator
appear and the yellow
light will illuminate on the cluster. If this
occurs, have the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OTM070025
OTM070026
ś Even though the steering is assisted by
Lane Keeping Assist, the driver may
control the steering wheel.
ś The steering wheel may feel heavier
or lighter when the steering wheel is
assisted by Lane Keeping Assist than
when it is not.
ś The images and colors in the
instrument cluster may differ
depending on the cluster type or theme
selected from the instrument cluster.
7-22
07
Limitations of Lane Keeping Assist
Lane Keeping Assist may not operate
normally or may operate unexpectedly
under the following circumstances:
ś The lane is contaminated or difficult
to distinguish because,
- The lane markings (or road edge)
is covered with rain, snow, dirt, oil,
etc.
- The color of the lane marking (or
road edge) is not distinguishable
from the road
- There are markings (or road edges)
on the road near the lane or the
markings (or road edges) on the
road looks similar to the lane
markings (or road edge)
- The lane marking (or road edge) is
indistinct or damaged
- The shadow is on the lane marking
(or road edge) by a median strip,
trees, guardrail, noise barriers, etc.
ś There are more than two lane
markings (or road edges) on the road
ś The number of lanes change or the
lanes merge
ś The lane markings (or road edges) are
complicated or a structure substitutes
for the lines, such as a construction
area
ś There are road markings, such as
zigzag lanes, crosswalk markings and
road signs
ś The lane suddenly disappears, such as
at the intersection
ś The lane (or road width) is very wide
or narrow
ś There is a road edge without a lane
ś There is a boundary structure in the
roadway, such as a tollgate, sidewalk,
curb, etc.
ś The distance to the front vehicle is
extremely short or the vehicle in front
is covering the lane marking (or road
edge)
For more details on the limitations
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Lane Keeping Assist:
ś The driver has the responsibility to
safely drive and control the vehicle.
Do not solely rely on Lane Keeping
Assist and drive dangerously.
ś The operation of Lane Keeping
Assist can be cancelled or not
work properly depending on road
conditions and surroundings. Always
be cautious while driving.
ś Refer to “Limitations of Lane Keeping
Assist” if the lane is not detected
properly.
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, we recommend that
Lane Keeping Assist is turned off due
to safety reasons.
ś If the vehicle is driven at high speed,
the steering wheel will not be
controlled. The driver must always
follow the speed limit when using
Lane Keeping Assist.
7-23
Driver assistance system
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or audible
warning is generated, Lane Keeping
Assist warning message may not be
displayed and audible warning may
not be generated.
ś You may not hear the warning
sound of Lane Keeping Assist if the
surroundings are noisy.
ś If you attach objects to the steering
wheel, steering may not be assisted
properly.
ś Lane Keeping Assist may not operate
for 15 seconds after the vehicle is
started, or the front view camera is
initialized.
ś Lane Keeping Assist will not operate
when:
- The turn signal or hazard warning
flasher is turned on
- The vehicle is not driven in the
center of the lane when Lane
Keeping Assist is turned on or right
after changing a lane
- ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
or VSM (Vehicle Stability
Management) is activated
- The vehicle is driven on a sharp
curve
- 35 mph (55 km/h) or above 130
mph (210 km/h)
- The vehicle makes sudden lane
changes
- The vehicle brakes suddenly
7-24
07
%/,1'ǘ6327&2//,6,21ǘ$92,'$1&($66,67ǣ%&$Ǥǣ,)
(48,33('Ǥ
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
is designed to help detect and monitor
DSSURDFKLQJYHKLFOHVLQWKHGULYHUŔV
blind spot area and warn the driver
of a possible collision with a warning
message and audible warning.
In addition, if there is a risk of collision
when changing lanes or driving forward
out of a parking space, Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist will help avoid
a collision by applying the brake.
OJX1079026
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
helps detect and informs the driver that
a vehicle is approaching at high speed
from the blind spot area.
CAUTION
Warning timing may vary depending on
the speed of the vehicle approaching at
high speed.
OJX1079256
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
helps detect and inform the driver that a
vehicle is in the blind spot.
CAUTION
The detecting range may vary
depending on the speed of your vehicle.
However, even if there is a vehicle in the
blind spot area, Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist may not warn you
when you pass by at high speeds.
OJX1079027
When changing lanes by detecting
the lane ahead, if Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist judges that there is a
collision risk with an approaching vehicle
in the blind spot, the function will help
avoid a collision by applying the brake.
7-25
Driver assistance system
Detecting sensor
OJX1079028
When you are driving forward out of a
parking space, if Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist judges that there is a
collision risk with an approaching vehicle
in the blind spot, the function will help
avoid a collision by applying the brake.
OTM071001L
OTM071002L
[1] : Front view camera,
[2] : Rear corner radar
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
7-26
07
CAUTION
Take the following precautions to
maintain optimal performance of the
detecting sensor:
ś Never disassemble the rear corner
radar or radar assembly, or apply any
impact on it.
ś If there is impact on the rear corner
radar or near the radar, even though
the warning message does not
appear on the cluster, Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist may not
operate properly. Have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś If the rear corner radars have
been replaced or repaired, have
the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Use only genuine parts to repair the
rear bumper where the rear corner
radar is located.
ś Do not apply license plate frame or
objects, such as a bumper sticker,
film or a bumper guard near the rear
corner radar.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not work properly if the
bumper has been replaced, or the
surroundings of the rear corner radar
has been damaged or paint has been
applied.
ś If a trailer, carrier, etc., is installed,
it may adversely affect the
performance of the rear corner radar
or it may not operate.
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist Settings
Blind-Spot Safety
OTM070096N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ%OLQG6SRW6DIHW\ŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to set whether or not to
use each function.
- ,Iœ$FWLYH$VVLVWŔLVVHOHFWHG%OLQG6SRW
Collision-Avoidance Assist will warn
the driver with a warning message, an
audible warning and braking assist will
be applied depending on the collision
risk levels.
- ,Iœ:DUQLQJ2QO\ŔLVVHOHFWHG%OLQG
Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
will warn the driver with a warning
message and an audible warning
depending on the collision risk levels.
Braking will not be assisted.
- ,Iœ2IIŔLVVHOHFWHG%OLQG6SRW
Collision-Avoidance Assist will turn
off.
For more details on the precautions
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
7-27
Driver assistance system
Warning Timing
OTM070097N
When the engine is restarted with BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist off,
WKHœ%OLQG6SRW6DIHW\6\VWHPLV2IIŔ
message will appear on the cluster.
,I\RXFKDQJHWKHVHWWLQJIURPœ2IIŔWR
œ$FWLYH$VVLVWŔRUœ:DUQLQJ2QO\ŔWKH
warning light on the side view mirror will
blink for three seconds.
In addition, if the engine is turned on,
when Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
$VVLVWLVVHWWRœ$FWLYH$VVLVWŔRUœ:DUQLQJ
2QO\ŔWKHZDUQLQJOLJKWRQWKHVLGHYLHZ
mirror will blink for three seconds.
WARNING
ś If ‘Warning Only’ is selected, braking
is not assisted.
ś If ‘Off’ is selected, the driver should
always be aware of the surroundings
and drive safely.
Information
If the engine is restarted, Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist will maintain
the last setting.
7-28
OTM070140N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the initial
warning activation time for Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist.
When the vehicle is first delivered,
:DUQLQJ7LPLQJLVVHWWRœ1RUPDOŔ,I\RX
change the Warning Timing, the warning
time of other Driver Assistance systems
may change.
07
Warning Volume
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist Operation
Vehicle detection
OTM070141N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the warning volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
CAUTION
ś The setting of the Warning Timing
and Warning Volume applies to all
functions of the Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist.
ś Even though ‘Normal’ is selected
for Warning Timing, if the vehicles
approaches at high speed, the initial
warning activation time may seem
late.
ś Select ‘Late’ for Warning Timing
when traffic is light and when driving
speed is slow.
OHY059034
ś To warn the driver a vehicle is
detected, the warning light on the
side view mirror and head-up display
(if equipped) will illuminate.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle speed
is above 12 mph (20 km/h) and the
speed of the vehicle in the blind spot
area is above 7 mph (10 km/h).
7-29
Driver assistance system
Collision Warning
ś Collision warning will operate when
the turn signal is turned on in the
direction of the detected vehicle.
ś ,Iœ:DUQLQJ2QO\ŔLVVHOHFWHGIURPWKH
Settings menu, the collision warning
will operate when your vehicle
approaches the lane the blind spot
vehicle is detected.
ś To warn the driver of a collision, the
warning light on the side view mirror
and head-up display (if equipped) will
blink. At the same time, an audible
warning will sound.
ś When the turn signal is turned off or
you move away from the lane, the
collision warning will be canceled and
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
will return to vehicle detection state.
7-30
WARNING
ś The detecting range of the rear
corner radar is determined by a
standard road width, therefore, on
a narrow road, Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist may detect other
vehicles in the next next lane and
warn you. In contrast, on a wide
road, Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not be able to detect a
vehicle driving in the next lane and
may not warn you.
ś When the hazard warning flasher is
on, the collision warning by the turn
signal will not operate.
Information
ś If the driver's seat is on the left side, the
collision warning may occur when you
turn left. Maintain a proper distance
with the vehicles in the left lane. If the
driver's seat is on the right side, the
collision warning may occur when you
turn right. Maintain a proper distance
with the vehicles in the right lane.
ś The images and colors in the
instrument cluster may differ
depending on the cluster type or theme
selected from the instrument cluster.
07
Collision-Avoidance Assist (while
driving)
OTM070017N
ś To warn the driver of a collision, the
warning light on the side view mirror
will blink and a warning message will
appear on the cluster. At the same
time, an audible warning will sound
and warning light on the head-up
display (if equipped) will blink.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle speed
is between 40~120 mph (60~200
km/h) and both lane markings of the
driving lane are detected.
ś Emergency braking will be assisted to
help prevent collision with the vehicle
in the blind spot area.
WARNING
ś Collision-Avoidance Assist will
be canceled under the following
circumstances:
- Your vehicle enters the next lane
by a certain distance
- Your vehicle is away from the
collision risk
- The steering wheel is sharply
steered
- The brake pedal is depressed
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
is operating
ś After Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist operation or lane change,
you must drive to the center of the
lane. Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist will not operate if the vehicle is
not driven in the center of the lane.
7-31
Driver assistance system
Collision-Avoidance Assist (while
departing)
OTM070240N
ś To warn the driver of a collision, the
warning light on the side view mirror
will blink and a warning message will
appear on the cluster. At the same
time, an audible warning will sound
and warning light on the head-up
display (if equipped) will blink.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate when your vehicle speed
is below 2 mph (3 km/h) and the
speed of the vehicle in the blind spot
area is above 3 mph (5 km/h).
ś Emergency braking will be assisted to
help prevent collision with the vehicle
in the blind spot area.
7-32
Stopping vehicle and ending brake
control
OTM070059L
ś When the vehicle is stopped due
to emergency braking, the ‘Drive
FDUHIXOO\ŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
appear on the cluster.
For your safety, the driver should
depress the brake pedal immediately
and check the surroundings.
ś Brake control will end after the vehicle
is stopped by emergency braking for
approximately 2 seconds.
07
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist:
ś For your safety, only change the
Settings after parking the vehicle at a
safe location.
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or audible
warning is generated, Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist’s warning
message may not be displayed
and audible warning may not be
generated.
ś You may not hear the warning sound
of Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist if the surroundings are noisy.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate if the driver
applies the brake pedal to avoid
collision.
ś When Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist is operating, braking control
by the function will automatically
cancel when the driver excessively
depresses the accelerator pedal or
sharply steers the vehicle.
ś During Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist operation, the
vehicle may stop suddenly injuring
passengers and shifting loose
objects. Always have the seat belt on
and keep loose objects secured.
ś Even if there is a problem with BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist, the
vehicle’s basic braking performance
will operate normally.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
does not operate in all situations and
cannot avoid all collisions.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may warn the driver late or
may not warn the driver depending
on the road and driving conditions.
ś Driver should maintain control of the
vehicle at all times. Do not depend
on Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist. Maintain a safe braking
distance, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce driving
speed or to stop the vehicle.
ś Never operate Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist on people, animal,
objects, etc. It may cause serious
injury or death.
WARNING
The brake control may not operate
properly depending on the status of
ESC (Electronic Stability Control).
There will only be a warning when:
- The ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
warning light is on
- ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
engaged in a different function
7-33
Driver assistance system
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist malfunction and
limitations
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist disabled
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist malfunction
OTM070098N
OTM070099N
When Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist is not working properly, the ‘Check
%OLQG6SRW6DIHW\V\VWHP V ŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster, and
the function will turn off automatically
or the function will be limited. Have the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
When the rear bumper around the rear
corner radar or sensor is covered with
foreign material, such as snow or rain,
or installing a trailer or carrier, it can
reduce the detecting performance and
temporarily limit or disable Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist.
If this occurs, the ‘Blind-Spot Safety
V\VWHP V GLVDEOHG5DGDUEORFNHGŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster.
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
will operate normally when such foreign
material or trailer, etc., is removed, and
then the engine is restarted.
If Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
does not operate normally after it is
removed, have the vehicle be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
OTM070100N
When the side view mirror warning
light is not working properly, the ‘Check
VLGHYLHZPLUURUZDUQLQJOLJKWŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster.
Have the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-34
ś Even though the warning message
does not appear on the cluster, BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist may
not properly operate.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not properly operate in
an area (for example, open terrain)
where any objects are not detected
right after the engine is turned on, or
when the detecting sensor is blocked
with foreign material right after the
engine is turned on.
07
CAUTION
Turn off Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or
remove the trailer, carrier, etc., to use
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist.
Limitations of Blind-Spot Collision
Avoidance Assist
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not operate normally, or it may
operate unexpectedly under the
following circumstances:
ś There is inclement weather, such as
heavy snow, heavy rain, etc.
ś The rear corner radar is covered with
snow, rain, dirt, etc.
ś The temperature around the rear
corner radar is high or low
ś Driving on a highway (or motorway)
ramp
ś The road pavement (or the peripheral
ground) abnormally contains metallic
components (for example, possibly
due to subway construction)
ś There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as sound barriers,
guardrails, central dividers, entry
barriers, street lamps, signs,
tunnels, walls, etc. (including double
structures)
ś Driving in large areas where there
are few vehicles or structures (for
example, desert, meadow, suburb,
etc.)
ś Driving through a narrow road where
trees or grass are overgrown
ś Driving on a wet road surface, such as
a puddle on the road
ś The other vehicle drives very close
behind your vehicle, or the other
vehicle passes by your vehicle in close
proximity
ś The speed of the other vehicle is very
fast that it passes by your vehicle in a
short time
ś Your vehicle passes by the other
vehicle
ś Your vehicle changes lane
ś Your vehicle has started at the same
time as the vehicle next to you and
has accelerated
ś The vehicle in the next lane moves
two lanes away from you, or when the
vehicle two lanes away moves to the
next lane from you
ś A trailer or carrier is installed around
the rear corner radar
ś The bumper around the rear corner
radar is covered with objects, such as
a bumper sticker, bumper guard, bike
rack, etc.
ś The bumper around the rear corner
radar is impacted, damaged or the
radar is out of position
ś Your vehicle height is low or high
due to heavy loads, abnormal tire
pressure, etc.
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not operate normally, or it may
operate unexpectedly when the
following objects are detected:
ś A motorcycle or bicycle is detected
ś A vehicle such as a flat trailer is
detected
ś A big vehicle such as a bus or truck is
detected
ś A moving obstacle such as a
pedestrian, animal, shopping cart or a
baby stroller is detected
ś A vehicle with low height such as a
sports car is detected
7-35
Driver assistance system
%UDNLQJFRQWUROPD\QRWZRUNGULYHUŔV
attention is required in the following
circumstances:
ś The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road, uneven
road or concrete patch
ś Driving on a slippery surface due to
snow, water puddle, ice, etc.
ś The tire pressure is low or a tire is
damaged
ś The brake is reworked
ś The vehicle makes abrupt lane
changes
WARNING
ś Driving on a curved road
OJX1079057
For more details on the limitations
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” and “Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)”
section in chapter 7.
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate properly
when driving on a curved road. The
function may not detect the vehicle
in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
OJX1079058
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate properly
when driving on a curved road. The
function may recognize a vehicle in
the same lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
7-36
07
ś Driving where the road is merging/
dividing
ś Driving on an inclined road
OTM070031
OJX1079059
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate properly
when driving where the road merges
or divides. The function may not
detect the vehicle in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not operate properly when
driving on a slope. The function may
not detect the vehicle in the next
lane or may incorrectly detect the
ground or structure.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
7-37
Driver assistance system
ś Driving where the heights of the
lanes are different
OTM070032
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate properly
when driving where the heights of
the lanes are different. The function
may not detect the vehicle on a
road with different lane heights
(underpass joining section, grade
separated intersections, etc.).
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
WARNING
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, make sure that
you turn off Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate normally if
interfered by strong electromagnetic
waves.
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate for 3 seconds
after the vehicle is started, or the
front view camera or rear corner
radars are initialized.
7-38
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the device.
Information
Radio frequency radiation exposure
information:
This equipment complies with FCC
radiation exposure limits set forth for an
uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and
operated with minimum distance of 8 in.
(20 cm) between the radiator (antenna)
and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or
operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter.
07
6$)((;,7$66,67ǣ6($Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Detecting sensor
OTM070238
After the vehicle stops, when an
approaching vehicle from the rear area is
detected as soon as a passenger opens a
door, Safe Exit Assist will warn the driver
with a warning message and an audible
warning to help prevent a collision.
OTM071146L
[1] : Rear corner radar
The rear corner radars are sensors
located inside the rear bumper to detect
the side and rear areas. Always keep the
rear bumper clean for proper operation
of Safe Exit Assist.
NOTICE
For more details on the precautions of
the rear corner radars, refer to “BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)”
section in chapter 7.
OTM070039
In addition, when the electronic child
safety lock button is in the LOCK position
and an approaching vehicle from the
rear area is detected, the electronic child
safety lock button will not unlock even if
the driver presses the button to prevent
the rear doors from opening.
CAUTION
Warning timing may vary depending on
the speed of the approaching vehicle.
7-39
Driver assistance system
Warning Timing
Safe Exit Assist Settings
Safe Exit Assist
OTM070140N
OTM070038N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ%OLQG6SRW6DIHW\Ɵ6DIH
([LW$VVLVW 6($ RU6($ 6DIH([LW$VVLVW Ŕ
from the Settings menu to turn on Safe
Exit Assist and deselect to turn off the
function.
WARNING
The driver should always be aware of
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. If ‘Safe Exit Assist’ is
deselected, the function cannot assist
you.
Information
If the engine is restarted, Safe Exit Assist
will maintain the last setting.
7-40
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the initial
warning activation time for Safe Exit
Assist.
When the vehicle is first delivered,
:DUQLQJ7LPLQJLVVHWWRœ1RUPDOŔ,I\RX
change the Warning Timing, the warning
time of other Driver Assistance systems
may change.
07
Warning Volume
Safe Exit Assist Operation
Collision warning when exiting
vehicle
OTM070141N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔDQGœ/RZŔIRU
Safe Exit Assist.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
CAUTION
ś The setting of the Warning Timing
and Warning Volume applies to all
functions of the Safe Exit Assist.
ś Even though ‘Normal’ is selected
for Warning Timing, if the vehicles
approaches at high speed from the
rear, the initial warning activation
time may seem late.
ś Select ‘Late’ for Warning Timing
when traffic is light.
OTM070101N
ś When an approaching vehicle from
the rear is detected, the ‘Watch (out)
IRUWUDIILFŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
appear on the cluster, and an audible
warning will sound.
ś Safe Exit Assist will warn the driver
when your vehicle speed is below 2
mph (3 km/h), and the speed of the
approaching vehicle from the rear is
above 3 mph (5 km/h).
7-41
Driver assistance system
Safe Exit Assist linked with
Electronic child safety lock
CAUTION
If the driver presses the electronic child
lock button again within 10 seconds
after the warning message appears,
Safe Exit Assist judges that the driver
has unlocked the doors acknowledging
the rear status. The electronic child
safety lock will turn off (button
indicator OFF) and the rear doors will
unlock. Always check the surroundings
before turning off the electronic child
safety lock button.
OTM070145L
ś When Electric child safety lock is
operating and an approaching vehicle
from the rear area is detected, the
rear doors cannot be unlocked even
if the driver tries to unlock the rear
doors using the electronic child safety
lock button. The ‘Check surroundings
WKHQWU\DJDLQŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
appear on the cluster.
ś Safe Exit Assist will warn the driver
when vehicle speed is below 2
mph (3 km/h) and the speed of the
approaching vehicle from the rear is
above 3 mph (5 km/h).
ś For more details on electric child
safety lock button, refer to “Electronic
Child Safety Lock” section in chapter
5.
7-42
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Safe Exit Assist:
ś For your safety, only change the
Settings after parking the vehicle at a
safe location.
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or audible
warning is generated, Safe Exit
Assist warning message may not be
displayed and audible warning may
not be generated.
ś You may not hear the warning sound
of Safe Exit Assist if the surroundings
are noisy.
ś Safe Exit Assist does not operate in
all situations and cannot prevent all
collisions.
ś Safe Exit Assist may warn the driver
late or may not warn the driver
depending on the road and driving
conditions. Always check vehicle
surroundings.
07
ś The driver and passengers are
responsible for accidents that occur
while exiting the vehicle. Always
check the surroundings before you
exit the vehicle.
ś Never deliberately operate Safe Exit
Assist. Doing so may lead to serious
injury or death.
ś Safe Exit Assist does not operate
if there is a problem with Safe Exit
Assist. There may be a problem with
Safe Exit Assist when:
- Safe Exit Assist warning light
appears
- Safe Exit Assist sensor or the
sensor surrounding is polluted or
covered
- Safe Exit Assist fails to warn
passengers or falsely warn
passengers
Information
Safe Exit Assist malfunction and
Limitations
Safe Exit Assist malfunction
OTM070099N
When Safe Exit Assist is not working
properly, the ‘Check Blind-Spot Safety
V\VWHP V ŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOODSSHDU
on the cluster, and the function will turn
off automatically or the function will be
limited. Have the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
After the engine is turned off, Safe Exit
Assist operates approximately for 3
minutes, but turns off immediately if the
doors are locked.
7-43
Driver assistance system
Safe Exit Assist disabled
CAUTION
Turn off Safe Exit Assist to install a
trailer, carrier, etc., or remove the
trailer, carrier, etc., to use Safe Exit
Assist.
Limitations of Safe Exit Assist
OTM070098N
When the rear bumper around the rear
corner radar or sensor is covered with
foreign material, such as snow or rain,
or installing a trailer or carrier, it can
reduce the detecting performance and
temporarily limit or disable Safe Exit
Assist.
If this occurs, the ‘Blind-Spot Safety
V\VWHP V GLVDEOHG5DGDUEORFNHGŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster.
Safe Exit Assist will operate normally
when such foreign material or trailer,
etc., is removed, and then the engine is
restarted.
If Safe Exit Assist does not operate
normally after it is removed, have the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
ś Even though the warning message
does not appear on the cluster, Safe
Exit Assist may not properly operate.
ś Safe Exit Assist may not properly
operate in an area (for example,
open terrain) where any objects are
not detected right after the engine
is turned on, or when the detecting
sensor is blocked with foreign
material right after the engine is
turned on.
7-44
Safe Exit Assist may not operate
normally, or it may operate unexpectedly
under the following circumstances:
ś Getting out of the vehicle where trees
or grass are overgrown
ś Getting out of the vehicle where the
road is wet
ś The approaching vehicle is very fast or
very slow
For more details on the limitations of
the rear corner radar, refer to “BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)”
section in chapter 7.
WARNING
ś Safe Exit Assist may not operate
normally if interfered by strong
electromagnetic waves.
ś Safe Exit Assist may not operate
for 3 seconds after the vehicle is
started, or the rear corner radars are
initialized.
07
'5,9(5$77(17,21:$51,1*ǣ'$:Ǥ
Basic function
Driver Attention Warning will help
determine the driver's attention level by
analyzing driving pattern, driving time,
etc., while vehicle is being driven. Driver
Attention Warning will recommend a
EUHDNZKHQWKHGULYHUŔVDWWHQWLRQOHYHO
falls below a certain level.
Driver Attention Warning
Settings
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ'ULYHU$WWHQWLRQ:DUQLQJŔ
from the Settings menu to set whether or
not to use each function.
Driver Attention Warning
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
function
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert function
will inform the driver when a detected
vehicle in front departs from a stop.
Detecting sensor
OTM070188N
ś ,Iœ,QDWWHQWLYH'ULYLQJ:DUQLQJŔ RU
œ6ZD\LQJZDUQLQJŔ LVVHOHFWHG'ULYHU
Attention Warning will inform the
GULYHURIWKHGULYHUŔVDWWHQWLRQOHYHO
and will recommend taking a break
when the level falls below a certain
level.
OTM071001L
[1] : Front view camera
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
The front view camera is used to detect
driving patterns and front vehicle
departure while vehicle is being driven.
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting sensor.
CAUTION
Always keep the front view camera in
good condition to maintain optimal
performance of Driver Attention
Warning.
For more details on the precautions
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
OTM070189N
ś ,Iœ/HDGLQJ9HKLFOH'HSDUWXUH$OHUWŔ
is selected, Driver Attention Warning
will inform the driver when the front
vehicle departs from a stop.
7-45
Driver assistance system
Warning Timing
Driver Attention Warning
Operation
Basic function
The basic function of Driver Attention
Warning is to inform the driver of their
œ$WWHQWLRQ/HYHOŔDQGWRZDUQWKHGULYHUWR
œ&RQVLGHUWDNLQJDEUHDNŔ
Attention level
Function off
Standby/Disabled
OTM070140N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the initial
warning activation time for Driver
Attention Warning.
When the vehicle is first delivered,
:DUQLQJ7LPLQJLVVHWWRœ1RUPDOŔ,I\RX
change the Warning Timing, the warning
time of other Driver Assistance systems
may change.
OTM070102N
Attentive driving
OTM070106N
Inattentive driving
Information
If the engine is restarted, Driver Attention
Warning will maintain the last setting.
OTMA070002
OTM070191N
ś The driver can monitor his/her driving
conditions on the cluster.
- When the ‘Inattentive Driving
:DUQLQJŔLVGHVHOHFWHGIURPWKH
6HWWLQJVPHQXœ6\VWHP2IIŔLV
displayed.
- Driver Attention Warning will
operate when vehicle speed is
between 0~110 mph (0~180 km/h).
- When vehicle speed is not within
the operating speed, the message
œ6WDQGE\Ŕ RU 'LVDEOHG ZLOOEH
displayed.
7-46
07
ś 7KHGULYHUŔVDWWHQWLRQOHYHOLVGLVSOD\HG
on the scale of 1 to 5. The lower the
level is, the more inattentive the driver
is.
ś The level decreases when the driver
does not take a break for a certain
period of time.
Taking a break
CAUTION
ś Driver Attention Warning may
suggest a break depending on the
driver’s driving pattern or habits,
even if the driver doesn’t feel
fatigued.
ś Driver Attention Warning is a
supplemental function and may not
be able to determine whether the
driver is inattentive.
ś A driver who feels fatigued should
take a break at a safe location, even
though there is no break suggestion
by Driver Attention Warning.
Information
OTM070105L
ś 7KHœ&RQVLGHUWDNLQJDEUHDNŔPHVVDJH
will appear on the cluster and an
audible warning will sound to suggest
that the driver take a break, when the
GULYHUŔVDWWHQWLRQOHYHOLVEHORZ
ś Driver Attention Warning will not
suggest a break when the total driving
time is shorter than 10 minutes or 10
minutes has not passed after the last
break was suggested.
WARNING
For your safety, only change the
Settings after parking the vehicle at a
safe location.
ś You may change settings from the
instrument cluster (User Settings) or
infotainment system (Vehicle Settings),
whichever option that is provided with
your vehicle. For more details, see
"User Settings" section in chapter 4, or
"Vehicle Settings" section in supplied
Infotainment Manual.
ś Driver Attention Warning will reset the
last break time to 00:00 in the following
situations:
- The engine is turned off
- The driver unfastens the seat belt
and opens the driver’s door
- The vehicle is stopped for more than
10 minutes
ś When the driver resets Driver Attention
Warning, the last break time is set to
00:00 and the driver’s attention level is
set to High.
7-47
Driver assistance system
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
function
Driver Attention Warning
Malfunction and Limitations
Driver Attention Warning
malfunction
OTM070042N
When the front vehicle departs from a
stop, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
will inform the driver by displaying
WKHœ/HDGLQJYHKLFOHLVGULYLQJDZD\Ŕ
message on the cluster and an audible
warning will sound.
WARNING
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or audible
warning is generated, Leading
Vehicle Departure Alert's warning
message may not be displayed
and audible warning may not be
generated.
ś The driver has the responsibility to
safely drive and control the vehicle.
CAUTION
ś Leading Vehicle Departure Alert is a
supplemental function and may not
alert the driver whenever the front
vehicle departs from a stop.
ś Always check the front of the
vehicle and road conditions before
departure.
7-48
OTM070107L
When Driver Attention Warning is not
working properly, the ‘Check Driver
$WWHQWLRQ:DUQLQJ '$: V\VWHPŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster. If this occurs, have the vehicle
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Limitations of Driver Attention
Warning
Driver Attention Warning may not work
properly in the following situations:
ś The vehicle is driven violently
ś The vehicle intentionally crosses over
lanes frequently
ś The vehicle is controlled by Driver
Assistance system, such as Lane
Keeping Assist
07
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert feature
ś When the vehicle cuts in
ś When the vehicle ahead sharply steers
OADAS034
OADAS021
[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Front vehicle
If the vehicle in front makes a sharp
turn, such as to turn left or right or
make a U-turn, etc., Leading Vehicle
Departure Alert may not operate
properly.
ś When the vehicle ahead abruptly
departures
OADAS022
[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Front vehicle
If a vehicle cuts in front of your
vehicle, Leading Departure Alert may
not operate properly.
OADAS024
If the vehicle in front abruptly
departures, Leading Vehicle Departure
Alert may not operate properly.
7-49
Driver assistance system
ś When a pedestrian or bicycle is
between you and the vehicle ahead
ś When driving at a tollgate or
intersection, etc.
OADAS025
OADAS026
If there is a pedestrian(s) or bicycle(s)
in between you and the vehicle in
front, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
may not operate properly.
If you pass a tollgate or intersection
with lots of vehicles or you drive
where lanes are merged or divided
frequently, Leading Vehicle Departure
Alert may not operate properly.
ś When in a parking lot
CAUTION
For more details on the precautions
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
OADAS027
If a vehicle parked in front drives away
from you, Leading Vehicle Departure
Alert may alert you that the parked
vehicle is driving away.
7-50
07
%/,1'ǘ63279,(:021,725ǣ%90Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Left side
Blind-Spot View Monitor
Settings
Right side
Setting features
Blind-Spot View
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ%OLQG6SRW6DIHW\Ɵ%OLQG
6SRW9LHZŔIURPWKH6HWWLQJVPHQXWR
turn on Blind-Spot View Monitor and
deselect to turn off the function.
OTM070014
OTM070015
Blind-Spot View Monitor displays the
rear blind spot area of the vehicle in the
cluster when the turn signal is turned on
to help change lanes.
Blind-Spot View Monitor
Operation
Detecting sensors
OIG046417
Blind-Spot View Monitor will turn on and
off when the turn signal is turned on and
off.
OTM070148
[1], [2] : SVM-side view camera
(camera located at bottom of the mirror)
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
7-51
Driver assistance system
Operating conditions
When the left or right side turn signal
turns on, the image in that direction is
displayed on the instrument cluster.
Off conditions
ś When the turn signal turns off, the
image on the instrument cluster will
turn off.
ś When the hazard warning flasher
is on, Blind-Spot View Monitor will
turn off, regardless of the turn signal
status.
ś When other important warning is
displayed on the instrument cluster,
Blind-Spot View Monitor may turn off.
7-52
Blind-Spot View Monitor
Malfunction
When Blind-Spot View Monitor is not
working properly, or the cluster display
flickers, or the camera image does not
display normally, have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
ś The image shown on the cluster may
differ from the actual distance of the
object. Make sure to directly check
the vehicle's surroundings for safety.
ś Always keep the camera lens clean.
If the lens is covered with foreign
material, it may adversely affect
camera performance and BlindSpot View Monitor may not operate
normally.
07
60$57&58,6(&21752/ǣ6&&Ǥ
Smart Cruise Control is designed to
help detect the vehicle ahead and
help maintain the desired speed and
minimum distance between the vehicle
ahead.
Overtaking Acceleration Assist
While Smart Cruise Control is operating,
if Smart Cruise Control judges that the
driver is determined to overtake the
vehicle in front, acceleration will be
assisted.
CAUTION
Always keep the front view camera
and front radar in good condition to
maintain optimal performance of Smart
Cruise Control.
For more details on the precautions of
the front view camera and front radar,
refer to “Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA)” section in chapter 7.
Detecting sensor
OTM071001L
OTM070022
[1] : Front view camera,
[2] : Front radar
The front view camera and front radar
are used as a detecting sensor to help
detect the vehicles in front.
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting sensor.
7-53
Driver assistance system
Smart Cruise Control Settings
Smart Cruise Control Operation
Smart Cruise Control Reaction
Operating conditions for basic
function
Smart Cruise Control will operate when
the following conditions are satisfied.
OTM070142N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ6&&5HDFWLRQŔIURPWKH
settings menu to select the sensitivity of
vehicle speed when following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance.
Warning Volume
Basic function
ś The gear is in D (Drive)
ś 7KHGULYHUŔVGRRULVFORVHG
ś EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) is not
applied
ś Your vehicle speed is within the
operating speed range
- 5~110 mph (10~180 km/h): when
there is no vehicle in front
- 0~110 mph (0~180 km/h): when
there is a vehicle in front
ś ESC (Electronic Stability Control),
TCS (Traction Control System) or ABS
(Anti-Lock Braking System) is on
ś ESC (Electronic Stability Control),
TCS (Traction Control System) or ABS
(Anti-Lock Braking System) is not
controlling the vehicle
ś Engine rpm is not in the red zone
ś Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
brake control is not operating
ś Remote Smart Parking Assist brake
control is not operating
OTM070141N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Smart Cruise Control.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
Information
If the engine is restarted, Warning Volume
will maintain the last setting.
7-54
Information
When stopped behind another vehicle, the
driver can turn on Smart Cruise Control
while the brake pedal is depressed.
07
Operating conditions for
Acceleration Assist
Overtaking Acceleration Assist will
operate when the turn signal indicator
is turned on to the left (left-hand drive)
or turned on to the right (right-hand
drive) while Smart Cruise Control is
operating, and the following conditions
are satisfied:
ś Your vehicle speed is above 40 mph
(60 km/h)
ś The hazard warning flasher is off
ś A vehicle is detected in front of your
vehicle
ś Deceleration is not needed to
maintain distance with the vehicle in
front
WARNING
ś When the turn signal indicator is
turned on to the left (left-hand drive)
or turned on to the right (righthand drive) while there is a vehicle
ahead, the vehicle may accelerate
temporarily. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
ś Regardless of your countries driving
direction, Overtaking Acceleration
Assist will operate when the
conditions are satisfied. When
using the function in countries with
different driving direction, always
check the road conditions at all
times.
Turning on Smart Cruise Control
OTM070205L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
ś Press the Driving Assist button to turn
on Smart Cruise Control. The speed
will be set to the current speed on the
cluster.
ś If there is no vehicle in front of you,
the set speed will be maintained, but
if there is a vehicle in front of you,
the speed may decrease to maintain
the distance to the vehicle ahead. If
the vehicle ahead accelerates, your
vehicle will travel at a steady cruising
speed after accelerating to the set
speed.
Information
ś If your vehicle speed is between 0~20
mph (0~30 km/h) when you press the
Driving Assist button, the Smart Cruise
Control speed will be set to 20 mph (30
km/h).
ś The Driving Assist button symbol may
vary depending on your vehicle option.
7-55
Driver assistance system
Setting vehicle distance
Increasing set speed
OTM070206L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
Each time the button is pressed, the
vehicle distance changes as follows:
Distance 4
Distance 3
Distance 2
Distance 1
Information
ś If you drive at 56 mph (90km/h), the
distance is maintained as follows:
Distance 4 approximately 172 ft. (53 m)
Distance 3 approximately 130 ft. (40m)
Distance 2 approximately 106 ft. (30m)
Distance 1 approximately 82 ft. (25m)
ś The distance is set to the last set
distance when the engine is restarted,
or when Smart Cruise Control was
temporarily canceled.
7-56
OTM070020
ś Push the + switch up and release it
immediately. The cruising speed will
increase by 1 mph (1 km/h) each time
the switch is operated in this manner.
ś Push the + switch up and hold it
while monitoring the set speed on
the cluster. The cruising speed will
increase by 5 mph or 10 km/h each
time the switch is operated in this
manner. Release the switch when
the desired speed is shown, and the
vehicle will accelerate to that speed.
You can set the speed to 110 mph (100
km/h).
WARNING
Check the driving condition before
using the + switch. Driving speed may
sharply increase when you push up and
hold the + switch.
07
Decreasing set speed
Temporarily cancelling Smart Cruise
Control
OTM070019
ś Push the - switch down and release it
immediately. The cruising speed will
decrease by 1 mph (1 km/h) each time
the switch is operated in this manner.
ś Push the - switch down and hold it
while monitoring the set speed on
the cluster. The cruising speed will
decrease by 5 mph or 10 km/h each
time the switch is operated in this
manner.
Release the switch at the speed you
want to maintain. You can set the
speed to 20 mph (30 km/h).
OTM070207L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
Press the
switch or depress the
brake pedal to temporarily cancel Smart
Cruise Control.
7-57
Driver assistance system
Resuming Smart Cruise Control
Turning off Smart Cruise Control
OTM070208L
OTM070205L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
To resume Smart Cruise Control after the
function was canceled, push the +, - or
switch.
If you push the + switch up or - switch
down, vehicle speed will be set to the
current speed on the cluster.
switch, vehicle speed
If you push the
will resume to the preset speed.
Press the Driving Assist button to turn
Smart Cruise Control off.
WARNING
Check the driving condition before
switch. Driving speed
using the
may sharply increase or decrease when
switch.
you press the
7-58
Information
If your vehicle is equipped with Manual
Speed Limit Assist, press and hold the
Driving Assist button to turn off Smart
Cruise Control. However, Manual Speed
Limit Assist will turn on.
07
Display and control
You can see the status of the Smart
Cruise Control operation in the Driving
Assist mode on the cluster. Refer to “LCD
Display Modes” section in chapter 4.
Smart Cruise Control will be displayed
as below depending on the status of the
function.
Operating
Temporarily
cancelled
OTMA070004
Accelerating temporarily
If you want to speed up temporarily
when Smart Cruise Control is on, depress
the accelerator pedal. While the speed
is increasing, the set speed, distance
level and target distance will blink on the
cluster.
OTM070245E
OTM070155
Basic function
ś When operating
(1) Whether there is a vehicle ahead
and the selected distance level are
displayed.
(2) Set speed is displayed.
(3) Whether there is a vehicle ahead
and the target vehicle distance are
displayed.
WARNING
Be careful when accelerating
temporarily, because the speed and
distance is not controlled automatically
even if there is a vehicle in front of you.
ś When temporarily canceled
indicator is displayed.
(1)
(2) The previous set speed is shaded.
Information
ś The distance of the front vehicle on the
cluster is displayed according to the
actual distance between your vehicle
and the vehicle ahead.
ś The target distance may vary according
to the vehicle speed and the set
distance level. If vehicle speed is low,
even though the vehicle distance have
changed, the change of the target
vehicle distance may be small.
7-59
Driver assistance system
Temporarily cancelling Smart Cruise
Control
WARNING
When Smart Cruise Control is
temporarily canceled, distance with the
front vehicle will not be maintained.
Always have your eyes on the road
while driving, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain a safe
distance.
Smart Cruise Control conditions not
satisfied
OTM070113N
Smart Cruise Control will be temporarily
canceled automatically when:
ś The vehicle speed is above 120 mph
(190 km/h)
ś The vehicle is stopped for a certain
period of time
ś The accelerator pedal is continuously
depressed for a certain period of time
ś The conditions for the Smart Cruise
Control to operate is not satisfied
If Smart Cruise Control is temporarily
canceled automatically, the ‘Smart
&UXLVH&RQWUROFDQFHOHGŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster, and
an audible warning will sound to warn
the driver.
If the Smart Cruise Control is temporarily
canceled while the vehicle is at a
standstill with the function operating,
EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) maybe
applied.
7-60
OTM070112N
If the Driving Assist button, + switch,
switch is pushed
- switch or
when Smart Cruise Control operating
conditions are not satisfied, the ‘Smart
&UXLVH&RQWUROFRQGLWLRQVQRWPHWŔZLOO
appear on the cluster, and an audible
warning will sound.
07
OTM070114L
In traffic situation
In traffic, your vehicle will stop if the
vehicle ahead of you stops. Also, if the
vehicle ahead of you starts moving, your
vehicle will start as well. In addition, after
the vehicle has stopped and a certain
time have passed, the ‘Use switch or
SHGDOWRDFFHOHUDWHŔPHVVDJHZLOODSSHDU
on the cluster. Depress the accelerator
pedal or push the + switch, - switch or
switch to start driving.
WARNING
While the message is displayed on
the cluster, if there is no vehicle in
front or the vehicle is far away from
you, and the + switch, – switch or
switch is pushed, Smart Cruise
Control will automatically cancel and
EPB will be applied. However, if the
accelerator pedal is depressed, EPB
will not be applied even though Smart
Cruise Control is canceled. Always pay
attention to the road condition ahead.
OTM070055L
Warning road conditions ahead
In the following situation, the ‘Watch for
VXUURXQGLQJYHKLFOHVŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
will appear on the cluster, and an audible
warning will sound to warn the driver of
road conditions ahead.
- The vehicle in front disappears when
Smart Cruise Control is maintaining
the distance with the vehicle ahead
while driving below a certain speed.
- While the ‘Use switch or pedal to
DFFHOHUDWHŔPHVVDJHLVGLVSOD\HGRQ
the cluster, if there is no vehicle in
front or the vehicle is far away from
you, and the + switch, – switch or
switch is pushed.
WARNING
Always pay attention to vehicles or
objects that may suddenly appear in
front of you, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain a safe
distance.
7-61
Driver assistance system
WARNING
OTM070143N
Collision Warning
While Smart Cruise Control is operating,
when the collision risk with the vehicle
DKHDGLVKLJKWKHœ&ROOLVLRQ:DUQLQJŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster, and an audible warning will
sound to warn the driver. Always have
your eyes on the road while driving, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
WARNING
In the following situations, Smart Cruise
Control may not warn the driver of a
collision.
- The distance from the front vehicle
is near, or the vehicle speed of the
front vehicle is faster or similar to
your vehicle
- The speed of the front vehicle is very
slow or is at a standstill
- The accelerator pedal is depressed
right after Smart Cruise Control is
turned on
7-62
Take the following precautions when
using Smart Cruise Control:
ś Smart Cruise Control does not
substitute for proper and safe
driving. It is the responsibility of the
driver to always check the speed and
distance to the vehicle ahead.
ś Smart Cruise Control may not
recognize unexpected and sudden
situations or complex driving
situations, so always pay attention to
driving conditions and control your
vehicle speed.
ś Keep Smart Cruise Control off when
the function is not in use to avoid
inadvertently setting a speed.
ś Do not open the door or leave the
vehicle when Smart Cruise Control
is operating, even if the vehicle is
stopped.
ś Always be aware of the selected
speed and vehicle distance.
ś Keep a safe distance according to
road conditions and vehicle speed.
If the vehicle distance is too close
during high-speed driving, a serious
collision may result.
ś When maintaining distance with
the vehicle ahead, if the front
vehicle disappears, Smart Cruise
Control may suddenly accelerate to
the set speed. Always be aware of
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring.
ś Vehicle speed may decrease on an
upward slope and increase on a
downward slope.
ś Always be aware of situations such
as when a vehicle cuts in suddenly.
07
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, we recommend that
Smart Cruise Control is turned off
due to safety reasons.
ś Turn off Smart Cruise Control when
your vehicle is being towed.
ś Smart Cruise Control may not
operate normally if interfered by
strong electromagnetic waves.
ś Smart Cruise Control may not
detect an obstacle in front and lead
to a collision. Always look ahead
cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring.
ś Vehicles moving in front of you with
a frequent lane change may cause
a delay in Smart Cruise Control
reaction or may cause Smart Cruise
Control to react to a vehicle actually
in an adjacent lane. Always drive
cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring.
ś Always be aware of the surroundings
and drive safely, even though a
warning message does not appear or
an audible warning does not sound.
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or warning
sound is generated, Smart Cruise
Control warning message may not
be displayed and warning sound may
not be generated.
ś You may not hear the warning sound
of Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist if the surroundings are noisy.
ś The vehicle manufacturer is not
responsible for any traffic violation
or accidents caused by the driver.
ś Always set the vehicle speed to the
speed limit in your area.
Information
ś Smart Cruise Control may not operate
for 15 seconds after the vehicle is
started or the front view camera or
front radar is initialized.
ś You may hear a sound when the brake
is controlled by Smart Cruise Control.
Smart Cruise Control
Malfunction and Limitations
Smart Cruise Control malfunction
OTM070116N
When Smart Cruise Control is not working
properly, the ‘Check Smart Cruise Control
V\VWHPŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOODSSHDUDQG
warning light will illuminate on the
the
cluster. Have the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-63
Driver assistance system
Smart Cruise Control disabled
OTM070115N
When the front radar cover or sensor
is covered with snow, rain, or foreign
material, it can reduce the detecting
performance and temporarily limit or
disable Smart Cruise Control.
If this occurs the ‘Smart Cruise Control
GLVDEOHG5DGDUEORFNHGŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear for a certain period
of time on the cluster.
Smart Cruise Control will operate
normally when snow, rain or foreign
material is removed.
WARNING
ś Even though the warning message
does not appear on the cluster,
Smart Cruise Control may not
properly operate.
ś Smart Cruise Control may not
properly operate in an area (for
example, open terrain), where there
is nothing to detect after turning ON
the engine.
7-64
Limitations of Smart Cruise Control
Smart Cruise Control may not operate
normally, or the function may operate
unexpectedly under the following
circumstances:
ś The detecting sensor or the
surroundings are contaminated or
damaged
ś Washer fluid is continuously sprayed,
or the wiper is on
ś The camera lens is contaminated due
to tinted, filmed or coated windshield,
damaged glass, or stuck of foreign
material (sticker, bug, etc.) on the
glass
ś Moisture is not removed or frozen on
the windshield
ś The field of view of the front view
camera is obstructed by sun glare
ś Street light or light from an oncoming
vehicle is reflected on the wet road
surface, such as a puddle on the road
ś The temperature around the front
view camera is high or low
ś An object is placed on the dashboard
ś The surrounding is very bright
ś The surrounding is very dark, such as
in a tunnel, etc.
ś The brightness changes suddenly, for
example when entering or exiting a
tunnel
ś The brightness outside is low, and the
headlights are not on or are not bright
ś Driving in heavy rain or snow, or thick
fog
ś Driving through steam, smoke or
shadow
07
ś Only part of the vehicle is detected
ś The vehicle in front has no tail lights,
tail lights are located unusually, etc.
ś The brightness outside is low, and the
tail lamps are not on or are not bright
ś The rear of the front vehicle is small
or does not look normal (for example,
tilted, overturned, etc.)
ś 7KHIURQWYHKLFOHŔVJURXQGFOHDUDQFHLV
low or high
ś A vehicle suddenly cuts in front
ś Your vehicle is being towed
ś Driving through a tunnel or iron bridge
ś Driving near areas containing metal
substances, such as a construction
zone, railroad, etc.
ś A material is near that reflects very
well on the front radar, such as a
guardrail, nearby vehicle, etc.
ś The bumper around the front radar is
impacted, damaged or the front radar
is out of position
ś The temperature around the front
radar is high or low
ś Driving in large areas where there
are few vehicles or structures (for
example, desert, meadow, suburb,
etc.)
ś The vehicle in front is made of
material that does not reflect on the
front radar
ś Driving near a highway (or motorway)
interchange or tollgate
ś Driving on a slippery surface due to
snow, water puddle, ice, etc.
ś Driving on a curved road
ś The vehicle in front is detected late
ś The vehicle in front is suddenly
blocked by a obstacle
ś The vehicle in front suddenly changes
lane or suddenly reduces speed
ś The vehicle in front is bent out of
shape
ś 7KHIURQWYHKLFOHŔVVSHHGLVIDVWRU
slow
ś With a vehicle in front, your vehicle
changes lane at low speed
ś The vehicle in front is covered with
snow
ś Unstable driving
ś You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front is not detected
ś You are continuously driving in a circle
ś Driving in a parking lot
ś Driving through a construction area,
unpaved road, partial paved road,
uneven road, speed bumps, etc.
ś Driving on an incline road, curved
road, etc.
ś Driving through a roadside with trees
or streetlights
ś The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
ś Your vehicle height is low or high
due to heavy loads, abnormal tire
pressure, etc.
ś Driving through a narrow road where
trees or grass are overgrown
ś There is interference by
electromagnetic waves, such as
driving in an area with strong radio
waves or electrical noise
7-65
Driver assistance system
ś Driving on a curved road
ś Driving on an inclined road
OADAS014
On curves, Smart Cruise Control may
not detect a vehicle in the same lane,
and may accelerate to the set speed.
Also, vehicle speed may rapidly
decrease when the vehicle ahead is
detected suddenly.
Select the appropriate set speed on
curves and apply the brake pedal or
accelerator pedal according to the
road and driving conditions ahead.
OADAS015
Your vehicle speed can be reduced
due to a vehicle in the adjacent lane.
Apply the accelerator pedal and select
the appropriate set speed. Check
to be sure that the road conditions
permit safe operation of the Smart
Cruise Control.
7-66
OADAS012
During uphill or downhill driving, the
Smart Cruise Control may not detect
a moving vehicle in your lane, and
cause your vehicle to accelerate to
the set speed. Also, vehicle speed will
rapidly decrease when the vehicle
ahead is detected suddenly.
Select the appropriate set speed on
inclines and apply the brake pedal or
accelerator pedal according to the
road and driving conditions ahead.
07
ś Changing lanes
ś Detecting vehicle
OJX1079181
OADAS030
[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Lane changing vehicle
When a vehicle moves into your lane
from an adjacent lane, it cannot be
detected by the sensor until it is in the
sensor's detection range. Smart Cruise
Control may not immediately detect
the vehicle when the vehicle changes
lanes abruptly. In this case, you must
maintain a safe braking distance, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
In the following cases, some vehicles
in your lane cannot be detected by the
sensor:
- Vehicles offset to one side
- Slow-moving vehicles or suddendecelerating vehicles
- Oncoming vehicles
- Stopped vehicles
- Vehicles with small rear profile, such
as trailers
- Narrow vehicles, such as
motorcycles or bicycles
- Special vehicles
- Animals and pedestrians
Adjust your vehicle speed by
depressing the brake pedal according
to the road and driving conditions
ahead.
7-67
Driver assistance system
OTM070147
In the following cases, the vehicle
in front cannot be detected by the
sensor:
- Vehicles with higher ground
clearance or vehicles carrying loads
that stick out of the back of the
vehicle
- Vehicles that has the front lifted due
to heavy loads
- You are steering your vehicle
- Driving on narrow or sharply curved
roads
Adjust your vehicle speed by
depressing the brake pedal according
to the road and driving conditions
ahead.
OTM058129
ś When a vehicle ahead disappears
at an intersection, your vehicle may
accelerate.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
OTM058119
ś When a vehicle in front of you merges
out of the lane, Smart Cruise Control
may not immediately detect the new
vehicle that is now in front of you.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
7-68
07
Information
OTM058124
ś Always look out for pedestrians when
your vehicle is maintaining a distance
with the vehicle ahead.
Radio frequency radiation exposure
information:
This equipment complies with FCC
radiation exposure limits set forth for an
uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and
operated with minimum distance of 8 in.
(20 cm) between the radiator (antenna)
and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or
operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the device.
7-69
Driver assistance system
1$9,*$7,21ǘ%$6('60$57&58,6(&21752/ǣ16&&Ǥǣ,)
(48,33('Ǥ
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
will help automatically adjust vehicle
speed when driving on highways (or
motorways) by using road information
from the navigation system while Smart
Cruise Control is operating.
Navigation-Based Smart Cruise
Control Settings
Information
ś Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
is available only on controlled access
road of certain highways.
à Controlled access road indicates
roads with limited entrances and
exits that allow uninterrupted high
speed traffic flow. Only passenger
cars and motorcycles are allowed on
controlled access roads.
ś Additional highways may be expanded
by future navigation updates.
Information
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
operates on main roads of highways (or
motorways), and does not operate on
interchanges or junctions.
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
If vehicle speed is high, Highway Curve
Zone Auto Slowdown function will
temporarily decelerate your vehicle
or limit acceleration to help you drive
safely on a curve based on the curve
information from the navigation.
Highway Set Speed Auto Change
Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function automatically changes Smart
Cruise Control set speed based on
the speed limit information from the
navigation.
7-70
OTM070192N
Auto Highway Speed Control
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ'ULYLQJ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ
$XWR+LJKZD\6SHHG&RQWUROŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to turn on Navigationbased Smart Cruise Control and deselect
to turn off the function.
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ'ULYLQJ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ
+LJKZD\$XWR&XUYH6ORZGRZQŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to turn on Highway Curve
Zone Auto Slowdown and deselect to
turn off the function.
Information
When there is a problem with Navigationbased Smart Cruise Control, the function
cannot be set from the Settings menu.
07
Navigation-Based Smart Cruise
Control Operation
Operating conditions
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
is ready to operate if all of the following
conditions are satisfied:
ś Smart Cruise Control is operating
ś Driving on main roads of highways (or
motorways)
OTMA070005
Information
For more details on how to operate Smart
Cruise Control, refer to “Smart Cruise
Control (SCC)” section in chapter 7.
Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control display and control
When Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control operates, it will be displayed on
the cluster as follows:
OTMA070007
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
operating
If temporary deceleration is required in
the standby state and Navigation-based
Smart Cruise Control is operating, the
symbol will illuminate on the
green
cluster.
If the Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function operates, the green
symbol and set speed will illuminate on
the cluster, and an audible warning will
sound.
WARNING
OTMA070006
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
standby
If the operating conditions are satisfied,
indicator will illuminate.
the white
OTM070198L
‘Drive carefully’ warning message will
appear in the following circumstances:
- Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control is not able to slow down your
vehicle to a safe speed
7-71
Driver assistance system
Information
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown and
Highway Set Speed Auto Change function
symbol.
uses the same
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
ś Depending on the curve ahead on the
highway, the vehicle will decelerate,
and after passing the curve, the
vehicle will accelerate to Smart Cruise
Control set speed.
ś Vehicle deceleration time may differ
depending on the vehicle speed
and the degree of the curve on the
road. The higher the driving speed,
deceleration will start faster.
Highway Set Speed Auto Change
ś Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function will operate when Smart
Cruise Control set speed and the
highway speed limit is matched.
ś While Highway Set Speed Auto
Change function is operating, when
the highway speed limit changes,
Smart Cruise Control set speed
automatically changes to the changed
speed limit.
ś If Smart Cruise Control set speed is
adjusted different from the speed
limit, Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function will be in the standby state.
ś If Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function has changed to the standby
state by driving on a road other than
the highway main road, Highway Set
Speed Auto Change function will
operate again when you drive on the
main road again without setting the
set speed.
7-72
ś If Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function has changed to the standby
state by depressing the brake pedal
switch on the
or pressing the
switch
steering wheel, press the
to restart the function.
ś Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function does not operate on highway
interchanges or junctions.
Information
ś Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function only operates based on the
speed limits of the highway, it does not
work with speed cameras.
ś When Highway Set Speed Auto Change
function is operating, the vehicle
automatically accelerates or decelerates
when the highway speed limit changes.
ś The maximum set speed for Highway
Set Speed Auto Change function is 86
mph (140 km/h).
ś If the speed limit of a new road is not
updated in the navigation, Highway Set
Speed Auto Change function may not
operate properly.
ś If the speed unit is set to a unit other
than the speed unit used in your
country, Highway Set Speed Auto
Change function may not operate
properly.
07
Limitations of Navigation-Based
Smart Cruise Control
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
may not operate normally under the
following circumstances:
ś The navigation is not working properly
ś Speed limit and road information in
the navigation is not updated
ś The map information and the actual
road is different because of real-time
GPS data or map information error
ś The navigation searches for a route
while driving
ś GPS signals are blocked in areas such
as a tunnel
ś The navigation is updated while
driving
ś Map information is not transmitted
due to infotainment system's
abnormal operation
ś A road that divides into two or more
roads and joins again
ś The driver goes off course the route
set in the navigation
ś The route to the destination is
changed or canceled by resetting the
navigation
ś The vehicle enters a service station or
rest area
ś The speed limit of some sections
changes according to the road
situations
ś Android Auto or Car Play is operating
ś The navigation cannot detect the
current vehicle position (for example,
elevated roads including overpass
adjacent to general roads or nearby
roads exist in a parallel way)
ś The navigation is being updated while
driving
ś The navigation is being restarted while
driving
ś There is bad weather, such as heavy
rain, heavy snow, etc.
ś Driving on a road under construction
ś Driving on a road that is controlled
ś Driving on a road that is sharply
curved
ś Driving on roads with intersections,
roundabouts, straight entrances and
exits, etc.
7-73
Driver assistance system
OJX1070280L
OJX1070281L
[1] : Set route, [2] : Branch line, [3] : Driving route,
[4] : Main road, [5] : Curved road section
[1] : Set route, [2] : Branch line, [3] : Driving route,
[4] : Main road, [5] : Curved road section
ś When there is a difference between
the navigation set route (branch line)
and the driving route (main road),
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
function may not operate until the
driving route is recognized as the
main road.
ś When the vehicle's driving route
is recognized as the main road by
maintaining the main road instead
of the navigation set route, Highway
Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function
will operate. Depending on the
distance to the curve and the current
vehicle speed, vehicle deceleration
may not be sufficient or may
decelerate rapidly.
ś When there is a difference between
the navigation route (main road)
and the driving route (branch line),
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
function will operate based on the
curve information on the main road.
ś When it is judged that you are driving
out of the route by entering the
highway interchange or junction,
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
function will not operate.
7-74
07
WARNING
OJX1070282L
[1] : Driving route, [2] : Branch line,
[3] : Curved road section, [4] : Main road
ś If there is no destination set on the
navigation, Highway Curve Zone Auto
Slowdown function will operate based
on the curve information on the main
road.
ś Even if you depart from the main road,
Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown
function may temporarily operate
due to navigation information of the
highway curve section.
ś Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control is not a substitute for safe
driving practices, but a convenience
function. Always have your eyes on
the road, and it is the responsibility
of the driver to avoid violating traffic
laws.
ś The navigation’s speed limit
information may differ from the
actual speed limit information on the
road. It is the driver's responsibility
to check the speed limit on the
actual driving road or lane.
ś Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control will automatically be
cancelled when you leave the
highway main road. Always pay
attention to road and driving
conditions while driving.
ś Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control may not operate due to the
existence of leading vehicles and
the driving conditions of the vehicle.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions while driving.
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, we recommend
that Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control is turned off due to safety
reasons.
7-75
Driver assistance system
ś After you pass through a tollgate on
a highway, Navigation-based Smart
Cruise Control will operate based on
the first lane. If you enter one of the
other lanes, the function may not
operate properly.
ś The vehicle will accelerate if the
driver depresses the accelerator
pedal while Navigation-based Smart
Cruise Control is operating, and
the function will not decelerate the
vehicle.
ś If the driver accelerates and
releases the accelerator pedal while
Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control is operating, the vehicle may
not decelerate sufficiently or may
rapidly decelerate to a safe speed.
ś If the curve is too large or too small,
Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control may not operate.
Information
ś The time gap could occur between
the navigation’s guidance and when
Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control
operation starts and ends.
ś The speed information on the cluster
and navigation may differ.
ś Even if you are driving at a speed lower
than Smart Cruise Control set speed,
acceleration may be limited by the
curve sections ahead.
ś If Navigation-based Smart Cruise
Control is operating while leaving the
main road to enter an interchange,
junction, rest area, etc., the function
may operate for a certain period of
time.
ś Deceleration by Navigation-based
Smart Cruise Control may feel it is not
sufficient due to road conditions such
as uneven road surfaces, narrow lanes,
etc.
7-76
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the device.
Information
Radio frequency radiation exposure
information:
This equipment complies with FCC
radiation exposure limits set forth for an
uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and
operated with minimum distance of 8 in.
(20 cm) between the radiator (antenna)
and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or
operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter.
07
/$1()2//2:,1*$66,67ǣ/)$Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Lane Following Assist is designed to help
detect lane markings and/or vehicles on
WKHURDGDQGDVVLVWVWKHGULYHUŔVVWHHULQJ
to help center the vehicle in the lane.
Lane Following Assist Settings
Warning Volume
Detecting sensor
OTM070141N
OTM071001L
[1] : Front view camera
The front view camera is used as a
detecting sensor to help detect lane
markings and vehicles in front.
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting sensor.
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Hands-off warning.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
CAUTION
For more details on the precautions
of the front view camera, refer to
“Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
7-77
Driver assistance system
Lane Following Assist Operation
Lane Following Assist
Turning Lane Following Assist On/
Off
OTMA070008
OTM070063
With the engine on, shortly press the
Lane Driving Assist button located on the
steering wheel to turn on Lane Following
indicator
Assist. The white or green
light will illuminate on the cluster.
Press the button again to turn off the
function.
If the vehicle ahead and/or both lane
markings are detected and your vehicle
speed is below 110 mph (180 km/h), the
indicator light will illuminate
green
on the cluster, and Lane Following Assist
will help center the vehicle in the lane by
assisting the steering wheel.
CAUTION
When the steering wheel is not assisted,
indicator light will blink
the green
and change to white.
7-78
07
Hands-off warning
WARNING
OTM070037N
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds, the
œ3ODFHKDQGVRQWKHVWHHULQJZKHHOŔ
warning message will appear and an
audible warning will sound in stages.
First stage : Warning message
Second stage : Warning message (red
steering wheel) and
audible warning
ś Lane Following Assist does not
operate at all times. It is the
responsibility of the driver to safely
steer the vehicle and to maintain the
vehicle in its lane.
ś The hands–off warning message
may appear late depending on road
conditions. Always have your hands
on the steering wheel while driving.
ś If the steering wheel is held very
lightly the hands–off warning
message may appear because the
function may not recognize that the
driver has their hands on the steering
wheel.
ś If you attach objects to the steering
wheel, the hands-off warning may
not work properly.
OTM070117N
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
hands-off warning, the ‘Lane Following
$VVLVW /)$ FDQFHOHGŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
will appear and Lane Following Assist will
be automatically canceled.
7-79
Driver assistance system
Information
ś You may change settings from the
instrument cluster (User Settings) or
infotainment system (Vehicle Settings),
whichever option that is provided with
your vehicle. For more details, see
"User Settings" section in chapter 4, or
"Vehicle Settings" section in supplied
Infotainment Manual.
ś When both lane markings are detected,
the lane lines on the cluster will change
from grey to white.
Lane undetected
Lane Following Assist
Malfunction and Limitations
Lane Following Assist malfunction
Lane detected
OTM070118N
When Lane Following Assist is not
working properly, the ‘Check Lane
)ROORZLQJ$VVLVW /)$ V\VWHPŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster. If this
occurs, have the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Limitations of Lane Following Assist
OTM070025
OTM070026
ś If lane markings are not detected,
steering wheel control by Lane
Following Assist can be limited
depending on whether a vehicle is in
front or the driving conditions of the
vehicle.
ś Even though the steering is assisted
by Lane Following Assist, the driver
may control the steering wheel.
ś The steering wheel may feel heavier
or lighter when the steering wheel is
assisted by Lane Following Assist than
when it is not.
7-80
For more details on Lane Following Assist
limitations, refer to “Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA)” section in chapter 7.
WARNING
For more details on Lane Following
Assist precautions, refer to “Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA)” section in chapter
7.
07
+,*+:$<'5,9,1*$66,67ǣ+'$Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Highway Driving Assist is designed to
help detect vehicles and lanes ahead,
and help maintain distance from the
vehicle ahead, maintain the set speed,
and help center the vehicle in the
lane while driving on the highway (or
motorway).
Detecting sensor
OTM071001L
OADAS035
Information
ś The Highway Driving Assist is available
only on controlled access road of
certain highways.
à Controlled access road indicates
roads with limited entrances and
exits that allow uninterrupted high
speed traffic flow. Only passenger
cars and motorcycles are allowed on
controlled access roads.
ś Additional highways may be expanded
by future navigation updates.
OTM070022
[1] : Front view camera,
[2] : Front radar
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
CAUTION
For more details on the precautions of
the detecting sensors, refer to “Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)”
section in chapter 7.
7-81
Driver assistance system
Highway Driving Assist Settings
OTM070193N
With the engine on, select or deselect
œ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ'ULYLQJ&RQYHQLHQFHŔ
from the Settings menu to set whether or
not to use the following function(s).
Basic function
,Iœ+LJKZD\'ULYLQJ$VVLVWŔLVVHOHFWHGLW
helps maintain distance from the vehicle
ahead, maintain the set speed, and helps
center the vehicle in the lane.
Information
ś If there is a problem with the
function(s), the settings cannot be
changed. Have the vehicle be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś If the engine is restarted, the function(s)
will maintain the last setting.
WARNING
For your safety, only change the
Settings after parking the vehicle at a
safe location.
7-82
Warning Volume
OTM070141N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Hands-off warning.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
07
Highway Driving Assist
Operation
Basic function
Displaying operating status
You can see the status of the Highway
Driving Assist operation in the Driving
Assist mode on the cluster. Refer to “LCD
Display Modes” section in chapter 4.
Highway Driving Assist will be displayed
as below depending on the status of the
function.
Operating state
OTMA070009
Standby state
OTMA070010
(1) Highway Driving Assist indicator,
whether there is a vehicle ahead
and the selected distance level are
displayed.
à Highway Driving Assist indicator
: Operating state
- Green
: Standby state
- White
(2) Set speed is displayed.
(3) Lane Following Assist indicator
displayed.
(4) Whether there is a vehicle ahead and
the selected vehicle distance are
displayed.
(5) Whether the lane is detected or not is
displayed.
à For more details and the limitations
of the function on Lane Following
Assistance, refer to “Lane Following
Assistance (LFA)”.
à For more details and the limitations of
the function on Smart Cruise Control,
refer to “Smart Cruise Control (SCC)”.
Highway Driving Assist operation
Highway Driving Assist will operate when
entering or driving on the main road of
highways, and satisfying all the following
conditions:
- Lane Following Assist is operating
- Smart Cruise Control is operating
Information
ś While driving on the highway, if
Smart Cruise Control starts operating,
Highway Driving Assist will operate.
ś When entering the main roads of
highways, Highway Driving Assist will
not turn on if the Lane Following Assist
is turned off even when Smart Cruise
Control is operating.
7-83
Driver assistance system
OTM070114L
Restarting after stopping
When Highway Driving Assist is
operating, your vehicle will stop if the
vehicle ahead of you stops. Also, if the
vehicle ahead of you starts moving
within 30 seconds after the stop, your
vehicle will start as well. In addition, after
the vehicle has stopped and 30 seconds
have passed, the ‘Use switch or pedal to
DFFHOHUDWHŔPHVVDJHZLOODSSHDURQWKH
cluster. Depress the accelerator pedal or
switch
push the + switch, - switch or
to start driving.
OTM070037N
Hands-off warning
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds, the
œ3ODFHKDQGVRQWKHVWHHULQJZKHHOŔ
warning message will appear and an
audible warning will sound in stages.
First stage : Warning message
Second stage : Warning message (red
steering wheel) and
audible warning
OTM070195N
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
hands-off warning, the ‘Highway Driving
$VVLVW +'$ FDQFHOHGŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
will appear and Highway Driving
Assist and Lane Change Assist will be
automatically canceled.
7-84
07
Highway Driving Assist standby
When Smart Cruise Control is
temporarily canceled while Highway
Driving Assist is operating, Highway
Driving Assist will be in the standby state.
At this time, Lane Following Assist will
operate normally.
Highway Driving Assist
Malfunction and Limitations
Highway Driving Assist malfunction
OTM070120N
When Highway Driving Assist or Highway
Lane Change function is not working
properly, the ‘Check Highway Driving
$VVLVW +'$ V\VWHPŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
warning light
will appear, and the
will illuminate on the cluster. Have the
function be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
ś The driver is responsible for
controlling the vehicle for safe
driving.
ś Always have your hands on the
steering wheel while driving.
ś Highway Driving Assist is a
supplemental function that assists
the driver in driving the vehicle
and is not a complete autonomous
driving function. Always check road
conditions, and if necessary, take
appropriate actions to drive safely.
ś Always have your eyes on the road,
and it is the responsibility of the
driver to avoid violating traffic laws.
The vehicle manufacturer is not
responsible for any traffic violation
or accidents caused by the driver.
ś Highway Driving Assist may not
be able to recognize all traffic
situations. Highway Driving Assist
may not detect possible collisions
due to limitations of the function.
Always be aware of the limitations
of the function. Obstacles such as
vehicles, motorcycles, bicycles,
pedestrians, unspecified objects,
structures, guardrails, toll gates, etc.,
that may collide with the vehicle may
not be detected.
ś Highway Driving Assist will turn off
automatically under the following
situations:
- Driving on roads that Highway
Driving Assist does not operate,
such as a rest area, intersection,
junction, etc.
- The navigation does not operate
properly such as when the
navigation is being updated or
restarted
7-85
Driver assistance system
ś Highway Driving Assist may
inadvertently operate or turn off
depending on road conditions
(navigation information) and
surroundings.
ś Lane Following Assist function may
be temporarily disabled when the
front view camera cannot detect
lanes properly or the hands-off
warning is on.
ś You may not hear the warning sound
of Highway Driving Assist if the
surrounding is noisy.
ś If the vehicle is driven at high speed
above a certain speed at a curve,
your vehicle may drive to one side or
may depart from the driving lane.
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, we recommend that
Highway Driving Assist is turned off
due to safety reasons.
ś The hands–off warning message
may appear early or late depending
on how the steering wheel is held or
road conditions. Always have your
hands on the steering wheel while
driving.
ś For your safety, please read the
owner's manual before using the
Highway Driving Assist.
ś Highway Driving Assist will not
operate when the engine is started,
or when the detecting sensors or
navigation is being initialized.
7-86
Limitations of Highway Driving
Assist
Highway Driving Assist may not operate
normally, or may not operate under the
following circumstances:
ś The map information and the
actual road is different because the
navigation is not updated
ś The map information and the actual
road is different because of real-time
GPS data or map information error
ś The infotainment system is overloaded
by simultaneously performing
functions such as route search, video
playback, voice recognition, etc.
ś GPS signals are blocked in areas such
as a tunnel
ś The driver goes off course or the
route to the destination is changed or
canceled by resetting the navigation
ś The vehicle enters a service station or
rest area
ś Android Auto or Car Play is operating
ś The navigation cannot detect the
current vehicle position (for example,
elevated roads including overpass
adjacent to general roads or nearby
roads exist in a parallel way)
For more details on the limitations of
the front view camera, front radar, front
corner radar and rear corner radar, refer
to “Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA)” section in chapter 7.
07
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the device.
Information
Radio frequency radiation exposure
information:
This equipment complies with FCC
radiation exposure limits set forth for an
uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and
operated with minimum distance of 8 in.
(20 cm) between the radiator (antenna)
and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or
operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter.
7-87
Driver assistance system
5($59,(:021,725ǣ590Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Detecting Sensor
OTM070071
Rear View Monitor will show the area
behind the vehicle to assist you when
parking or backing up.
7-88
OTM071167L
[1] : Rear view camera
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the camera.
07
Rear View Monitor Settings
Rear View Monitor Operation
Camera settings
Parking/View button
OTM070210L
ś You can change Rear View Monitor
œ'LVSOD\&RQWHQWVŔRUœ'LVSOD\6HWWLQJVŔ
by touching the setup icon ( ) on
the screen while Rear View Monitor
is operating, or selecting ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\Ɵ&DPHUD
6HWWLQJVŔIURPWKH6HWWLQJVPHQX
while the engine is on.
ś In the Display Contents, you can
FKDQJHVHWWLQJVIRUœ5HDU9LHZŔ
and in the Display Settings, you can
FKDQJHWKHVFUHHQŔVœ%ULJKWQHVVŔDQG
œ&RQWUDVWŔ
OTM070072
Press the Parking/View button (1) to turn
on Rear View Monitor.
Press the button again to turn off the
function.
7-89
Driver assistance system
Rear view
Rear top view
Operating conditions
ś Shift the gear to R (Reverse), the
image will appear on the screen.
ś Press the Parking/View button (1)
while the gear is in P (Park), the image
will appear on the screen. However,
parking guidance is not displayed.
Off conditions
ś The rear view cannot be turned off
when the gear is in R (Reverse).
ś Press the Parking/View button (1)
again while the gear is in P (Park) with
the rear view on the screen, the rear
view will turn off.
ś Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to P
(Park), the rear view will turn off.
Maintaining rear view
The rear view will maintain showing on
the screen to help you when parking.
However, parking guidance is not
displayed.
Operating conditions
Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to N
(Neutral) or D (Drive), the rear view will
appear on the screen.
Off conditions
ś When vehicle speed is above 6 mph
(10 km/h), the rear view will turn off.
ś Shift the gear to P (Park), the rear view
will turn off.
7-90
OTM070212L
When you touch the icon, the top view
is displayed on the screen and shows the
distance from the vehicle in the back of
your vehicle while parking.
07
Rear View Monitor Malfunction
and Limitations
Rear View Monitor malfunction
When Rear View Monitor is not working
properly, or the screen flickers, or the
camera image does not display normally,
have the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Limitations of Rear View Monitor
When the vehicle is stopped for a long
time in winter or when the vehicle is
parked in an indoor parking lot, the
exhaust fumes may temporarily blur the
image.
WARNING
ś The rear view camera does not
cover the complete area behind the
vehicle. The driver should always
check the rear area directly through
the inside and side view mirror
before parking or backing up.
ś The image shown on the screen may
differ from the actual distance of the
object. Make sure to directly check
the vehicle's surroundings for safety.
ś Always keep the rear view camera
lens clean. If the lens is covered with
foreign material, it may adversely
affect camera performance and
Rear View Monitor may not operate
normally. However, do not use
chemical solvents such as strong
detergents containing high alkaline
or volatile organic solvents (gasoline,
acetone etc.). This may damage the
camera lens.
7-91
Driver assistance system
6855281'9,(:021,725ǣ690Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Detecting Sensors
OTM070183
OTM070239
OTM070182
Surround View Monitor can help assist in
parking using the cameras installed on
the vehicle and displays images around
the vehicle through the infotainment
system screen.
ś Parking Assist View function helps
the driver to see the surroundings of
the vehicle in a parking situation in
various view modes.
7-92
OTM070171
[1] : SVM-front view camera,
[2],[3] : SVM-side view camera
(under the side view mirror),
[4] : SVM-rear view camera
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the cameras.
07
Surround View Monitor Settings
Front top view
Camera settings
OTMA070003
Rear top view
OTM070213L
ś You can change Surround View
0RQLWRUœ'LVSOD\&RQWHQWVŔRUœ'LVSOD\
6HWWLQJVŔE\WRXFKLQJWKHVHWXSLFRQ
( ) on the screen while Surround
View Monitor is operating, or selecting
œ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\Ɵ
&DPHUD6HWWLQJVŔIURPWKH6HWWLQJV
menu while the engine is on.
ś In the Display Contents, you can
change settings for ‘Top View Parking
*XLGDQFHŔœ5HDU9LHZ3DUNLQJ
*XLGDQFHŔDQGœ3DUNLQJ'LVWDQFH
:DUQLQJŔ
ś In the Display Settings, you can
FKDQJHWKHVFUHHQŔVœ%ULJKWQHVVŔDQG
œ&RQWUDVWŔ
OTM070214L
Top View Parking Guidance
ś :KHQWKHœ7RS9LHZ3DUNLQJ*XLGDQFHŔ
is selected, parking guidance is
displayed on the right side of the
Surround View Monitor screen.
ś You may see the front top view or the
rear top view when using Top View
Parking Guidance.
7-93
Driver assistance system
Surround View Monitor Auto On
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\Ɵ6XUURXQG
9LHZ0RQLWRU$XWR2QŔIURPWKH6HWWLQJV
menu to use the function.
To use this function, refer to “Surround
View Monitor Operation”.
Surround View Monitor
Operation
OTM070216L
Parking/View button
Rear View Parking Guidance
ś When the ‘Rear View Parking
*XLGDQFHŔLVVHOHFWHGSDUNLQJ
guidance is displayed in the rear view.
ś The horizontal guideline of the Rear
View Parking Guidance shows the
distance of 1.6 ft (0.5m), 3.3 ft (1 m)
and 7.6 ft (2.3m) from the vehicle.
OTM070072
OTM070217L
Parking Distance Warning
ś :KHQWKHœ3DUNLQJ'LVWDQFH:DUQLQJŔ
is selected, parking distance warning
is displayed on the right side of the
Surround View Monitor screen.
ś The image will be displayed only when
Parking Distance Warning is warning
the driver.
7-94
OTM070074
ś Press the Parking/View button (1) to
turn on Surround View Monitor.
Press the button again to turn off the
function.
ś Other view modes can be selected
by touching the view icons (2) on the
Surround View Monitor screen.
ś When one of the infotainment system
button (3) is pressed without the gear
in R (Reverse), Surround View Monitor
will turn off.
07
Front view
Rear view
The front image is displayed on the
screen when the gear is in N (Neutral) or
D (Drive) to assist in parking. The front
view has a top view/front view/side view.
The rear image is displayed on the screen
when the gear is in R (Revers) or P (Park)
to assist in parking. The rear view has a
top view/rear view/side view.
Operating conditions
ś Front view function will operate when
the following conditions are satisfied:
- While the infotainment system
screen is being displayed, press the
Parking/View button (1) briefly when
the gear is in D (Drive) or N (Neutral)
and vehicle speed is below 9 mph
(15 km/h).
ś Surround View Monitor Auto On
function will operate when the
following conditions are satisfied:
- :LWKœ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ
6DIHW\Ɵ6XUURXQG9LHZ0RQLWRU
$XWR2QŔVHOHFWHGIURPWKH6HWWLQJV
menu, the front parking assist view
screen is displayed when Parking
Distance Warning warns the driver
while driving in D (Drive).
Operating conditions
ś Shift the gear to R (Reverse), the
image will appear on the screen.
ś Press the Parking/View button (1)
while the gear is in P (Park), the image
will appear on the screen. However,
parking guidance is not displayed.
Off conditions
ś The image cannot be turned off when
the gear is in R (Reverse).
ś Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to P
(Park), the image will turn off.
ś Press the Parking/View button (1)
again while the gear is in P (Park) with
the image on the screen.
Off conditions
ś Press the Parking/View button (1)
again, the image will turn off.
ś When vehicle speed is above 9 mph
(15 km/h) with the gear in D (Drive),
Surround View Monitor will turn off
and the screen will change back to the
previous infotainment system screen.
Although you drive below 9 mph (15
km/h) again, Surround View Monitor
will not turn on.
ś Press one of the infotainment system
button (3), the screen will change to
the infotainment system screen.
ś Shift the gear to P (Park), the image
will turn off.
7-95
Driver assistance system
Surround View Monitor
Malfunction and Limitations
Surround View Monitor malfunction
When Surround View Monitor is not
working properly, or the screen flickers,
or the camera image does not display
normally, have the vehicle be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Limitations of Surround View
Monitor
ś When the vehicle is stopped for a long
time in winter or when the vehicle is
parked in an indoor parking lot, the
exhaust fumes may temporarily blur
the image.
ś The screen may be displayed
abnormally, and an icon will appear at
the top left side of the screen under
the following circumstances:
- The liftgate is opened
- The driver or front passenger door
is opened
- The side view mirror is folded
7-96
WARNING
ś ALWAYS look around your vehicle
to make sure there are no objects
or obstacles before moving the
vehicle. What you see on the screen
may differ from the actual vehicle’s
location.
ś The image shown on the screen may
differ from the actual distance of the
object. Make sure to directly check
the vehicle's surroundings for safety.
ś When the rear view is displayed
while driving, an icon ( ) appears at
the top right side of the infotainment
system screen to inform the driver
the rear view is being displayed. Do
not be confused with the front wide
view image.
ś Surround View Monitor is designed
to be used on a flat surface.
Therefore, if used on roads with
different heights such as curbs
and speed bumps, the image in the
screen may not look correct.
ś Always keep the camera lens clean.
If the lens is covered with foreign
material, it may adversely affect
camera performance and Surround
View Monitor may not operate
normally. However, do not use
chemical solvents such as strong
detergents containing high alkaline
or volatile organic solvents (gasoline,
acetone etc.). This may damage the
camera lens.
07
5($5&5266ǘ75$)),&&2//,6,21ǘ$92,'$1&($66,67
ǣ5&&$Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist is designed to help detect vehicles
approaching from the left and right side
while your vehicle is reversing, and warn
the driver that a collision is imminent
with a warning message and an audible
warning. Also, braking is assisted to help
prevent a collision.
Detecting sensor
OTM071146L
[1] : Rear corner radar
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
OJX1079108
[A] : Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning operating
range,
[B] : Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist
operating range
CAUTION
For more details on the precautions of
the rear corner radar, refer to “BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)”
section in chapter 7.
CAUTION
Warning timing may vary depending on
the speed of the approaching vehicle.
7-97
Driver assistance system
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist Settings
Rear Cross-Traffic Safety
OTM070140N
OTM070194N
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\Ɵ5HDU&URVV
7UDIILF6DIHW\ŔIURPWKH6HWWLQJVPHQX
to turn on Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist and deselect to turn off
the function.
WARNING
When the engine is restarted, Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist
will always turn on. However, if ‘Off’ is
selected after the engine is restarted,
the driver should always be aware of
the surroundings and drive safely.
7-98
Warning Timing
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the initial
warning activation time for Rear CrossTraffic Collision-Avoidance Assist.
When the vehicle is first delivered,
:DUQLQJ7LPLQJLVVHWWRœ1RUPDOŔ,I\RX
change the Warning Timing, the warning
time of other Driver Assistance systems
may change.
07
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist Operation
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist will warn and control the vehicle
depending on collision level: ‘Collision
:DUQLQJŔœ(PHUJHQF\%UDNLQJŔDQG
‘Stopping vehicle and ending brake
FRQWUROŔ
Collision Warning
OTM070141N
Warning Volume
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
OHY059034
OTM070168
CAUTION
ś The setting of the Warning Timing
and Warning Volume applies to
all functions of the Rear CollisionAvoidance Assist.
ś Even though ‘Normal’ is selected for
Warning Timing, if the vehicles from
the left and right side approaches
at high speed, the initial warning
activation time may seem late.
ś Select ‘Late’ for Warning Timing
when traffic is light and when driving
speed is slow.
Information
If the engine is restarted, Warning Timing
and Warning Volume will maintain the
last setting.
OTM070076
ś To warn the driver of an approaching
vehicle from the rear left/right side
of your vehicle, the warning light on
the side view mirror will blink and a
warning will appear on the cluster. At
the same time, an audible warning
will sound. If Rear View Monitor is
operating, a warning will also appear
on the infotainment system screen.
7-99
Driver assistance system
ś Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist will operate when all the
following conditions are satisfied:
- The gear is shifted to R (Reverse)
- Vehicle speed is below 5 mph (8
km/h)
- The approaching vehicle is within
approximately 82 ft. (25 m) from the
left or right side of your vehicle
- The speed of the vehicle
approaching from the left and right
is above 3 mph (5 km/h)
Emergency Braking
OHY059034
OTM070122N
Information
If the operating conditions are satisfied,
there will be a warning whenever the
vehicle approaches from the left or right
side even though your vehicle speed is 0
mph (0 km/h).
OTM070076
ś To warn the driver of an approaching
vehicle from the rear left/right side
of your vehicle, the warning light on
the side view mirror will blink and,
the 'Emergency Braking' warning
message will appear on the cluster.
At the same time, an audible warning
will sound. If Rear View Monitor is
operating, a warning will also appear
on the infotainment system screen.
7-100
07
ś Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist will operate when all the
following conditions are satisfied:
- The gear is shifted to R (Reverse)
- Vehicle speed is below 5 mph (8
km/h)
- The approaching vehicle is within
approximately 5 ft. (1.5 m) from the
left or right side of your vehicle
- The speed of the vehicle
approaching from the left and right
is above 3 mph (5 km/h)
ś Emergency braking will be assisted
to help prevent collision with
approaching vehicles from the left
and right.
WARNING
Brake control will end when:
- The approaching vehicle is out of the
detecting range
- The approaching vehicle passes
behind your vehicle
- The approaching vehicle does not
drive toward your vehicle
- The approaching vehicle speed slows
down
- The driver depresses the brake pedal
with sufficient power
Stopping vehicle and ending brake
control
OTM070169L
ś When the vehicle is stopped due
to emergency braking, the ‘Drive
FDUHIXOO\ŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOO
appear on the cluster.
ś For your safety, the driver should
depress the brake pedal immediately
and check the surroundings.
ś Brake control will end after the vehicle
is stopped by emergency braking for
approximately 2 seconds.
ś During emergency braking, braking
control by Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist will automatically
cancel when the driver excessively
depresses the brake pedal.
7-101
Driver assistance system
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist:
ś For your safety, only change the
Settings after parking the vehicle at a
safe location.
ś If any other system’s warning
message is displayed or audible
warning is generated, Rear CrossTraffic Collision-Avoidance Assist
warning message may not be
displayed and audible warning may
not be generated.
ś You may not hear the warning sound
of Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist if the surroundings
are noisy.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may not operate if
the driver applies the brake pedal to
avoid collision.
ś During Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist operation, the
vehicle may stop suddenly injuring
passengers and shifting loose
objects. Always have the seat belt on
and keep loose objects secured.
ś Even if there is a problem with Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist, the vehicle’s basic braking
performance will operate normally.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist does not operate
in all situations and cannot avoid all
collisions.
ś During emergency braking, braking
control by Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision-Avoidance Assist will
automatically cancel when the
driver excessively depresses the
accelerator pedal.
7-102
ś The driver is solely responsible to
operate the vehicle in a safe manner.
Do not solely depend on Rear CrossTraffic Collision-Avoidance Assist.
Rather, maintain a safe braking
distance, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce driving
speed or to stop the vehicle.
ś Never deliberately operate Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist on people, animal, objects,
etc. It may cause serious injury or
death.
CAUTION
The brake control may not operate
properly depending on the status of
ESC (Electronic Stability Control).
There will only be a warning when:
- The ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
warning light is on
- ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
engaged in a different function
Information
ś If Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist assists you with
braking, the driver needs to pay
attention as the brake assist will end
within 2 seconds. The driver must
immediately depress the brake pedal
and check vehicle surroundings.
ś Brake control will end when the
driver depresses the brake pedal with
sufficient power.
ś After shifting the gear to R (Reverse),
braking control will operate once for
left and right vehicle approach.
07
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist Malfunction
and Limitations
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist disabled
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist malfunction
OTM070124N
OTM070125N
When Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist is not working properly,
the ‘Check Rear Cross-Traffic Safety
V\VWHP V ŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOODSSHDU
on the cluster, and the function will turn
off automatically or the function will be
limited. Have the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When the rear bumper around the rearside radar or sensor is covered with
foreign material, such as snow or rain,
or installing a trailer or carrier, it can
reduce the detecting performance and
temporarily limit or disable Rear CrossTraffic Collision-Avoidance Assist.
If this occurs, the ‘Rear Cross-Traffic
6DIHW\V\VWHPGLVDEOHG5DGDUEORFNHGŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster.
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist will operate normally when
such foreign material or trailer, etc., is
removed.
If Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist does not operate normally after
it is removed, have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
OTM070100N
When the side view mirror warning
light is not working properly, the ‘Check
VLGHYLHZPLUURUZDUQLQJOLJKWŔZDUQLQJ
message will appear on the cluster.
Have the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-103
Driver assistance system
WARNING
ś Even though the warning message
does not appear on the cluster, Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate properly.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may not operate
properly in an area (for example:
open terrain), where any substance
are not detected after turning ON the
engine.
CAUTION
For more details on the limitations of
the rear corner radar, refer to “BlindSpot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)”
section in chapter 7.
WARNING
ś Driving near a vehicle or structure
CAUTION
Turn off Rear Cross-Traffic Safety
system to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or
remove the trailer, carrier, etc., to use
Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system.
Limitations of Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision-Avoidance Assist
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate normally, or it
may operate unexpectedly under the
following circumstances:
ś Departing from where trees or grass
are overgrown
ś Departing from where roads are wet
ś Speed of the approaching vehicle is
fast or slow
%UDNLQJFRQWUROPD\QRWZRUNGULYHUŔV
attention is required in the following
circumstances:
ś The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road, uneven
road or concrete patch
ś Driving on a slippery surface due to
snow, water puddle, ice, etc.
ś The tire pressure is low or a tire is
damaged
ś The brake is reworked
ś Remote Smart Parking Assist is
operating (if equipped)
7-104
OJX1079111
[A] : Structure
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may be limited
when driving near a vehicle or
structure, and may not detect the
vehicle approaching from the left
or right. If this occurs, Rear CrossTraffic Collision-Avoidance Assist
may not warn the driver or control
the brakes when necessary.
Always check your surroundings
while backing up.
07
ś When the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment
ś When the vehicle is parked
diagonally
OJX1079112
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may detect vehicles
which are parking or pulling out
near your vehicle (for example: a
vehicle leaving beside your vehicle,
a vehicle parking or pulling out in
the rear area, a vehicle approaching
your vehicle making a turn, etc.).
If this occurs, the function may
unnecessarily warn the driver and
control the brake.
Always check your surroundings
while backing up.
OJX1079113
[A] : Vehicle
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may be limited
when backing up diagonally,
and may not detect the vehicle
approaching from the left or right.
If this occurs, the function may not
warn the driver or control the brakes
when necessary. Always check your
surroundings while backing up.
ś When the vehicle is on or near a
slope
OTM070229L
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may be limited
when the vehicle is on a uphill or
downhill slope, or near it, and may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the left or right. If this occurs,
the function may not warn the
driver or control the brakes when
necessary.
Always check your surroundings
while backing up.
7-105
Driver assistance system
ś Pulling into the parking space where
there is a structure
ś When the vehicle is parked rearward
OJX1079116
OJX1079115
[A] : Structure, [B] :Wall
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may detect vehicles
passing by in front of you when
parking in reverse into a parking
space with a wall or structure in the
rear or side area. If this occurs, the
function may unnecessarily warn the
driver and control the brake.
Always check your surroundings
while backing up.
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may detect vehicles
passing by behind you when parking
in reverse into a parking space.
If this occurs, the function may
unnecessarily warn the driver and
control the brake.
Always check your surroundings
while backing up.
WARNING
ś When you are towing a trailer or
another vehicle, we recommend
that Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist is turned off due to
safety reasons.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may not operate
normally if interfered by strong
electromagnetic waves.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist may not operate
for 3 seconds after the vehicle is
started, or the rear corner radars are
initialized.
7-106
07
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the device.
Information
Radio frequency radiation exposure
information:
This equipment complies with FCC
radiation exposure limits set forth for an
uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and
operated with minimum distance of 8 in.
(20 cm) between the radiator (antenna)
and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or
operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter.
7-107
Driver assistance system
5(9(56(3$5.,1*',67$1&(:$51,1*ǣ3':Ǥǣ,)
(48,33('Ǥ
Reverse Parking Distance Warning will
help warn the driver if an obstacle is
detected within a certain distance when
the vehicle is moving in reverse at low
speeds.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning Operation
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
Off button
Detecting sensors
OTM070082L
OTM070081L
[1] : Rear ultrasonic sensors
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning Settings
Warning Volume
OTM070141N
6HOHFWœ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ
9ROXPHŔIURPWKHFOXVWHURULQIRWDLQPHQW
system Settings menu to change the
:DUQLQJ9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔ
RUœ/RZŔIRU5HYHUVH3DUNLQJ'LVWDQFH
Warning.
7-108
ś Press the Parking Distance Warning
Off ( ) button to turn off Reverse
Parking Distance Warning. Press the
button again to turn on the function.
ś When Reverse Parking Distance
Warning is off (button indicator
light on), if you shift the gear
to R (Reverse), the function will
automatically turn on.
07
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
will operate when the gear is in R
(Reverse).
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
detects a person, animal or object in
WKHUHDUZKHQWKHYHKLFOHŔVUHDUZDUG
speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h).
Distance
from object
Warning
indicator
Driving
rearward
Warning
sound
24~48 in.
(60~120 cm)
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
12~24 in.
(30~60 cm)
Beeps more
frequently
within 12 in.
(30 cm)
Beeps
continuously
ś The corresponding indicator will
illuminate whenever each ultrasonic
sensor detects a person, animal or
object in its sensing range. Also an
audible warning will sound.
ś When more than two objects are
detected at the same time, the closest
one will be warned with an audible
warning.
ś The shape of the indicator in the
illustration may differ from the actual
vehicle.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning Malfunction and
Limitations
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
malfunction
After starting the engine, a beep will
sound when the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse) to indicate Reverse Parking
Distance Warning is operating normally.
However, if one or more of the following
occurs, first check whether the ultrasonic
sensor is damaged or blocked with
foreign material. If it still does not work
properly, have the vehicle be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś The audible warning does not sound.
ś The buzzer sounds intermittently.
ś 7KHœ3DUNLQJVHQVRUHUURURUEORFNDJHŔ
warning message appears on the
cluster.
OTM070218L
7-109
Driver assistance system
WARNING
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
is a supplemental function. The
operation of Reverse Parking
Distance Warning can be affected
by several factors (including
environmental conditions). It is the
responsibility of the driver to always
check the rear view before and while
parking.
ś Your new vehicle warranty does not
cover any accidents or damage to
the vehicle due to the malfunction of
Reverse Parking Distance Warning.
ś Pay close attention when driving
near objects, pedestrians, and
especially children. Some objects
may not be detected by the
ultrasonic sensors, due to the objects
distance, size or material, all of
which can limit the effectiveness of
the sensor.
Limitations of Reverse Parking
Distance Warning
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
may not operate normally when:
- Moisture is frozen to the sensor
- Sensor is covered with foreign
material, such as snow or water
(Reverse Parking Distance Warning
will operate normally when such
foreign material are removed.)
- The weather is extremely hot or cold
- The sensor or sensor assembly is
disassembled
- The surface of the sensor has been
subjected to a hard impact
- The surface of the sensor has been
scratched with a sharp object
- The sensors or its surrounding
area is directly sprayed with high
pressure washer
7-110
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
may malfunction when:
- Heavy rain or water spray is present
- Water flows on the surface of the
sensor
- $IIHFWHGE\DQRWKHUYHKLFOHŔV
sensors
- The sensor is covered with snow
- Driving on uneven road, gravel
roads or bushes
- Objects that generates ultrasonic
waves are near the sensor
- Installing the license plate
differently from the original location
- The vehicle bumper height or
ultrasonic sensor installation has
been modified
- Attaching equipments or
accessories around the ultrasonic
sensors
ś The following objects may not be
detected:
- Sharp or slim objects, such as ropes,
chains or small poles.
- Objects, which tend to absorb
sensor frequency, such as clothes,
spongy material or snow.
- Objects smaller than 40 in. (100 cm)
in length and narrower than 6 in. (14
cm) in diameter.
- Pedestrians, animals or objects
that are very close to the ultrasonic
sensors
ś Parking Distance Warning Indicators
may be displayed differently from
the actual detected location when
the obstacle is located between the
sensors.
ś Parking Distance Warning indicator
may not occur sequentially depending
on vehicle speed or obstacle shape.
ś If Reverse Parking Distance Warning
needs repair, have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
07
)25:$5'5(9(56(3$5.,1*',67$1&(:$51,1*ǣ3':Ǥ
ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning will help warn the driver if an
obstacle is detected within a certain
distance when the vehicle is moving
forward or in reverse at low speeds.
Parking Distance Warning
Settings
Warning Volume
Detecting sensors
OTM070141N
OTM070080
6HOHFWœ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ
9ROXPHŔIURPWKHFOXVWHURULQIRWDLQPHQW
system Settings menu to change the
:DUQLQJ9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔ
RUœ/RZŔIRU)RUZDUG5HYHUVH3DUNLQJ
Distance Warning.
Parking Distance Warning Auto On
To use Parking Distance Warning Auto
On function, select ‘Driver Assistance
Ɵ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\Ɵ3DUNLQJ'LVWDQFH
:DUQLQJ$XWR2QŔIURPWKHFOXVWHURU
infotainment system Settings menu.
OTM070081
[1] : Front ultrasonic sensors,
[2] : Rear ultrasonic sensors
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
7-111
Driver assistance system
Parking Distance Warning
Operation
Parking Safety button
OTM070082
ś Press the Parking Safety (
) button
to turn on Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning. Press the button
again to turn off the function.
ś When Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning is off (button
indicator light off), if you shift the
gear to R (Reverse), the function will
automatically turn on.
ś When Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning turns on, the button
indicator light will turn on. If vehicle
speed is above 12 mph (20 km/h),
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning will turn off (button indicator
light off).
à If equipped with Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist or
Remote Smart Parking Assist,
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning will turn off (button
indicator light off) when vehicle
speed is above 18 mph (30 km/h).
7-112
Forward Parking Distance Warning
ś Forward Parking Distance Warning will
operate when one of the condition is
satisfied.
- The gear is shifted from R (Reverse)
to D (Drive) with Reverse Parking
Distance Warning on
- The gear is in D (Drive) and the
Parking Safety button indicator light
is on
- œ3DUNLQJ'LVWDQFH:DUQLQJ$XWR2QŔ
is selected from the Settings menu
and the gear is in D (Drive)
ś Forward Parking Distance Warning
detects a person, animal or object
LQIURQWZKHQWKHYHKLFOHŔVIRUZDUG
speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h).
ś Forward Parking Distance Warning
does not operate when the vehicle's
forward speed is above 6 mph (10
km/h) even when the Parking Safety
button indicator is on. Forward
Parking Distance Warning will operate
again when the vehicle's forward
speed decreases below 6 mph (10
km/h) while the Parking Safety button
indicator is on.
ś When ‘Parking Distance Warning Auto
2QŔLVVHOHFWHGWKH3DUNLQJ6DIHW\
button indicator light stays on.
07
ś When ‘Parking Distance Warning Auto
2QŔLVGHVHOHFWHGDQGWKHYHKLFOHŔV
forward speed is above 12 mph (20
km/h), the Parking Safety button
indicator will turn off. Although you
drive below 6 mph (10 km/h), the
function will not turn on.
à If equipped with Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist or
Remote Smart Parking Assist,
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning will turn off when vehicle
speed is above 18 mph (30 km/h).
Distance
from object
Warning
indicator
Driving
forward
Warning
sound
24~40 in.
(60~100 cm)
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
12~24 in.
(30~60 cm)
Beeps more
frequently
within 12 in.
(30 cm)
Beeps
continuously
ś The corresponding indicator will
illuminate whenever each ultrasonic
sensor detects a person, animal or
object in its sensing range. Also an
audible warning will sound.
ś When more than two objects are
detected at the same time, the closest
one will be warned with an audible
warning.
ś The shape of the indicator in the
illustration may differ from the actual
vehicle.
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
will operate when the gear is in R
(Reverse).
ś Reverse Parking Distance Warning
detects a person, animal or object in
WKHUHDUZKHQWKHYHKLFOHŔVUHDUZDUG
speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h).
ś :KHQWKHYHKLFOHŔVUHDUZDUGVSHHGLV
below 6 mph (10 km/h), both the front
and rear ultrasonic sensors will detect
objects. However, the front ultrasonic
sensors can detect a person, animal or
object when it is within 24 in. (60 cm)
from the sensors.
Distance
from object
Warning
indicator
Driving
rearward
Warning
sound
24~48 in.
(60~120 cm)
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
12~24 in.
(30~60 cm)
Beeps more
frequently
within 12 in.
(30 cm)
Beeps
continuously
ś The corresponding indicator will
illuminate whenever each ultrasonic
sensor detects a person, animal or
object in its sensing range. Also an
audible warning will sound.
ś When more than two objects are
detected at the same time, the closest
one will be warned with an audible
warning.
ś The shape of the indicator in the
illustration may differ from the actual
vehicle.
7-113
Driver assistance system
Parking Distance Warning
Malfunction and Limitations
Parking Distance Warning
malfunction
After starting the engine, a beep will
sound when the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse) to indicate Forward/Reverse
Parking Distance Warning is operating
normally.
However, if one or more of the following
occurs, first check whether the ultrasonic
sensor is damaged or blocked with
foreign material. If it still does not work
properly, have the vehicle be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś The audible warning does not sound.
ś The buzzer sounds intermittently.
ś 7KHœ3DUNLQJVHQVRUHUURURUEORFNDJHŔ
warning message appears on the
cluster.
OTM070172L
7-114
WARNING
ś Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning is a supplemental function.
The operation of Forward/Reverse
Parking Distance Warning can be
affected by several factors (including
environmental conditions). It is the
responsibility of the driver to always
check the front and rear views before
and while parking.
ś Your new vehicle warranty does not
cover any accidents or damage to
the vehicle due to the malfunction of
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning.
ś Pay close attention when driving
near objects, pedestrians, and
especially children. Some objects
may not be detected by the
ultrasonic sensors, due to the objects
distance, size or material, all of
which can limit the effectiveness of
the sensor.
07
Limitations of Parking Distance
Warning
ś Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning may not operate normally
when:
- Moisture is frozen to the sensor
- Sensor is covered with foreign
material, such as snow or water
(Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning will operate normally when
such foreign material are removed.)
- The weather is extremely hot or cold
- The sensor or sensor assembly is
disassembled
- The surface of the sensor has been
subjected to a hard impact
- The surface of the sensor has been
scratched with a sharp object
- The sensors or its surrounding
area is directly sprayed with high
pressure washer
ś Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning may malfunction when:
- Heavy rain or water spray is present
- Water flows on the surface of the
sensor
- $IIHFWHGE\DQRWKHUYHKLFOHŔV
sensors
- The sensor is covered with snow
- Driving on uneven road, gravel
roads or bushes
- Objects that generates ultrasonic
waves are near the sensor
- Installing the license plate
differently from the original location
- The vehicle bumper height or
ultrasonic sensor installation has
been modified
- Attaching equipments or
accessories around the ultrasonic
sensors
ś The following objects may not be
detected:
- Sharp or slim objects, such as ropes,
chains or small poles.
- Objects, which tend to absorb
sensor frequency, such as clothes,
spongy material or snow.
- Objects smaller than 40 in. (100 cm)
in length and narrower than 6 in. (14
cm) in diameter.
- Pedestrians, animals or objects
that are very close to the ultrasonic
sensors
ś Parking Distance Warning Indicators
may be displayed differently from
the actual detected location when
the obstacle is located between the
sensors.
ś Parking Distance Warning indicator
may not occur sequentially depending
on vehicle speed or obstacle shape.
ś If Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning needs repair, have the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
7-115
Driver assistance system
5(9(56(3$5.,1*&2//,6,21ǘ$92,'$1&($66,67ǣ3&$Ǥǣ,)
(48,33('Ǥ
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist will warn the driver or will
assist with braking to help reduce the
possibility of collision with a pedestrian
or an object when backing up.
Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist Settings
Parking Safety
Detecting sensors
OJX1079207L
OTM071167L
OTM070081
[1] : Rear view camera,
[2] : Rear ultrasonic sensors
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
7-116
With the engine on, select or deselect
œ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\ŔIURP
the Settings menu to set whether or not
to use each function.
- ,Iœ5HDU$FWLYH$VVLVWŔ RUœ$FWLYHUHDU
DVVLVWŔ LVVHOHFWHG5HYHUVH3DUNLQJ
Collision-Avoidance Assist will warn
the driver and assist with braking
when a collision with a pedestrian or
an object is imminent.
- ,Iœ5HDU:DUQLQJ2QO\Ŕ RUœ5HDU
ZDUQLQJRQO\Ŕ LVVHOHFWHG5HYHUVH
Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist will
warn the driver when a collision with
a pedestrian or an object is imminent.
Braking will not be assisted.
- ,Iœ2IIŔLVVHOHFWHG5HYHUVH3DUNLQJ
Collision-Avoidance Assist will turn
off.
07
Warning Timing
Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist Operation
Operating conditions
OJX1079245L
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the initial
warning activation time for Reverse
Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist.
When the vehicle is first delivered,
:DUQLQJ7LPLQJLVVHWWRœ1RUPDOŔ,I
'Normal' feels sensitive, change the
settings to Late.
If you change the Warning Timing, the
warning time of other Driver Assistance
systems may change.
Warning Volume
,Iœ5HDU$FWLYH$VVLVWŔRUœ5HDU:DUQLQJ
2QO\ŔLVVHWIURPWKH6HWWLQJVPHQX
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist will be in the ready status when
the following conditions are satisfied:
- The liftgate is closed
- The gear is shifted to R (Reverse)
- Vehicle speed is below 6 mph (10
km/h)
- Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist components such as the rear
view camera and the rear ultrasonic
sensors are in normal conditions
When Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist activates, a line
appears behind the vehicle image in the
instrument cluster.
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist operates only once after the gear
is shifted to R (Reverse). To reactivate
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist, shift the gear from another gear
to R (Reverse).
OJX1079246L
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
OTM070174
7-117
Driver assistance system
Rear Active Assist
ś If Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist detects a risk of collision with a
pedestrian or an object, the function
will warn the driver with an audible
warning and warning message on the
cluster. When Rear View Monitor is
operating, a warning will appear on
the infotainment system screen.
ś If Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist detects an imminent collision
with a pedestrian or an object behind
the vehicle, the function will assist
you with braking. The driver needs to
pay attention as the brake assist will
end within 2 seconds. The driver must
immediately depress the brake pedal
and check vehicle surroundings.
ś Brake control will end when:
- The gear is shifted to P (Park) or D
(Drive).
- The driver depresses the brake
pedal with sufficient power
- Braking assist has last for
approximately 2 seconds
ś The warning will turn off when:
- The driver shifts the gear to P (Park),
N (Neutral), or D (Drive)
ś The brake control may not operate
properly depending on the status of
ESC (Electronic Stability Control).
There will only be a warning when:
- The ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) warning light is on
- ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
engaged in a different function
7-118
Rear Warning Only
ś If Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist detects a risk of collision with a
pedestrian or an object, the function
will warn the driver with an audible
warning and warning message on the
cluster. When Rear View Monitor is
operating, a warning will appear on
the infotainment system screen.
ś ,Iœ5HDU:DUQLQJ2QO\ŔLVVHOHFWHG
braking will not be assisted.
ś The warning will turn off when the
gear is shifted to P (Park), N (Neutral)
or D (Drive).
Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist Malfunction and
Limitations
Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist
malfunction
OTM070173L
When Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist or other related systems
are not working properly, the ‘Check
3DUNLQJ6DIHW\V\VWHPŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJH
will appear on the cluster, and Reverse
Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist will
turn off automatically. Have the vehicle
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
07
Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist
disabled
Rear view camera
OTM070219L
OTM071070L
The rear view camera is used as a
detecting sensor to detect pedestrians. If
the camera lens is covered with foreign
material, such as snow or rain, it may
adversely affect camera performance
and Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate normally. Always
keep the camera lens clean.
Rear ultrasonic
sensor
OTM070176L
7KHœ5HDUFDPHUDHUURURUEORFNDJHŔ
RUœ3DUNLQJVHQVRUHUURURUEORFNDJHŔ
warning message will appear on the
cluster if the following situations occur:
- The rear view camera is covered with
foreign material, such as snow or rain,
etc.
- There is inclement weather, such as
heavy snow, heavy rain, etc.
If this occurs, Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist may turn off or may not
operate properly. Check whether the rear
view camera and rear ultrasonic sensors
are clean.
OTM070079
The rear ultrasonic sensors are located
inside the rear bumper to detect objects
in the rear area. If the sensors are
covered with foreign material, such as
snow or rain, it may adversely affect
sensor performance and Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist may not
operate normally. Always keep the rear
bumper clean.
7-119
Driver assistance system
Limitations of Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not assist braking or warn
the driver even if there are pedestrians
or objects under the following
circumstances:
ś Any non-factory equipment or
accessory is installed
ś Your vehicle is unstable due to an
accident or other causes
ś Bumper height or rear ultrasonic
sensor installation has been modified
ś Rear view camera or rear ultrasonic
sensor(s) is damaged
ś Rear view camera or the rear
ultrasonic sensor(s) is stained with
foreign material, such as snow, dirt,
etc.
ś Rear view camera is obscured by a
light source or by inclement weather,
such as heavy rain, fog, snow, etc.
ś The surrounding is very bright or very
dark
ś Outside temperature is very high or
very low
ś The wind is either strong (above
12 mph (20 km/h)) or blowing
perpendicular to the rear bumper
ś Objects generating excessive
noise, such as vehicle horns, loud
motorcycle engines or truck air
brakes, are near your vehicle
ś An ultrasonic sensor with similar
frequency is near your vehicle
ś There is ground height difference
between the vehicle and the
pedestrian
ś The image of the pedestrian in the
rear view camera is indistinguishable
from the background
7-120
ś The pedestrian is near the rear edge of
the vehicle
ś The pedestrian is not standing upright
ś The pedestrian is either very short or
very tall for Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist to detect
ś The pedestrian or cyclist is wearing
clothing that easily blends into the
background, making it difficult to
detect
ś The pedestrian is wearing clothing
that does not reflect ultrasonic waves
well
ś Size, thickness, height, or shape of
the object does not reflect ultrasonic
waves well (for example, pole, bush,
curbs, carts, edge of a wall, etc.)
ś The pedestrian or the object is moving
ś The pedestrian or the object is very
close to the rear of the vehicle
ś A wall is behind the pedestrian or the
object
ś The object is not located at the rear
center of your vehicle
ś The object is not parallel to the rear
bumper
ś The road is slippery or inclined
ś The driver backs up the vehicle
immediately after shifting to R
(Reverse)
ś The driver accelerates or circles the
vehicle
07
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist may unnecessarily warn the driver
or assist with braking even if there are
no pedestrians or objects under the
following circumstances:
ś Any non-factory equipment or
accessory is installed
ś Your vehicle is unstable due to an
accident or other causes
ś Bumper height or rear ultrasonic
sensor installation has been modified
ś Your vehicle height is low or high
due to heavy loads, abnormal tire
pressure, etc.
ś Rear view camera or the rear
ultrasonic sensor(s) is stained with
foreign material, such as snow, dirt,
etc.
ś The pattern on the road is mistaken
for a pedestrian
ś There is shadow or light reflecting on
the ground
ś Pedestrians or objects are around the
path of the vehicle
ś Objects generating excessive
noise, such as vehicle horns, loud
motorcycle engines or truck air
brakes, are near your vehicle
ś Your vehicle is backing towards a
narrow passage or parking space
ś Your vehicle is backing towards an
uneven road surface, such as an
unpaved road, gravel, bump, gradient,
etc.
ś A trailer or carrier is installed on the
rear of your vehicle
ś An ultrasonic sensor with similar
frequency is near your vehicle
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist:
ś Always exercise extreme caution
while driving. The driver is
responsible for braking and for safe
driving.
ś Always pay attention to road and
traffic conditions while driving,
whether or not there is a warning.
ś Always look around your vehicle to
make sure there are no pedestrians
or objects before moving the vehicle.
ś The performance of Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist may
vary under certain conditions. If
vehicle speed is above 2 mph (4
km/h), the function will provide
collision avoidance assist only when
pedestrians are detected. Always
look around and pay attention when
backing up your vehicle.
ś Some objects may not be detected
by the rear ultrasonic sensors due
to the objects distance, size or
material, all of which can limit the
effectiveness of the sensor.
ś Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate properly
or may operate unnecessarily
depending on the road conditions
and the surroundings.
ś Do not solely rely on Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist. Doing
so may lead to vehicle damage or
injuries.
7-121
Driver assistance system
CAUTION
ś Noise may be heard when sudden
braking occurs to avoid a collision.
ś If any other warning sound such
as the seat belt warning chime is
already generated, Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist warning
may not sound.
ś Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not work properly if the
bumper has been damaged, replaced
or repaired.
ś Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist may not operate normally if
interfered by strong electromagnetic
waves.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent passengers
from hearing Reverse Parking
Collision-Avoidance Assist warning
sounds.
ś Turn off Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist when towing a
trailer. If towing and moving in
reverse, Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist will activate as it
detects the trailer.
CAUTION
Take the following precautions to
maintain optimal performance of the
detecting sensors:
ś Always keep the rear view camera
and rear ultrasonic sensors clean.
ś Do not use any cleanser containing
acid or alkaline detergents when
cleaning the rear view camera lens.
Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly with
water.
ś Do not spray the rear view camera or
the rear ultrasonic sensors or their
surrounding area directly with a
high pressure washer. It may cause
the rear view camera or the rear
ultrasonic sensors to malfunction.
ś Do not apply objects, such as a
bumper sticker or a bumper guard,
near the rear view camera or rear
ultrasonic sensors or apply paint to
the bumper. Doing so may adversely
affect the performance of Reverse
Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist.
ś Never disassemble or strike the rear
view camera or the rear ultrasonic
sensors components.
ś Do not strike or pry the rear view
camera or the rear ultrasonic
sensors. Reverse Parking CollisionAvoidance Assist may not operate
properly if the rear view camera
or the rear ultrasonic sensor(s)
is forcibly moved out of proper
alignment. Have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Information
Reverse Parking Collision-Avoidance
Assist can detect a pedestrian or an object
when:
ś A pedestrian is standing behind the
vehicle
ś A large obstacle, such as a vehicle,
is parked in the rear center of your
7-122
07
vehicle
5(027(60$573$5.,1*
$66,67ǣ563$Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Detecting sensors
Remote Smart Parking Assist uses
vehicle sensors to help the driver park
and exit parking spaces remotely from
outside the vehicle by controlling the
steering wheel, vehicle speed and
gearshifts.
Function
Description
Remotely moving forward
or in reverse
OTM070179
Remote
Forward/
Backward
OJX1079037
ś Remote Forward/Backward function
helps the driver move the vehicle
forward or in reverse from outside the
vehicle using the smart key.
ś When Remote Smart Parking Assist
operates, Surround View Monitor and
Parking Distance Warning will also
operate. For more details, refer to
“Surround View Monitor (SVM) and
“Parking Distance Warning (PDW)”
sections in chapter 7.
OTM070180
[1] : Front ultrasonic sensors,
[2] : Front side ultrasonic sensors,
[3] : Rear side ultrasonic sensors,
[4] : Rear ultrasonic sensors
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
7-123
Driver assistance system
CAUTION
Take the following precautions to
maintain optimal performance of the
detecting sensors:
ś Never disassemble the detecting
sensor or sensor assembly, or apply
any impact on it.
ś If the detecting sensor have been
replaced or repaired, have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Remote Smart Parking Assist
may malfunction if the vehicle
bumper height or ultrasonic sensor
installation has been modified
or damaged. Any non-factory
installed equipment or accessories
may also interfere with the sensor
performance.
ś When the ultrasonic sensor is frozen
or stained with snow, dirt, or water,
the sensor may be not operate until
the stains are removed using a soft
cloth.
ś Do not push, scratch or strike the
ultrasonic sensor. Sensor damage
could occur.
ś Do not spray the ultrasonic sensors
or its surrounding area directly with
a high pressure washer.
7-124
Remote Smart Parking Assist
Settings
Settings features
OJX1079246L
Warning Volume
With the engine on, select ‘Driver
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHŔIURPWKH
Settings menu to change the Warning
9ROXPHWRœ+LJKŔœ0HGLXPŔRUœ/RZŔIRU
Remote Smart Parking Assist.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the Warning Volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
07
Remote Smart Parking Assist Operation
Remote Smart Parking Assist button
Parking/View button
Smart key
OTM070183
Location
Inside
vehicle
Smart
key
Name
Symbol
OTM070177
Description
Parking/View
button
śPress and hold the Parking/View button to
turn on Remote Smart Parking Assist. Also,
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance warning will
automatically turn on.
Parking
Safety button
śPress the Parking Safety button while Remote
Smart Parking Assist is operating to end function
operation.
Remote Start
button
śPress the Remote Start button after the door is
locked with the engine off to start the engine
remotely.
śPress the Remote Start button while Remote
Forward/Backward function is operating to end
function operation.
Forward
button
Backward
button
śWhen using the Remote Forward/Backward
function, the vehicle moves in the direction of the
button while the button is pressed.
7-125
Driver assistance system
Remote Operation
Operating order
Remote Forward/Backward operates in
the following order:
1. Getting ready to remotely move
forward and in reverse
2. Remotely moving forward and in
reverse
1. Getting ready to remotely move forward
and in reverse
OTM070130
There are two ways to operate Remote
Forward/Backward function.
OTM070223L
OTM070178L
Method (1) Using the function with
engine off
(1) Within a certain range from the
vehicle press the door lock ( )
button on the smart key and lock
all doors.
(2) Press and hold the Remote Start
button ( ) within 4 seconds until
the engine starts.
śFor more details on remotely
starting the engine, refer to
“Remote Start” section in chapter 6.
Information
If the vehicle is remotely started that has
been parked in cold weather for a long
time, the operation of Remote Forward/
Backward function may be delayed
depending on the engine condition.
7-126
Method (2) Using the function with
engine on
(1) Park the vehicle in front of the
space where you want to use
Remote Forward/Backward
function, and shift the gear to P
(Park).
(2) Press and hold the Parking/View
) button to turn on Smart
(
Parking Assist. A message ‘Under
5HPRWH&RQWUROŔZLOODSSHDURQWKH
infotainment system screen.
(3) Get out of the vehicle with the
smart key and close all doors.
ś'Agree' must be selected on the
infotainment system screen and the
infotainment system has to operate
properly to use Remote Forward/
Backward function.
07
2. Remotely moving forward and in
reverse
OTM070084L
(1) Press and hold one of the Forward
( ) or Reverse ( ) button on the
smart key. Remote Smart Parking
Assist will automatically control
the steering wheel, vehicle speed
and gearshift. The vehicle will
move in the direction of the button
pressed.
(2) While Remote Forward/Backward
function is operating, if the you do
not hold down the Forward ( ) or
Reverse ( ) button, the vehicle
will stop and function control
will pause. The function will start
operating again when the button is
pressed and held again.
(3) When the vehicle reaches the
target location, release the smart
key Forward or Backward button.
(4) When the driver gets in the vehicle
with the smart key, a message
will appear informing the driver
Remote Forward/Backward
function is complete on the
infotainment system screen and
the engine will remain on.
In addition, when the Remote Start
( ) button is pressed on the smart
key from outside the vehicle, a
message will appear informing the
driver Remote Entry/Exit Parking
function is complete and the
engine will turn off.
śCheck that all smart keys are
outside the vehicle when using
Remote Forward/Backward
function.
śRemote Forward/Backward
function will operate only when the
smart key is within 13 ft. (4 m) from
the vehicle. If there is no vehicle
movement even when the Forward
or Reverse button is pressed on the
smart key, check the distance to the
vehicle and press the button again.
śThe detecting range of the smart
key may vary depending on the
surroundings that are affected by
radio waves such as transmission
tower, broadcast station, etc.
śWhen remotely moving forward
using method (1), it is recognized
as an exit situation, and the
vehicle moves 13 ft. (4 m) to
check for pedestrians, animals or
objects around the vehicle. After
confirmation, the steering wheel
is controlled according to the
condition ahead.
7-127
Driver assistance system
śWhen remotely moving forward
using method (2), it is recognized
as a parking situation, and will
immediately control the steering
wheel according to the condition
ahead to assist with entering the
parking space and aligning the
vehicle. However, performance
may reduce depending on the
pedestrians, animals, shape of
objects, location, for example,
around the vehicle.
śFor moving remotely in reverse,
both method (1) and (2) aligns the
steering wheel first, and then will
only move the vehicle straight.
śWhen remotely moving forward or
in reverse is completed, the vehicle
will automatically shift to P (Park)
and engage EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake).
CAUTION
ś When using Remote Remote
Forward/Backward function, make
sure that all passengers have gotten
out of the vehicle.
ś If the vehicle’s battery is discharged
or Remote Smart Parking Assist
malfunctions when parked in a
narrow parking space, Remote
Forward/Backward function will not
operate. Always park your vehicle in
a space wide enough for you to get in
or out of your vehicle.
ś Please note that depending on the
parking space, you may not be able
to exit from the space you have
entered by using Remote Forward/
Backward function.
ś After parking, the surrounding may
change due to the movement of
surrounding vehicles. If this occurs,
Remote Forward/Backward function
may not operate.
ś Before leaving the vehicle, close
windows and sunroofs, and make
sure the engine is off before locking
the doors.
7-128
Remote Operation function operation
status
Operation
status
Under
control
Pause
Off
Complete
Smart key LED
Green LED
continuously
blinks
Red LED
continuously
blinks
Red LED
illuminates for
4 seconds and
then turns off
Green LED
illuminates for
4 seconds and
then turns off
Hazard
warning
light
-
Blinks
Blinks 3
times and
turns off
Blinks 1
time and
turns off
à Operation status by the hazard
warning light may not be applicable
based on the regulation of your
country.
à If the smart key is not within the
operating range from the vehicle
(approximately 13 ft. (4 m)), the
smart key LED will not illuminate or
blink. Use the smart key within the
operating range.
07
How to turn off Remote Forward/
Backward function while operating
ś Press the Parking/View (
) button
while the infotainment system screen
guides the driver using method 2.
ś Shift the gear except to P (Park)
while the infotainment system screen
guides the driver using method 2.
) button
ś Press the Parking Safety (
RUVHOHFWœ&DQFHOŔRQWKHLQIRWDLQPHQW
system screen.
ś Press the Remote Start ( ) button
on the smart key while the vehicle
is being controlled by RRemote
Forward/Backward function. Remote
Forward/Backward function will turn
off. At this time, the engine will turn
off.
ś Get on the vehicle with the smart key.
Remote Forward/Backward function
will turn off. At this time, the engine
will remain on.
The function will pause in the
following conditions when:
ś There is a pedestrian, animal or object
in the direction the vehicle is moving
ś The door or liftgate is open
ś The Forward ( ) or Reverse ( )
button is not continuously pressed
ś Simultaneously pressing multiple
buttons on a smart key
ś The smart key is not operated within
13 ft. (4 m) from the vehicle
ś Button of another smart key is pressed
in addition to the operating smart key
ś Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist or Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist operates while the
vehicle is being controlled in the
reverse direction.
ś The vehicle moves 22 ft. (7 m)
while the smart key is pressed with
Remote Forward/Backward function
(maximum travel distance per button
press)
When Remote Forward/Backward
function is paused, the vehicle will stop.
If the condition that made the function
to pause disappears, the function may
operate again.
The function will cancel in the
following conditions when:
ś The steering wheel is steered
ś The gear is shifted while the vehicle is
moving
ś Operating EPB while the vehicle is
moving
ś The engine hood is open
ś The brake pedal or accelerator pedal
is depressed when all the doors are
closed
ś The smart key is outside the vehicle
when the brake pedal is depressed
while the driver's door is open
ś Rapid acceleration occurs
ś Vehicle skid occurs
ś The wheel is stuck by an obstacle and
cannot move
ś There are pedestrians, animals or
objects at the front and rear of the
vehicle at the same time
7-129
Driver assistance system
ś Approximately 3 minutes and 50
seconds have past after Remote
Forward/Backward function has
started to operate
ś The slope of the road exceeds the
operational range
ś The function is paused for more than
1 minute
ś The total travel distance of the vehicle
has exceeded 45 ft. (14 m) after
Remote Entry/Exit Parking function
operation
ś The steering wheel, gearshift, braking,
and drive controls are not working
normally
ś There is a problem with the smart key
or the smart key battery is low
ś ABS, TCS or ESC system operates due
to slippery road conditions
ś The alarm of the Theft Alarm System
sounds
When Remote Forward/Backward
function is canceled, the vehicle will
automatically stop, shift the gear to
P (Park) and engage EPB (Electronic
Parking Brake).
7-130
Remote Smart Parking Assist
Malfunction and Limitations
Remote Smart Parking Assist
malfunction
OTM070222L
Remote Smart Parking Assist check
When Remote Smart Parking Assist is
not working properly, the ‘Check Parking
$VVLVWŔZDUQLQJPHVVDJHZLOODSSHDURQ
the infotainment system screen. If the
message appears, stop using Remote
Smart Parking Assist, and have the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
07
Limitations of Remote Smart Parking
Assist
OJX1079200L
Remote Smart Parking Assist canceled
When Remote Parking Assist is
operating, the function can be canceled,
DQGWKHœ3DUNLQJ$VVLVW&DQFHOHGŔ
warning message may appear regardless
of the parking order. Other messages
may appear depending on the situations.
Follow the instructions provided on
the infotainment system screen while
parking your vehicle with Remote
Parking Assist. Always look around and
pay attention when using the function.
OTM070221L
Remote Smart Parking Assist standby
When ‘Parking Assist Conditions Not
0HWŔPHVVDJHDSSHDUVZKHQ3DUNLQJ
) button has been pressed and
View (
held, Remote Smart Parking Assist is in
standby. After a while, press and hold the
) button again to see if
Parking/View (
the function works.
The message appears even when the
smart key's battery is low. Check the
smart key battery level.
In the following circumstances, function
performance to park or exit the vehicle
may be limited, there may be a risk of
collision, or Remote Smart Parking Assist
may turn off. Park or exit the vehicle
manually if necessary.
ś An object is attached to the steering
wheel
ś The vehicle is installed with a snow
chain, spare tire or different size
wheel
ś Tire pressure is lower or higher than
the standard tire pressure
ś Your vehicle is loaded with cargo
longer or wider than your vehicle or a
trailer is connected to your vehicle
ś There is a problem with the wheel
alignment
ś Your vehicle is leaned severely to one
side
ś Your vehicle is equipped with a trailer
hitch
ś The license plate is installed
differently from the original location
ś There is a person, animal or object
above or below the ultrasonic sensor
when Remote Smart Parking Assist is
activated
ś The parking space is curved or
diagonal
ś There is an obstacle such as a person,
animal or object (trash can, bicycle,
motorcycle, shopping cart, narrow
pillar etc.) near the parking space
7-131
Driver assistance system
ś There is a circular pillar or narrow
pillar, or a pillar surrounded by objects
such as fire extinguisher, etc., near the
parking space
ś The road surface is bumpy (curbstone,
speed bump, etc.)
ś The road is slippery
ś The parking space is near a vehicle
with higher ground clearance or big,
such as a truck, etc.
ś The parking space is Inclined
ś There is heavy wind
ś Operating Remote Smart Parking
Assist on uneven roads, gravel roads,
bushes, etc.
ś The performance of the ultrasonic
sensor is affected by extremely hot or
cold weather
ś The ultrasonic sensor is covered with
snow or water
ś An object that generates ultrasonic
waves is nearby
ś A wireless device with a transmission
function operates near the ultrasonic
sensors
ś Your vehicle is affected by another
YHKLFOHŔV3DUNLQJ'LVWDQFH:DUQLQJ
ś The sensor is mounted or positioned
incorrectly by an impact to the
bumper
ś When the ultrasonic sensor cannot
detect the following objects:
- Sharp or slim objects, such as ropes,
chains or small poles
- Objects smaller than 40 in. (100 cm)
in length and narrower than 6 in. (14
cm) in diameter
- Objects which tend to absorb
sensor frequency, such as clothes,
spongy material or snow
7-132
Remote Smart Parking Assist may not
operate normally under the following
circumstances:
ś Parking on inclines
OTM070132
Park manually when parking on
inclines.
ś Parking on uneven road
OTM070134
Remote Smart Parking Assist may
cancel when the vehicle slips, or
the vehicle cannot move due to
road conditions such as pebbles or
fragmented stones.
07
ś Parking behind a truck
ś Parking in a parking space with a
vehicle on one side only
OTM070137
Do not use Remote Smart Parking
Assist around vehicles with higher
ground clearance, such as a bus,
truck, etc. It may lead to an accident.
ś Parking near a pillar
OJX1079049
If Remote Smart Parking Assist is
used, when parking in a parking space
with a vehicle only on one side, your
vehicle may cross the parking line to
avoid the parked vehicle.
ś Parking diagonal
OTM070135
Remote Smart Parking Assist
performance may reduce when there
is a pillar or pillar surrounded by
objects such as a fire extinguisher
near the parking space.
OTM070133
Remote Smart Parking Assist does not
provide diagonal parking. Even if your
vehicle was able to enter the parking
space, do not use Remote Smart
Parking Assist because the function
cannot operate normally.
7-133
Driver assistance system
ś Parking in snow
OTM070131
Snow may interfere with sensor
operation, or Remote Smart Parking
Assist may cancel if the road is
slippery while parking.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Remote Smart Parking Assist:
ś The driver is responsible for safe
parking and exit when using Remote
Smart Parking Assist. Make sure
there are no pedestrians, animals
or objects around the vehicle when
using Remote Smart Parking Assist.
ś When using Remote Smart Parking
Assist, stay out of the way in the
direction the vehicle moves for your
safety.
ś Always check surroundings when
using Remote Smart Parking Assist.
You may collide with pedestrians,
animals, or objects if they are near
the sensor or are in the sensor’s blind
spot area.
ś A collision may occur if a pedestrian,
animal, or object suddenly appears
while Remote Smart Parking Assist is
operating.
7-134
ś Do not use Remote Smart Parking
Assist when under the influence of
alcohol.
ś Do not let children or other people to
use the smart key.
ś If Remote Smart Parking Assist is
used continuously for a long period,
it may adversely affect function
performance.
ś Remote Smart Parking Assist may not
operate normally if the vehicle needs
wheel alignment adjustment such
as when the vehicle tilts to one side.
Have the vehicle be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Noise may be heard when braking
occurs by Remote Smart Parking
Assist or when the brake pedal is
depressed by the driver.
ś Remote Smart Parking Assist may
suddenly apply the brake to avoid
collision.
ś Use Remote Smart Parking Assist
only in a parking space that is large
enough for the vehicle to move
safely.
NOTICE
ś If the 3rd stage warning (continuous
beep) of the Forward/Reverse
Parking Distance Warning sounds
while Remote Smart Parking
Assist is operating, it means the
obstacle detected is close to your
vehicle. At this time, Remote Smart
Parking Assist will temporarily stop
operating. Make sure there are no
pedestrians, animals, or objects
around your vehicle.
ś Depending on brake operation, the
stop lights may come on while the
vehicle is moving.
07
'(&/$5$7,212)&21)250,7<
The radio frequency components complies:
Front radar
- For Canada
- For USA
OANATEL125
OANATEL126
7-135
Driver assistance system
Rear corner radar
- For Canada
- For USA
OANATEL002
OANATEL003
OANATEL114
7-136
8. Emergency situations
Hazard warning flasher..................................................................................... 8-2
In case of an emergency while driving............................................................ 8-2
If the engine stalls while driving .................................................................................8-2
If the engine stalls at a crossroad or crossing ............................................................8-2
If you have a flat tire while driving ..............................................................................8-3
If the engine will not start ................................................................................ 8-3
Jump starting .................................................................................................... 8-4
If the engine overheats......................................................................................8-7
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ........................................................8-9
Check tire pressure ..................................................................................................... 8-9
Tire pressure monitoring system............................................................................... 8-10
Low tire pressure warning light .................................................................................. 8-11
Low tire pressure position and tire pressure telltale................................................. 8-11
TPMS malfunction indicator ...................................................................................... 8-12
Changing a tire with TPMS ........................................................................................ 8-12
If you have a flat tire (with spare tire) .............................................................8-14
Jack and tools............................................................................................................. 8-14
Removing and storing the spare tire......................................................................... 8-14
Changing tires ............................................................................................................ 8-16
Jack label .................................................................................................................... 8-21
If you have a flat tire (with Tire Mobility Kit) ................................................. 8-22
Introduction ................................................................................................................8-22
Notes on the safe use of the Tire Mobility Kit ..........................................................8-23
Components of the Tire Mobility Kit .........................................................................8-24
Using the Tire Mobility Kit .........................................................................................8-25
How to adjust tire pressure .......................................................................................8-28
Towing ............................................................................................................. 8-29
Towing service ............................................................................................................8-29
8
Emergency situations
HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER
IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY
WHILE DRIVING
If the engine stalls while driving
ś Reduce your speed gradually, keeping
a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place.
ś Turn on your hazard warning flasher.
ś Try to start the engine again. If your
vehicle will not start, contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer or seek
other qualified assistance.
OTM080001
The hazard warning flasher serves as
a warning to other drivers to exercise
extreme caution when approaching,
overtaking, or passing your vehicle.
It should be used whenever emergency
repairs are being made or when the
vehicle is stopped near the edge of a
roadway.
To turn the hazard warning flasher on
or off, press the hazard warning flasher
button with the Engine Start/Stop button
in any position. The hazard warning
flasher button is located in the center
fascia panel. All turn signal lights will
flash simultaneously.
ś The hazard warning flasher operates
regardless of whether your vehicle is
running or not.
ś The turn signals do not work when the
hazard flasher is on.
8-2
If the engine stalls at a crossroad
or crossing
If the engine stalls at a crossroads or
crossing, if safe to do so, shift the gear to
N (Neutral) and then push the vehicle to
a safe location.
08
If you have a flat tire while
driving
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
ś Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow down
while driving straight ahead. Do not
apply the brakes immediately or
attempt to pull off the road as this
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. When the
vehicle has slowed to such a speed
that it is safe to do so, brake carefully
and pull off the road. Drive off the
road as far as possible and park on
firm, level ground. If you are on a
divided highway, do not park in the
median area between the two traffic
lanes.
ś When the vehicle is stopped, press the
hazard warning flasher button, shift
the gear to P (Park), apply the parking
brake, and press the Engine Start/Stop
button to the OFF position.
ś Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on the
side of the vehicle that is away from
traffic.
ś When changing a flat tire, follow the
instructions provided later in this
chapter.
IF THE ENGINE WILL NOT
START
ś Be sure to shift the gear to N (Neutral)
or P (Park). The engine starts only
when the gear is in N (Neutral) or P
(Park).
ś Turn on the interior light. If the light
dims or goes out when you operate
the starter, the battery is drained.
See instructions for “Jump Starting”
provided in this chapter.
ś Check the fuel level and add fuel if
necessary.
If the vehicle still does not start, call
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
NOTICE
Push or pull starting the vehicle may
cause the catalytic converter to
overload which can lead to damage to
the emission control system.
8-3
Emergency situations
JUMP STARTING
Jump starting can be dangerous if done
incorrectly. Follow the jump starting
procedure in this section to avoid serious
injury or damage to your vehicle. If in
doubt about how to properly jump start
your vehicle, we strongly recommend
that you have a service technician or
towing service do it for you.
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH
to you or bystanders, always follow
these precautions when working near
or handling the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions carefully when
handling a battery.
Wear eye protection designed
to protect the eyes from acid
splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks, or
smoking materials away from
the battery.
Hydrogen is always present
in battery cells, is highly
combustible, and may explode
if ignited.
Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
Batteries contain sulfuric acid
which is highly corrosive. Do
not allow acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
8-4
If acid gets into your eyes, flush your
eyes with clean water for at least 15
minutes and get immediate medical
attention. If acid gets on your skin,
thoroughly wash the area. If you feel
pain or a burning sensation, get medical
attention immediately.
ś When lifting a plastic-cased battery,
excessive pressure on the case may
cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a
battery carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
ś Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle if your battery is frozen.
ś NEVER attempt to recharge the
battery when the vehicle’s battery
cables are connected to the battery.
ś The electrical ignition system works
with high voltage.
NEVER touch these components
with the engine running or when the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON
position.
08
Jump starting procedure
1. Position the vehicles close enough
that the jumper cables will reach, but
do not allow the vehicles to touch.
2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in the
engine compartment at all times, even
when the vehicles are turned off.
3. Turn off all electrical devices such as
radios, lights, air conditioning, etc.
Put the vehicles in P (Park) and set the
parking brake. Turn both vehicles OFF.
4. Open the engine hood.
CAUTION
Before jump starting, make sure to
correctly identify the positive (+) and
negative (-) terminals to avoid reverse
polarity connections.
OTM080021
5. Connect the jumper cables in
the exact sequence shown in the
illustration. First connect one jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) jumper
terminal of your vehicle (1).
6. Connect the other end of the jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
7. Connect the second jumper cable to
the black, negative (-) battery/jumper
terminal of the assisting vehicle (3).
8. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the black, negative (-)
chassis ground of your vehicle (4).
Do not allow the jumper cables to
contact anything except the correct
battery or jumper terminals or the
correct ground. Do not lean over the
battery when making connections.
WARNING
Do not connect the jumper cable to
the negative (-) jumper terminal of the
discharged battery. A spark could cause
the battery to explode and lead to a
personal injury or vehicle damage.
8-5
Emergency situations
9. Start the engine of the assisting
vehicle and let it run at approximately
2,000 rpm for a few minutes. Then
start your vehicle.
10. Keep your vehicle operating for at
least 30 minutes at idle or driving to
assure your battery receives enough
charge to be able to start on its
own after the vehicle is shut off. A
completely discharged battery may
require as long as 60 minutes runtime
to fully recharge it. If the vehicle is run
for less, the vehicle may not restart.
If your vehicle will not start after a few
attempts, it probably requires service.
In this event please seek qualified
assistance. If the cause of your battery
discharging is not apparent, have your
vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Disconnect the jumper cables in the
exact reverse order you connected them:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from the
black, negative (-) chassis ground of
your vehicle (4).
2. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the black, negative
(-) battery/chassis ground of the
assisting vehicle (3).
3. Disconnect the second jumper cable
from the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
4. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the red, positive (+)
jumper terminal of your vehicle (1).
8-6
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle:
ś Only use a 12-volt power supply
(battery or jumper system) to jump
start your vehicle.
ś Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle by push-starting.
WARNING
While jump starting your vehicle, avoid
the positive (+) and negative (-) cables
to come in contact. A spark could cause
personal injury.
08
IF THE ENGINE OVERHEATS
If your temperature gauge indicates
overheating, you experience a loss of
power, or hear loud pinging or knocking,
the engine may be overheating. If this
happens, you should:
1. Pull off the road and stop as soon as it
is safe to do so.
2. Shift the gear to P (Park) and set the
parking brake. If the air conditioning is
ON, turn it OFF.
3. If engine coolant is running out under
the vehicle or steam is coming out
from the hood, stop the engine. Do
not open the hood until the coolant
has stopped running or the steaming
has stopped. If there is no visible
loss of engine coolant and no steam,
leave the engine running and check
to be sure the engine cooling fan is
operating. If the fan is not running,
turn the engine off.
WARNING
While the engine is running,
keep hands, clothing and tools
away from the moving parts
such as the cooling fan and
drive belt to prevent serious
injury.
4. Check for coolant leaking from the
radiator, hoses or under the vehicle. (If
the air conditioning had been in use, it
is normal for cold water to be draining
from it when you stop.)
5. If engine coolant is leaking out, stop
the engine immediately and call the
nearest authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for assistance.
WARNING
Never remove the engine
coolant cap and/or watercooled intercooler coolant
cap or the drain plug while the
engine and radiator are hot.
Hot coolant and steam may blow out
under pressure, causing serious injury.
Turn the engine off and wait until the
engine cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the coolant cap. Wrap
a thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the first
stop. Step back while the pressure is
released from the cooling system. When
you are sure all the pressure has been
released, press down on the cap, using
a thick towel, and continue turning
counterclockwise to remove it.
8-7
Emergency situations
6. If you cannot find the cause of the
overheating, wait until the engine
temperature has returned to normal.
Then, if coolant has been lost,
carefully add coolant to the reservoir
to bring the fluid level in the reservoir
up to the halfway mark.
7. Proceed with caution, keeping alert
for further signs of overheating. If
overheating happens again, call
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
8-8
CAUTION
ś Serious loss of coolant indicates
a leak in the cooling system and
have the system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś When the engine overheats from
low engine coolant, suddenly adding
engine coolant may cause cracks
in the engine. To prevent damage,
add engine coolant slowly in small
quantities. It may require several
refilling cycles to properly fill the
engine cooling system. If necessary,
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
should be consulted to perform this
task.
08
7,5(35(6685(021,725,1*6<67(0ǣ7306Ǥ
Check tire pressure
OTM080002
OTM080005L
OTM080027L
(1) Low Tire Pressure Telltale/TPMS
Malfunction Indicator
(2) Low Tire Pressure Position Telltale
and Tire Pressure Telltale (Shown on
the LCD display)
ś You can check the tire pressure in the
Warning mode on the cluster.
Refer to the “LCD Display Modes” in
chapter 4.
ś Tire pressure is displayed after a few
minutes of driving after initial engine
start up.
ś If tire pressure is not displayed when
the vehicle is stopped, “Drive to
display” message will appear. After
driving, check the tire pressure.
ś The displayed tire pressure values may
differ from those measured with a tire
pressure gauge.
ś You can change the tire pressure unit
in the User Settings mode on the
instrument cluster.
- psi, kpa, bar (Refer to “LCD Modes”
in chapter 4).
8-9
Emergency situations
Tire pressure monitoring system
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle
handling, and lead to sudden tire failure
that may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
Each tire, including the spare (if
provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle
manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label. (If your
vehicle has tires of a different size than
the size indicated on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated. Accordingly,
when the low tire pressure telltale
illuminates, you should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure. Driving on
a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver’s responsibility to
maintain correct tire pressure, even if
under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
tire pressure telltale.
8-10
Your vehicle has also been equipped with
a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate
when the system is not operating
properly. The TPMS malfunction
indicator is combined with the low
tire pressure telltale. When the system
detects a malfunction, the telltale will
flash for approximately one minute and
then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as
the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be able
to detect or signal low tire pressure as
intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur
for a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate
tires or wheels on the vehicle that
prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more tires
or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that
the replacement or alternate tires and
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
function properly.
NOTICE
If any of the below happens, have
the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure Telltale/ TPMS
Malfunction Indicator does not
illuminate for 3 seconds when the
Engine Start/Stop button is pressed
to the ON position or when the
engine is running.
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for
approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure Position
Telltale remains illuminated.
08
Low tire pressure
warning light
Low tire pressure position and
tire pressure telltale
If you cannot reach a service station or
if the tire cannot hold the newly added
air, replace the low pressure tire with the
spare tire.
The Low Tire Pressure Telltale will remain
on and the TPMS Malfunction Indicator
may blink for one minute and then
remain illuminated (when the vehicle
is driven approximately 10 minutes at
speed above 15.5 mph (25 km/h)) until
you have the low pressure tire repaired
and replaced on the vehicle.
CAUTION
OTM080028L
When the tire pressure monitoring
system warning indicators are
illuminated and a warning message
displayed on the cluster LCD display,
one or more of your tires is significantly
under-inflated. The Low Tire Pressure
Position Telltale will indicate which
tire is significantly underinflated by
illuminating the corresponding position
light.
If either telltale illuminates, immediately
reduce your speed, avoid hard cornering
and anticipate increased stopping
distances. You should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible. Inflate the
tires to the proper pressure as indicated
on the vehicle’s placard or tire inflation
pressure label located on the driver’s
side center pillar outer panel.
In winter or cold weather, the Low Tire
Pressure Telltale may be illuminated if
the tire pressure was adjusted to the
recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not mean
your TPMS is malfunctioning because
the decreased temperature leads to a
proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle from a
warm area to a cold area or from a cold
area to a warm area, or the outside
temperature is greatly higher or lower,
you should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to the
recommended tire inflation pressure.
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure makes
the vehicle unstable and can contribute
to loss of vehicle control and increased
braking distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires
can cause the tires to overheat and fail.
8-11
Emergency situations
TPMS malfunction
indicator
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
will illuminate after it blinks for
approximately one minute when there
is a problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
Have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
TPMS, the individual tire pressures
in the cluster LCD display will not be
available. Have the system checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
NOTICE
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator may
illuminate after blinking for one minute
if the vehicle is near electric power
supply cables or radio transmitters
such as police stations, government
and public offices, broadcasting
stations, military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow chains
are used or electronic devices such as
computers, chargers, remote starters,
navigation, etc. This may interfere with
normal operation of the TPMS.
8-12
Changing a tire with TPMS
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure and Position telltales will come
on. Have the flat tire repaired by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible or replace the flat tire with the
spare tire.
NOTICE
It is recommended that you do not
use a puncture-repairing agent not
approved by HYUNDAI dealer or the
equivalent specified for your vehicle to
repair and/or inflate a low pressure tire.
Tire sealant not approved by HYUNDAI
dealer or the equivalent specified for
your vehicle may damage the tire
pressure sensor.
The spare tire (if equipped) does not
come with a tire pressure monitoring
sensor. When the low pressure tire or
the flat tire is replaced with the spare
tire, the Low Tire Pressure Telltale will
remain on. Also, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator will illuminate after blinking
for one minute if the vehicle is driven
at speed above 15.5 mph (25 km/h) for
approximately 10 minutes.
Once the original wheel equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure
and reinstalled on the vehicle, the
Low Tire Pressure Telltale and TPMS
Malfunction Indicator will go off within a
few minutes of driving.
08
If the indicators do not extinguish after a
few minutes, please visit an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the tire
behind the valve stem (except for the
spare tire). You must use TPMS specific
wheels. It is recommended that you
always have your tires serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
You may not be able to identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking at it.
Always use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to measure. Please note that a tire
that is hot (from being driven) will have a
higher pressure measurement than a tire
that is cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has been
sitting for 3 hours and driven for less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure.
WARNING
ś The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors such as nails or road
debris.
ś If you feel any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off
the accelerator, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
WARNING
Tampering with, modifying, or disabling
the Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) components may interfere
with the system’s ability to warn the
driver of low tire pressure conditions
and/or TPMS malfunctions. Tampering
with, modifying, or disabling the Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
components may void the warranty for
that portion of the vehicle.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.
8-13
Emergency situations
,)<28+$9($)/$77,5(ǣ:,7+63$5(7,5(,)(48,33('Ǥ
Jacking instructions
WARNING
Changing a tire can be dangerous.
Follow the instructions in this section
when changing a tire to reduce the risk
of serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Be careful as you use the jack handle to
stay clear of the flat end. The flat end
has sharp edges that could cause cuts.
Jack and tools
The jack is provided for emergency tire
changing only.
To prevent the jack from “rattling” while
the vehicle is in motion, store it properly.
Follow jacking instructions to reduce the
possibility of personal injury.
Removing and storing the spare
tire
Your spare tire is stored underneath your
vehicle, directly below the cargo area.
OTMA080001
1. Jack
2. Wheel lug wrench
The jack and wheel lug wrench are stored
in the luggage compartment under the
luggage box cover.
The jack is provided for emergency tire
changing only.
8-14
OTM080029L
To remove the spare tire:
1. Open the liftgate.
2. Find the plastic hex bolt cover and
remove the cover with a coin or flat blade screwdriver.
08
OTM080030L
3. Connect the socket and wheel lug nut
wrench (A).
4. Loosen the bolt enough to lower the
spare tire.
Turn the wrench counterclockwise
until the spare tire reaches the
ground.
5. After the spare tire reaches the
ground, continue to turn the wrench
counterclockwise, and draw the spare
tire outside. Never rotate the wrench
excessively, otherwise the spare tire
carrier may be damaged.
OTM080031L
6. Draw out the retainer guide (1) the
through the center hole of spare tire.
To store the spare tire:
1. Lay the tire on the ground with the
valve stem facing up.
2. Place the wheel under the vehicle and
install the retainer guide and chain
through the wheel center.
3. Turn the wrench clockwise until it
clicks.
CAUTION
Ensure the spare tire retainer guide is
properly aligned with the center of the
spare tire to prevent the spare tire from
“rattling”.
Otherwise, it may cause the spare tire
to fall off the carrier and lead to an
accident.
8-15
Emergency situations
Changing tires
WARNING
A vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack
causing serious injury or death to you or
those nearby. Take the following safety
precautions:
ś Do not get under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
ś NEVER attempt to change a tire in
the lane of traffic. ALWAYS move the
vehicle completely off the road on
level, firm ground away from traffic
before trying to change a tire. If you
cannot find a level, firm place off
the road, call a towing service for
assistance.
ś Be sure to use the jack provided with
the vehicle.
ś ALWAYS place the jack on the
designated jacking positions on the
vehicle and NEVER on the bumpers
or any other part of the vehicle for
jacking support.
ś Do not start or run the engine while
the vehicle is on the jack.
ś Do not allow anyone to remain in the
vehicle while it is on the jack.
ś Keep children away from the road
and the vehicle.
8-16
Follow these steps to change your
vehicle’s tire:
1. Park on a level, firm surface.
2. Shift the gear to P (Park), apply the
parking brake, and press the Engine
Start/Stop button to the OFF position.
3. Press the hazard warning flasher
button.
4. Remove the wheel lug wrench, jack,
jack handle, and spare tire from the
vehicle.
OTM080032L
[A] : Block
5. Block both the front and rear of the
tire diagonally opposite of the tire you
are changing.
08
OTM080033L
6. Loosen the wheel bolts
counterclockwise one turn each in
the order shown above, but do not
remove any wheel bolts until the tire
has been raised off of the ground.
OTM080034L
7. Place the jack at the designated
jacking position under the frame
closest to the tire you are changing.
The jacking positions are plates
welded to the frame with two
notches. Never jack at any other
position or part of the vehicle. Doing
so may damage the side seal molding
or other parts of the vehicle.
OTM080035L
8. Insert the jack handle into the jack
and turn it clockwise, raising the
vehicle until the tire clears the ground.
Make sure the vehicle is stable on the
jack.
9. Loosen a wheel bolt with the wheel
lug wrench and remove it with your
fingers.
Slide the wheel off the studs and lay
it flat so it cannot roll away. To put the
wheel on the hub, pick up the spare
tire, line up the holes with the studs
and slide the wheel onto them. If this
is difficult, tip the wheel slightly and
get the top hole in the wheel lined
up with the top stud. Then jiggle the
wheel back and forth until the wheel
can be slid over the other studs.
8-17
Emergency situations
WARNING
Wheels may have sharp edges. Handle
them carefully to avoid possible severe
injury. Before putting the wheel into
place, be sure that there is nothing on
the hub or wheel (such as mud, tar,
gravel, etc.) that interferes with the
wheel from fitting solidly against the
hub.
If there is, remove it. If there is not
good contact on the mounting surface
between the wheel and hub, the wheel
nuts could come loose and cause the
loss of a wheel. Loss of a wheel may
result in loss of control of the vehicle.
This may cause serious injury or death.
10. To reinstall the wheel, hold it on the
studs, put the wheel nuts on the studs
and tighten them finger tight. The
nuts should be installed with their
tapered small diameter ends directed
inward. Jiggle the tire to be sure it is
completely seated, then tighten the
nuts as much as possible with your
fingers again.
11. Lower the vehicle to the ground
by turning the wheel lug wrench
counterclockwise.
8-18
OTM080045L
12. Use the wheel lug wrench to tighten
the wheel bolts in the order shown.
Double-check each wheel bolts until
they are tight. After changing tires,
have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
tighten the wheel bolts to their proper
torque as soon as possible. The wheel
bolt should be tightened to 79~94
lbf.ft (11~13 kgf.m).
If you have a tire gauge, check the
tire pressure (see “Tires and Wheels”
section in chapter 2 for tire pressure
instructions.). If the pressure is lower or
higher than recommended, drive slowly
to the nearest service station and adjust
it to the recommended pressure. Always
reinstall the valve cap after checking
or adjusting tire pressure. If the cap
is not replaced, air may leak from the
tire. If you lose a valve cap, buy another
and install it as soon as possible. After
changing tires, secure the flat tire and
return the jack and tools to their proper
storage locations.
08
NOTICE
Check the tire pressure as soon as
possible after installing a spare tire.
Adjust it to the recommended pressure.
CAUTION
Your vehicle has metric threads on the
studs and wheel bolts. Make certain
during tire changing that the same bolts
that were removed are reinstalled. If
you have to replace your wheel bolts
make sure they have metric threads to
avoid damaging the studs and ensure
the wheel is properly secured to the
hub. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for assistance.
WARNING
Wheel studs
If the studs are damaged, they may lose
their ability to retain the wheel. This
could lead to the loss of the wheel and a
collision resulting in serious injuries.
Use of compact spare tires
(if equipped)
Compact spare tires are designed for
emergency use only. Drive carefully on
the compact spare tire and always follow
the safety precautions.
WARNING
To prevent compact spare tire failure
and loss of control possibly resulting in
an accident:
ś Use the compact spare tire only in an
emergency.
ś NEVER operate your vehicle over 50
mph (80 km/h).
ś Do not exceed the vehicle’s
maximum load rating or the load
carrying capacity shown on the
sidewall of the compact spare tire.
ś Do not use the compact spare tire
continuously. Repair or replace the
original tire as soon as possible to
avoid failure of the compact spare
tire.
If any of the equipment such as the jack,
wheel bolts, studs, or other equipment
is damaged or in poor condition, do not
attempt to change the tire and call for
assistance.
8-19
Emergency situations
When driving with the compact spare tire
mounted to your vehicle:
ś Check the tire pressure after installing
the compact spare tire. The compact
spare tire should be inflated to 420
kPa (60 psi).
ś Do not take this vehicle through
an automatic car wash while the
compact spare tire is installed.
ś Do not use the compact spare tire on
any other vehicle because this tire
has been designed especially for your
vehicle.
ś The compact spare tire’s tread life is
shorter than a regular tire. Inspect
your compact spare tire regularly and
replace worn compact spare tires with
the same size and design, mounted on
the same wheel.
ś Do not use more than one compact
spare tire at a time.
ś Do not tow a trailer while the compact
spare tire is installed.
8-20
Information
When the original tire and wheel are
repaired and reinstalled on the vehicle, the
wheel bolt torque must be set correctly.
The correct wheel bolt tightening torque is
79~94 lbf.ft (11~13 kgf.m).
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the compact
spare tire and your vehicle:
ś Drive slowly enough for the road
conditions to avoid all hazards, such
as a potholes or debris.
ś Avoid driving over obstacles. The
compact spare tire diameter is
smaller than the diameter of a
conventional tire and reduces the
ground clearance approximately 25
mm (1 inch).
ś Do not use tire chains on the
compact spare tire. Because of the
smaller size, a tire chain will not fit
properly.
ś Do not use the compact spare tire
on any other wheels, nor should
standard tires, snow tires, wheel
covers or trim rings be used with the
compact spare wheel.
ś Do not suddenly accelerate or
decelerate 0 25 mph (0 40 km/h)
in any driving mode. It may cause
leakage of transfer oil.
08
Jack label
OOS067043
The actual Jack label in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more detailed specifications, refer to the label attached to the jack.
1. Model Name
2. Maximum allowable load
3. When using the jack, set your parking brake.
4. When using the jack, stop the engine.
5. Do not get under a vehicle that is supported by a jack.
6. The designated locations under the frame
7. When supporting the vehicle, the base plate of jack must be vertical under the
lifting point.
8. Shift into Reverse gear on vehicles with manual transmission or shift the gear to the
P position on vehicles with automatic transmission.
9. The jack should be used on firm level ground.
10. Jack manufacture
11. Production date
12. Representative company and address
8-21
Emergency situations
,)<28+$9($)/$77,5(ǣ:,7+7,5(02%,/,7<.,7
,)(48,33('Ǥ
Introduction
OTM080007
For safe operation, carefully read and
follow the instructions in this manual
before use.
(1) Compressor
(2) Sealant bottle
The Tire Mobility Kit is a temporary fix to
the tire and the tire should be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
CAUTION
When two or more tires are flat, do not
use the tire mobility kit because the
sealant provided with the Tire Mobility
Kit must be used for only one flat tire.
WARNING
Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit to repair
punctures in the tire walls. This can
result in an accident due to tire failure.
WARNING
Have your tire repaired as soon as
possible. The tire may lose air pressure
at any time after inflating with the Tire
Mobility Kit.
8-22
With the Tire Mobility Kit you stay mobile
even after experiencing a tire puncture.
The compressor and sealing compound
system effectively and comfortably seals
most punctures in a passenger car tire
caused by nails or similar objects and
reinflates the tire.
After you ensure that the tire is properly
sealed you can drive cautiously on the
tire (distance up to 120 miles (200 km))
at a max. speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) in
order to reach a service station or tire
dealer for the tire replacement.
It is possible that some tires, especially
with larger punctures or damage to the
sidewall, cannot be sealed completely.
Air pressure loss in the tire may adversely
affect tire performance.
For this reason, you should avoid abrupt
steering or other driving maneuvers,
especially if the vehicle is heavily loaded
or if a trailer is in use.
The Tire Mobility Kit is not designed
or intended as a permanent tire repair
method and is to be used for one tire
only.
This instruction shows you step by step
how to temporarily seal the puncture
simply and reliably.
Read the section “Notes on the safe use
of the Tire Mobility Kit”.
08
WARNING
Do not use the TMK if a tire is severely
damaged by driving run flat or with
insufficient air pressure.
Only punctured areas located within the
tread region of the tire can be sealed
using the TMK.
Notes on the safe use of the Tire
Mobility Kit
ś Park your car at the side of the road
so that you can work with the Tire
Mobility Kit away from moving traffic.
ś To be sure your vehicle will not move,
even when you’re on fairly level
ground, always set your parking brake.
ś Only use the Tire Mobility Kit for
sealing/inflation passenger car tires.
Only punctured areas located within
the tread region of the tire can be
sealed using the tire mobility kit.
ś Do not use on motorcycles, bicycles
or any other type of tires.
ś When the tire and wheel are
damaged, do not use Tire Mobility Kit
for your safety.
ś Use of the Tire Mobility Kit may not be
effective for tire damage larger than
approximately 4 mm (16 inch).
Please contact the nearest HYUNDAI
dealer if the tire cannot be made
roadworthy with the Tire Mobility Kit.
ś Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if a tire
is severely damaged by driving run flat
or with insufficient air pressure.
ś Do not remove any foreign objects
such as nails or screws that have
penetrated the tire.
ś Provided the car is outdoors, leave the
engine running. Otherwise operating
the compressor may eventually drain
the car battery.
ś Never leave the Tire Mobility Kit
unattended while it is being used.
ś Do not leave the compressor running
for more than 10 minutes at a time or
it may overheat.
ś Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if the
ambient temperature is below -22°F
(30°C).
ś In case of skin contact with the
sealant, wash the area thoroughly
with plenty of water. If the irritation
persists, seek medical attention.
ś In case of eye contact with the
sealant, flush your eyes for at least 15
minutes. If the irritation persists, seek
medical attention.
ś In case of swallowing the sealant,
rinse the mouth and drink plenty of
water. However, never give anything
to an unconscious person and seek
medical attention immediately.
ś Long time exposure to the sealant
may cause damage to bodily tissue
such as kidney, etc.
8-23
Emergency situations
Components of the Tire Mobility Kit
OTM080022
1. Speed restriction label
2. Sealant and sealant bottle
3. Connection hose of compressor and tire
4. Connector and cable for connection of power outlet
5. Holder for the sealant bottle
6. Compressor
7. ON/OFF switch
8. Pressure gauge for displaying the tire inflation pressure
9. Valve for reducing tire inflation pressure
Connectors, cable and connection hose are stored in the compressor housing.
Strictly follow the specified sequence, otherwise the sealant may escape under high
pressure.
8-24
08
WARNING
Do not use the tire sealant after the
sealant has expired (for example, past
the expiration date on the sealant
container). This can increase the risk of
tire failure.
WARNING
ś Keep out of reach of children.
ś Avoid contact with eyes.
ś Do not swallow.
OTM080025
1. Shake the sealant bottle (2).
Using the Tire Mobility Kit
WARNING
OTM080023
2. Remove the cover (A) of the sealant
bottle (2) and compressor (6).
OTM080008
Detach the speed restriction label (1)
from the sealant bottle (2), and place
it in a highly visible place inside the
vehicle such as on the steering wheel to
remind the driver not to drive too fast.
OTM080024
3. Connect the sealant bottle (2) and
compressor (6).
4. Make sure that the valve (9) for
reducing tire inflation pressure is
closed.
8-25
Emergency situations
OTM080009
5. Unscrew the valve cap from the
valve of the defective and screw
the connection hose (3) of the
compressor and tire.
NOTICE
Securely install the sealant filling hose
to the valve. If not, sealant may flow
backward, possibly clogging the filling
hose.
6. Make sure the compressor turns off.
OTM080010
7. Connect the cable and connector (4)
to the power outlet in the vehicle.
8. Start the vehicle.
8-26
9. With the engine running, switch
on the compressor by pressing [I]
and let it run for approximately 5~7
minutes to fill the sealant up to proper
pressure. (Refer to “Tire and Wheels”
section in chapter 2). The inflation
pressure of the tire after filling is
unimportant and will be checked/
corrected later.
Be careful not to overinflate the tire
and stay away from the tire when
filling it.
CAUTION
Do not attempt to drive your vehicle if
the tire pressure is below 200 kpa (29
psi). This could result in an accident due
to sudden tire failure.
10. Switch off the compressor.
11. Detach the hoses from the sealant
bottle connector and from the tire
valve.
Return the Tire Mobility Kit to its storage
location in the vehicle.
08
WARNING
Do not leave your vehicle running in
a poorly ventilated area for extended
periods of time. Carbon monoxide
poisoning and suffocation can occur.
13. After driving approximately 4~6 miles
(7~10 km or about 10 minutes), stop at
a safe location.
Distributing the sealant
OTM080009
OOSH079022L
12. Immediately drive approximately 4~6
miles (7~10 km or about 10 minutes)
to evenly distribute the sealant in the
tire.
Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph (80
km/h). If possible, do not fall below a
speed of 12 mph (20 km/h).
While driving, if you experience any
unusual vibration, ride disturbance or
noise, reduce your speed and drive with
caution until you can safely pull off of the
side of the road.
Call for road side service or towing.
14. Connect the connection hose (3) of
the compressor and tire into the tire
valve.
15. Connect cables (4) to the battery.
16. Adjust the tire inflation pressure to the
recommended tire inflation.
With the engine running, proceed as
follows.
- To increase the inflation pressure:
Switch on the compressor.
To check the current inflation
pressure setting, briefly switch off
the compressor.
- To reduce the inflation pressure:
Adjust the valve (9) for reducing
tire inflation pressure.
NOTICE
Do not let the compressor run for more
than 10 minutes, otherwise the device
will overheat and may be damaged.
8-27
Emergency situations
Information
The pressure gauge may show higher than
actual reading when the compressor is
running. To get an accurate tire pressure,
the compressor needs to be turned off.
How to adjust tire pressure
1. After driving approximately 4~6 miles
(7~10 km or about 10 minutes), stop at
a safe location.
CAUTION
If the inflation pressure is not
maintained, drive the vehicle a second
time, refer to Distributing the sealant.
Then repeat steps 1 to 16.
Use of the TMK may be ineffectual for
tire damage larger than approximately
4 mm (0.16 in).
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
if the tire cannot be made roadworthy
with the Tire Mobility Kit.
WARNING
The tire inflation pressure must be
inflated to the proper pressure (Refer to
“Tire and Wheels” section in chapter 2).
If it is not, do not continue driving.
Call for road side service or towing.
CAUTION
Tire pressure sensor
The sealant on the tire pressure sensor
and wheel should be removed when
you replace the tire with a new one and
inspect the tire pressure sensors. We
recommend that you get this done at an
authorized dealer.
Information
When reinstalling the repaired or replaced
tire and wheel on the vehicle, tighten the
wheel bolt to 79~94 lbf.ft (11~13 kgf.m).
8-28
OTM080009
2. Connect the connection hose (3) of
the compressor and tire into the tire
valve.
3. Connect cables (4) to the battery.
4. Adjust the tire inflation pressure to the
recommended tire inflation.
With the engine running, proceed as
follows.
- To increase the inflation pressure:
Switch on the compressor.
To check the current inflation
pressure setting, briefly switch off
the compressor.
- To reduce the inflation pressure:
Adjust the valve (9) for reducing
tire inflation pressure.
NOTICE
Do not let the compressor run for more
than 10 minutes, otherwise the device
will overheat and may be damaged.
08
TOWING
Information
Towing service
The pressure gauge may show higher than
actual reading when the compressor is
running. To get an accurate tire pressure,
the compressor needs to be turned off.
WARNING
The tire inflation pressure must be
inflated to the proper pressure (Refer to
“Tire and Wheels” section in chapter 2).
If it is not, do not continue driving.
Call for road side service or towing.
CAUTION
Tire pressure sensor
The sealant on the tire pressure sensor
and wheel should be removed when
you replace the tire with a new one and
inspect the tire pressure sensors. We
recommend that you get this done at an
authorized dealer.
Information
When reinstalling the repaired or replaced
tire and wheel on the vehicle, tighten the
wheel bolt to 79~94 lbf.ft (11~13 kgf.m).
OTM080011L
[A] : Dollies
If emergency towing is necessary,
we recommend having it done by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a
commercial tow-truck service.
Proper lifting and towing procedures
are necessary to prevent damage to
the vehicle. The use of wheel dollies or
flatbed is recommended.
For 2WD vehicles, it is acceptable to tow
the vehicle with the rear wheels on the
ground (without dollies) and the front
wheels off the ground.
8-29
Emergency situations
If any of the loaded wheels or suspension
components are damaged or the vehicle
is being towed with the front wheels on
the ground, use a towing dolly under the
front wheels.
When being towed by a commercial tow
truck and wheel dollies are not used,
the front of the vehicle should always be
lifted, not the rear.
For 4WD vehicles, it must be towed
with a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed
equipment with all the wheels off the
ground.
NOTICE
Do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting
or body and chassis parts. Otherwise
the vehicle may be damaged.
CAUTION
ś Vehicle with EPB
1. Release EPB before turning off the
engine.
2. Place the ignition switch to the OFF
position.
3. Change the gear to N (Neutral) while
pressing the brake pedal.
4. Place the ignition switch to the ACC
position.
CAUTION
ś Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. Use wheel lift or flatbed
equipment.
OTM080013
ś Do not tow the vehicle with the front
wheels on the ground as this may
cause damage to the vehicle.
OTM080014
8-30
When towing your vehicle in an
emergency without wheel dollies:
ś Vehicle without EPB
1. Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position.
2. Place the shift button in N (Neutral).
3. Release the parking brake.
Failure to shift the gear to N (Neutral)
may cause internal damage to the
transmission.
9. Maintenance
Engine compartment........................................................................................ 9-3
Maintenance services ....................................................................................... 9-4
Owner’s responsibility ................................................................................................ 9-4
Owner maintenance precautions............................................................................... 9-4
Owner maintenance ......................................................................................... 9-5
Owner maintenance schedule ................................................................................... 9-6
Scheduled maintenance services .....................................................................9-7
Normal maintenance schedule .................................................................................. 9-8
Maintenance under severe usage conditions .......................................................... 9-12
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items ..............................................9-14
Fuel filter (for gasoline engine) ................................................................................. 9-14
Parking brake .............................................................................................................. 9-15
Engine oil ..........................................................................................................9-16
Checking the engine oil level .................................................................................... 9-16
Checking the engine oil and filter ............................................................................. 9-18
Engine coolant /Liquid-cooled intercooler coolant ......................................9-19
Checking the coolant level ........................................................................................ 9-19
Changing coolant ....................................................................................................... 9-21
Brake fluid ....................................................................................................... 9-22
Checking the brake fluid level ...................................................................................9-22
Washer fluid .................................................................................................... 9-23
Checking the washer fluid level ................................................................................9-23
Air cleaner ....................................................................................................... 9-24
Filter replacement ......................................................................................................9-24
Cabin air filter .................................................................................................. 9-25
Filter inspection..........................................................................................................9-25
Filter replacement ......................................................................................................9-25
Wiper blades ................................................................................................... 9-26
Blade inspection.........................................................................................................9-26
Blade replacement .....................................................................................................9-26
Battery ............................................................................................................. 9-29
For best battery service ............................................................................................ 9-30
Battery capacity label ................................................................................................ 9-31
Battery recharging ..................................................................................................... 9-31
Reset items .................................................................................................................9-32
9
Tires and wheels ............................................................................................. 9-33
Tire care ......................................................................................................................9-33
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures ............................................................9-33
Check tire inflation pressure .....................................................................................9-34
Tire rotation ................................................................................................................9-35
Wheel alignment and tire balance ............................................................................9-36
Tire replacement ........................................................................................................9-36
Wheel replacement ....................................................................................................9-37
Tire traction ................................................................................................................9-37
Tire maintenance .......................................................................................................9-37
Tire sidewall labeling................................................................................................. 9-38
Tire Terminology and Definitions Air Pressure ........................................................ 9-41
All Season Tires.......................................................................................................... 9-44
Snow Tires.................................................................................................................. 9-44
Radial-Ply Tires .......................................................................................................... 9-44
Low aspect ratio tires ................................................................................................ 9-45
Fuses ................................................................................................................ 9-47
Instrument panel fuse replacement ........................................................................ 9-48
Engine compartment panel fuse replacement ....................................................... 9-49
Fuse/relay panel description .................................................................................... 9-50
Light bulbs ....................................................................................................... 9-57
Headlight, position lamp, turn signal lamp, Daytime Running Light (DRL)
replacement .............................................................................................................. 9-58
Side repeater lamp replacement ............................................................................. 9-60
Rear combination lamp replacement ...................................................................... 9-60
High mounted stop lamp replacement ................................................................... 9-63
License plate lamp replacement .............................................................................. 9-64
Interior light replacement ......................................................................................... 9-64
Appearance care .............................................................................................9-66
Exterior care .............................................................................................................. 9-66
Interior care ................................................................................................................ 9-72
Emission control system..................................................................................9-75
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF) ............................................................................... 9-77
9
California perchlorate notice ......................................................................... 9-78
09
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OTMA090001/OTMA090015
1.
2.
3.
4.
Engine oil filler cap
Engine oil dipstick
Engine coolant reservoir
Windshield washer fluid reservoir
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Brake fluid reservoir
Battery terminal [+]
Battery terminal [-]
Air cleaner
Fuse box
9-3
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE SERVICES
You should exercise the utmost care
to prevent damage to your vehicle and
injury to yourself whenever performing
any maintenance or inspection
procedures.
Have your vehicle maintained and
repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer. An authorized HYUNDAI dealer
meets HYUNDAI’s high service quality
standards and receives technical support
from HYUNDAI in order to provide you
with a high level of service satisfaction.
Owner’s responsibility
Maintenance service and record
retention are the owner’s responsibility.
You should retain documents that show
proper maintenance has been performed
on your vehicle in accordance with
the scheduled maintenance service
charts shown on the following pages.
You need this information to establish
your compliance with the servicing
and maintenance requirements of your
vehicle warranties.
Detailed warranty information is
provided in your Owner’s Handbook &
Warranty Information booklet.
Repairs and adjustments required as a
result of improper maintenance or a lack
of required maintenance are not covered.
9-4
Owner maintenance precautions
Inadequate, incomplete or insufficient
servicing may result in operational
problems with your vehicle that could
lead to vehicle damage, an accident, or
personal injury. This chapter provides
instructions only for the maintenance
items that are easy to perform.
Your vehicle should not be modified
in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety
or durability of your vehicle and may, in
addition, violate conditions of the limited
warranties covering the vehicle.
NOTICE
Improper owner maintenance during
the warranty period may affect
warranty coverage. For details, read the
separate Owner’s Handbook & Warranty
Information booklet provided with
the vehicle. If you’re unsure about any
servicing or maintenance procedure,
have the system be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
09
OWNER MAINTENANCE
WARNING
Performing maintenance work on a
vehicle can be dangerous. If you lack
sufficient knowledge and experience
or the proper tools and equipment
to do the work, have it done by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. ALWAYS
follow these precautions for performing
maintenance work:
ś Park your vehicle on level ground.
Shift the vehicle to P (Park), apply
the parking brake, and press the
Engine Start/Stop button to the OFF
position.
ś Block the tires (front and back) to
prevent the vehicle from moving.
Remove loose clothing or jewelry
that can become entangled in
moving parts.
ś If you must run the engine during
maintenance, do so out doors or in
an area with plenty of ventilation.
ś Keep flames, sparks, or smoking
materials away from the battery and
fuel-related parts.
The following lists are vehicle checks and
inspections that should be performed
by the owner or an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer at the frequencies indicated to
help ensure safe, dependable operation
of your vehicle.
Any adverse conditions should be
brought to the attention of your dealer as
soon as possible.
These Owner Maintenance vehicle
checks are generally not covered by
warranties and you may be charged for
labor, parts and lubricants used.
WARNING
Touching metal parts
Do not touch metal parts (including
strut bars) while the engine is operating
or hot. Doing so could result in serious
personal injury. Turn the engine off and
wait until the metal parts cool down
to perform maintenance work on the
vehicle.
9-5
Maintenance
Owner maintenance schedule
At least monthly:
When you stop for fuel:
ś Check coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir.
ś Check the operation of all exterior
lights, including the stoplights, turn
signals and hazard warning flashers.
ś Check the inflation pressures of all
tires including the spare for tires that
are worn, show uneven wear, or are
damaged.
ś Check for loose wheel lug nuts.
ś Check the coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir or the water-cooled
intercooler coolant reservoir.
ś Check the windshield washer fluid
level.
ś Check for low or under-inflated tires.
WARNING
Be careful when checking your coolant
level when the engine is hot. This may
result in coolant being blown out of the
opening and cause serious burns and
other injuries.
While operating your vehicle:
ś Note any changes in the sound of the
exhaust or any smell of exhaust fumes
in the vehicle.
ś Check for vibrations in the steering
wheel. Notice if there is any increased
steering effort or looseness in the
steering wheel, or change in its
straight-ahead position.
ś Notice if your vehicle constantly turns
slightly or “pulls” to one side when
traveling on smooth, level road.
ś When stopping, listen and check for
unusual sounds, pulling to one side,
increased brake pedal travel or “hardto-push” brake pedal.
ś If any slipping or changes in the
operation of your transmission occurs,
check the transmission fluid level.
ś Check the automatic transmission P
(Park) function.
ś Check the parking brake.
ś Check for fluid leaks under your
vehicle (water dripping from the air
conditioning system during or after
use is normal).
9-6
At least twice a year: (for example,
every Spring and Autumn)
ś Check radiator, heater and air
conditioning hoses for leaks or
damage.
ś Check windshield washer spray and
wiper operation. Clean wiper blades
with a clean cloth dampened with
washer fluid.
ś Check headlight alignment.
ś Check muffler, exhaust pipes, shields
and clamps.
ś Check the seat belts for wear and
function.
At least once a year:
ś Clean body and door drain holes.
ś Lubricate door hinges and hood
hinges.
ś Lubricate door and hood locks and
latches.
ś Lubricate door rubber weather strips.
ś Check the air conditioning system.
ś Inspect and lubricate automatic
transmission linkage and controls.
ś Clean the battery and terminals.
ś Check the brake fluid level.
09
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICES
Follow Normal Maintenance Schedule if the vehicle is usually operated where none of
the following conditions apply. If any of the following conditions apply, you must follow
the Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions.
ś Repeated driving short distance of less than 5 miles (8 km) in normal temperature or
less than 10 miles (16 km) in freezing temperature
ś Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distances
ś Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread roads
ś Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather
ś Driving in heavy dust conditions
ś Driving in heavy traffic area
ś Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roads repeatedly
ś Towing a trailer or using a camper, or driving with loads on the roof
ś Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use of vehicle towing
ś Frequently driving under high speed or rapid acceleration/deceleration
ś Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
ś Engine oil usage which is not recommended (Mineral type, Semi-synthetic, Lower
grade spec, etc.)
If your vehicle is operated under the above conditions, you should inspect, replace or
refill more frequently than the following Normal Maintenance Schedule. After the periods
or distance shown in the chart, continue to follow the prescribed maintenance intervals.
Information
After driving more than 10 years or 100,000 miles, use severe maintenance schedule.
Information
ś As it is normal for engine oil to be consumed during driving, the engine oil level should
be checked on regular basis.
ś The engine oil change interval for normal operating conditions is based on the use of the
recommended engine specification. If the recommended engine oil specification is not
used, then replace the engine oil according to the maintenance schedule under severe
operating conditions.
ś The vehicle may be equipped with the Oil Life Management System that predicts engine
oil life based on the driver’s driving history and alerts the driver to change engine oil.
- If the deterioration of the engine oil increases depending on the driver’s driving
severity, the remaining oil life alert appears on the instrument cluster before the
normal engine oil replacement interval. Have the engine oil and filter changed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
- Oil Life Management System works when the recommended engine oil is used.
So, if recommended engine oil is not used, replace the engine oil according to the
maintenance schedule under severe usage conditions. Also, check the amount of engine
oil regularly as this system assumes that the engine oil is being filled normally.
- Always reset the remaining engine oil life whenever the engine oil is changed.
Otherwise, The indication of remaining Oil life in the Oil Life Management System
may not be accurate. To reset the Oil Change Reminder, select ‘RESET’ from the
infotainment system screen. Then, select ‘Yes’ when the message “Changed engine oil?
Press [Yes] to reset the oil life.” appears on the screen.
- If there is no alert until the maximum maintenance interval, have the vehicle checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-7
9-8
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
At first, inspect at 48,000 miles (78,000 km) or 72 months.
After that, inspect every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months
Add every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
132
16
24
32
40
48
56
64
72
80
88
26
39
52
65
78
91
104
117
130 143
R
144
96
156
R
156
104
169
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*1 : Requires API SN PLUS (or above) grade engine oil. If a lower grade engine oil is used, then the engine oil and engine oil filter must
be replaced at every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months as indicated for severe maintenance condition.
*2 : Check the engine oil level and leak every 350 miles (500km) or before starting a long trip.
*3 : The drive belt should be replaced when cracks occur or tension is reduced excessively.
*4 : If TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is not available, one bottle of additive is recommended. Additives are available from your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information on how to use them. Do not mix other additives.
Fuel additives *4
Drive belts
R
Engine oil and engine oil filter *1 *2
*3
12
8
13
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule
Maintenance
I
Air cleaner filter
I
I
I
I
R
I
R
I
I
R
I
R
Replace every 96,000 miles (156,000 km)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
132
16
24
32
40
48
56
64
72
80
88
26
39
52
65
78
91
104
117
130 143
I
I
I
R
R
144
96
156
I
156
104
169
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*5 : For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it’s interval when you do maintenance of other items.
*6 : The fuel filter is considered to be maintenance free but periodic inspection is recommended for this maintenance schedule
depends on fuel quality. If there are some important matters like fuel flow restriction, surging, loss of power, hard starting problem
etc, replace the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for details.
TGDI
Spark plugs *5
EXCEPT TGDI
Vapor hose, fuel filler cap and fuel tank
Fuel tank air filter *6
Fuel lines, hoses and connections
12
8
13
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule
09
9-9
9-10
I
I
Brake pedal
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Inspect every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months,
Replace every 48,000 miles (78,000 km) or 48 months
I
I
I
I
I
Inspect coolant level for leak every day
At first, inspect 40,000 miles (60,000 km) or 48 months.
After that, inspect every 20,000 miles (30,000 km) or 24 months
At first, replace at 120,000 miles (200,000 km) or 120 months.
After that, replace every 24,000 miles (40,000 km) or 24 months
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
132
16
24
32
40
48
56
64
72
80
88
26
39
52
65
78
91
104
117
130 143
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
Brake fluid
Parking brake (if equipped)
I
Brake lines, hoses and connections
12
8
13
Battery condition
Engine coolant
Cooling system
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule
I
I
I
I
144
96
156
I
I
I
156
104
169
Maintenance
TGDI
EXCEPT TGDI
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
R
No check, No service required
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
No check, No service required
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
Rotate tires every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months
I
I
I
I
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
132
16
24
32
40
48
56
64
72
80
88
26
39
52
65
78
91
104
117
130 143
I
I
I
I
I
12
8
13
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*1 : Front/rear differential oil should be changed anytime, front/rear differential have been submerged in water.
Driveshaft and boots
Rotate Tires (includes tread wear inspection
and tire pressure check)
Suspension mounting bolts
Air conditioner refrigerant
Air conditioner compressor
Cabin air filter
Automatic transmission fluid
Dual clutch transmission fluid
Exhaust pipe and muffler
Front (AWD) / rear differential oil *1
Transfer case oil (AWD)
Propeller shaft
Steering gear rack, linkage and
boots
Disc brakes and pads
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
144
96
156
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
156
104
169
09
9-11
Maintenance
Maintenance under severe usage conditions
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars mainly used under
severe driving conditions. Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance
intervals.
R : Replace
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace
Maintenance item
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance intervals
Driving
condition
Replace every 5,000 miles
D, H, I, L
(8,000 km) or 6 months
Replace more frequently
Air cleaner filter
R
depending on the
C, E
condition
Replace more frequently
Spark plugs
R
depending on the
A, B, H, I, K
condition
Steering gear box, linkage &
Inspect more frequently
C, D, E, F, G,
boots / lower arm ball joint,
I
depending on the
H, I
upper arm ball joint
condition
Inspect more frequently
Disc brakes and pads, calipers
I
depending on the
C, D, G, H
and rotors
condition
*1 : Requires API SN PLUS(or Above) grade engine oil. If a lower grade engine oil is used, then
the engine oil and engine oil filter must be replaced at every 5,000 miles.
Engine oil and engine oil
filter*1
9-12
R
09
Maintenance item
Parking brake (if equipped)
Maintenance
operation
I
T-GDI
I
EXCEPT
T-GDI
I
Climate control air filter
(for evaporator and blower unit)
R
Automatic transmission fluid
R
Dual clutch transmission fluid
R
Front differential oil (AWD) /
Rear differential oil
R
Transfer case oil (AWD)
-
Propeller shaft
I
Drive shafts and boots
Maintenance intervals
Driving
condition
Inspect more frequently
C, D, G, H
depending on the condition
Every 3,000 miles or
6 months
C, D, E, F,
G, H, I
Every 3,750 miles or
6 months
Replace more frequently
C, E
depending on the condition
Replace every 60,000 miles A, C, E, F, G,
(96,000 km)
H, I, K
Replace every 91,000 km A, C, D, E, F,
(56,000 miles)
G, H, I, J
Replace every 72,000 miles C, D, E, G,
(120,000 km)
H, I, J
No check,
No service required
Inspect more frequently
C, D, E, F,
depending on the condition G, H, I, J
Severe driving conditions
A. Repeatedly driving short distance of less than 5 miles (8 km) in normal temperature
or less than 10 miles (16 km) in freezing temperature
B. Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distances
C. Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread roads
D. Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather
E. Driving in heavy dust conditions
F. Driving in heavy traffic area
G. Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roads repeatedly
H. Towing a trailer or using a camper, or driving with loads on the roof
I. Driving for patrol car, taxi, other commercial use of vehicle towing
J. Frequently driving under high speed or rapid acceleration/deceleration
K. Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
L. Engine oil usage which is not recommended (Mineral type, Semi-synthetic, Lower
grade spec, etc.)
9-13
Maintenance
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Engine oil and filter
Vapor hose and fuel filler cap
The engine oil and filter should be
changed at the intervals specified in the
maintenance schedule. If the vehicle
is being driven in severe conditions,
more frequent oil and filter changes are
required.
The vapor hose and fuel filler cap should
be inspected at those intervals specified
in the maintenance schedule. Make sure
a new vapor hose or fuel filler cap is
correctly replaced.
Drive belts
Inspect all drive belts for evidence
of cuts, cracks, excessive wear or oil
saturation and replace if necessary.
Drive belts should be checked
periodically for proper tension and
adjusted as necessary.
Information
When you are inspecting the belt, turn the
engine off.
Fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections
Check the fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
replace any damaged or leaking parts
immediately.
Fuel filter (for gasoline engine)
The fuel filter is considered to be
maintenance free but periodic inspection
is recommended for this maintenance
depends on fuel quality. If there are
some important matters like fuel flow
restriction, surging, loss of power, hard
starting problem etc., replace the fuel
filter immediately. Consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for details.
9-14
Vacuum crankcase ventilation
hoses (if equipped)
Inspect the surface of hoses for evidence
of heat and/or mechanical damage.
Hard and brittle rubber, cracking,
tears, cuts, abrasions, and excessive
swelling indicate deterioration. Particular
attention should be paid to examine
those hose surfaces nearest to high heat
sources, such as the exhaust manifold.
Inspect the hose routing to ensure that
the hoses do not come in contact with
any heat source, sharp edges or moving
component which might cause heat
damage or mechanical wear. Inspect
all hose connections, such as clamps
and couplings, to make sure they are
secure, and that no leaks are present.
Hoses should be replaced immediately if
there is any evidence of deterioration or
damage.
09
Air cleaner filter
Have the air cleaner filter be replaced by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Spark plugs
Make sure to install new spark plugs of
the correct heat range.
When assembling parts, be sure to
wipe out foreign substances inside
and outside of the boot bottom of the
ignition coil and the insulator of the
spark plug with a soft cloth to prevent
contamination of the spark plug
insulator.
Cooling system
Check cooling system components, such
as radiator, coolant reservoir, hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Engine coolant
The coolant should be changed at the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
Engine coolant/water-cooled
intercooler coolant
The coolant should be changed at the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
Automatic transmission fluid
Automatic transmission fluid should
not be checked under normal usage
conditions.
Have the automatic transmission fluid
be changed by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer according to the maintenance
schedule.
Information
Automatic transmission fluid color is red
when new.
As the vehicle is driven, the automatic
transmission fluid will begin to look
darker.
This is a normal condition. It does not
need to be replaced based on the color
change.
NOTICE
The use of a non-specified fluid could
result in transmission malfunction and
failure.
Use only specified automatic
transmission fluid. (Refer to
“Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” section in chapter 2.)
Dual clutch transmission fluid (if
equipped)
Inspect the dual clutch transmission fluid
according to the maintenance schedule.
Brake hoses and lines
Visually check for proper installation,
chafing, cracks, deterioration and any
leakage. Replace any deteriorated or
damaged parts immediately.
Brake fluid
Check the brake fluid level in the brake
fluid reservoir. The level should be
between the MIN and the MAX marks
on the side of the reservoir. Use only
hydraulic brake fluid conforming to DOT
4 specification.
Parking brake
Inspect the parking brake system
including the parking brake lever and
cables.
9-15
Maintenance
ENGINE OIL
Brake discs, pads, calipers and
rotors
Check the pads, the disc, and the rotor
for any excessive wear-out. Inspect
calipers for any fluid leakage.
For more information on checking the
pads or lining wear limit, refer to the
HYUNDAI web site.
(http://service.hyundai-motor.com)
Propeller shaft
Check the propeller shaft, boots, clamps,
rubber couplings and center-bearing
rubber for cracks, deterioration, or
damage. Replace any damaged parts
and if necessary, repack the grease.
Suspension mounting bolts
Check the suspension connections for
looseness or damage. Retighten to the
specified torque.
Steering gear box, linkage &
boots/lower arm ball joint
With the vehicle stopped and the engine
off, check for excessive free-play in the
steering wheel. Check the linkage for
bends or damage. Check the dust boots
and ball joints for deterioration, cracks,
or damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Drive shafts and boots
Check the drive shafts, boots and clamps
for cracks, deterioration, or damage.
Replace any damaged parts and, if
necessary, repack the grease.
Air conditioning refrigerant
Check the air conditioning lines and
connections for leakage and damage.
9-16
Checking the engine oil level
Engine oil is used for lubricating,
cooling, and operating various hydraulic
components in the engine. Engine oil
consumption while driving is normal,
and it is necessary to check and refill the
engine oil regularly. Also, check and refill
the oil level within the recommended
maintenance schedule to prevent
deterioration of oil performance.
Check the engine oil following the below
procedure.
Gasoline engine
1. Follow all of the oil manufacturer’s
precautions.
2. Be sure the vehicle is on the level
ground in P (Park) with the parking
brake set and the wheels blocked.
3. Turn the engine on and warm
the engine up until the coolant
temperature reaches a constant
normal temperature.
4. Turn the engine off, remove the oil
filler cap and pull the dipstick out.
Wait for 15 minutes for the oil to return
to the oil pan.
5. Wipe the dipstick clean and re-insert
it fully.
09
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
OTMA090002
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
OTMA090003
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
OTMA090016
6. Pull the dipstick out again and check
the level. The level should be between
F (Full) and L (Low).
OTMA090017
7. If the oil level is below L, add enough
oil to bring the level to F.
Use only the specified engine oil (Refer
to “Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” section in chapter 2).
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your engine:
ś Do not spill engine oil when adding
or changing engine oil. Wipe off
spilled oil immediately.
ś The engine oil consumption may
increase while you break in a new
vehicle and it will be stabilized after
driving 4,000 miles (6,000 km).
ś The engine oil consumption can be
affected by driving habits, climate
conditions, traffic conditions,
oil quality, etc. Therefore, it is
recommended that you inspect the
engine oil level regularly and refill it
if necessary.
9-17
Maintenance
Checking the engine oil and
filter
OCN7092026
ś The lubrication, rust prevention,
cooling, and cleaning effect of the
engine oil will gradually degrade
during its use. Have the engine oil
and filter changed by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer according to the Oil
Life Management System function
or the Maintenance Schedule at the
beginning of this chapter.
ś If the maintenance schedule to
replace engine oil is exceeded,
the engine oil performance may
deteriorate, and the engine condition
may be affected. Therefore, replace
the engine oil according to the
maintenance schedule.
ś To keep the engine in optimal
condition, use the recommended
engine oil and filter. If the
recommended engine oil and filter are
not used, replace it according to the
maintenance schedule under severe
usage conditions.
ś The purpose of the maintenance
schedule for engine oil replacement
is to prevent oil deterioration and it is
irrelevant to oil consumption. Check
and refill engine oil regularly.
9-18
Information
When the oil pressure is low due to
insufficient engine oil, the Engine
Oil Pressure ( ) warning light will
illuminate. In addition, the enhanced
engine protection system, which limits
the engine’s power is activated and the
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ( ) will
illuminate when the vehicle is driven in
this state continuously. When oil pressure
is restored, the Engine Oil Pressure
warning light will turn off and the engine
power will no longer be limited.
However, for gasoline 2.5 turbo engine
and 2.5 gdi engine, when the engine oil
pressure is restored, the warning light and
the enhanced engine protection system will
turn off after the engine is restarted.
CAUTION
The engine oil is very hot immediately
after the vehicle has been driven and
can cause burns during replacement.
Replace the engine oil after the engine
oil has cooled down.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Engine oil contains chemicals known to
the State of California to cause cancer,
birth defects and reproductive harm.
Used engine oil may cause irritation or
cancer of the skin if left in contact with
the skin for prolonged periods of time.
Always protect your skin by washing
your hands thoroughly with soap and
warm water as soon as possible after
handling used oil.
09
(1*,1(&22/$17/,48,'ǘ&22/(',17(5&22/(5
COOLANT
The high-pressure cooling system has a
reservoir filled with year-round antifreeze
coolant. The reservoir is filled at the
factory.
Check the antifreeze protection and
coolant level at least once a year, at
the beginning of the winter season and
before traveling to a colder climate.
Checking the coolant level
Smartstream G2.5 GDI
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen or
deteriorated hoses.
The coolant level should be filled
between the MAX and the MIN marks on
the side of the coolant reservoir when
the engine is cool.
If the coolant level is low, add enough
distilled (deionized) water to bring the
level to the MAX mark, but do not overfill.
If frequent additions are required, see an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for a cooling
system inspection.
WARNING
OTMA090004
Smartstream G2.5 T-GDI
OTMA090018
Never remove the engine
coolant cap and/or watercooled intercooler coolant
cap or the drain plug while
the engine and radiator are
hot. Hot coolant and steam
may blow out under pressure,
causing serious injury.
Turn the vehicle off and wait until the
engine cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the engine coolant
cap and/or water-cooled intercooler
coolant cap. Wrap a thick towel around
it, and turn it slowly to the first stop.
Step back while the pressure is released
from the cooling system. When you are
sure all the pressure has been released,
press down on the cap, using a thick
towel, and continue turning to remove
it.
9-19
Maintenance
Information
The coolant level is influenced by the
engine temperature. Before checking or
refilling the coolant, turn the engine off.
WARNING
The electric motor for the cooling fan
may continue to operate or start up
when the engine is not running and
can cause serious injury. Keep hands,
clothing and tools away from the
rotating fan blades of the cooling fan.
Always turn off the vehicle unless the
vehicle has to be inspected with the
engine on. Be cautious as the cooling
fan may operate if the negative (-)
battery terminal is not disconnected.
WARNING
Make sure the coolant cap is properly
closed after refilling coolant. Otherwise
the engine could be overheated while
driving.
Engine compartment front view
OOSH089010L
1. Check if the coolant cap label is
straight in front.
OJX1099046
2. Make sure that the tiny protrusions
inside the coolant cap are securely
interlocked.
9-20
09
Recommended coolant
ś When adding coolant, use only
deionized water, distilled water or soft
water for your vehicle and never mix
hard water in the coolant filled at the
factory.
ś An incorrect coolant mixture can
result in severe malfunction or engine
damage.
ś The engine in your vehicle has
aluminum engine parts and must be
protected by an phosphate-based
ethylene glycol coolant to prevent
corrosion and freezing.
ś Do not use alcohol or methanol
coolant or mix them with the specified
coolant.
ś Do not use a solution that contains
more than 60% antifreeze or less than
35% antifreeze, which would reduce
the effectiveness of the solution.
For mixing percentage, refer to the
following table:
Ambient
Temperature
5°F (-15°C)
-13°F (-25°C)
-31°F (-35°C)
-49°F (-45°C)
Mixture Percentage
(volume)
Antifreeze
Water
35
65
40
60
50
50
60
40
Information
If in doubt about the mix ratio, a 50%
water and 50% antifreeze mix is the
easiest to mix together as it will be the
same quantity of each. It is suitable to
use for most temperature ranges of -31°F
(-35°C) and higher.
Changing coolant
Have coolant be changed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer according
to the Maintenance Schedule at the
beginning of this chapter.
WARNING
Do not use engine coolant or antifreeze
in the washer fluid reservoir.
Engine coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Engine coolant may also cause damage
to paint and body trim.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to engine parts, put
a thick towel around the engine coolant
cap and/or inverter coolant cap before
refilling the coolant to prevent the
coolant from overflowing into engine
parts, such as the alternator.
9-21
Maintenance
BRAKE FLUID
Checking the brake fluid level
WARNING
Do not let brake fluid enter into your
eyes. If brake fluid gets in your eyes,
flush your eyes with clean water for
at least 15 minutes and get immediate
medical attention.
NOTICE
OTMA090005
Check the fluid level in the reservoir
periodically. The fluid level should be
between MAX and MIN marks on the side
of the reservoir.
Before removing the reservoir cap and
adding brake fluid, clean the area around
the reservoir cap thoroughly to prevent
brake fluid contamination.
If the level is low, add the specified brake
fluid to the MAX level. The level will fall
with accumulated mileage. This is a
normal condition associated with the
wear of the brake linings. If the fluid level
is excessively low, have the brake system
be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
If the brake system requires frequent
additions of fluid this could indicate
a leak in the brake system. Have the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
9-22
ś Do not allow brake fluid to contact
the vehicle’s body paint, as it will
result in paint damage.
ś NEVER use brake fluid which has
been exposed to open air for an
extended time, as its quality cannot
be guaranteed. It should be disposed
of properly.
ś Do not use the wrong type of brake
fluid. A few drops of mineral based,
oil such as engine oil in your brake
system can damage brake system
parts.
Information
Use only the specified brake fluid (refer
to “Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” section in chapter 2).
09
WASHER FLUID
Checking the washer fluid level
OTMA090006
Check the fluid level in the washer fluid
reservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plain
water may be used if washer fluid is not
available. However, use washer solvent
with antifreeze characteristics in cold
climates to prevent freezing.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury or death, take
the following safety precautions when
using washer fluid:
ś Do not use engine coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir. Engine coolant can
severely obscure visibility when
sprayed on the windshield and
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident or damage to
paint and body trim.
ś Do not allow sparks or flame to
contact the washer fluid or the
washer fluid reservoir. Washer fluid
may contain alcohol and can be
flammable.
ś Do not drink washer fluid and avoid
contact with skin. Washer fluid is
harmful to humans and animals.
ś Keep washer fluid away from
children and animals.
9-23
Maintenance
AIR CLEANER
Filter replacement
OTMA090024
OTMA090007
The air cleaner filter can be cleaned for
inspection using compressed air. Do not
attempt to wash or to rinse it, as water
will damage the filter. If soiled, the air
cleaner filter must be replaced.
4. Replace the air cleaner filter.
5. Reassemble the air cleaner cover in
the reverse order.
Information
If the vehicle is operated in extremely
dusty or sandy areas, replace the element
more often than the usual recommended
intervals (refer to “Maintenance Under
Severe Usage Conditions” in this chapter).
NOTICE
OTMA090008
1. Pull up the air cleaner filter cover (1).
OTMA090023
2. Wipe the inside of the air cleaner.
3. Pull down the lever to the UNLOCK (2)
position.
9-24
ś Do not drive with the air cleaner filter
removed. This will result in excessive
engine wear.
ś When removing the air cleaner filter,
be careful that dust or dirt does not
enter the air intake, or damage may
result.
ś Use HYUNDAI genuine parts or the
equivalent specified for your vehicle.
Use of non-genuine parts could
damage the air flow sensor.
09
CABIN AIR FILTER
Filter inspection
The cabin air filter should be replaced
according to the Maintenance Schedule.
If the vehicle is operated in severely airpolluted cities or on dusty rough roads
for a long period, it should be inspected
more frequently and replaced sooner.
Replace the cabin air filter by following
the procedure below and be careful to
avoid damaging other components.
OTM090011
Filter replacement
3. Press and hold the lock on the right
side of the cover.
4. Pull out the cover.
5. Replace the cabin air filter.
6. Reassemble in the reverse order of
disassembly.
NOTICE
OTM090009
1. Open the glove box and remove the
support rod (1).
OHI078055
Install a new cabin air filter in the
correct direction with the arrow symbol
Ƣ IDFLQJGRZQZDUGVWRSUHYHQWQRLVH
and improve effectiveness.
OTM090010
2. Remove the stoppers on both sides to
allow the glove box to hang freely on
the hinges.
9-25
Maintenance
WIPER BLADES
Blade inspection
Blade replacement
Contamination of either the windshield
or the wiper blades with foreign matter
can reduce the effectiveness of the
windshield wipers.
Common sources of contamination are
insects, tree sap, and hot wax treatments
used by some commercial car washes. If
the blades are not wiping properly, clean
both the window and the blades with a
good cleaner or mild detergent, and rinse
thoroughly with clean water.
When the wipers no longer clean
adequately, the blades may be worn or
cracked, and require replacement.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper blades,
arms or other components, do not:
ś Use gasoline, kerosene, paint
thinner, or other solvents on or near
them.
ś Attempt to move the wipers
manually.
ś Use non-specified wiper blades.
Information
Commercial hot waxes applied by
automatic car washes have been known to
make the windshield difficult to clean.
Information
Wiper blades are consumable items.
Normal wear of the wipers may not be
covered by your vehicle warranty.
9-26
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
or other components, do not attempt to
move the wipers manually.
NOTICE
The use of a non-specified wiper blade
could result in wiper malfunction and
failure.
NOTICE
ś In order to prevent damage to the
hood and the wiper arms, the wiper
arms should only be lifted when in
the top wiping position.
ś Always return the wiper arms to the
windshield before driving.
09
Front windshield wiper service
positions
Type A
OHI078075
OTM090012
This vehicle has a “hidden” wiper design
which means that the wipers cannot
be lifted when they are in their bottom
resting position.
1. Within 20 seconds of turning off the
engine, lift and hold the wiper lever up
to the MIST (or down to the V) position
for about 2 seconds until the wipers
move to the top wipe position.
2. At this time you can lift the wipers off
the windshield.
3. Gently put the wipers back down onto
the windshield.
4. Turn the wipers to any ON position
to return the wipers to the bottom
resting position.
OHI078076
1. Lift up the wiper blade clip. Then lift
up the wiper blade.
2. While pushing the lock (1), pull down
the wiper blade (2).
OHI078077
3. Remove the wiper blade from the
wiper arm.
4. Install a new wiper blade assembly in
the reverse order of removal.
5. Return the wiper arm on the
windshield.
9-27
Maintenance
Type B
Rear window wiper blade
replacement
OTM090039
1. Raise the wiper arm.
OOSH089025L
1. Raise the wiper arm and then rotate
the wiper blade assembly (1).
2. Pull out the wiper blade assembly (2).
OTM090040
2. Lift up the wiper blade clip. Then pull
down the blade assembly and remove
it.
OOSH089026L
OTM090041
3. Install the new blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
4. Return the wiper arm on the
windshield.
9-28
3. Install the new blade assembly by
inserting the center part into the slot
in the wiper arm until it clicks into
place (3).
4. Make sure the blade assembly is
installed firmly by trying to pull it
slightly.
5. Rotate back the blade assembly so
that it aligns with the wiper arm.
To prevent damage to the wiper arms or
other components, we recommend that
you have the wiper blades replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
09
BATTERY
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH
to you or bystanders, always follow
these precautions when working near
or handling the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions carefully when
handling a battery.
Wear eye protection designed
to protect the eyes from acid
splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks, or
smoking materials away from
the battery.
Hydrogen is always present
in battery cells, is highly
combustible, and may explode
if ignited.
Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
Batteries contain sulfuric acid
which is highly corrosive. Do
not allow acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
If acid gets into your eyes, flush your
eyes with clean water for at least 15
minutes and get immediate medical
attention. If acid gets on your skin,
thoroughly wash the area. If you feel
pain or a burning sensation, get medical
attention immediately.
ś When lifting a plastic-cased battery,
excessive pressure on the case may
cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a
battery carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
ś Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle if your battery is frozen.
ś NEVER attempt to recharge the
battery when the vehicle’s battery
cables are connected to the battery.
ś The electrical ignition system works
with high voltage. NEVER touch
these components with the engine
running or when the Engine Start/
Stop button is in the ON position.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Battery posts, terminals, and related
accessories contain lead and lead
compounds, chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer,
birth defects and reproductive harm.
Batteries also contain other chemicals
known to the State of California
to cause cancer. Wash hands after
handling.
NOTICE
Always follow these instructions when
handling your vehicle’s battery to
prevent damage to your battery:
ś When you do not use the vehicle for a
long time in a low temperature area,
disconnect the battery and keep it
indoors.
ś Always charge the battery fully to
prevent battery case damage in low
temperature areas.
ś Prevent liquid from wetting the
battery terminals. The performance
of the battery may be degraded, and
may cause injury. Be cautious when
loading liquid in the trunk.
ś Do not tilt the battery.
ś If you connect unauthorized
electronic devices to the battery, the
battery may be discharged. Never
use unauthorized devices.
9-29
Maintenance
For best battery service
Information - For batteries
marked with UPPER and
LOWER
OTMA090009
ś Keep the battery securely mounted.
ś Keep the battery top clean and dry.
ś Keep the terminals and connections
clean, tight, and coated with
petroleum jelly or terminal grease.
ś Rinse any spilled electrolyte from the
battery immediately with a solution of
water and baking soda.
ś If the vehicle is not going to be used
for an extended time, disconnect the
battery cables.
9-30
OHI078084L
If your vehicle is equipped with a battery
marked with LOWER (MIN) and UPPER
(MAX) on the side, you should check the
electrolyte level.
The electrolyte level should be between
LOWER (MIN) and UPPER (MAX).
When the electrolyte level is low, add
distilled (or de-mineralized) water. (Never
add sulfuric acids or other electrolyte).
Be careful not to spill distilled (or
demineralized) water over the battery
surface or other adjacent components.
Also, do not overfill the battery cells.
If not, it may corrode the battery or other
components. Finally, securely close the
cell cap. However, contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for better battery
service.
09
Battery capacity label
Battery recharging
By battery charger
Type A
OTM090063L
Type B
Your vehicle has a maintenance-free,
calcium-based battery.
ś If the battery becomes discharged
over a short time (because, for
example, the headlights or interior
lights were left on while the vehicle
was not in use), recharge it by slow
charging (trickle) for 10 hours.
ś If the battery gradually discharges
because of high electrical load while
the vehicle is being used, recharge it
at 20-30A for two hours.
WARNING
OTM090064L
1. MF68L-DIN : The HYUNDAI model
name of battery
2. 12V : The nominal voltage
3. 68Ah (20HR) : The nominal capacity
(in Ampere hours)
4. RC 110min : The nominal capacity (in
Ampere hours)
5. 600A : The cold-test current in
amperes by SAE/EN
Always follow these instructions when
recharging your vehicle’s battery to
avoid the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH from explosions or acid burns:
ś Before performing maintenance or
recharging the battery, turn off all
accessories and stop the engine.
ś Keep all flames, sparks, or smoking
materials away from the battery.
ś Always work outdoors or in an area
with plenty of ventilation.
ś Wear eye protection when checking
the battery during charging.
ś The battery must be removed from
the vehicle and placed in a well
ventilated area.
ś Watch the battery during charging,
and stop or reduce the charging
rate if the battery cells begin boiling
violently.
9-31
Maintenance
ś The negative battery cable must
be removed first and installed last
when the battery is disconnected.
Disconnect the battery charger in the
following order:
1. Turn off the battery charger main
switch.
2. Unhook the negative clamp from
the negative battery terminal.
3. Unhook the positive clamp from
the positive battery terminal.
ś Always use a genuine HYUNDAI
approved battery when you replace
the battery.
NOTICE
AGM battery (if equipped)
ś Absorbent Glass Matt (AGM)
batteries are maintenance-free
and we recommend that the AGM
battery be serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer. For charging
your AGM battery, use only fully
automatic battery chargers that
are specially developed for AGM
batteries.
ś When replacing the AGM battery,
we recommend that you use parts
for replacement from an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Do not open or remove the cap on
top of the battery. This may cause
leaks of internal electrolyte that
could result in severe injury.
9-32
By jump starting
After a jump start from a good battery,
drive the vehicle for 20-30 minutes
before it is shutoff. The vehicle may
not restart if you shut it off before the
battery had a chance to adequately
recharge. See “Jump Starting” in chapter
6 for more information on jump starting
procedures.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human health.
Dispose of the battery according
to your local law(s) or regulation.
Reset items
The following items may need to be reset
after the battery has been discharged or
the battery has been disconnected.
ś Auto up/down window (see chapter 5)
ś Sunroof (see chapter 5)
ś Trip computer (see chapter 5)
ś Climate control system (see chapter 5)
ś Driver position memory system (see
chapter 5)
ś Clock (see chapter 5)
ś Infotainment system (see
infotainment system manual)
09
TIRES AND WHEELS
WARNING
Tire failure may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident. To reduce risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the
following precautions:
ś Inspect your tires monthly for
proper inflation as well as wear
and damage.
ś The recommended cold tire
pressure for your vehicle can be
found in this manual and on the
tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar. Always use a
tire pressure gauge to measure
tire pressure. Tires with too
much or too little pressure wear
unevenly causing poor handling.
ś Check the pressure of the
spare every time you check the
pressure of the other tires on
your vehicle.
ś Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of
braking effectiveness, steering
control, or traction.
ś ALWAYS replace tires with the
same size, type, construction and
tread pattern as each tire that
was originally supplied with this
vehicle. Using tires and wheels
other than the recommended
sizes could cause unusual
handling characteristics, poor
vehicle control, or negatively
affect your vehicle’s Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) resulting in a
serious accident.
Tire care
For proper maintenance, safety, and
maximum fuel economy, you must
always maintain recommended
tire inflation pressures and stay
within the load limits and weight
distribution recommended for your
vehicle.
OTM078063L
All specifications (sizes and
pressures) can be found on a label
attached to the driver’s side center
pillar.
Recommended cold tire inflation
pressures
All tire pressures (including the
spare) should be checked when the
tires are cold. “Cold tires” means the
vehicle has not been driven for at
least three hours or driven less than 1
mile (1.6km).
Warm tires normally exceed
recommended cold tire pressures
by 4 to 6 psi (28 to 41 kPa). Do not
release air from warm tires to adjust
the pressure or the tires will be
under-inflated. For recommended
inflation pressure, refer to “Tire and
Wheels” section in chapter 2.
9-33
Maintenance
WARNING
Recommended pressures must be
maintained for the best ride, vehicle
handling, and minimum tire wear.
Over-inflation or under-inflation
can reduce tire life, adversely
affect vehicle handling, and lead to
sudden tire failure that could result
in loss of vehicle control resulting in
an accident.
Severe under-inflation can lead
to severe heat build-up, causing
blowouts, tread separation and
other tire failures that can result in
the loss of vehicle control resulting
in an accident. This risk is much
higher on hot days and when
driving for long periods at high
speeds.
CAUTION
ś Under-inflation results in
excessive wear, poor handling
and reduced fuel economy.
Wheel deformation is also
possible. Keep your tire pressures
at the proper levels. If a tire
frequently needs refilling, have
it be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Over-inflation produces a harsh
ride, excessive wear at the center
of the tire tread, and a greater
possibility of damage from road
hazards.
9-34
Check tire inflation pressure
Check your tires, including the spare
tire, once a month or more.
How to check
Use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to check tire pressure. You
can not tell if your tires are properly
inflated simply by looking at them.
Radial tires may look properly
inflated when they are underinflated.
Remove the valve cap from the tire
valve stem. Press the tire gauge
firmly onto the valve to get a
pressure measurement. If the cold
tire inflation pressure matches the
recommended pressure on the tire
and loading information label, no
further adjustment is necessary. If
the pressure is low, add air until you
reach the recommended pressure.
Make sure to put the valve caps
back on the valve stems. Without
the valve cap, dirt or moisture could
get into the valve core and cause
air leakage. If a valve cap is missing,
install a new one as soon as possible.
If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the
center of the tire valve. Recheck the
tire pressure with the tire gauge. Be
sure to put the valve caps back on
the valve stems. Without the valve
cap, dirt or moisture could get into
the valve core and cause air leakage.
If a valve cap is missing, install a new
one as soon as possible.
09
Tire rotation
Information
To equalize tread wear, HYUNDAI
recommends that the tires
be rotated according to the
maintenance schedule or sooner if
irregular wear develops.
During rotation, check the tires for
correct balance.
When rotating tires, check for
uneven wear and damage. Abnormal
wear is usually caused by incorrect
tire pressure, improper wheel
alignment, out-of-balance wheels,
severe braking or severe cornering.
Look for bumps or bulges in the
tread or side of the tire. Replace
the tire if you find any of these
conditions. Replace the tire if fabric
or cord is visible. After rotation, be
sure to bring the front and rear tire
pressures to specification and check
wheel bolt tightness (proper torque
is 101~116 lbf.ft [14~16 kgf.m]).
The outside and inside of the
unsymmetrical tire is distinguishable.
When installing an unsymmetrical
tire, be sure to install the side marked
“outside” face the outside. If the side
marked “inside” is installed on the
outside, it will have a negative effect
on vehicle performance.
WARNING
ś Do not use the compact spare
tire for tire rotation.
ś Do not mix bias ply and radial ply
tires under any circumstances.
This may cause unusual handling
characteristics that may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in
an accident.
OHI078078
Disc brake pads should be inspected
for wear whenever tires are rotated.
9-35
Maintenance
Wheel alignment and tire
balance
WARNING
The wheels on your vehicle were
aligned and balanced carefully at the
factory to give you the longest tire
life and best overall performance.
In most cases, you will not need to
have your wheels aligned again.
However, if you notice unusual tire
wear or your vehicle pulling one way
or the other, the alignment may need
to be reset.
If you notice your vehicle vibrating
when driving on a smooth road, your
wheels may need to be rebalanced.
NOTICE
Incorrect wheel weights can
damage your vehicle’s aluminum
wheels. Use only approved wheel
weights.
Tire replacement
Tread wear indicator
OHI078080
If the tire is worn evenly, a tread
wear indicator will appear as a solid
band across the tread. This shows
there is less than 1/16 inch (1.6mm) of
tread left on the tire. Replace the tire
when this happens.
Do not wait for the band to appear
across the entire tread before
replacing the tire.
9-36
To reduce the risk of DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY:
ś Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of
braking effectiveness, steering
control, and traction.
ś Always replace tires with the
same size as each tire that was
originally supplied with this
vehicle. Using tires and wheels
other than the recommended
sizes could cause unusual
handling characteristics, poor
vehicle control, or negatively
affect your vehicle’s Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) resulting in a
serious accident.
ś When replacing tires (or wheels),
it is recommended to replace
the two front or two rear tires (or
wheels) as a pair. Replacing just
one tire can seriously affect your
vehicle’s handling.
ś Tires degrade over time, even
when they are not being used.
Regardless of the remaining
tread, HYUNDAI recommends
that tires be replaced after six (6)
years of normal service.
ś Heat caused by hot climates or
frequent high loading conditions
can accelerate the aging process.
Failure to follow this warning
may cause sudden tire failure,
which could lead to a loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
09
Compact spare tire replacement
(if equipped)
A compact spare tire has a shorter
tread life than a regular size tire.
Replace it when you can see the
tread wear indicator bars on the tire.
The replacement compact spare tire
should be the same size and design
tire as the one provided with your
new vehicle and should be mounted
on the same compact spare tire
wheel. The compact spare tire is
not designed to be mounted on a
regular size wheel, and the compact
spare tire wheel is not designed for
mounting a regular size tire.
WARNING
The original tire should be repaired
or replaced as soon as possible to
avoid failure of the spare and loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident. The compact spare tire
is for emergency use only. Do not
operate your vehicle over 50 mph
(80 km/h) when using the compact
spare tire.
Wheel replacement
When replacing the metal wheels
for any reason, make sure the new
wheels are equivalent to the original
factory units in diameter, rim width
and offset.
Tire traction
Tire traction can be reduced if you
drive on worn tires, tires that are
improperly inflated or on slippery
road surfaces. Tires should be
replaced when tread wear indicators
appear. To reduce the possibility of
losing control, slow down whenever
there is rain, snow or ice on the road.
Tire maintenance
In addition to proper inflation,
correct wheel alignment helps to
decrease tire wear. If you find a tire
is worn unevenly, have your dealer
check the wheel alignment.
When you have new tires installed,
make sure they are balanced. This
will increase vehicle ride comfort
and tire life. Additionally, a tire
should always be rebalanced if it is
removed from the wheel.
9-37
Maintenance
Tire sidewall labeling
This information identifies and
describes the fundamental
characteristics of the tire and also
provides the tire identification
number (TIN) for safety standard
certification. The TIN can be used to
identify the tire in case of a recall.
OHI078081
1. Manufacturer or brand name
Manufacturer or brand name is
shown.
2. Tire size designation
A tire’s sidewall is marked with a
tire size designation. You will need
this information when selecting
replacement tires for your car.
The following explains what the
letters and numbers in the tire size
designation mean.
9-38
Example tire size designation:
(These numbers are provided as
an example only; your tire size
designator could vary depending on
your vehicle.)
235/60R18 102H
235 - Tire width in millimeters.
60 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s section
height as a percentage of its
width.
R - Tire construction code (Radial).
18 - Rim diameter in inches.
102 - Load Index, a numerical code
associated with the maximum
load the tire can carry.
H - Speed Rating Symbol. See the
speed rating chart in this section
for additional information.
Wheel size designation
Wheels are also marked with
important information that you need
if you ever have to replace one. The
following explains what the letters
and numbers in the wheel size
designation mean.
Example wheel size designation:
7.5J X 18
7.5 - Rim width in inches.
J - Rim contour designation.
18 - Rim diameter in inches.
09
Tire speed ratings
The chart below lists many of the
different speed ratings currently
being used for passenger vehicle
tires. The speed rating is part of the
tire size designation on the sidewall
of the tire. This symbol corresponds
to that tire’s designed maximum safe
operating speed.
Speed Rating
Symbol
S
T
H
V
W
Y
Maximum Speed
112 mph (180 km/h)
118 mph (190 km/h)
130 mph (210 km/h)
149 mph (240 km/h)
168 mph (270 km/h)
186 mph (300 km/h)
3. Checking tire life (TIN : Tire
Identification Number)
Any tires that are over six years old,
based on the manufacturing date,
(including the spare tire) should be
replaced by new ones. You can find
the manufacturing date on the tire
sidewall (possibly on the inside of
the wheel), displaying the DOT Code.
The DOT Code is a series of numbers
on a tire consisting of numbers and
English letters. The manufacturing
date is designated by the last four
digits (characters) of the DOT code.
4. Tire ply composition and material
The number of layers or plies of
rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the
materials in the tire, which include
steel, nylon, polyester, and others.
The letter “R” means radial ply
construction; the letter “D“ means
diagonal or bias ply construction;
and the letter “B” means belted-bias
ply construction.
5. Maximum permissible inflation
pressure
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure. Refer
to the Tire and Loading Information
label for recommended inflation
pressure.
6. Maximum load rating
This number indicates the maximum
load in kilograms and pounds that
can be carried by the tire. When
replacing the tires on the vehicle,
always use a tire that has the same
load rating as the factory installed
tire.
DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO
The front part of the DOT shows a
plant code number, tire size and
tread pattern and the last four
numbers indicate week and year
manufactured.
For example:
DOT XXXX XXXX 1522 represents that
the tire was produced in the 15th
week of 2022.
9-39
Maintenance
7. Uniform tire quality grading
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and
maximum section width.
For example:
TREADWEAR 200
TRACTION AA
TEMPERATURE A
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a
comparative rating based on the
wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150 would
wear one-and-a-half times (1½) as
well on the government course as a
tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires
depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may
depart significantly from the norm
due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in
road characteristics and climate.
These grades are molded on the
sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires.
The tires available as standard or
optional equipment on your vehicle
may vary with respect to grade.
9-40
Traction - AA, A, B & C
The traction grades, from highest
to lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those
grades represent the tire’s ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces
of asphalt and concrete. A tire
marked C may have poor traction
performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to
this tire is based on straight ahead
braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering,
hydroplaning, or peak traction
characteristics.
Temperature - A, B & C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B and C representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation
of heat and its ability to dissipate
heat when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified indoor
laboratory test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can
cause the material of the tire to
degenerate and reduce tire life,
and excessive temperature can
lead to sudden tire failure. Grades
B and A represent higher levels of
performance on the laboratory test
wheel than the minimum required
by law.
09
WARNING
The temperature grade for this
tire is established for a tire that
is properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
under-inflation, over-inflation, or
excessive loading, either separately
or in combination, can cause heat
build-up and possible sudden
tire failure. This may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Tire Terminology and Definitions
Air Pressure
The amount of air inside the tire pressing
outward on the tire. Air pressure is
expressed in pounds per square inch
(psi) or kilopascal (kPa).
Accessory Weight
This means the combined weight of
optional accessories. Some examples
of optional accessories are automatic
transmission, power seats, and air
conditioning.
Aspect Ratio
The relationship of a tire’s height to its
width.
Belt
A rubber coated layer of cords that is
located between the plies and the tread.
Cords may be made from steel or other
reinforcing materials.
Bead
The tire bead contains steel wires
wrapped by steel cords that hold the tire
onto the rim.
Bias Ply Tire
A pneumatic tire in which the plies are
laid at alternate angles less than 90
degrees to the centerline of the tread.
Cold Tire Pressure
The amount of air pressure in a tire,
measured in pounds per square inch (psi)
or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire has built
up heat from driving.
Curb Weight
This means the weight of a motor vehicle
with standard and optional equipment
including the maximum capacity of fuel,
oil and coolant, but without passengers
and cargo.
9-41
Maintenance
DOT Markings
Maximum Inflation Pressure
A code molded into the sidewall
of a tire signifying that the tire is in
compliance with the U.S. Department
of Transportation motor vehicle safety
standards. The DOT code includes the
Tire Identification Number (TIN), an
alphanumeric designator which can
also identify the tire manufacturer,
production plant, brand and date of
production.
The maximum air pressure to which a
cold tire may be inflated. The maximum
air pressure is molded onto the sidewall.
GVWR
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
The sum of curb weight; accessory
weight; vehicle capacity weight; and
production options weight.
GAWR FRT
Normal Occupant Weight
Gross Axle Weight Rating for the Front
Axle.
The number of occupants a vehicle
is designed to seat multiplied by 150
pounds (68 kg).
GAWR RR
Maximum Load Rating
The load rating for a tire at the maximum
permissible inflation pressure for that
tire.
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight
Gross Axle Weight Rating for the Rear
axle.
Occupant Distribution
Intended Outboard Sidewall
Outward Facing Sidewall
The side of an asymmetrical tire,
that must always face outward when
mounted on a vehicle.
An asymmetrical tire has a particular
side that faces outward when mounted
on a vehicle. The outward facing
sidewall bears white lettering or bears
manufacturer, brand, and/or model
name molding that is higher or deeper
than the same moldings on the inner
facing sidewall.
Kilopascal (kPa)
The metric unit for air pressure.
Light truck(LT) tire
A tire designated by its manufacturer as
primarily intended for use on lightweight
trucks or multipurpose passenger
vehicles.
Designated seating positions.
Passenger (P-Metric) tire
A tire used on passenger cars and some
light duty trucks and multipurpose
vehicles.
Load ratings
The maximum load that a tire is rated to
carry for a given inflation pressure.
Load Index
An assigned number ranging from 1 to
279 that corresponds to the load carrying
capacity of a tire.
9-42
Ply
A layer of rubber-coated parallel cords.
09
Pneumatic tire
Traction
A mechanical device made of rubber,
chemicals, fabric and steel or other
materials, that, when mounted on an
automotive wheel provides the traction
and contains the gas or fluid that
sustains the load.
The friction between the tire and
the road surface. The amount of grip
provided.
Pneumatic options weight
The combined weight of installed regular
production options weighing over 5 lb.
(2.3 kg) in excess of the standard items
which they replace, not previously
considered in curb weight or accessory
weight, including heavy duty breaks, ride
levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery,
and special trim.
Recommended Inflation Pressure
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended
tire inflation pressure as shown on the
tire placard.
Radial Ply Tire
A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords
that extend to the beads are laid at 90
degrees to the centerline of the tread.
Rim
A metal support for a tire and upon
which the tire beads are seated.
Tread
The portion of a tire that comes into
contact with the road.
Treadwear Indicators
Narrow bands, sometimes called “wear
bars”, that show across the tread of a tire
when only 1/16 inch of tread remains.
UTQGS
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
is a tire information system that provides
consumers with ratings for a tire’s
traction, temperature and treadwear.
Ratings are determined by tire
manufacturers using government testing
procedures. The ratings are molded into
the sidewall of the tire.
Vehicle Capacity Weight
The number of designated seating
positions multiplied by 150 lbs. (68 kg)
plus the rated cargo and luggage load.
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire
Sidewall
Load on an individual tire due to curb
and accessory weight plus maximum
occupant and cargo weight.
The portion of a tire between the tread
and the bead.
Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire
Speed Rating
An alphanumeric code assigned to a tire
indicating the maximum speed at which
a tire can operate.
Load on an individual tire that is
determined by distributing to each axle
its share of the curb weight, accessory
weight, and normal occupant weight and
dividing by 2.
Vehicle Placard
A label permanently attached to a vehicle
showing the original equipment tire size
and recommended inflation pressure.
9-43
Maintenance
All Season Tires
Radial-Ply Tires
HYUNDAI specifies all season tires
on some models to provide good
performance for use all year round,
including snowy and icy road conditions.
All season tires are identified by ALL
SEASON and/or M+S (Mud and Snow) on
the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better
snow traction than all season tires and
may be more appropriate in some areas.
Radial-ply tires provide improved tread
life, road hazard resistance and smoother
high speed ride. The radial-ply tires used
on this vehicle are of belted construction,
and are selected to complement the
ride and handling characteristics of your
vehicle.
Radial-ply tires have the same load
carrying capacity, as bias-ply or bias
belted tires of the same size, and use the
same recommended inflation pressure.
Mixing of radial-ply tires with bias-ply or
bias belted tires is not recommended.
Any combinations of radial-ply and biasply or bias belted tires when used on the
same vehicle will seriously deteriorate
vehicle handling. The best rule to follow
is: Identical pairs of radial-ply tires
should always be used as a set for the
front tires and a set for the rear tires.
Longer wearing tires can be more
susceptible to irregular tread wear. It is
very important to follow the tire rotation
interval in this chapter to achieve the
tread life potential of these tires. Cuts
and punctures in radial-ply tires are
repairable only in the tread area, because
of sidewall flexing. Consult your tire
dealer for radial-ply tire repairs.
Snow Tires
If you equip your car with snow tires,
they should be the same size and have
the same load capacity as the original
tires. Snow tires should be installed on
all four wheels; otherwise, poor handling
may result. Snow tires should carry 4
psi (28 kPa) more air pressure than the
pressure recommended for the standard
tires on the tire label on the driver’s
side of the center pillar, or up to the
maximum pressure shown on the tire
sidewall, whichever is less. Do not drive
faster than 75 mph (120 km/h) when your
vehicle is equipped with snow tires.
WARNING
Do not mix bias ply and radial ply tires
under any circumstances. This may
cause unusual handling characteristics
that may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
9-44
09
CAUTION
ś When driving on a rough road or
off road, drive cautiously because
tires and wheels may be damaged.
And after driving, inspect tires and
wheels.
ś When passing over a pothole, speed
bump, manhole, or curb stone, drive
slowly so that the tires and wheels
are not damaged.
ś If the tire is subjected to a severe
impact, have the tire and wheel
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś It is not easy to recognize tire
damage with your own eyes. But
if there is the slightest hint of tire
damage, have the tire checked or
replaced because the tire damage
may cause air leakage from the tire.
Low aspect ratio tires
(if equipped)
The aspect ratio is lower than 50 on
low aspect ratio tires.
Because low aspect ratio tires are
optimized for handling and braking,
their sidewall is a little stiffer than
a standard tire. Also low aspect
ratio tires tend to be wider and
consequently have a greater contact
patch with the road surface. In some
instances they may generate more
road noise compared with standard
tires.
ś If the tire is damaged by driving
on a rough road, off road,
pothole, manhole, or curb stone,
it will not be covered by the
warranty.
9-45
Maintenance
CAUTION
The side wall of a low aspect ratio
tire is shorter than the normal one.
Thus, the low-aspect wheel and
tire are easily damaged. Follow the
below instructions.
ś When driving on a rough road or
driving off a road, be careful not
to damage the tires and wheels.
After driving, inspect the tires
and wheels.
ś When passing over a pothole,
speed bump, manhole, or curb
stone, drive the vehicle slowly so
as not to damage the tires and
wheels.
ś When there is an impact on a tire,
inspect the tire condition. Or,
you can contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Inspect the tire condition and
pressure every 1,800 miles (3,000
km) to prevent tire damage.
ś It is difficult to recognize a tire
damage only with your eyes.
When there is a slight hint of a
tire damage, check and replace
the tire to prevent the damage
caused by air leakage.
ś When a tire is damaged while
driving on a rough road, off a
road, or over obstacles, such as a
pothole, manhole, or curb stone,
your warranty does not cover the
damage.
ś The tire information is specified
on the tire side wall.
9-46
09
FUSES
Ŷ Blade type
Normal
Blown
Ŷ Cartridge type
Normal
Blown
Ŷ Multi type
A vehicle’s electrical system is protected
from electrical overload damage by
fuses.
This vehicle has 5 fuse panels, one
located in the driver’s side panel bolster,
the other in the engine compartment.
If any of your vehicle’s lights,
accessories, or controls do not work,
check the appropriate circuit fuse. If a
fuse has blown, the element inside the
fuse will be melted or broken.
If the electrical system does not work,
first check the driver’s side fuse panel.
Before replacing a blown fuse, turn the
engine and all switches off, and then
disconnect the negative battery cable.
Always replace a blown fuse with one of
the same rating.
If the replacement fuse blows, this
indicates an electrical problem. Avoid
using the system involved. Consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer immediately.
WARNING
Normal
Blown
OTM078035
NEVER replace a fuse with anything but
another fuse of the same rating.
ś A higher capacity fuse could cause
damage and possibly cause a fire.
ś Do not install a wire or aluminum
foil instead of the proper fuse even as a temporary repair. It may
cause extensive wiring damage and
possibly a fire.
NOTICE
Do not use a screwdriver or any other
metal object to remove fuses because
it may cause a short circuit and damage
the system.
9-47
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse
replacement
Driver’s side
OTMA090010
OTM090013
1.
2.
3.
4.
Turn the vehicle off.
Turn all other switches off.
Open the fuse panel cover.
Refer to the label on the inside of
the fuse panel cover to locate the
suspected fuse location.
9-48
5. Pull the suspected fuse straight out.
Use the removal tool (1) provided in
the engine compartment fuses panel
cover.
6. Check the removed fuse; replace it if
it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in
the instrument panel fuse panels (or in
the engine compartment fuse panel).
7. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly in
the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
In an emergency, if you do not have
a spare fuse, use a fuse of the same
rating from a circuit you may not need
for operating the vehicle, such as the
cigarette lighter fuse.
If the headlights or other electrical
components do not work and the fuses
are undamaged, check the fuse panel
in the engine compartment. If a fuse is
blown, it must be replaced with the same
rating.
09
Engine compartment panel fuse
replacement
Blade fuse / Cartridge fuse
Blade type fuse
NOTICE
After checking the fuse panel in the
engine compartment, securely install
the fuse panel cover. You may hear a
clicking sound if the cover is securely
latched. If it is not securely latched,
electrical failure may occur from water
contact.
Multi fuse
Multi type
OTMA090011
Cartridge type fuse
OTMA090013
If the multi fuse or midi fuse is blown,
consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OTMA090012
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches off.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tap and pulling up.
4. Check the removed fuse; replace it
if it is blown. To remove or insert the
fuse, use the fuse puller in the engine
compartment fuse panel.
5. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly in
the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-49
Maintenance
Fuse/relay panel description
Instrument panel fuse panel
Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle;
the information is accurate at the time of
printing. When you inspect the fuse box on
your vehicle, refer to the fuse box label.
OTM090019
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can
find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/
relay names and ratings.
OTMA090026
9-50
09
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Fuse
Rating
MODULE 4
7.5A
Data Link Connector, Stop Lamp Switch, Driver Area Unit
AIR BAG 1
15A
SRS Control Module, Passenger Occupant Detection Sensor
BRAKE SWITCH
7.5A
IBU, Stop Lamp Switch
MODULE 9
15A
Front A/C Control Module, Driver Door Area Unit, Power
Tailgate Module, Low DC-DC Converter, Rear Occupant
Alert (ROA) Sensor,
Driver IMS Control Module, Head-Up Display,
Driver/Passenger Power Outside Mirror
MODULE 10
10A
Blind-Spot Collision Warning Unit LH/RH, Front Wireless
Charger
AIR BAG IND.
10A
Overhead Console Assembly, Instrument Cluster
IBU 1
7.5A
IBU
MODULE 2
7.5A
AC Inverter Outlet, AC Inverter Module, Front Air Ventilation
Control Module,
Front Seat Warmer Control Module, 2nd Seat Warmer LH/
RH Control Module
MODULE 8
7.5A
Hazard Switch, Key Solenoid, Mood Lamp, Rain Sensor,
Mood Lamp Unit,
Mood Lamp #1/#2
S/HEATER FRT
20A
Data Link Connector, Front Air Ventilation Control Module,
Front Seat Warmer Control Module
Circuit Protected
AIR BAG 2
15A
SRS Control Module
E-SHIFTER1
10A
Electronic Shift Dial
E-SHIFTER2
7.5A
Electronic Shift Dial
MODULE 5
7.5A
Lane Departure Warning Unit, Crash Pad Switch, IBU,
Console Switch, 4WD ECM, Surround View Monitor Unit,
Upper Console Switch, Parking Collision Avoidance Assist
Unit
IBU 2
15A
IBU, Ignition Switch, BLE (Bluetooth Low Energy) Unit,
IAU (Identity Authentication Unit), Driver/Passenger Smart
Key Outside Handle
SUNROOF 2
20A
Panorama Sunroof
MODULE 1
7.5A
IBU, IAU (Identity Authentication Unit)
P/WINDOW RH
25A
Passenger Safety Power Window Module, Passenger Power
Window Switch, Rear Power Window Switch RH, Rear Safety
Power Window RH
9-51
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Fuse
Rating
Circuit Protected
ISG
15A
Low DC-DC Converter (AMP), Instrument Cluster, Front
A/C Control Module, A/V & Navigation Head Unit, Head Up
Display, Audio
RR SEAT(LH)
25A
2nd Seat Warmer LH Control Module, 2nd Seat LH Folding
Actuator
CLUSTER
7.5A
Instrument Cluster, Head Up Display
MDPS *
10A
MDPS Unit
A/C
7.5A
E/R Junction Block (Blower Relay, PTC Heater Relay)
CHILD LOCK
15A
ICM Relay Box (Child Lock/Unlock Relay)
DOOR LOCK
20A
Door Lock Relay, Door Unlock Relay, Tailgate Relay, Driver
Door Unlock Relay
SUNROOF 1
20A
Panorama Sunroof
P/WINDOW LH
25A
Driver Safety Power Window Module, Rear Power Window
Switch LH, Rear Safety Power Window LH
MODULE 3
7.5A
IBU
MODULE 6
7.5A
Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit, A/V & Navigation
Keyboard, Front A/C Control Module, Front Wireless
Charger, Electro Chromic Mirror, Low DC-DC Converter
WASHER
15A
Multifunction Switch
RR SEAT(RH)
25A
2nd Seat Warmer RH Control Module, 2nd Seat RH Folding
Actuator
WIPER RR
15A
Rear Wiper Relay, Rear Wiper Motor
AMP
25A
Low DC-DC Converter (With AMP)
ACC
7.5A
IBU, Front USB Charger, Low DC-DC Converter,
Rear USB Charger LH/RH, IAU (Identity Authentication
Unit)
P/SEAT (PASS)
30A
Passenger Seat Manual Switch
1
*1 :
30A
Driver IMS Control Module, Driver Seat Manual Switch
P/SEAT (DRV)
MDPS (Motor Driven Power Steering) is the same as EPS (Electric Power Steering)
9-52
09
Engine compartment fuse panel
(Engine room junction block)
Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle;
the information is accurate at the time of
printing. When you inspect the fuse panel
in your vehicle, refer to the fuse panel
label.
OTMA090014
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can
find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/
relay names and ratings.
OTMA090025
9-53
Maintenance
Engine compartment fuse panel (Engine room junction block)
Type
MULTI
FUSE 1
(10P)
Fuse Name
Fuse
Rating
COOLING FAN1
80A
[BLDC 600W] Cooling Fan Controller
COOLING FAN2
60A
[BLDC 400W] Cooling Fan Controller
B+4
50A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - MODULE8,
SUNROOF1, AMP, P/WINDOW RH, S/HEATER
DRV/PASS)
B+2
50A
ICU Junction Block (IPS 8 SPOC+/IPS 10/IPS 11/
IPS 13/IPS 14/IPS 15)
B+3
50A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - E-SHIFTER1, P/
SEAT (DRV, P/SEAT (PASS), P/WINDOW LH, RR
SEAT(LH))
BLOWER
40A
Blower Relay
IG2
40A
Start Relay, PCB Block (PDM (IG2) Relay)
ABS 2
30A
ESC Module
MDPS *
100A
MDPS Unit
ABS 3
60A
ESC Module
B+6
60A
PCB Block (B+)
TCM
1
MULTI
FUSE 2
(10P)
FUSE
*1 :
Circuit Protected
DCT
60A
E-CVVT1
50A
PCB Block (E-CVVT Relay)
REAR HEATED
40A
Rear Heated Relay
INVERTER
40A
AC Inverter Module
E-SHIFTER 1
40A
SCU
HEATED
MIRROR
10A
Rear Heated Relay, Driver/Passenger Outside
Mirror, Front A/C Control Module
E-CVVT3
20A
PCM, PCB Block (E-CVVT Relay)
E-CVVT2
20A
PCM, PCB Block (E-CVVT Relay)
A/C2
10A
Blower Relay, Front A/C Control Module
VACUUM
PUMP2
10A
ESC Module, Vacuum Pump Relay, Vacuum Pump
B+5
50A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - DOOR LOCK,
IBU1, IBU2, BRAKE SWITCH, CHILD LOCK, RR
SEAT(RH), SUNROOF2)
60A
[G4KP] Electronic Oil Pump
EOP2
MDPS (Motor Driven Power Steering) is the same as EPS (Electric Power Steering)
9-54
09
Engine compartment fuse panel (Engine room junction block)
Type
FUSE
Fuse Name
Fuse
Rating
B+1
50A
ICU Junction Block (IPS 1 SPOC+/IPS 2/IPS 3/IPS
5/IPS 6/IPS 7/Long Term Load Latch Relay, Short
Term Load Latch Relay)
PTC HEATER
50A
PTC Heater Relay
TRAILER3
30A
Trailer Module
POWER TAIL
GATE
30A
Power Tail Gate Unit
TRAILER2
30A
Trailer Module
FUEL PUMP
20A
Fuel Pump Relay
Circuit Protected
AMS
10A
Battery Sensor
VACUUM PUMP1
20A
Vacuum Pump Relay
4WD
20A
4WD ECM
E-SHIFTER2
10A
SCU
TRAILER1
30A
Trailer Module
9-55
Maintenance
Engine compartment fuse panel (PCB block)
Fuse Name
Fuse
Rating
Circuit Protected
IG1
40A
PDM (IG1) Relay
TCU2
10A
TCM
SENSOR3
20A
Injector #2/#4
SENSOR1
10A
Injector #1/#3
ECU3
10A
PCM
EOP3
10A
[G4KN] Electronic Oil Pump
POWER OUTLET1
20A
Luggage Power Outlet
WIPER2
10A
IBU, PCM
HORN
15A
Horn Relay
ABS4
10A
ESC Module
ECU2
20A
PCM
10A
[G4KN] Canister Close Valve, Cooling Fan Controller,
Variable Oil Pump Solenoid Valve, Purge Control Solenoid
Valve, Oil Control Valve, Variable Intake Solenoid Valve, A/
CON Relay
[G4KP] Canister Close Valve, Cooling Fan Controller,
Variable Oil Pump Solenoid Valve, Purge Control Solenoid
Valve, Oil Control Valve, RCV Control Solenoid Valve, A/CON
Relay
SENSOR2
SENSOR4
15A
Oxygen Sensor (Up/Down)
IGN COIL
20A
Ignition Coil #1/#2/#3/#4
ACC
20A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - ACC)
POWER
OUTLET2
20A
Front Power Outlet
WIPER FRT1
30A
Front Wiper Motor, Front Wiper (Low) Relay
E-SHIFTER3
10A
SCU
FCA
10A
Front Radar Unit
ECU1
15A
PCM
A/C1
10A
TCM
TCU1
20A
PCM
REAR
HEATED2
10A
E/R Junction Block (Rear Heated Relay)
9-56
09
LIGHT BULBS
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
to replace most vehicle light bulbs. It is
difficult to replace vehicle light bulbs
because other parts of the vehicle must
be removed before you can get to the
bulb. This is especially true for removing
the headlight assembly to get to the
bulb(s).
Removing/installing the headlight
assembly can result in damage to the
vehicle.
WARNING
ś Prior to working on a light, depress
the foot brake, shift to P (Park), apply
the parking brake, press the Engine
Start/Stop button to the OFF position
and take the key with you when
leaving the vehicle to avoid sudden
movement of the vehicle and to
prevent possible electric shock.
ś Be aware the bulbs may be hot and
may burn your fingers.
NOTICE
Be sure to replace the burned-out bulb
with one of the same wattage rating.
Otherwise, it may cause damage to the
fuse or electrical wiring system.
Information - Headlight
desiccant (if equipped)
This vehicle is equipped with desiccant to
reduce fogging inside the headlight due
to moisture. The desiccant is consumable
and its performance may change based on
the used period or environment. If fogging
inside the headlight due to moisture
continues for a long time, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
The headlight and tail lamp lenses could
appear frosty if the vehicle is washed after
driving or the vehicle is driven at night in
wet weather. This condition is caused by
temperature difference between the lamp
inside and outside and, it does not indicate
a problem with your vehicle. When
moisture condenses in the lamp, it will be
removed after driving with the headlight
on. The removable level may differ
depending on lamp size, lamp position
and environmental condition. However, if
moisture is not removed, have your vehicle
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
To prevent damage, do not clean the
headlight lens with chemical solvents
or strong detergents.
9-57
Maintenance
Information
ś A normally functioning lamp may
flicker momentarily to stabilize the
vehicle’s electrical control system.
However, if the lamp goes out after
flickering momentarily, or continues to
flicker, have the system be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś The position lamp may not turn on
when the position lamp switch is turned
on, but the position lamp and headlight
switch may turn on when the headlight
switch is turned on. This may be caused
by network failure or vehicle electrical
control system malfunction. If this
occurs, have the system be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
The headlight aiming should be adjusted
after an accident or after the headlight
assembly is reinstalled.
Information
Traffic Change (For Europe)
The low beam light distribution is
asymmetric. If you go abroad to a country
with opposite traffic direction, this
asymmetric part will dazzle oncoming car
driver. To prevent dazzle, ECE regulation
demand several technical solutions (ex.
automatic change system, adhesive
sheet, down aiming). This headlights are
designed not to dazzle opposite drivers. So,
you need not change your headlights in a
country with opposite traffic direction.
Headlight, position lamp, turn
signal lamp, Daytime Running
Light (DRL) replacement
Type A
OTMA090019
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Headlight (High)
Headlight (Low)
Daytime running light/Position light
Turn signal lamp
Side marker lamp
Turn signal lamp
1. Engage the parking brake and
disconnect the negative battery cable.
OTM090022
2. Remove wheel guard clips (under the
front bumper : 4 pieces).
9-58
09
Type B
OTM090035
3. Push the wheel guard aside and
remove the bulb socket by turning it
counterclockwise.
4. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
5. Install a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
6. Push the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
7. Install the wheel guard in the reverse
order.
OTMA090020
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Headlight (High)/Support Headlight
Headlight (Low)
Support Headlight
Daytime running light/Position light
Turn signal lamp
Side marker lamp
WARNING
Headlight (High/Low), Daytime running
light, position light (LED)
If the LED lamp does not operate, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OLMB073042L
ś Handle halogen bulbs with care.
Halogen bulbs contain pressurized
gas that will produce flying pieces
of glass that could cause injuries if
broken.
ś Wear eye protection when changing
a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down
before handling it.
9-59
Maintenance
ś Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids.
ś Never touch the glass with bare
hands. Residual oil may cause the
bulb to overheat and burst when lit.
ś A bulb should be operated only when
installed in a headlight.
ś If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately and
carefully dispose of it.
Lamps
If the LED lamp does not operate, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Side repeater lamp replacement
Rear combination lamp
replacement
Type A
OTMA090021
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Tail/Stop lamp
Tail lamp
Turn signal lamp
Reverse lamp
Side marker lamp
OTM090023
If the LED lamp (1) does not operate,
have the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
9-60
OTM090044
Stop/Tail lamp (Outside), Reverse lamp
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Open the liftgate.
3. Loosen the lamp assembly retaining
screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.
4. Remove the rear combination lamp
assembly from the body of the
vehicle.
5. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
09
OTM090045L
6. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
7. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
8. Install the socket into the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
9. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
OTMPH091013N
Tail lamp (Inside)
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Open the liftgate.
3. Remove the service cover using a
flat-blade screwdriver.
4. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
OTM090046
5. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
6. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
9-61
Maintenance
7. Install the socket into the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
8. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
Turn signal lamp
If these lamps do not operate, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Type B
OTMA090022
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Tail/Stop lamp
Stop lamp
Turn signal lamp
Reverse lamp
Side marker lamp
9-62
OTM090044
Reverse lamp
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Open the liftgate.
3. Loosen the lamp assembly retaining
screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.
4. Remove the rear combination lamp
assembly from the body of the
vehicle.
5. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
09
High mounted stop lamp
replacement
OTM090045L
6. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
7. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
8. Install the socket into the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
9. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
OTM090026
If the LED lamp (1) does not operate,
have the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
Tail / Stop lamp, Tail lamp, Turn signal
lamp
If these lamps do not operate, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
9-63
Maintenance
License plate lamp replacement
Interior light replacement
Map lamp (LED/Bulb type), Room
lamp (LED type)
Map lamp (LED type)
OTM090047
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver, gently
pry the lens cover from the lamp
housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
3. Install a new bulb.
4. Reinstall in the reverse order.
OTM050247L
Map lamp (Bulb type)
OTM050248L
Room lamp (Personnal lamp)
OTM078014
If the map lamp (LED/Bulb) (1) and the
room lamp (LED type) (1) do not operate,
have the system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-64
09
Room lamp, Sunvisor lamp, Glove box lamp and Luggage compartment lamp
(Bulb type)
Room lamp (Personnal lamp)
Sunvisor lamp
OTM090048
Glove box lamp
OTM090049
Luggage compartment lamp
OTM090030
1.
2.
3.
4.
OTMPH091014N
Using a flat-head screwdriver, gently pry the lens from the interior light housing.
Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out.
Install a new bulb into the socket.
Align the lens tabs with the interior light housing notches and snap the lens into
place.
NOTICE
Be careful not to damage the cover, tab, and plastic housing.
9-65
Maintenance
APPEARANCE CARE
NOTICE
If you park your vehicle near a stainless
steel sign or glass facade building, the
vehicle’s exterior plastic parts such
as a bumper, spoiler, garnish, lamp
or outside rearview mirror might be
damaged due to sunlight reflected from
the sign or building. To prevent damage
of the exterior plastic parts, you should
avoid parking in areas where light may
be reflected or use a car cover. (The
exterior plastic parts applied to your
vehicle may vary.)
Exterior care
Exterior general caution
It is very important to follow the label
directions when using any chemical
cleaner or polish. Read all warning and
caution statements that appear on the
label.
Finish maintenance
Washing
To help protect your vehicle’s finish from
rust and deterioration, wash it thoroughly
and frequently at least once a month
with lukewarm or cold water.
If you use your vehicle for off-road
driving, you should wash it after each
off-road trip. Pay special attention to the
removal of any accumulation of salt, dirt,
mud, and other foreign materials. Make
sure the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors and rocker panels are kept
clear and clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial pollution and similar deposits
can damage your vehicle’s finish if not
removed immediately.
Even prompt washing with plain water
may not completely remove all these
deposits. A mild soap, safe for use on
painted surfaces, should be used.
After washing, rinse the vehicle
thoroughly with lukewarm or cold water.
Do not allow soap to dry on the finish.
9-66
High-pressure washing
ś When using high-pressure washers,
make sure to maintain sufficient
distance from the vehicle.
Insufficient clearance or excessive
pressure can lead to component
damage or water penetration.
ś Do not spray the camera, sensors or
its surrounding area directly with a
high pressure washer. Shock applied
from high pressure water may cause
the device to not operate normally.
ś Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers) or
connectors as they may be damaged
if they come into contact with high
pressure water.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see
if they have been affected by water
before getting on the road. If braking
performance is impaired, dry the
brakes by applying them lightly while
maintaining a slow forward speed.
09
NOTICE
NOTICE
ś Do not use strong soap, chemical
detergents or hot water, and do not
wash the vehicle in direct sunlight
or when the body of the vehicle is
warm.
ś Be careful when washing the side
windows of your vehicle.
ś Especially, with high-pressure water,
water may leak through the windows
and wet the interior.
ś To prevent damage to the plastic
parts, do not clean with chemical
solvents or strong detergents.
NOTICE
OTM090031
ś Water washing in the engine
compartment including high
pressure water washing may cause
the failure of electrical circuits
located in the engine compartment.
ś Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)
Automatic car wash which uses rotating
brushes should not be used as this can
damage the surface of your vehicle. A
steam cleaner which washes the vehicle
surface at high temperature may result
the oil to adhere and leave stains that is
difficult to remove.
Use a soft cloth (for example, microfiber
towel or sponge) when washing your
vehicle and dry with a microfiber towel.
When you hand wash your vehicle, you
should not use a cleaner that finishes
with wax. If the vehicle surface is too
dirty (sand, dirt, dust, contaminant,
etc.), clean the surface with water
before washing the car.
Waxing
A good coat of wax is a barrier between
your paint and contaminate. Keeping
a good coat of wax on your vehicle will
help protect it.
Wax the vehicle when water will no
longer bead on the paint.
Always wash and dry the vehicle before
waxing. Use a good quality liquid or
paste wax, and follow the manufacturer’s
instructions. Wax all metal trim to protect
it and to maintain its luster.
Removing oil, tar, and similar materials
with a spot remover will usually strip the
wax from the finish. Be sure to re-wax
these areas even if the rest of the vehicle
does not yet need waxing.
9-67
Maintenance
NOTICE
ś Wiping dust or dirt off the body with
a dry cloth will scratch the finish.
ś Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or
caustic agents on chrome-plated or
anodized aluminum parts. This may
result in damage to the protective
coating and cause discoloration or
paint deterioration.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)
Do not use any polish protector such as
a detergent, an abrasive and a polish.
In case wax is applied, remove the wax
immediately using a silicon remover
and if any tar or tar contaminant is on
the surface use a tar remover to clean.
However, be careful not to apply too
much pressure on the painted area.
9-68
Finish damage repair
Deep scratches or stone chips in the
painted surface must be repaired
promptly. Exposed metal will quickly
rust and may develop into a major repair
expense.
NOTICE
If your vehicle is damaged and requires
any metal repair or replacement,
be sure the body shop applies anticorrosion materials to the parts
repaired or replaced.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)
In case of matte paint finish vehicles,
it is impossible to modify only the
damaged area and repair of the whole
part is necessary. If the vehicle is
damaged and painting is required, have
your vehicle maintained and repaired
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Take
extreme care, as it is difficult to restore
the quality after the repair.
09
Bright-metal maintenance
ś To remove road tar and insects, use
a tar remover, not a scraper or other
sharp object.
ś To protect the surfaces of bright metal
parts from corrosion, apply a coating
of wax or chrome preservative and rub
to a high luster.
ś During winter weather or in coastal
areas, cover the bright metal parts
with a heavier coating of wax or
preservative. If necessary, coat the
parts with non-corrosive petroleum
jelly or other protective compound.
Underbody maintenance
Corrosive materials used for ice and
snow removal and dust control may
collect on the underbody. If these
materials are not removed, accelerated
rusting can occur on underbody parts
such as the fuel lines, frame, floor pan
and exhaust system, even though they
have been treated with rust protection.
Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbody
and wheel openings with lukewarm or
cold water once a month, after off-road
driving and at the end of each winter. Pay
special attention to these areas because
it is difficult to see all the mud and dirt.
It will do more harm than good to wet
down the road grime without removing
it. The lower edges of doors, rocker
panels, and frame members have drain
holes that should not be allowed to clog
with dirt; trapped water in these areas
can cause rusting.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see if
they have been affected by water. If
braking performance is impaired, dry
the brakes by applying them lightly
while maintaining a slow forward
speed.
Aluminum wheel maintenance
The aluminum wheels are coated with a
clear protective finish.
ś Do not use abrasive cleaner, polishing
compound, solvent, or wire brushes
on aluminum wheels.
ś Clean the wheel when it has cooled.
ś Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly with
water. Also, clean the wheels after
driving on salted roads.
ś Do not wash the wheels with highspeed car wash brushes.
ś Do not use any cleaners containing
acid or alkaline detergents.
9-69
Maintenance
Corrosion protection
Protecting your vehicle from corrosion
By using the most advanced design
and construction practices to combat
corrosion, HYUNDAI produces vehicles
of the highest quality. However, this is
only part of the job. To achieve the longterm corrosion resistance your vehicle
can deliver, the owner’s cooperation and
assistance is also required.
Common causes of corrosion
The most common causes of corrosion
on your vehicle are:
ś Road salt, dirt and moisture that is
allowed to accumulate underneath
the vehicle.
ś Removal of paint or protective
coatings by stones, gravel, abrasion
or minor scrapes and dents which
leave unprotected metal exposed to
corrosion.
9-70
High-corrosion areas
If you live in an area where your vehicle is
regularly exposed to corrosive materials,
corrosion protection is particularly
important. Some of the common causes
of accelerated corrosion are road salts,
dust control chemicals, ocean air and
industrial pollution.
Moisture breeds corrosion
Moisture creates the conditions in
which corrosion is most likely to occur.
For example, corrosion is accelerated
by high humidity, particularly when
temperatures are just above freezing. In
such conditions, the corrosive material is
kept in contact with the vehicle surfaces
by moisture that is slow to evaporate.
Mud is particularly corrosive because
it is slow to dry and holds moisture in
contact with the vehicle. Although the
mud appears to be dry, it can still retain
moisture and promote corrosion.
High temperatures can also accelerate
corrosion of parts that are not properly
ventilated so the moisture can be
dispersed. For all these reasons, it is
particularly important to keep your
vehicle clean and free of mud or
accumulations of other materials. This
applies not only to the visible surfaces
but particularly to the underside of the
vehicle.
09
To help prevent corrosion
Keep your vehicle clean
The best way to prevent corrosion is
to keep your vehicle clean and free of
corrosive materials. Attention to the
underside of the vehicle is particularly
important.
ś If you live in a high-corrosion area —
where road salts are used, near the
ocean, areas with industrial pollution,
acid rain, etc.—, you should take extra
care to prevent corrosion. In winter,
hose off the underside of your vehicle
at least once a month and be sure to
clean the underside thoroughly when
winter is over.
ś When cleaning underneath the
vehicle, pay particular attention to the
components under the fenders and
other areas that are hidden from view.
Do a thorough job; just dampening
the accumulated mud rather than
washing it away will accelerate
corrosion rather than prevent it. Water
under high pressure and steam are
particularly effective in removing
accumulated mud and corrosive
materials.
ś When cleaning lower door panels,
rocker panels and frame members, be
sure that drain holes are kept open so
that moisture can escape and not be
trapped inside to accelerate corrosion.
Keep your garage dry
Don’t park your vehicle in a damp,
poorly ventilated garage. This creates
a favorable environment for corrosion.
This is particularly true if you wash your
vehicle in the garage or drive it into the
garage when it is still wet or covered with
snow, ice or mud. Even a heated garage
can contribute to corrosion unless it is
well ventilated so moisture is dispersed.
Keep paint and trim in good condition
Scratches or chips in the finish should
be covered with “touch-up” paint as
soon as possible to reduce the possibility
of corrosion. If bare metal is showing
through, the attention of a qualified body
and paint shop is recommended.
Bird droppings are highly corrosive and
may damage painted surfaces in just a
few hours. Always remove bird droppings
as soon as possible.
9-71
Maintenance
Interior general precautions
Cleaning the upholstery and interior
trim
Prevent caustic solutions such as
perfume and cosmetic oil, from
contacting the interior parts because
they may cause damage or discoloration.
If they do contact the interior parts,
wipe them off immediately. See the
instructions for the proper way to clean
vehicle interior surfaces.
Vehicle interior surfaces (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from interior
surfaces with a whisk broom or a vacuum
cleaner.
If necessary, clean interior surfaces with
a mixture of warm water and mild nondetergent cleaner (test all cleaners on a
concealed area before use).
Interior care
NOTICE
ś Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
ś When cleaning leather products
(steering wheel, seats etc.), use
neutral detergents or low alcohol
content solutions. If you use high
alcohol content solutions or acid/
alkaline detergents, the color of the
leather may fade or the surface may
get stripped off.
Fabric (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from
fabric with a whisk broom or vacuum
cleaner. Clean with a mild soap solution
recommended for upholstery or carpets.
Remove fresh spots immediately with
a fabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots do
not receive immediate attention, the
fabric can be stained and its color can be
affected. Also, its fire-resistant properties
can be reduced if the material is not
properly maintained.
NOTICE
Using anything but recommended
cleaners and procedures may affect the
fabric’s appearance and fire-resistant
properties.
9-72
09
Leather (if equipped)
ś Features of seat leather
- Leather is made from the outer skin
of an animal, which goes through a
special process to be available for
use. Since it is a natural product,
each part differs in thickness or
density.
Wrinkles may appear as a natural
result of stretching and shrinking
depending on the temperature and
humidity.
- The seat is made of stretchable
fabric to improve comfort.
- The parts contacting the body are
curved and the side supporting
area is high which provides driving
comfort and stability.
- Wrinkles may appear naturally
from usage. It is not a fault of the
products.
NOTICE
ś Wrinkles or abrasions which appear
naturally from usage are not covered
by warranty.
ś Belts with metallic accessories,
zippers or keys inside the back
pocket may damage the seat fabric.
ś Make sure not to wet the seat. It may
change the nature of natural leather.
ś Jeans or clothes which could bleach
may contaminate the surface of the
seat covering fabric.
ś Caring for the leather seats
- Vacuum the seat periodically to
remove dust and sand on the seat. It
will prevent abrasion or damage of
the leather and maintain its quality.
- Wipe the natural leather seat cover
often with dry or soft cloth.
- Use of proper leather protector may
prevent abrasion of the cover and
helps maintain the color. Be sure to
read the instructions and consult
a specialist when using leather
coating or protective agent.
- Light colored (beige, cream beige)
leather is easily contaminated and
the stain is noticeable. Clean the
seats frequently.
- Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may
cause the surface to crack.
ś Cleaning the leather seats
- Remove all contaminations
instantly. Refer to instructions below
for removal of each contaminant.
- Cosmetic products (sunscreen,
foundation, etc.)
Apply cleansing cream on a cloth
and wipe the contaminated spot.
Wipe off the cream with a wet cloth
and remove water with a dry cloth.
- Beverages (coffee, soft drink, etc.)
Apply a small amount of neutral
detergent and wipe until
contaminations do not smear.
9-73
Maintenance
- Oil
Remove oil instantly with
absorbable cloth and wipe with
stain remover used only for natural
leather.
- Chewing gum
Harden the gum with ice and
remove gradually.
ś Handling prime napa leather (if
equipped)
Try to avoid excessive sunlight and
heat exposure. Excessive sunlight
and heat exposure naturally fades
and dries out napa leather, causing
wrinkles and discoloration. If the napa
leather is wet with liquid, immediately
clean it with lint-free cloth to minimize
damage. Do not scratch the napa
leather surface with a sharp object.
If your napa leather seat is bright
colored, it may be contaminated or
stained from dyed materials such as
jeans.
ś Sharp objects (for example, driver,
knife), adhesive materials, or tapes
may damage the interior wooden trim.
ś Any strong impacts may damage the
interior wooden trim.
ś If the coating finish over the interior
wooden trim is removed, moisture
may damage or change wood traits.
ś If the interior wooden trim is
damaged, you may get a splinter
from the wood surface. Therefore,
you should immediately have the
damaged interior wooden trim
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Interior wooden trim
Cleaning the interior window glass
ś Use a wooden furniture protector (for
example, wax, coating compound) to
clean the interior wooden trim.
ś Often wipe the interior wooden
trim with a lint-free, clean cloth to
maintain the unique wooden textures
for a longer period of time.
ś If you spill beverage (for example,
water, coffee) over the interior
wooden trim, immediately wipe it with
clean, dry cloth.
If the interior glass surfaces of the
vehicle become fogged (that is, covered
with an oily, greasy or waxy film), they
should be cleaned with glass cleaner.
Follow the directions on the glass cleaner
container.
9-74
Cleaning the seat belt webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any
mild soap solution recommended for
cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow
the instructions provided with the soap.
Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing
because this may weaken the seat belt.
NOTICE
Do not scrape or scratch the inside of
the rear window. This may result in
damage to the rear window defroster
grid.
09
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
The emission control system of your
vehicle is covered by a written limited
warranty. Please see the warranty
information contained in the Owner’s
Handbook & Warranty Information
booklet in your vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emission control system to meet all
applicable emission regulations. There
are three emission control systems, as
follows.
1. Crankcase emission control
system
(1) Crankcase emission control system
(2) Evaporative emission control system
(3) Exhaust emission control system
2. Evaporative Emission Control
System Including Onboard
Refueling Vapor Recovery
(ORVR)
In order to ensure the proper function
of the emission control systems, it
is recommended that you have your
vehicle inspected and maintained
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer in
accordance with the maintenance
schedule in this manual.
The Evaporative Emission Control System
is designed to prevent fuel vapors from
escaping into the atmosphere. The
ORVR system is designed to allow the
vapors from the fuel tank to be loaded
into a canister while refueling at the gas
station, preventing the escape of fuel
vapors into the atmosphere.
The positive crankcase ventilation system
is employed to prevent air pollution
caused by blow-by gases being emitted
from the crankcase. This system supplies
fresh filtered air to the crankcase through
the air intake hose. Inside the crankcase,
the fresh air mixes with blow-by gases,
which then pass through the PCV valve
into the induction system.
NOTICE
For the Inspection and Maintenance
Test (with Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system)
ś To prevent the vehicle from misfiring
during dynamometer testing, turn
the Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system off by pressing the ESC
switch (ESC OFF light illuminated).
ś After dynamometer testing is
completed, turn the ESC system back
on by pressing the ESC switch again.
Canister
Fuel vapors generated inside the fuel
tank are absorbed and stored in the
onboard canister. When the engine is
running, the fuel vapors absorbed in the
canister are drawn into the surge tank
through the purge control solenoid valve.
Purge Control Solenoid Valve (PCSV)
The purge control solenoid valve
is controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM); when the engine coolant
temperature is low during idling, the
PCSV closes so that evaporated fuel
is not taken into the engine. After the
engine warms-up during ordinary
driving, the PCSV opens to introduce
evaporated fuel to the engine.
9-75
Maintenance
3. Exhaust emission control
system
The Exhaust Emission Control System is
a highly effective system which controls
exhaust emissions while maintaining
good vehicle performance.
When the engine starts or fails to start,
excessive attempts to restart the engine
may cause damage to the emission
system.
Engine exhaust (carbon monoxide)
precautions
ś Carbon monoxide can be present
with other exhaust fumes. If you smell
exhaust fumes of any kind in your
vehicle, drive with all the windows
fully open. Have your vehicle checked
and repaired immediately.
WARNING
Engine exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide (CO). Though colorless and
odorless, it is dangerous and could be
lethal if inhaled. Follow the instructions
on this page to avoid CO poisoning.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Engine exhaust and a wide variety of
automobile components and parts,
including components found in the
interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain
or emit chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and
birth defects and reproductive harm.
In addition, certain fluids contained
in vehicles and certain products of
component wear contain or emit
chemicals known to the State of
California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm.
9-76
ś Do not operate the engine in confined
or closed areas (such as garages) any
more than what is necessary to move
the vehicle in or out of the area.
ś When the vehicle is stopped in an
open area for more than a short time
with the engine running, adjust the
ventilation system (as needed) to draw
outside air into the vehicle.
ś Never sit in a parked or stopped
vehicle for any extended time with the
engine running.
ś When the engine stalls or fails to
start, excessive attempts to restart
the engine may cause damage to the
emission control system.
Operating precautions for catalytic
converters (if equipped)
WARNING
The exhaust system and catalytic
system are very hot while the engine is
running or immediately after the engine
is turned off. To avoid SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ś Do not park, idle, or drive the vehicle
over or near flammable objects, such
as grass, vegetation, paper, leaves,
etc. A hot exhaust system can ignite
flammable items under your vehicle.
ś Keep away from the exhaust system
and catalytic converter or you may
get burned.
Also, do not remove the heat sink
around the exhaust system, do not
seal the bottom of the vehicle, and
do not coat the vehicle for corrosion
control. It may present a fire risk
under certain conditions.
09
Your vehicle is equipped with a catalytic
converter emission control device.
To prevent damage to the catalytic
converter and to your vehicle, take the
following precautions:
ś Use only UNLEADED FUEL for
gasoline engines.
ś Do not operate the vehicle when
there are signs of engine malfunction,
such as misfire or a noticeable loss of
performance.
ś Do not misuse or abuse the engine.
Examples of misuse are coasting with
the engine off and descending steep
grades in gear with the engine off.
ś Do not operate the engine at high
idle speed for extended periods (5
minutes or more).
ś Do not modify or tamper with any
part of the engine or emission
control system. Have all inspections
and adjustments are made by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level.
Running out of fuel could cause the
engine to misfire, damaging the
catalytic converter.
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)
(if equipped)
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF) system
removes the soot in the exhaust gas.
The GPF system automatically burns
(or oxidizes) the accumulated soot in
accordance with driving situations,
unlike a disposable air filter.
In other words, the accumulated soot is
automatically purged out by the engine
control system and by the high exhaustgas temperature at normal/ high driving
speeds. However, when the vehicle is
continually driven at repeated short
distances or driven at low speed for a
long time, the accumulated soot may
not be automatically removed because
of low exhaust gas temperature. In this
case, the accumulated soot may reach
a certain amount regardless of the soot
oxidization process, then the GPF lamp
) will illuminate.
(
The Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)
lamp stops illuminating, when the
driving speed exceeds 50 mph (80 km/h)
with engine rpm 1,500 ~ 4,000 and the
gear in the 3rd position or above for
approximately 30 minutes.
When the GPF lamp starts to blink or
the warning message “Check exhaust
system” pops up even though the vehicle
was driven as mentioned above, have the
GPF system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
With GPF lamp blinking for an extended
period of time, it may damage the GPF
system and lower the fuel economy.
CAUTION
We recommend you to use only the
regulated gasoline fuels, when your
vehicle is equipped with the GPF
system.
When you use other gasoline fuels
which contain unspecified additives,
they may damage the GPF system and
cause exhaust emission problems.
9-77
Maintenance
CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE NOTICE
Perchlorate Material-special handling may apply, See: https://dtsc.ca.gov/perchlorate.
Notice to California Vehicle Dismantlers: Perchlorate containing materials, such as
air bag inflators, seatbelt pretensioners and keyless remote entry batteries, must be
disposed of according to Title 22 California Code of Regulations Section 67384.10 (a).
9-78